Document the 'info proc files' command.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
550 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
551 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
552 Stafford Horne.
553
554 @node Sample Session
555 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
556
557 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
558 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
559 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
560
561 @iftex
562 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
563 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
564 @end iftex
565
566 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
567 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
568
569 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
570 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
571 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
572 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
573 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
574 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
575 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
576 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
577 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
578
579 @smallexample
580 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
581 $ @b{./m4}
582 @b{define(foo,0000)}
583
584 @b{foo}
585 0000
586 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
587
588 @b{bar}
589 0000
590 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
591
592 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
593 @b{baz}
594 @b{Ctrl-d}
595 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
596 @end smallexample
597
598 @noindent
599 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
600
601 @smallexample
602 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
603 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
604 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
605 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
606 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
607 the conditions.
608 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
609 for details.
610
611 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
612 (@value{GDBP})
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
617 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
618 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
619 that examples fit in this manual.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
623 @end smallexample
624
625 @noindent
626 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
627 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
628 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
629 @code{break} command.
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
633 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
634 @end smallexample
635
636 @noindent
637 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
638 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
639 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
640
641 @smallexample
642 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
643 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
644 @b{define(foo,0000)}
645
646 @b{foo}
647 0000
648 @end smallexample
649
650 @noindent
651 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
652 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
653 context where it stops.
654
655 @smallexample
656 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
657
658 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
659 at builtin.c:879
660 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
665 the next line of the current function.
666
667 @smallexample
668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
669 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
670 : nil,
671 @end smallexample
672
673 @noindent
674 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
675 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
676 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
677 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
678
679 @smallexample
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
681 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
682 at input.c:530
683 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
684 @end smallexample
685
686 @noindent
687 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
688 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
689 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
690 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
691 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
692 stack frame for each active subroutine.
693
694 @smallexample
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
696 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
697 at input.c:530
698 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
699 at builtin.c:882
700 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
701 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
702 at macro.c:71
703 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
704 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
709 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
710 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
711
712 @smallexample
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
714 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
716 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
717 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
719 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
720 : xstrdup(rq);
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
722 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
723 @end smallexample
724
725 @noindent
726 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
727 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
728 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
729 (@code{print}) to see their values.
730
731 @smallexample
732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
733 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
735 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
736 @end smallexample
737
738 @noindent
739 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
740 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
741 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
742
743 @smallexample
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
745 533 xfree(rquote);
746 534
747 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
748 : xstrdup (lq);
749 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
750 : xstrdup (rq);
751 537
752 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
753 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
754 540 @}
755 541
756 542 void
757 @end smallexample
758
759 @noindent
760 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
761 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
762
763 @smallexample
764 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
765 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
766 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
767 540 @}
768 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
769 $3 = 9
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
771 $4 = 7
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
776 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
777 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
778 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
779 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
780 assignments.
781
782 @smallexample
783 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
784 $5 = 7
785 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
786 $6 = 9
787 @end smallexample
788
789 @noindent
790 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
791 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
792 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
793 example that caused trouble initially:
794
795 @smallexample
796 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
797 Continuing.
798
799 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
800
801 baz
802 0000
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
807 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
808 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
809
810 @smallexample
811 @b{Ctrl-d}
812 Program exited normally.
813 @end smallexample
814
815 @noindent
816 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
817 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
818 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
819
820 @smallexample
821 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
822 @end smallexample
823
824 @node Invocation
825 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
826
827 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
828 The essentials are:
829 @itemize @bullet
830 @item
831 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
832 @item
833 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
834 @end itemize
835
836 @menu
837 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
838 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
839 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
840 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
841 @end menu
842
843 @node Invoking GDB
844 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
845
846 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
847 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
848
849 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
850 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
851
852 The command-line options described here are designed
853 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
854 options may effectively be unavailable.
855
856 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
857 specifying an executable program:
858
859 @smallexample
860 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
861 @end smallexample
862
863 @noindent
864 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
865 specified:
866
867 @smallexample
868 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
869 @end smallexample
870
871 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
872 to debug a running process:
873
874 @smallexample
875 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
876 @end smallexample
877
878 @noindent
879 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
880 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
881
882 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
883 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
884 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
885 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
886 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
887
888 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
889 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
890 option processing.
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
893 @end smallexample
894 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
895 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
896
897 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
898 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
899 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
900
901 @smallexample
902 @value{GDBP} --silent
903 @end smallexample
904
905 @noindent
906 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
907 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
908
909 @noindent
910 Type
911
912 @smallexample
913 @value{GDBP} -help
914 @end smallexample
915
916 @noindent
917 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
918 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
919
920 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
921 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
922 @samp{-x} option is used.
923
924
925 @menu
926 * File Options:: Choosing files
927 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
928 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
929 @end menu
930
931 @node File Options
932 @subsection Choosing Files
933
934 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
935 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
936 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
937 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
938 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
939 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
940 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
941 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
942 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
943 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
944 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
945 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
946 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
947
948 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
949 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
950 argument and ignore it.
951
952 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
953 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
954 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
955 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
956 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
957
958 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
959 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
960 @c it.
961
962 @table @code
963 @item -symbols @var{file}
964 @itemx -s @var{file}
965 @cindex @code{--symbols}
966 @cindex @code{-s}
967 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
968
969 @item -exec @var{file}
970 @itemx -e @var{file}
971 @cindex @code{--exec}
972 @cindex @code{-e}
973 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
974 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
975
976 @item -se @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--se}
978 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
979 file.
980
981 @item -core @var{file}
982 @itemx -c @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--core}
984 @cindex @code{-c}
985 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
986
987 @item -pid @var{number}
988 @itemx -p @var{number}
989 @cindex @code{--pid}
990 @cindex @code{-p}
991 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
992
993 @item -command @var{file}
994 @itemx -x @var{file}
995 @cindex @code{--command}
996 @cindex @code{-x}
997 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
998 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
999 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1000
1001 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1002 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1003 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1004 @cindex @code{-ex}
1005 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1006
1007 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1008 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1009
1010 @smallexample
1011 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1012 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1013 @end smallexample
1014
1015 @item -init-command @var{file}
1016 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1017 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1018 @cindex @code{-ix}
1019 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1020 after loading gdbinit files).
1021 @xref{Startup}.
1022
1023 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1024 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1025 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1026 @cindex @code{-iex}
1027 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1028 after loading gdbinit files).
1029 @xref{Startup}.
1030
1031 @item -directory @var{directory}
1032 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1033 @cindex @code{--directory}
1034 @cindex @code{-d}
1035 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1036
1037 @item -r
1038 @itemx -readnow
1039 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1040 @cindex @code{-r}
1041 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1042 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1043 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1044
1045 @item --readnever
1046 @anchor{--readnever}
1047 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1048 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1049 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1050 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1051 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1052 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1053 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1054 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1055 @end table
1056
1057 @node Mode Options
1058 @subsection Choosing Modes
1059
1060 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1061 batch mode or quiet mode.
1062
1063 @table @code
1064 @anchor{-nx}
1065 @item -nx
1066 @itemx -n
1067 @cindex @code{--nx}
1068 @cindex @code{-n}
1069 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1070 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1071
1072 @table @code
1073 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1074 This is the system-wide init file.
1075 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1076 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1077 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1078 have been processed.
1079 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1080 This is the init file in your home directory.
1081 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1082 command options have been processed.
1083 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1084 This is the init file in the current directory.
1085 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1086 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1087 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1088 @end table
1089
1090 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1091 For documentation on how to write command files,
1092 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1093
1094 @anchor{-nh}
1095 @item -nh
1096 @cindex @code{--nh}
1097 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1098 in your home directory.
1099 @xref{Startup}.
1100
1101 @item -quiet
1102 @itemx -silent
1103 @itemx -q
1104 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1105 @cindex @code{--silent}
1106 @cindex @code{-q}
1107 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1108 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1109
1110 @item -batch
1111 @cindex @code{--batch}
1112 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1113 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1114 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1115 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1116 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1117 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1118 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1119
1120 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1121 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1122 make this more useful, the message
1123
1124 @smallexample
1125 Program exited normally.
1126 @end smallexample
1127
1128 @noindent
1129 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1130 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1131 mode.
1132
1133 @item -batch-silent
1134 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1135 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1136 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1137 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1138 for an interactive session.
1139
1140 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1141 messages, for example.
1142
1143 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1144 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1145
1146 @item -return-child-result
1147 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1148 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1149 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1150
1151 @itemize @bullet
1152 @item
1153 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1154 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1155 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1156 @item
1157 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1158 @item
1159 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1160 the exit code will be -1.
1161 @end itemize
1162
1163 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1164 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1165 interface.
1166
1167 @item -nowindows
1168 @itemx -nw
1169 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1170 @cindex @code{-nw}
1171 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1172 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1173 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1174
1175 @item -windows
1176 @itemx -w
1177 @cindex @code{--windows}
1178 @cindex @code{-w}
1179 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1180 used if possible.
1181
1182 @item -cd @var{directory}
1183 @cindex @code{--cd}
1184 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1185 instead of the current directory.
1186
1187 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1188 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1189 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1190 @cindex @code{-D}
1191 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1192 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1193 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1194
1195 @item -fullname
1196 @itemx -f
1197 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1198 @cindex @code{-f}
1199 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1200 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1201 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1202 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1203 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1204 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1205 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1206 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1207 frame.
1208
1209 @item -annotate @var{level}
1210 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1211 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1212 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1213 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1214 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1215 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1216 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1217 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1218 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1219
1220 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1221 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1222
1223 @item --args
1224 @cindex @code{--args}
1225 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1226 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1227 This option stops option processing.
1228
1229 @item -baud @var{bps}
1230 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1231 @cindex @code{--baud}
1232 @cindex @code{-b}
1233 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1234 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1235
1236 @item -l @var{timeout}
1237 @cindex @code{-l}
1238 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1239 for remote debugging.
1240
1241 @item -tty @var{device}
1242 @itemx -t @var{device}
1243 @cindex @code{--tty}
1244 @cindex @code{-t}
1245 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1246 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1247
1248 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1249 @item -tui
1250 @cindex @code{--tui}
1251 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1252 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1253 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1254 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1255 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1256 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1257
1258 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1259 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1260 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1261 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1262 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1263 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1264
1265 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1266 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1267 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1268 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1269 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1270 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1271
1272 @item -write
1273 @cindex @code{--write}
1274 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1275 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1276 (@pxref{Patching}).
1277
1278 @item -statistics
1279 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1280 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1281 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1282
1283 @item -version
1284 @cindex @code{--version}
1285 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1286 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1287
1288 @item -configuration
1289 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1290 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1291 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1292 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1293
1294 @end table
1295
1296 @node Startup
1297 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1298 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1299
1300 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1301
1302 @enumerate
1303 @item
1304 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1305 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1306
1307 @item
1308 @cindex init file
1309 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1310 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1311 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1312 that file.
1313
1314 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1315 @item
1316 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1317 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1318 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1319 that file.
1320
1321 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1322 @item
1323 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1324 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1325 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1326 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1327 gets loaded.
1328
1329 @item
1330 Processes command line options and operands.
1331
1332 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1333 @item
1334 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1335 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1336 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1337 This is only done if the current directory is
1338 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1339 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1340 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1341 @value{GDBN}.
1342
1343 @item
1344 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1345 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1346 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1347 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1348
1349 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1350 you must do something like the following:
1351
1352 @smallexample
1353 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1354 @end smallexample
1355
1356 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1357 off too late.
1358
1359 @item
1360 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1361 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1362 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1363
1364 @item
1365 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1366 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1367 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1368 @end enumerate
1369
1370 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1371 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1372 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1373 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1374 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1375 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1376
1377 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1378 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1379
1380 @cindex init file name
1381 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1382 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1383 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1384 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1385 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1386 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1387 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1388 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1389
1390
1391 @node Quitting GDB
1392 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1393 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1394 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1395
1396 @table @code
1397 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1398 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1399 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1400 @itemx q
1401 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1402 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1403 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1404 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1405 error code.
1406 @end table
1407
1408 @cindex interrupt
1409 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1410 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1411 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1412 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1413 until a time when it is safe.
1414
1415 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1416 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1417 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1418
1419 @node Shell Commands
1420 @section Shell Commands
1421
1422 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1423 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1424 just use the @code{shell} command.
1425
1426 @table @code
1427 @kindex shell
1428 @kindex !
1429 @cindex shell escape
1430 @item shell @var{command-string}
1431 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1432 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1433 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1434 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1435 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1436 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1437 @end table
1438
1439 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1440 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1441 @value{GDBN}:
1442
1443 @table @code
1444 @kindex make
1445 @cindex calling make
1446 @item make @var{make-args}
1447 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1448 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1449 @end table
1450
1451 @node Logging Output
1452 @section Logging Output
1453 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1454 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1455
1456 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1457 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1458
1459 @table @code
1460 @kindex set logging
1461 @item set logging on
1462 Enable logging.
1463 @item set logging off
1464 Disable logging.
1465 @cindex logging file name
1466 @item set logging file @var{file}
1467 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1468 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1469 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1470 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1471 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1472 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1473 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1474 @kindex show logging
1475 @item show logging
1476 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1477 @end table
1478
1479 @node Commands
1480 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1481
1482 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1483 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1484 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1485 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1486 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1487
1488 @menu
1489 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1490 * Completion:: Command completion
1491 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1492 @end menu
1493
1494 @node Command Syntax
1495 @section Command Syntax
1496
1497 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1498 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1499 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1500 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1501 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1502 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1503
1504 @cindex abbreviation
1505 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1506 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1507 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1508 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1509 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1510 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1511 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1512
1513 @cindex repeating commands
1514 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1515 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1516 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1517 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1518 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1519 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1520 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1521
1522 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1523 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1524 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1525
1526 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1527 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1528 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1529 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1530 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1531
1532 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1533 @cindex comment
1534 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1535 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1536 Files,,Command Files}).
1537
1538 @cindex repeating command sequences
1539 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1540 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1541 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1542 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1543 for editing.
1544
1545 @node Completion
1546 @section Command Completion
1547
1548 @cindex completion
1549 @cindex word completion
1550 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1551 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1552 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1553 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1554
1555 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1556 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1557 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1558 enter it). For example, if you type
1559
1560 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1561 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1562 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1563 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1564 @smallexample
1565 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1566 @end smallexample
1567
1568 @noindent
1569 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1570 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1571
1572 @smallexample
1573 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1574 @end smallexample
1575
1576 @noindent
1577 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1578 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1579 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1580 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1581 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1582 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1583
1584 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1585 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1586 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1587 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1588 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1589 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1590 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1591 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1592 example:
1593
1594 @smallexample
1595 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1596 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1597 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1598 make_abs_section make_function_type
1599 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1600 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1601 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1602 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @noindent
1606 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1607 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1608 command.
1609
1610 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1611 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1612 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1613 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1614 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1615
1616 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1617 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1618 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1622 main
1623 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1624 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1625 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1626 @end smallexample
1627
1628 @noindent
1629 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1630
1631 @table @code
1632 @kindex set max-completions
1633 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1634 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1635 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1636 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1637 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1638 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1639 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1640 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1641 completion slow.
1642 @kindex show max-completions
1643 @item show max-completions
1644 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1645 during completion.
1646 @end table
1647
1648 @cindex quotes in commands
1649 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1650 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1651 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1652 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1653 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1654 @value{GDBN} commands.
1655
1656 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1657 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1658 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1659 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1660 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1661 Operators}).
1662
1663 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1664 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1665 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1666 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1667 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1668 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1669 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1670 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1671 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1672
1673 @smallexample
1674 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1675 func<int>() func<float>()
1676 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1677 @end smallexample
1678
1679 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1680 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1681 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1682 function:
1683
1684 @smallexample
1685 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1686 func<int>() func<float>()
1687 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1688 @end smallexample
1689
1690 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1691 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1692 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1693 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1694 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1695 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1696
1697 @smallexample
1698 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1699 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1700 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1701 bubble(double)
1702 @end smallexample
1703
1704 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1705 require quoting.
1706
1707 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1708 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1709 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1710 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1711
1712 @cindex completion of structure field names
1713 @cindex structure field name completion
1714 @cindex completion of union field names
1715 @cindex union field name completion
1716 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1717 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1718 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1719 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1720 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1721 left-hand-side:
1722
1723 @smallexample
1724 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1725 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1726 to_data to_isatty to_write
1727 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1728 to_flush to_read
1729 @end smallexample
1730
1731 @noindent
1732 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1733 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1734 follows:
1735
1736 @smallexample
1737 struct ui_file
1738 @{
1739 int *magic;
1740 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1741 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1742 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1743 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1744 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1745 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1746 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1747 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1748 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1749 void *to_data;
1750 @}
1751 @end smallexample
1752
1753
1754 @node Help
1755 @section Getting Help
1756 @cindex online documentation
1757 @kindex help
1758
1759 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1760 using the command @code{help}.
1761
1762 @table @code
1763 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1764 @item help
1765 @itemx h
1766 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1767 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1768
1769 @smallexample
1770 (@value{GDBP}) help
1771 List of classes of commands:
1772
1773 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1774 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1775 data -- Examining data
1776 files -- Specifying and examining files
1777 internals -- Maintenance commands
1778 obscure -- Obscure features
1779 running -- Running the program
1780 stack -- Examining the stack
1781 status -- Status inquiries
1782 support -- Support facilities
1783 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1784 stopping the program
1785 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1786
1787 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1788 commands in that class.
1789 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1790 documentation.
1791 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1792 (@value{GDBP})
1793 @end smallexample
1794 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1795
1796 @item help @var{class}
1797 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1798 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1799 help display for the class @code{status}:
1800
1801 @smallexample
1802 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1803 Status inquiries.
1804
1805 List of commands:
1806
1807 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1808 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1809 info -- Generic command for showing things
1810 about the program being debugged
1811 show -- Generic command for showing things
1812 about the debugger
1813
1814 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1815 documentation.
1816 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1817 (@value{GDBP})
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @item help @var{command}
1821 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1822 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1823
1824 @kindex apropos
1825 @item apropos @var{args}
1826 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1827 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1828 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1829
1830 @smallexample
1831 apropos alias
1832 @end smallexample
1833
1834 @noindent
1835 results in:
1836
1837 @smallexample
1838 @c @group
1839 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1840 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1841 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1842 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1843 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1844 @c @end group
1845 @end smallexample
1846
1847 @kindex complete
1848 @item complete @var{args}
1849 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1850 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1851 command you want completed. For example:
1852
1853 @smallexample
1854 complete i
1855 @end smallexample
1856
1857 @noindent results in:
1858
1859 @smallexample
1860 @group
1861 if
1862 ignore
1863 info
1864 inspect
1865 @end group
1866 @end smallexample
1867
1868 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1869 @end table
1870
1871 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1872 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1873 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1874 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1875 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1876 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1877 Index}.
1878
1879 @c @group
1880 @table @code
1881 @kindex info
1882 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1883 @item info
1884 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1885 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1886 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1887 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1888 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1889 @w{@code{help info}}.
1890
1891 @kindex set
1892 @item set
1893 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1894 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1895 @code{set prompt $}.
1896
1897 @kindex show
1898 @item show
1899 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1900 @value{GDBN} itself.
1901 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1902 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1903 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1904 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1905
1906 @kindex info set
1907 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1908 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1909 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1910 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1911 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1912 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1913 @end table
1914 @c @end group
1915
1916 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1917 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1918
1919 @table @code
1920 @kindex show version
1921 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1922 @item show version
1923 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1924 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1925 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1926 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1927 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1928 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1929 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1930 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1931 @value{GDBN}.
1932
1933 @kindex show copying
1934 @kindex info copying
1935 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1936 @item show copying
1937 @itemx info copying
1938 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1939
1940 @kindex show warranty
1941 @kindex info warranty
1942 @item show warranty
1943 @itemx info warranty
1944 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1945 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1946
1947 @kindex show configuration
1948 @item show configuration
1949 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1950 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1951 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1952 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1953 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1954 your report.
1955
1956 @end table
1957
1958 @node Running
1959 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1960
1961 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1962 debugging information when you compile it.
1963
1964 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1965 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1966 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1967 kill a child process.
1968
1969 @menu
1970 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1971 * Starting:: Starting your program
1972 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1973 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1974
1975 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1976 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1977 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1978 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1979
1980 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1981 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1982 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1983 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1984 @end menu
1985
1986 @node Compilation
1987 @section Compiling for Debugging
1988
1989 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1990 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1991 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1992 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1993 and addresses in the executable code.
1994
1995 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1996 the compiler.
1997
1998 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1999 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2000 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2001 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2002 executables containing debugging information.
2003
2004 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2005 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2006 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2007 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2008 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2009
2010 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2011 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2012 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2013
2014 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2015 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2016 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2017 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2018 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2019 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2020
2021 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2022 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2023 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2024
2025 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2026 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2027 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2028 format in @value{GDBN}.
2029
2030 @need 2000
2031 @node Starting
2032 @section Starting your Program
2033 @cindex starting
2034 @cindex running
2035
2036 @table @code
2037 @kindex run
2038 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2039 @item run
2040 @itemx r
2041 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2042 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2043 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2044 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2045 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2046
2047 @end table
2048
2049 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2050 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2051 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2052 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2053 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2054 message like this one:
2055
2056 @smallexample
2057 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2058 Try "help target" or "continue".
2059 @end smallexample
2060
2061 @noindent
2062 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2063 first (@pxref{load}).
2064
2065 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2066 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2067 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2068 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2069 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2070 divided into four categories:
2071
2072 @table @asis
2073 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2074 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2075 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2076 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2077 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2078 the arguments.
2079 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2080 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2081 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2082 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2083 below for details).
2084
2085 @item The @emph{environment.}
2086 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2087 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2088 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2089 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2090
2091 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2092 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2093 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2094 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2095 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2096 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2097 Directory}.
2098
2099 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2100 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2101 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2102 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2103 set a different device for your program.
2104 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2105
2106 @cindex pipes
2107 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2108 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2109 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2110 wrong program.
2111 @end table
2112
2113 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2114 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2115 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2116 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2117 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2118
2119 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2120 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2121 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2122 your current breakpoints.
2123
2124 @table @code
2125 @kindex start
2126 @item start
2127 @cindex run to main procedure
2128 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2129 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2130 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2131 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2132 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2133 procedure, depending on the language used.
2134
2135 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2136 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2137 the @samp{run} command.
2138
2139 @cindex elaboration phase
2140 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2141 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2142 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2143 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2144 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2145 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2146 will remain to halt execution.
2147
2148 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2149 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2150 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2151 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2152 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2153
2154 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2155 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2156 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2157 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2158 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2159 use the @code{starti} command.
2160
2161 @kindex starti
2162 @item starti
2163 @cindex run to first instruction
2164 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2165 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2166 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2167 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2168 the start of the elaboration phase.
2169
2170 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2171 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2172 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2173 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2174 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2175 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2176 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2177 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2178 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2179 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2180 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2181 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2182
2183 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2184 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2185 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2186 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2187
2188 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2189 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2190 environment:
2191
2192 @smallexample
2193 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2194 (@value{GDBP}) run
2195 @end smallexample
2196
2197 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2198 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2199
2200 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2201 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2202 @item set startup-with-shell
2203 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2204 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2205 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2206 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2207 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2208 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2209 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2210 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2211 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2212 startup failures such as:
2213
2214 @smallexample
2215 (@value{GDBP}) run
2216 Starting program: ./a.out
2217 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2218 @end smallexample
2219
2220 @noindent
2221 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2222 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2223 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2224 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2225 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2226 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2227
2228 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2229 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2230 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2231 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2232 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2233 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2234
2235 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2236 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2237 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2238 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2239 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2240 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2241
2242 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2243 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2244 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2245
2246 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2247 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2248
2249 @smallexample
2250 (@value{GDBP}) run
2251 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2252 @end smallexample
2253
2254 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2255 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2256
2257 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2258 @code{target native} command. For example,
2259
2260 @smallexample
2261 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2262 (@value{GDBP}) run
2263 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2264 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2265 (@value{GDBP}) run
2266 Starting program: ./a.out
2267 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2268 @end smallexample
2269
2270 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2271 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2272 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2273 disconnect.
2274
2275 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2276 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2277 proc}, @code{info os}.
2278
2279 @kindex set disable-randomization
2280 @item set disable-randomization
2281 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2282 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2283 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2284 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2285 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2286
2287 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2288 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2289
2290 @smallexample
2291 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2292 @end smallexample
2293
2294 @item set disable-randomization off
2295 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2296 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2297 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2298 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2299 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2300 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2301
2302 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2303 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2304 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2305 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2306 a code at its expected addresses.
2307
2308 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2309 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2310 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2311 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2312 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2313 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2314 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2315 a randomly chosen address.
2316
2317 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2318 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2319 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2320 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2321 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2322
2323 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2324 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2325
2326 @item show disable-randomization
2327 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2328 the virtual address space of the started program.
2329
2330 @end table
2331
2332 @node Arguments
2333 @section Your Program's Arguments
2334
2335 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2336 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2337 @code{run} command.
2338 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2339 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2340 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2341 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2342 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2343
2344 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2345 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2346 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2347 the program, not by the shell.
2348
2349 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2350 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2351
2352 @table @code
2353 @kindex set args
2354 @item set args
2355 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2356 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2357 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2358 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2359 it again without arguments.
2360
2361 @kindex show args
2362 @item show args
2363 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2364 @end table
2365
2366 @node Environment
2367 @section Your Program's Environment
2368
2369 @cindex environment (of your program)
2370 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2371 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2372 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2373 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2374 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2375 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2376 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2377
2378 @table @code
2379 @kindex path
2380 @item path @var{directory}
2381 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2382 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2383 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2384 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2385 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2386 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2387 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2388
2389 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2390 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2391 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2392 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2393 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2394 @var{directory} to the search path.
2395 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2396 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2397
2398 @kindex show paths
2399 @item show paths
2400 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2401 environment variable).
2402
2403 @kindex show environment
2404 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2405 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2406 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2407 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2408 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2409
2410 @kindex set environment
2411 @anchor{set environment}
2412 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2413 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2414 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2415 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2416 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2417 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2418 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2419 null value.
2420 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2421 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2422
2423 For example, this command:
2424
2425 @smallexample
2426 set env USER = foo
2427 @end smallexample
2428
2429 @noindent
2430 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2431 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2432 are not actually required.)
2433
2434 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2435 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2436 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2437 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2438 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2439
2440 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2441 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2442 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2443
2444 @kindex unset environment
2445 @anchor{unset environment}
2446 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2447 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2448 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2449 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2450 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2451
2452 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2453 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2454 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2455 @end table
2456
2457 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2458 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2459 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2460 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2461 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2462 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2463 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2464 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2465 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2466 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2467
2468 @node Working Directory
2469 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2470
2471 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2472 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2473 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2474 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2475 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2476 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2477 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2478 debugging.
2479
2480 @table @code
2481 @kindex set cwd
2482 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2483 @anchor{set cwd command}
2484 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2485 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2486 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2487 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2488 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2489 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2490 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2491 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2492 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2493 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2494 fallback.
2495
2496 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2497 the @code{cd} command.
2498 @xref{cd command}.
2499
2500 @kindex show cwd
2501 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2502 @item show cwd
2503 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2504 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2505 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2506
2507 @kindex cd
2508 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2509 @anchor{cd command}
2510 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2511 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2512 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2513
2514 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2515 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2516 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2517 @xref{set cwd command}.
2518
2519 @kindex pwd
2520 @item pwd
2521 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2522 @end table
2523
2524 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2525 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2526 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2527 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2528 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2529 current working directory of the debuggee.
2530
2531 @node Input/Output
2532 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2533
2534 @cindex redirection
2535 @cindex i/o
2536 @cindex terminal
2537 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2538 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2539 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2540 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2541 running your program.
2542
2543 @table @code
2544 @kindex info terminal
2545 @item info terminal
2546 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2547 program is using.
2548 @end table
2549
2550 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2551 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2552
2553 @smallexample
2554 run > outfile
2555 @end smallexample
2556
2557 @noindent
2558 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2559
2560 @kindex tty
2561 @cindex controlling terminal
2562 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2563 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2564 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2565 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2566 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2567
2568 @smallexample
2569 tty /dev/ttyb
2570 @end smallexample
2571
2572 @noindent
2573 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2574 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2575 that as their controlling terminal.
2576
2577 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2578 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2579 terminal.
2580
2581 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2582 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2583 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2584 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2585
2586 @cindex inferior tty
2587 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2588 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2589 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2590 program.
2591
2592 @table @code
2593 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2594 @kindex set inferior-tty
2595 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2596 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2597 @value{GDBN}.
2598
2599 @item show inferior-tty
2600 @kindex show inferior-tty
2601 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2602 @end table
2603
2604 @node Attach
2605 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2606 @kindex attach
2607 @cindex attach
2608
2609 @table @code
2610 @item attach @var{process-id}
2611 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2612 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2613 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2614 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2615 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2616
2617 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2618 executing the command.
2619 @end table
2620
2621 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2622 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2623 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2624 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2625
2626 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2627 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2628 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2629 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2630 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2631 Specify Files}.
2632
2633 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2634 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2635 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2636 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2637 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2638 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2639 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2640
2641 @table @code
2642 @kindex detach
2643 @item detach
2644 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2645 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2646 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2647 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2648 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2649 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2650 executing the command.
2651 @end table
2652
2653 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2654 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2655 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2656 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2657 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2658 Messages}).
2659
2660 @node Kill Process
2661 @section Killing the Child Process
2662
2663 @table @code
2664 @kindex kill
2665 @item kill
2666 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2667 @end table
2668
2669 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2670 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2671 is running.
2672
2673 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2674 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2675 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2676 outside the debugger.
2677
2678 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2679 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2680 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2681 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2682 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2683 breakpoint settings).
2684
2685 @node Inferiors and Programs
2686 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2687
2688 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2689 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2690 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2691 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2692 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2693 from multiple executables.
2694
2695 @cindex inferior
2696 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2697 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2698 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2699 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2700 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2701 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2702 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2703 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2704 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2705 threads running in it.
2706
2707 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2708 inferiors}}:
2709
2710 @table @code
2711 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2712 @item info inferiors
2713 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2714 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2715 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2716 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2717
2718 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2719
2720 @enumerate
2721 @item
2722 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2723
2724 @item
2725 the target system's inferior identifier
2726
2727 @item
2728 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2729
2730 @end enumerate
2731
2732 @noindent
2733 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2734 indicates the current inferior.
2735
2736 For example,
2737 @end table
2738 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2739
2740 @smallexample
2741 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2742 Num Description Executable
2743 2 process 2307 hello
2744 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2745 @end smallexample
2746
2747 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2748
2749 @table @code
2750 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2751 @item inferior @var{infno}
2752 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2753 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2754 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2755 @end table
2756
2757 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2758 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2759 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2760 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2761 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2762 information on convenience variables.
2763
2764 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2765 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2766 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2767 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2768 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2769 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2770
2771 @table @code
2772 @kindex add-inferior
2773 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2774 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2775 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2776 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2777 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2778 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2779
2780 @kindex clone-inferior
2781 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2782 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2783 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2784 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2785 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2786
2787 @smallexample
2788 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2789 Num Description Executable
2790 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2791 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2792 Added inferior 2.
2793 1 inferiors added.
2794 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2795 Num Description Executable
2796 2 <null> helloworld
2797 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2798 @end smallexample
2799
2800 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2801
2802 @kindex remove-inferiors
2803 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2804 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2805 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2806 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2807
2808 @end table
2809
2810 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2811 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2812 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2813 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2814
2815 @table @code
2816 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2817 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2818 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2819 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2820 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2821 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2822
2823 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2824 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2825 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2826 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2827 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2828 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2829 @end table
2830
2831 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2832 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2833 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2834 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2835
2836
2837 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2838 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2839
2840 @table @code
2841 @kindex set print inferior-events
2842 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2843 @item set print inferior-events
2844 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2845 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2846 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2847 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2848 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2849 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2850
2851 @kindex show print inferior-events
2852 @item show print inferior-events
2853 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2854 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2855 @end table
2856
2857 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2858 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2859 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2860
2861
2862 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2863 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2864 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2865 info program-spaces}} command.
2866
2867 @table @code
2868 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2869 @item maint info program-spaces
2870 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2871 @value{GDBN}.
2872
2873 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2874
2875 @enumerate
2876 @item
2877 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2878
2879 @item
2880 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2881 the @code{file} command.
2882
2883 @end enumerate
2884
2885 @noindent
2886 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2887 indicates the current program space.
2888
2889 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2890 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2891 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2892
2893 @smallexample
2894 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2895 Id Executable
2896 * 1 hello
2897 2 goodbye
2898 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2899 @end smallexample
2900
2901 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2902 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2903 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2904 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2905 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2906
2907 @smallexample
2908 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2909 Id Executable
2910 * 1 vfork-test
2911 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2912 @end smallexample
2913
2914 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2915 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2916 @end table
2917
2918 @node Threads
2919 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2920
2921 @cindex threads of execution
2922 @cindex multiple threads
2923 @cindex switching threads
2924 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2925 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2926 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2927 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2928 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2929 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2930 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2931
2932 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2933 programs:
2934
2935 @itemize @bullet
2936 @item automatic notification of new threads
2937 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2938 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2939 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
2940 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2941 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2942 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2943 messages on thread start and exit.
2944 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2945 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2946 isn't compatible with the program.
2947 @end itemize
2948
2949 @cindex focus of debugging
2950 @cindex current thread
2951 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2952 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2953 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2954 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2955 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2956
2957 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2958 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2959 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2960 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2961 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2962 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2963 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2964 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2965 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2966 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2967
2968 @smallexample
2969 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2970 @end smallexample
2971
2972 @noindent
2973 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2974 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2975 further qualifier.
2976
2977 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2978 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2979 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2980 @c program?
2981 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2982 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2983 @c threads ab initio?
2984
2985 @anchor{thread numbers}
2986 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2987 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2988 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2989 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2990 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2991 between threads of different inferiors.
2992
2993 @cindex qualified thread ID
2994 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2995 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2996 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2997 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2998 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2999 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3000 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3001 inferior.
3002
3003 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3004 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3005 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3006 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3007
3008 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3009 @cindex thread ID lists
3010 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3011 argument. A list element can be:
3012
3013 @enumerate
3014 @item
3015 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3016 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3017 @samp{1}.
3018
3019 @item
3020 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3021 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3022 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3023
3024 @item
3025 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3026 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3027 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3028 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3029 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3030
3031 @end enumerate
3032
3033 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3034 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3035 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3036 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3037 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3038 7.1}.
3039
3040
3041 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3042 @cindex global thread number
3043 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3044 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3045 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3046 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3047 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3048 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3049
3050 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3051 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3052 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3053
3054 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3055 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3056 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3057 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3058 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3059 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3060 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3061 general information on convenience variables.
3062
3063 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3064 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3065 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3066
3067 @smallexample
3068 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3069 @end smallexample
3070
3071 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3075 @end smallexample
3076
3077 @table @code
3078 @kindex info threads
3079 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3080
3081 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3082 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3083 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3084 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3085
3086 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3087
3088 @enumerate
3089 @item
3090 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3091
3092 @item
3093 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3094 option was specified
3095
3096 @item
3097 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3098
3099 @item
3100 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3101 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3102 program itself.
3103
3104 @item
3105 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3106 @end enumerate
3107
3108 @noindent
3109 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3110 indicates the current thread.
3111
3112 For example,
3113 @end table
3114 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3115
3116 @smallexample
3117 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3118 Id Target Id Frame
3119 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3120 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3121 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3122 at threadtest.c:68
3123 @end smallexample
3124
3125 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3126 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3127 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3128
3129 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3130 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3131
3132 @smallexample
3133 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3134 Id GId Target Id Frame
3135 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3136 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3137 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3138 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3139 @end smallexample
3140
3141 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3142 Solaris-specific command:
3143
3144 @table @code
3145 @item maint info sol-threads
3146 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3147 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3148 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3149 @end table
3150
3151 @table @code
3152 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3153 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3154 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3155 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3156 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3157 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3158
3159 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3160 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3161
3162 @smallexample
3163 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3164 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3165 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3166 8 printf ("hello\n");
3167 @end smallexample
3168
3169 @noindent
3170 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3171 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3172 threads.
3173
3174 @kindex thread apply
3175 @cindex apply command to several threads
3176 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3177 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3178 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3179 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3180 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3181 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3182 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3183 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3184
3185 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3186 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3187 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3188 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3189 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3190
3191 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3192 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3193 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3194 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3195
3196 @table @code
3197 @item -c
3198 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3199 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3200 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3201 @item -s
3202 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3203 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3204 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3205 are not printed.
3206 @item -q
3207 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3208 information.
3209 @end table
3210
3211 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3212
3213 @kindex taas
3214 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3215 @item taas @var{command}
3216 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s @var{command}}.
3217 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3218
3219 @kindex tfaas
3220 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3221 @item tfaas @var{command}
3222 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
3223 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3224 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3225 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3226 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3227 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3228 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3229 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3230
3231 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3232 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3233 is, using:
3234 @smallexample
3235 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3236 @end smallexample
3237
3238
3239 @kindex thread name
3240 @cindex name a thread
3241 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3242 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3243 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3244 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3245
3246 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3247 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3248 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3249 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3250 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3251
3252 @kindex thread find
3253 @cindex search for a thread
3254 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3255 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3256 matches the supplied regular expression.
3257
3258 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3259 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3260 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3261 is the LWP id.
3262
3263 @smallexample
3264 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3265 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3266 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3267 Id Target Id Frame
3268 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3269 @end smallexample
3270
3271 @kindex set print thread-events
3272 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3273 @item set print thread-events
3274 @itemx set print thread-events on
3275 @itemx set print thread-events off
3276 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3277 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3278 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3279 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3280 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3281
3282 @kindex show print thread-events
3283 @item show print thread-events
3284 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3285 have started and exited.
3286 @end table
3287
3288 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3289 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3290 programs with multiple threads.
3291
3292 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3293 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3294
3295 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3296 @table @code
3297 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3298 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3299 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3300 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3301 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3302 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3303 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3304 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3305 macro.
3306
3307 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3308 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3309 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3310 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3311 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3312 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3313
3314 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3315 refers to the default system directories that are
3316 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3317 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3318 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3319
3320 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3321 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3322 was loaded in the inferior process.
3323
3324 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3325 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3326 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3327 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3328 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3329 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3330 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3331
3332 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3333 only on some platforms.
3334
3335 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3336 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3337 Display current libthread_db search path.
3338
3339 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3340 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3341 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3342 @item set debug libthread-db
3343 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3344 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3345 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3346 @end table
3347
3348 @node Forks
3349 @section Debugging Forks
3350
3351 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3352 @cindex multiple processes
3353 @cindex processes, multiple
3354 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3355 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3356 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3357 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3358 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3359 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3360 will cause it to terminate.
3361
3362 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3363 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3364 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3365 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3366 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3367 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3368 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3369 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3370 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3371 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3372
3373 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3374 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3375 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3376 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3377
3378 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3379 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3380 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3381
3382 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3383 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3384
3385 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3386 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3387
3388 @table @code
3389 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3390 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3391 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3392 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3393 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3394
3395 @table @code
3396 @item parent
3397 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3398 unimpeded. This is the default.
3399
3400 @item child
3401 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3402 unimpeded.
3403
3404 @end table
3405
3406 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3407 @item show follow-fork-mode
3408 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3409 @end table
3410
3411 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3412 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3413 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3414
3415 @table @code
3416 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3417 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3418 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3419 retain debugger control over them both.
3420
3421 @table @code
3422 @item on
3423 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3424 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3425 independently. This is the default.
3426
3427 @item off
3428 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3429 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3430 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3431 is held suspended.
3432
3433 @end table
3434
3435 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3436 @item show detach-on-fork
3437 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3438 @end table
3439
3440 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3441 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3442 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3443 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3444 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3445 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3446
3447 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3448 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3449 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3450 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3451 and Programs}.
3452
3453 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3454 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3455 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3456 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3457 the child process's @code{main}.
3458
3459 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3460 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3461
3462 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3463 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3464 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3465 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3466 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3467 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3468 command.
3469
3470 @table @code
3471 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3472 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3473
3474 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3475 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3476
3477 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3478
3479 @table @code
3480 @item new
3481 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3482 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3483 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3484 original inferior.
3485
3486 For example:
3487
3488 @smallexample
3489 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3490 (gdb) info inferior
3491 Id Description Executable
3492 * 1 <null> prog1
3493 (@value{GDBP}) run
3494 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3495 Program exited normally.
3496 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3497 Id Description Executable
3498 1 <null> prog1
3499 * 2 <null> prog2
3500 @end smallexample
3501
3502 @item same
3503 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3504 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3505 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3506 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3507 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3508
3509 For example:
3510
3511 @smallexample
3512 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3513 Id Description Executable
3514 * 1 <null> prog1
3515 (@value{GDBP}) run
3516 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3517 Program exited normally.
3518 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3519 Id Description Executable
3520 * 1 <null> prog2
3521 @end smallexample
3522
3523 @end table
3524 @end table
3525
3526 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3527 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3528
3529 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3530 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3531 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3532
3533 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3534 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3535
3536 @cindex checkpoint
3537 @cindex restart
3538 @cindex bookmark
3539 @cindex snapshot of a process
3540 @cindex rewind program state
3541
3542 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3543 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3544 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3545 later.
3546
3547 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3548 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3549 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3550 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3551 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3552
3553 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3554 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3555 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3556 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3557 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3558 start again from there.
3559
3560 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3561 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3562
3563 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3564
3565 @table @code
3566 @kindex checkpoint
3567 @item checkpoint
3568 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3569 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3570 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3571
3572 @kindex info checkpoints
3573 @item info checkpoints
3574 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3575 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3576 listed:
3577
3578 @table @code
3579 @item Checkpoint ID
3580 @item Process ID
3581 @item Code Address
3582 @item Source line, or label
3583 @end table
3584
3585 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3586 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3587 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3588 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3589 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3590 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3591 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3592
3593 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3594 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3595 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3596 the debugger.
3597
3598 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3599 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3600 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3601
3602 @end table
3603
3604 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3605 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3606 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3607 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3608 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3609 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3610 previously read data can be read again.
3611
3612 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3613 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3614 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3615 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3616 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3617 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3618
3619 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3620 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3621 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3622 different execution path this time.
3623
3624 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3625 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3626 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3627 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3628 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3629 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3630 potentially pose a problem.
3631
3632 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3633
3634 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3635 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3636 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3637 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3638 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3639 next.
3640
3641 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3642 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3643 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3644 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3645 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3646
3647 @node Stopping
3648 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3649
3650 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3651 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3652 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3653
3654 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3655 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3656 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3657 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3658 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3659 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3660 explicitly request this information at any time.
3661
3662 @table @code
3663 @kindex info program
3664 @item info program
3665 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3666 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3667 @end table
3668
3669 @menu
3670 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3671 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3672 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3673 Skipping over functions and files
3674 * Signals:: Signals
3675 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3676 @end menu
3677
3678 @node Breakpoints
3679 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3680
3681 @cindex breakpoints
3682 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3683 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3684 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3685 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3686 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3687 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3688 program.
3689
3690 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3691 the executable is run.
3692
3693 @cindex watchpoints
3694 @cindex data breakpoints
3695 @cindex memory tracing
3696 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3697 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3698 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3699 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3700 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3701 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3702 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3703 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3704 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3705 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3706 same commands.
3707
3708 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3709 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3710 Automatic Display}.
3711
3712 @cindex catchpoints
3713 @cindex breakpoint on events
3714 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3715 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3716 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3717 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3718 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3719 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3720 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3721
3722 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3723 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3724 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3725 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3726 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3727 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3728 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3729 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3730 enable it again.
3731
3732 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3733 @cindex breakpoint lists
3734 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3735 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3736 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3737 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3738 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3739 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3740 are operated on.
3741
3742 @menu
3743 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3744 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3745 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3746 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3747 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3748 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3749 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3750 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3751 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3752 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3753 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3754 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3755 @end menu
3756
3757 @node Set Breaks
3758 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3759
3760 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3761 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3762 @c
3763 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3764
3765 @kindex break
3766 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3767 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3768 @cindex latest breakpoint
3769 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3770 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3771 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3772 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3773 convenience variables.
3774
3775 @table @code
3776 @item break @var{location}
3777 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3778 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3779 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3780 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3781 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3782
3783 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3784 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3785 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3786 that situation.
3787
3788 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3789 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3790 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3791
3792 @item break
3793 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3794 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3795 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3796 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3797 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3798 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3799 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3800 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3801 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3802 inside loops.
3803
3804 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3805 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3806 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3807 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3808 existed when your program stopped.
3809
3810 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3811 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3812 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3813 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3814 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3815 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3816 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3817
3818 @kindex tbreak
3819 @item tbreak @var{args}
3820 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3821 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3822 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3823 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3824
3825 @kindex hbreak
3826 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3827 @item hbreak @var{args}
3828 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3829 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3830 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3831 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3832 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3833 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3834 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3835 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3836 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3837 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3838 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3839 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3840 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3841 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3842 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3843 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3844 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3845 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3846
3847 @kindex thbreak
3848 @item thbreak @var{args}
3849 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3850 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3851 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3852 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3853 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3854 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3855 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3856 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3857
3858 @kindex rbreak
3859 @cindex regular expression
3860 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3861 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3862 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3863 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3864 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3865 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3866 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3867 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3868 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3869
3870 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3871 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3872 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3873 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3874 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3875 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3876
3877 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3878 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3879 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3880 classes.
3881
3882 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3883 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3884 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3885
3886 @smallexample
3887 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3888 @end smallexample
3889
3890 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3891 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3892 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3893 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3894 every function in a given file:
3895
3896 @smallexample
3897 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3898 @end smallexample
3899
3900 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3901 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3902
3903 @kindex info breakpoints
3904 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3905 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3906 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3907 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3908 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3909 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3910 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3911
3912 @table @emph
3913 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3914 @item Type
3915 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3916 @item Disposition
3917 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3918 @item Enabled or Disabled
3919 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3920 that are not enabled.
3921 @item Address
3922 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3923 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3924 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3925 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3926 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3927 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3928 @item What
3929 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3930 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3931 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3932 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3933 @end table
3934
3935 @noindent
3936 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3937 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3938 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3939 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3940 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3941 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3942
3943 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3944 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3945 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3946 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3947
3948 @noindent
3949 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3950 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3951 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3952 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3953 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3954
3955 @noindent
3956 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3957 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3958 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3959 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3960 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3961 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3962
3963 @noindent
3964 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3965 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3966
3967 @end table
3968
3969 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3970 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3971 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3972 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3973
3974 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3975 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3976 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3977 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3978
3979 @itemize @bullet
3980 @item
3981 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3982
3983 @item
3984 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3985 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3986
3987 @item
3988 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3989 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3990
3991 @item
3992 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3993 several places where that function is inlined.
3994 @end itemize
3995
3996 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3997 the relevant locations.
3998
3999 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4000 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4001 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4002 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4003 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4004 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4005 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4006
4007 For example:
4008
4009 @smallexample
4010 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4011 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4012 stop only if i==1
4013 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4014 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4015 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4016 @end smallexample
4017
4018 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4019 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4020 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4021 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4022 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4023 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4024 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4025 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4026 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4027 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4028 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4029
4030 @cindex pending breakpoints
4031 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4032 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4033 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4034 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4035 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4036 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4037 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4038 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4039 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4040 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4041 is not yet resolved.
4042
4043 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4044 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4045 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4046 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4047 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4048 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4049
4050 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4051 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4052 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4053 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4054
4055 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4056 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4057 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4058
4059 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4060 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4061 address specification to an address:
4062
4063 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4064 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4065 @table @code
4066 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4067 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4068 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4069
4070 @item set breakpoint pending on
4071 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4072 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4073
4074 @item set breakpoint pending off
4075 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4076 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4077 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4078
4079 @item show breakpoint pending
4080 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4081 @end table
4082
4083 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4084 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4085 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4086
4087 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4088 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4089 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4090 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4091 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4092 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4093 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4094 breakpoints.
4095
4096 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4097
4098 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4099 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4100 @table @code
4101 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4102 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4103 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4104 breakpoint must be used.
4105
4106 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4107 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4108 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4109 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4110 @end table
4111
4112 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4113 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4114 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4115 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4116 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4117 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4118 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4119 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4120 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4121
4122 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4123 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4124 @table @code
4125 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4126 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4127 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4128 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4129
4130 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4131 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4132 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4133 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4134 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4135 @end table
4136
4137 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4138 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4139 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4140
4141 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4142 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4143
4144 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4145
4146 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4147 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4148 @table @code
4149 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4150 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4151 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4152 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4153 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4154
4155 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4156 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4157 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4158 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4159 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4160 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4161 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4162 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4163 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4164 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4165 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4166 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4167 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4168
4169 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4170 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4171 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4172 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4173 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4174 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4175 @end table
4176
4177
4178 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4179 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4180 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4181 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4182 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4183 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4184 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4185 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4186
4187
4188 @node Set Watchpoints
4189 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4190
4191 @cindex setting watchpoints
4192 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4193 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4194 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4195 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4196 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4197
4198 @itemize @bullet
4199 @item
4200 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4201
4202 @item
4203 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4204 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4205 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4206
4207 @item
4208 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4209 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4210 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4211 @end itemize
4212
4213 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4214 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4215 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4216 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4217 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4218 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4219 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4220 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4221 the expression changes.
4222
4223 @cindex software watchpoints
4224 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4225 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4226 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4227 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4228 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4229 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4230 culprit.)
4231
4232 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4233 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4234 slow down the running of your program.
4235
4236 @table @code
4237 @kindex watch
4238 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4239 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4240 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4241 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4242 to watch the value of a single variable:
4243
4244 @smallexample
4245 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4246 @end smallexample
4247
4248 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4249 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4250 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4251 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4252 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4253 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4254
4255 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4256 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4257 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4258 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4259 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4260 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4261 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4262 error.
4263
4264 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4265 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4266 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4267 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4268 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4269 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4270 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4271 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4272 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4273 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4274 Examples:
4275
4276 @smallexample
4277 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4278 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4279 @end smallexample
4280
4281 @kindex rwatch
4282 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4283 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4284 by the program.
4285
4286 @kindex awatch
4287 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4288 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4289 or written into by the program.
4290
4291 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4292 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4293 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4294 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4295 @end table
4296
4297 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4298 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4299 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4300 a never-changing value:
4301
4302 @smallexample
4303 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4304 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4305 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4306 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4307 @end smallexample
4308
4309 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4310 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4311 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4312 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4313 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4314 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4315
4316 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4317 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4318 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4319 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4320 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4321 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4322 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4323 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4324
4325 @table @code
4326 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4327 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4328 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4329
4330 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4331 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4332 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4333 @end table
4334
4335 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4336 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4337 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4338
4339 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4340
4341 @smallexample
4342 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4343 @end smallexample
4344
4345 @noindent
4346 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4347
4348 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4349 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4350 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4351 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4352 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4353 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4354 will print a message like this:
4355
4356 @smallexample
4357 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4358 @end smallexample
4359
4360 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4361 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4362 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4363 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4364 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4365 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4366 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4367 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4368
4369 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4370 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4371 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4372 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4373 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4374 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4375
4376 @smallexample
4377 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4378 @end smallexample
4379
4380 @noindent
4381 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4382
4383 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4384 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4385 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4386 expression with separately allocated resources.
4387
4388 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4389 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4390 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4391
4392 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4393 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4394 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4395 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4396 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4397 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4398 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4399 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4400 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4401
4402 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4403 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4404 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4405 watched expression from every thread.
4406
4407 @quotation
4408 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4409 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4410 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4411 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4412 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4413 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4414 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4415 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4416 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4417 @end quotation
4418
4419 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4420
4421 @node Set Catchpoints
4422 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4423 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4424 @cindex exception handlers
4425 @cindex event handling
4426
4427 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4428 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4429 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4430
4431 @table @code
4432 @kindex catch
4433 @item catch @var{event}
4434 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4435
4436 @table @code
4437 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4438 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4439 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4440 @kindex catch throw
4441 @kindex catch rethrow
4442 @kindex catch catch
4443 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4444 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4445
4446 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4447 regular expression will be caught.
4448
4449 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4450 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4451 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4452 exception being thrown.
4453
4454 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4455 @value{GDBN}:
4456
4457 @itemize @bullet
4458 @item
4459 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4460 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4461 supported.
4462
4463 @item
4464 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4465 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4466 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4467 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4468 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4469 built.
4470
4471 @item
4472 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4473 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4474
4475 @item
4476 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4477 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4478 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4479 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4480
4481 @item
4482 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4483 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4484 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4485 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4486 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4487 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4488 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4489 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4490 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4491
4492 @item
4493 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4494
4495 @item
4496 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4497 @end itemize
4498
4499 @item exception
4500 @kindex catch exception
4501 @cindex Ada exception catching
4502 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4503 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4504 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4505 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4506 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4507
4508 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4509 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4510 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4511 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4512 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4513 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4514 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4515 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4516
4517 @item handlers
4518 @kindex catch handlers
4519 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4520 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4521 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4522 specified at the end of the command
4523 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4524 only when this specific exception is handled.
4525 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4526
4527 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4528 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4529 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4530 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4531 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4532 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4533 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4534 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4535 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4536
4537 @item exception unhandled
4538 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4539 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4540
4541 @item assert
4542 @kindex catch assert
4543 A failed Ada assertion.
4544
4545 @item exec
4546 @kindex catch exec
4547 @cindex break on fork/exec
4548 A call to @code{exec}.
4549
4550 @item syscall
4551 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4552 @kindex catch syscall
4553 @cindex break on a system call.
4554 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4555 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4556 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4557 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4558 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4559 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4560 will be caught.
4561
4562 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4563 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4564 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4565 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4566
4567 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4568 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4569 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4570 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4571
4572 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4573 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4574 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4575 available choices.
4576
4577 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4578 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4579 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4580 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4581 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4582 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4583 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4584 behind the OS upgrades).
4585
4586 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4587 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4588 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4589 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4590 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4591 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4592 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4593 syscall groups available on your environment.
4594
4595 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4596 arguments to it:
4597
4598 @smallexample
4599 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4600 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4601 (@value{GDBP}) r
4602 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4603
4604 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4605 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4606 (@value{GDBP}) c
4607 Continuing.
4608
4609 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4610 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4611 (@value{GDBP})
4612 @end smallexample
4613
4614 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4615
4616 @smallexample
4617 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4618 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4619 (@value{GDBP}) r
4620 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4621
4622 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4623 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4624 (@value{GDBP}) c
4625 Continuing.
4626
4627 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4628 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4629 (@value{GDBP})
4630 @end smallexample
4631
4632 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4633 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4634 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4635
4636 @smallexample
4637 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4638 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4639 (@value{GDBP}) r
4640 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4641
4642 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4643 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4644 (@value{GDBP}) c
4645 Continuing.
4646
4647 Program exited normally.
4648 (@value{GDBP})
4649 @end smallexample
4650
4651 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4652
4653 @smallexample
4654 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4655 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4656 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4657 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4658 (@value{GDBP}) r
4659 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4660
4661 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4662 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4663
4664 (@value{GDBP}) c
4665 Continuing.
4666 @end smallexample
4667
4668 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4669 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4670 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4671 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4672
4673 @smallexample
4674 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4675 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4676 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4677 (@value{GDBP})
4678 @end smallexample
4679
4680 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4681 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4682 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4683 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4684 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4685 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4686
4687 @smallexample
4688 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4689 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4690 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4691 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4692 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4693 (@value{GDBP})
4694 @end smallexample
4695
4696 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4697
4698 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4699 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4700
4701 @smallexample
4702 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4703 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4704 @end smallexample
4705
4706 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4707
4708 @item fork
4709 @kindex catch fork
4710 A call to @code{fork}.
4711
4712 @item vfork
4713 @kindex catch vfork
4714 A call to @code{vfork}.
4715
4716 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4717 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4718 @kindex catch load
4719 @kindex catch unload
4720 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4721 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4722 matches one of the affected libraries.
4723
4724 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4725 @kindex catch signal
4726 The delivery of a signal.
4727
4728 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4729 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4730 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4731
4732 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4733 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4734 signal names.
4735
4736 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4737 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4738 will be caught.
4739
4740 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4741 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4742 catchpoint.
4743
4744 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4745 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4746 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4747 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4748 commands.
4749
4750 @end table
4751
4752 @item tcatch @var{event}
4753 @kindex tcatch
4754 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4755 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4756
4757 @end table
4758
4759 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4760
4761
4762 @node Delete Breaks
4763 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4764
4765 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4766 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4767 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4768 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4769 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4770 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4771
4772 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4773 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4774 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4775 their breakpoint numbers.
4776
4777 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4778 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4779 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4780
4781 @table @code
4782 @kindex clear
4783 @item clear
4784 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4785 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4786 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4787 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4788
4789 @item clear @var{location}
4790 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4791 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4792 most useful ones are listed below:
4793
4794 @table @code
4795 @item clear @var{function}
4796 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4797 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4798
4799 @item clear @var{linenum}
4800 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4801 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4802 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4803 @end table
4804
4805 @cindex delete breakpoints
4806 @kindex delete
4807 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4808 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4809 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4810 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4811 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4812 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4813 @end table
4814
4815 @node Disabling
4816 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4817
4818 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4819 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4820 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4821 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4822 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4823
4824 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4825 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4826 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4827 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4828 do not know which numbers to use.
4829
4830 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4831 affects all of its locations.
4832
4833 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4834 different states of enablement:
4835
4836 @itemize @bullet
4837 @item
4838 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4839 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4840 @item
4841 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4842 @item
4843 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4844 disabled.
4845 @item
4846 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4847 N times, then becomes disabled.
4848 @item
4849 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4850 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4851 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4852 @end itemize
4853
4854 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4855 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4856
4857 @table @code
4858 @kindex disable
4859 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4860 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4861 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4862 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4863 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4864 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4865 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4866
4867 @kindex enable
4868 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4869 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4870 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4871
4872 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4873 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4874 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4875
4876 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4877 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4878 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4879 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4880 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4881 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4882 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4883
4884 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4885 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4886 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4887 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4888 @end table
4889
4890 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4891 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4892 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4893 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4894 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4895 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4896 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4897 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4898 Stepping}.)
4899
4900 @node Conditions
4901 @subsection Break Conditions
4902 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4903 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4904
4905 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4906 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4907 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4908 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4909 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4910 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4911 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4912 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4913
4914 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4915 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4916 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4917 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4918 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4919
4920 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4921 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4922 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4923 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4924 one.
4925
4926 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4927 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4928 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4929 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4930 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4931 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4932 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4933 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4934 conditions for the
4935 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4936 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4937
4938 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4939 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4940 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4941 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4942 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4943 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4944
4945 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4946 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4947 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4948 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4949 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4950
4951 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4952 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4953 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4954 with the @code{condition} command.
4955
4956 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4957 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4958 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4959 catchpoint.
4960
4961 @table @code
4962 @kindex condition
4963 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4964 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4965 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4966 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4967 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4968 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4969 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4970 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4971 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4972 prints an error message:
4973
4974 @smallexample
4975 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4976 @end smallexample
4977
4978 @noindent
4979 @value{GDBN} does
4980 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4981 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4982 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4983
4984 @item condition @var{bnum}
4985 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4986 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4987 @end table
4988
4989 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4990 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4991 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4992 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4993 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4994 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4995 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4996 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4997 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4998 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4999 your program reaches it.
5000
5001 @table @code
5002 @kindex ignore
5003 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5004 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5005 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5006 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5007 takes no action.
5008
5009 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5010 a count of zero.
5011
5012 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5013 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5014 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5015 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5016
5017 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5018 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5019 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5020
5021 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5022 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5023 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5024 Variables}.
5025 @end table
5026
5027 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5028
5029
5030 @node Break Commands
5031 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5032
5033 @cindex breakpoint commands
5034 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5035 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5036 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5037 enable other breakpoints.
5038
5039 @table @code
5040 @kindex commands
5041 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5042 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5043 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5044 @itemx end
5045 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5046 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5047 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5048
5049 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5050 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5051
5052 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5053 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5054 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5055 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5056 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5057 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5058 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5059 Expressions}).
5060 @end table
5061
5062 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5063 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5064
5065 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5066 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5067 that resumes execution.
5068
5069 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5070 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5071 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5072 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5073 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5074
5075 @kindex silent
5076 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5077 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5078 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5079 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5080 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5081 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5082
5083 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5084 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5085 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5086
5087 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5088 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5089
5090 @smallexample
5091 break foo if x>0
5092 commands
5093 silent
5094 printf "x is %d\n",x
5095 cont
5096 end
5097 @end smallexample
5098
5099 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5100 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5101 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5102 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5103 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5104 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5105 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5106
5107 @smallexample
5108 break 403
5109 commands
5110 silent
5111 set x = y + 4
5112 cont
5113 end
5114 @end smallexample
5115
5116 @node Dynamic Printf
5117 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5118
5119 @cindex dynamic printf
5120 @cindex dprintf
5121 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5122 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5123 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5124 having to recompile it.
5125
5126 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5127 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5128 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5129 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5130 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5131 redirects to files and so forth.
5132
5133 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5134 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5135 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5136 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5137 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5138 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5139 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5140
5141 @table @code
5142 @kindex dprintf
5143 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5144 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5145 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5146 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5147
5148 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5149 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5150 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5151 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5152 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5153 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5154
5155 @table @code
5156 @item gdb
5157 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5158 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5159
5160 @item call
5161 @kindex dprintf-style call
5162 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5163 @code{printf}).
5164
5165 @item agent
5166 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5167 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5168 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5169 support running commands on the target.
5170 @end table
5171
5172 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5173 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5174 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5175 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5176 command.
5177
5178 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5179 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5180 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5181 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5182 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5183 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5184
5185 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5186 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5187 you could do the following:
5188
5189 @example
5190 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5191 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5192 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5193 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5194 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5195 (gdb) info break
5196 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5197 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5198 continue
5199 (gdb)
5200 @end example
5201
5202 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5203 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5204 the variable settings.
5205
5206 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5207 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5208 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5209 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5210 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5211 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5212
5213 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5214 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5215 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5216
5217 @end table
5218
5219 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5220 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5221 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5222 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5223 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5224 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5225
5226 @node Save Breakpoints
5227 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5228
5229 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5230 breakpoints}} command.
5231
5232 @table @code
5233 @kindex save breakpoints
5234 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5235 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5236 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5237 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5238 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5239 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5240 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5241 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5242 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5243 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5244 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5245 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5246 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5247 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5248 that can no longer be recreated.
5249 @end table
5250
5251 @node Static Probe Points
5252 @subsection Static Probe Points
5253
5254 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5255 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5256 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5257 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5258 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5259
5260 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5261 ELF-compatible systems:
5262
5263 @itemize @bullet
5264
5265 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5266 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5267 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5268 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5269 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5270 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5271 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5272 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5273
5274 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5275 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5276 C@t{++} languages.
5277 @end itemize
5278
5279 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5280 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5281 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5282 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5283 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5284 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5285 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5286 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5287 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5288
5289 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5290 probes}, with optional arguments:
5291
5292 @table @code
5293 @kindex info probes
5294 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5295 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5296 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5297 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5298
5299 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5300 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5301 probes from all providers are listed.
5302
5303 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5304 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5305 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5306
5307 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5308 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5309 given, all object files are considered.
5310
5311 @item info probes all
5312 List the available static probes, from all types.
5313 @end table
5314
5315 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5316 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5317 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5318 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5319 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5320
5321 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5322 commands, with optional arguments:
5323
5324 @table @code
5325 @kindex enable probes
5326 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5327 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5328 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5329 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5330
5331 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5332 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5333 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5334
5335 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5336 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5337 given, all object files are considered.
5338
5339 @kindex disable probes
5340 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5341 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5342 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5343 @end table
5344
5345 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5346 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5347 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5348 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5349 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5350 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5351 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5352 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5353 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5354 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5355 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5356 at the current probe point.
5357
5358 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5359 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5360 an error message.
5361
5362
5363 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5364 @node Error in Breakpoints
5365 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5366
5367 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5368 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5369
5370 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5371 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5372 @smallexample
5373 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5374 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5375 @end smallexample
5376
5377 @noindent
5378 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5379 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5380 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5381
5382 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5383 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5384
5385 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5386 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5387 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5388
5389 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5390 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5391 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5392 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5393
5394 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5395 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5396 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5397 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5398 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5399 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5400 first in the bundle.
5401
5402 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5403 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5404 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5405 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5406 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5407 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5408 is hit.
5409
5410 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5411 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5412
5413 @smallexample
5414 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5415 @end smallexample
5416
5417 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5418 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5419 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5420 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5421 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5422 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5423 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5424 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5425
5426 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5427 adjusted breakpoints:
5428
5429 @smallexample
5430 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5431 to 0x00010410.
5432 @end smallexample
5433
5434 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5435 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5436 frequently than expected.
5437
5438 @node Continuing and Stepping
5439 @section Continuing and Stepping
5440
5441 @cindex stepping
5442 @cindex continuing
5443 @cindex resuming execution
5444 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5445 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5446 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5447 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5448 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5449 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5450 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5451 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5452 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5453 handlers}).)
5454
5455 @table @code
5456 @kindex continue
5457 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5458 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5459 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5460 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5461 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5462 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5463 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5464 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5465 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5466 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5467
5468 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5469 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5470 @code{continue} is ignored.
5471
5472 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5473 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5474 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5475 @code{continue}.
5476 @end table
5477
5478 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5479 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5480 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5481 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5482
5483 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5484 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5485 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5486 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5487 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5488 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5489
5490 @table @code
5491 @kindex step
5492 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5493 @item step
5494 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5495 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5496 abbreviated @code{s}.
5497
5498 @quotation
5499 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5500 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5501 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5502 @c distinction here.
5503 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5504 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5505 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5506 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5507 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5508 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5509 below.
5510 @end quotation
5511
5512 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5513 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5514 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5515 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5516 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5517 called within the line.
5518
5519 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5520 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5521 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5522 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5523 was any debugging information about the routine.
5524
5525 @item step @var{count}
5526 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5527 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5528 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5529
5530 @kindex next
5531 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5532 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5533 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5534 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5535 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5536 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5537 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5538 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5539
5540 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5541
5542
5543 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5544 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5545 @c
5546 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5547 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5548 @c function are executed without stopping.
5549
5550 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5551 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5552 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5553
5554 @kindex set step-mode
5555 @item set step-mode
5556 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5557 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5558 @itemx set step-mode on
5559 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5560 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5561 information rather than stepping over it.
5562
5563 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5564 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5565 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5566
5567 @item set step-mode off
5568 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5569 debug information. This is the default.
5570
5571 @item show step-mode
5572 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5573 source line debug information.
5574
5575 @kindex finish
5576 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5577 @item finish
5578 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5579 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5580 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5581
5582 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5583 ,Returning from a Function}).
5584
5585 @kindex until
5586 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5587 @cindex run until specified location
5588 @item until
5589 @itemx u
5590 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5591 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5592 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5593 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5594 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5595 than the address of the jump.
5596
5597 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5598 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5599 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5600 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5601 through the next iteration.
5602
5603 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5604 stack frame.
5605
5606 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5607 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5608 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5609 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5610 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5611
5612 @smallexample
5613 (@value{GDBP}) f
5614 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5615 206 expand_input();
5616 (@value{GDBP}) until
5617 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5618 @end smallexample
5619
5620 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5621 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5622 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5623 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5624 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5625 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5626 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5627
5628 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5629 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5630 argument.
5631
5632 @item until @var{location}
5633 @itemx u @var{location}
5634 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5635 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5636 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5637 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5638 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5639 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5640 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5641 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5642 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5643 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5644 invocations have returned.
5645
5646 @smallexample
5647 94 int factorial (int value)
5648 95 @{
5649 96 if (value > 1) @{
5650 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5651 98 @}
5652 99 return (value);
5653 100 @}
5654 @end smallexample
5655
5656
5657 @kindex advance @var{location}
5658 @item advance @var{location}
5659 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5660 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5661 @ref{Specify Location}.
5662 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5663 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5664 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5665 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5666
5667
5668 @kindex stepi
5669 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5670 @item stepi
5671 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5672 @itemx si
5673 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5674
5675 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5676 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5677 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5678 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5679
5680 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5681
5682 @need 750
5683 @kindex nexti
5684 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5685 @item nexti
5686 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5687 @itemx ni
5688 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5689 proceed until the function returns.
5690
5691 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5692
5693 @end table
5694
5695 @anchor{range stepping}
5696 @cindex range stepping
5697 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5698 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5699 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5700 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5701 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5702 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5703 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5704 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5705 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5706 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5707 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5708 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5709 if necessary:
5710
5711 @table @code
5712 @kindex set range-stepping
5713 @kindex show range-stepping
5714 @item set range-stepping
5715 @itemx show range-stepping
5716 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5717
5718 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5719 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5720 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5721 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5722 default is @code{on}.
5723
5724 @end table
5725
5726 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5727 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5728 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5729
5730 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5731 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5732 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5733 a particular file when stepping.
5734
5735 For example, consider the following C function:
5736
5737 @smallexample
5738 101 int func()
5739 102 @{
5740 103 foo(boring());
5741 104 bar(boring());
5742 105 @}
5743 @end smallexample
5744
5745 @noindent
5746 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5747 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5748 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5749 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5750
5751 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5752 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5753 is called from many places.
5754
5755 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5756 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5757 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5758 @code{foo}.
5759
5760 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5761 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5762 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5763
5764 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5765 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5766 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5767 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5768 the underlying system.
5769 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5770 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5771
5772 @table @code
5773 @kindex skip
5774 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5775 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5776 that specify what to skip.
5777 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5778
5779 @table @code
5780 @item -file @var{file}
5781 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5782 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5783
5784 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5785 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5786 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5787 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5788 over when stepping.
5789
5790 @smallexample
5791 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5792 @end smallexample
5793
5794 @item -function @var{linespec}
5795 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5796 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5797 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5798 @xref{Specify Location}.
5799
5800 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5801 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5802 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5803 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5804
5805 This form is useful for complex function names.
5806 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5807 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5808 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5809 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5810 regular expression makes this easier.
5811
5812 @smallexample
5813 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5814 @end smallexample
5815
5816 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5817 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5818
5819 @smallexample
5820 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5821 @end smallexample
5822 @end table
5823
5824 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5825 will be skipped.
5826
5827 @kindex skip function
5828 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5829 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5830 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5831 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5832
5833 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5834 will be skipped.
5835
5836 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5837 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5838
5839 @kindex skip file
5840 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5841 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5842 will be skipped over when stepping.
5843
5844 @smallexample
5845 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5846 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5847 @end smallexample
5848
5849 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5850 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5851 @end table
5852
5853 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5854 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5855
5856 @table @code
5857 @kindex info skip
5858 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5859 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5860 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5861 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5862
5863 @table @emph
5864 @item Identifier
5865 A number identifying this skip.
5866 @item Enabled or Disabled
5867 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5868 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5869 @item Glob
5870 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5871 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5872 @item File
5873 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5874 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5875 @item RE
5876 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5877 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5878 @item Function
5879 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5880 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5881 @end table
5882
5883 @kindex skip delete
5884 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5885 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5886 skips.
5887
5888 @kindex skip enable
5889 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5890 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5891 skips.
5892
5893 @kindex skip disable
5894 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5895 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5896 skips.
5897
5898 @kindex set debug skip
5899 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
5900 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
5901
5902 @kindex show debug skip
5903 @item show debug skip
5904 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
5905
5906 @end table
5907
5908 @node Signals
5909 @section Signals
5910 @cindex signals
5911
5912 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5913 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5914 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5915 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5916 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5917 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5918 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5919 requested an alarm).
5920
5921 @cindex fatal signals
5922 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5923 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5924 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5925 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5926 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5927 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5928
5929 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5930 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5931 signal.
5932
5933 @cindex handling signals
5934 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5935 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5936 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5937 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5938 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5939
5940 @table @code
5941 @kindex info signals
5942 @kindex info handle
5943 @item info signals
5944 @itemx info handle
5945 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5946 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5947 the defined types of signals.
5948
5949 @item info signals @var{sig}
5950 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5951
5952 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5953
5954 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5955 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5956 for details about this command.
5957
5958 @kindex handle
5959 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5960 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5961 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5962 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5963 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5964 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5965 say what change to make.
5966 @end table
5967
5968 @c @group
5969 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5970 Their full names are:
5971
5972 @table @code
5973 @item nostop
5974 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5975 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5976
5977 @item stop
5978 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5979 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5980
5981 @item print
5982 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5983
5984 @item noprint
5985 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5986 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5987
5988 @item pass
5989 @itemx noignore
5990 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5991 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5992 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5993
5994 @item nopass
5995 @itemx ignore
5996 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5997 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5998 @end table
5999 @c @end group
6000
6001 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6002 program until you
6003 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6004 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6005 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6006 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6007 program sees that signal when you continue.
6008
6009 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6010 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6011 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6012 erroneous signals.
6013
6014 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6015 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6016 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6017 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6018 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6019 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6020 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6021 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6022 Program a Signal}.
6023
6024 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6025 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6026
6027 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6028 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6029 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6030 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6031 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6032 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6033 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6034 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6035 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6036 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6037 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6038 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6039 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6040
6041 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6042
6043 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6044 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6045 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6046 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6047
6048 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6049 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6050 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6051 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6052
6053 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6054 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6055
6056 @smallexample
6057 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6058 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6059 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6060 (@value{GDBP}) c
6061 Continuing.
6062
6063 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6064 main () sigusr1.c:28
6065 28 p = 0;
6066 (@value{GDBP}) si
6067 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6068 9 @{
6069 @end smallexample
6070
6071 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6072 program to receive the signal first:
6073
6074 @smallexample
6075 (@value{GDBP}) n
6076 28 p = 0;
6077 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6078 (@value{GDBP}) si
6079 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6080 9 @{
6081 (@value{GDBP})
6082 @end smallexample
6083
6084 @cindex extra signal information
6085 @anchor{extra signal information}
6086
6087 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6088 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6089 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6090 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6091 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6092 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6093 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6094 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6095 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6096 system header.
6097
6098 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6099 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6100
6101 @smallexample
6102 @group
6103 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6104 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6105 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6106 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6107 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6108 type = struct @{
6109 int si_signo;
6110 int si_errno;
6111 int si_code;
6112 union @{
6113 int _pad[28];
6114 struct @{...@} _kill;
6115 struct @{...@} _timer;
6116 struct @{...@} _rt;
6117 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6118 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6119 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6120 @} _sifields;
6121 @}
6122 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6123 type = struct @{
6124 void *si_addr;
6125 @}
6126 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6127 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6128 @end group
6129 @end smallexample
6130
6131 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6132
6133 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6134 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6135 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6136 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6137 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6138 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6139 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6140 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6141 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6142 information is displayed.
6143
6144 The usual output of a segfault is:
6145 @smallexample
6146 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6147 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6148 68 value = *(p + len);
6149 @end smallexample
6150
6151 While a bound violation is presented as:
6152 @smallexample
6153 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6154 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6155 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6156 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6157 68 value = *(p + len);
6158 @end smallexample
6159
6160 @node Thread Stops
6161 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6162
6163 @cindex stopped threads
6164 @cindex threads, stopped
6165
6166 @cindex continuing threads
6167 @cindex threads, continuing
6168
6169 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6170 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6171 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6172 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6173 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6174 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6175 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6176 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6177 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6178
6179 @menu
6180 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6181 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6182 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6183 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6184 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6185 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6186 @end menu
6187
6188 @node All-Stop Mode
6189 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6190
6191 @cindex all-stop mode
6192
6193 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6194 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6195 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6196 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6197 underfoot.
6198
6199 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6200 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6201 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6202
6203 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6204 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6205 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6206 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6207 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6208 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6209 stops.
6210
6211 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6212 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6213 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6214 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6215
6216 @cindex automatic thread selection
6217 @cindex switching threads automatically
6218 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6219 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6220 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6221 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6222 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6223 thread.
6224
6225 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6226 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6227
6228 @table @code
6229 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6230 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6231 @cindex lock scheduler
6232 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6233 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6234 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6235 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6236 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6237 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6238 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6239 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6240 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6241 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6242 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6243 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6244 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6245 @code{on} in replay mode.
6246
6247 @item show scheduler-locking
6248 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6249 @end table
6250
6251 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6252 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6253 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6254 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6255 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6256 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6257 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6258 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6259 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6260 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6261 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6262 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6263 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6264 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6265
6266 @table @code
6267 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6268 @item set schedule-multiple
6269 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6270 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6271 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6272 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6273 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6274 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6275
6276 @item show schedule-multiple
6277 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6278 multiple processes.
6279 @end table
6280
6281 @node Non-Stop Mode
6282 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6283
6284 @cindex non-stop mode
6285
6286 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6287 @c with more details.
6288
6289 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6290 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6291 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6292 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6293 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6294 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6295
6296 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6297 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6298 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6299 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6300 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6301 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6302 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6303 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6304 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6305 independently and simultaneously.
6306
6307 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6308 or attach to your program:
6309
6310 @smallexample
6311 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6312 set pagination off
6313
6314 # Finally, turn it on!
6315 set non-stop on
6316 @end smallexample
6317
6318 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6319
6320 @table @code
6321 @kindex set non-stop
6322 @item set non-stop on
6323 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6324 @item set non-stop off
6325 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6326 @kindex show non-stop
6327 @item show non-stop
6328 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6329 @end table
6330
6331 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6332 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6333 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6334 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6335 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6336 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6337 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6338 default.
6339
6340 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6341 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6342 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6343
6344 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6345 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6346 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6347 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6348 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6349
6350 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6351 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6352 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6353 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6354 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6355
6356 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6357
6358 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6359 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6360 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6361 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6362 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6363 previously current thread.
6364
6365 @node Background Execution
6366 @subsection Background Execution
6367
6368 @cindex foreground execution
6369 @cindex background execution
6370 @cindex asynchronous execution
6371 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6372
6373 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6374 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6375 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6376 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6377 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6378 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6379
6380 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6381 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6382
6383 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6384 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6385 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6386 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6387 are:
6388
6389 @table @code
6390 @kindex run&
6391 @item run
6392 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6393
6394 @item attach
6395 @kindex attach&
6396 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6397
6398 @item step
6399 @kindex step&
6400 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6401
6402 @item stepi
6403 @kindex stepi&
6404 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6405
6406 @item next
6407 @kindex next&
6408 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6409
6410 @item nexti
6411 @kindex nexti&
6412 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6413
6414 @item continue
6415 @kindex continue&
6416 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6417
6418 @item finish
6419 @kindex finish&
6420 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6421
6422 @item until
6423 @kindex until&
6424 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6425
6426 @end table
6427
6428 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6429 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6430 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6431 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6432 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6433 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6434
6435 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6436 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6437
6438 @table @code
6439 @kindex interrupt
6440 @item interrupt
6441 @itemx interrupt -a
6442
6443 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6444 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6445 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6446 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6447 @end table
6448
6449 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6450 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6451
6452 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6453 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6454 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6455
6456 @table @code
6457 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6458 @cindex thread breakpoints
6459 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6460 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6461 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6462 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6463 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6464 specify some source line.
6465
6466 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6467 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6468 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6469 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6470 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6471
6472 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6473 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6474 program.
6475
6476 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6477 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6478 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6479
6480 @smallexample
6481 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6482 @end smallexample
6483
6484 @end table
6485
6486 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6487 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6488 thread list. For example:
6489
6490 @smallexample
6491 (@value{GDBP}) c
6492 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6493 @end smallexample
6494
6495 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6496 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6497 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6498 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6499 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6500 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6501 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6502 command.
6503
6504 @node Interrupted System Calls
6505 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6506
6507 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6508 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6509 @cindex premature return from system calls
6510 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6511 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6512 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6513 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6514 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6515 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6516 stop execution.
6517
6518 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6519 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6520 style anyways.
6521
6522 For example, do not write code like this:
6523
6524 @smallexample
6525 sleep (10);
6526 @end smallexample
6527
6528 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6529 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6530
6531 Instead, write this:
6532
6533 @smallexample
6534 int unslept = 10;
6535 while (unslept > 0)
6536 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6537 @end smallexample
6538
6539 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6540 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6541 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6542 @value{GDBN}.
6543
6544 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6545 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6546 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6547 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6548
6549 @node Observer Mode
6550 @subsection Observer Mode
6551
6552 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6553 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6554 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6555 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6556 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6557
6558 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6559 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6560 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6561 mode.
6562
6563 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6564 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6565 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6566 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6567 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6568
6569 @table @code
6570
6571 @kindex observer
6572 @item set observer on
6573 @itemx set observer off
6574 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6575 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6576 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6577 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6578
6579 @item show observer
6580 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6581
6582 @kindex may-write-registers
6583 @item set may-write-registers on
6584 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6585 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6586 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6587 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6588
6589 @item show may-write-registers
6590 Show the current permission to write registers.
6591
6592 @kindex may-write-memory
6593 @item set may-write-memory on
6594 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6595 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6596 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6597 defaults to @code{on}.
6598
6599 @item show may-write-memory
6600 Show the current permission to write memory.
6601
6602 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6603 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6604 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6605 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6606 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6607 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6608
6609 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6610 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6611
6612 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6613 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6614 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6615 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6616 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6617 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6618 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6619
6620 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6621 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6622
6623 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6624 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6625 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6626 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6627 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6628 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6629 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6630
6631 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6632 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6633
6634 @kindex may-interrupt
6635 @item set may-interrupt on
6636 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6637 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6638 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6639 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6640 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6641
6642 @item show may-interrupt
6643 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6644
6645 @end table
6646
6647 @node Reverse Execution
6648 @chapter Running programs backward
6649 @cindex reverse execution
6650 @cindex running programs backward
6651
6652 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6653 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6654 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6655 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6656
6657 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6658 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6659 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6660 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6661 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6662 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6663
6664 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6665 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6666 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6667 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6668 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6669 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6670 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6671 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6672 prior values@footnote{
6673 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6674 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6675 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6676
6677 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6678 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6679 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6680 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6681 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6682 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6683 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6684 }.
6685
6686 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6687 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6688
6689 @table @code
6690 @kindex reverse-continue
6691 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6692 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6693 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6694 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6695 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6696 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6697 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6698
6699 @kindex reverse-step
6700 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6701 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6702 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6703 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6704
6705 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6706 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6707 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6708 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6709 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6710 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6711
6712 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6713 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6714
6715 @kindex reverse-stepi
6716 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6717 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6718 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6719 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6720 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6721 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6722 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6723
6724 @kindex reverse-next
6725 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6726 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6727 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6728 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6729 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6730 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6731 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6732 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6733 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6734 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6735
6736 @kindex reverse-nexti
6737 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6738 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6739 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6740 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6741 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6742 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6743 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6744 frame) is reached.
6745
6746 @kindex reverse-finish
6747 @item reverse-finish
6748 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6749 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6750 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6751 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6752
6753 @kindex set exec-direction
6754 @item set exec-direction
6755 Set the direction of target execution.
6756 @item set exec-direction reverse
6757 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6758 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6759 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6760 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6761 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6762 @item set exec-direction forward
6763 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6764 This is the default.
6765 @end table
6766
6767
6768 @node Process Record and Replay
6769 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6770 @cindex process record and replay
6771 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6772
6773 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6774 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6775 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6776
6777 @cindex replay mode
6778 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6779 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6780 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6781 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6782 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6783 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6784 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6785 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6786 execution log.
6787
6788 @cindex record mode
6789 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6790 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6791 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6792 for future replay.
6793
6794 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6795 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6796 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6797 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6798 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6799 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6800
6801 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6802 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6803 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6804 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6805
6806 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6807 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6808
6809 @table @code
6810 @kindex target record
6811 @kindex target record-full
6812 @kindex target record-btrace
6813 @kindex record
6814 @kindex record full
6815 @kindex record btrace
6816 @kindex record btrace bts
6817 @kindex record btrace pt
6818 @kindex record bts
6819 @kindex record pt
6820 @kindex rec
6821 @kindex rec full
6822 @kindex rec btrace
6823 @kindex rec btrace bts
6824 @kindex rec btrace pt
6825 @kindex rec bts
6826 @kindex rec pt
6827 @item record @var{method}
6828 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6829 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6830 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6831 recording methods are available:
6832
6833 @table @code
6834 @item full
6835 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6836 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6837 execution.
6838
6839 @item btrace @var{format}
6840 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6841 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6842 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6843 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6844 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6845 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6846 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6847
6848 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6849 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6850 formats are available:
6851
6852 @table @code
6853 @item bts
6854 @cindex branch trace store
6855 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6856 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6857 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6858
6859 @item pt
6860 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6861 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6862 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6863 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6864
6865 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6866 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6867 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6868
6869 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6870 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6871 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6872 buffer-size with care.
6873 @end table
6874
6875 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6876 @end table
6877
6878 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6879 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6880 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6881 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6882
6883 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6884 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6885 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6886 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6887 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6888
6889 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6890 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6891 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6892 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6893 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6894 does not support these two modes.
6895
6896 @kindex record stop
6897 @kindex rec s
6898 @item record stop
6899 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6900 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6901 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6902
6903 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6904 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6905 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6906 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6907 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6908
6909 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6910 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6911 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6912 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6913 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6914
6915 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6916 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6917
6918 @kindex record goto
6919 @item record goto
6920 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6921 ways to specify the location to go to:
6922
6923 @table @code
6924 @item record goto begin
6925 @itemx record goto start
6926 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6927
6928 @item record goto end
6929 Go to the end of the execution log.
6930
6931 @item record goto @var{n}
6932 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6933 @end table
6934
6935 @kindex record save
6936 @item record save @var{filename}
6937 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6938 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6939 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6940
6941 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6942
6943 @kindex record restore
6944 @item record restore @var{filename}
6945 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6946 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6947
6948 @kindex set record full
6949 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6950 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6951 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6952 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6953
6954 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6955 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6956 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6957 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6958 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6959 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6960 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6961 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6962
6963 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6964 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6965 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6966
6967 @kindex show record full
6968 @item show record full insn-number-max
6969 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6970 recording method.
6971
6972 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6973 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6974 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6975 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6976 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6977 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6978 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6979 oldest one to be deleted.
6980
6981 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6982 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6983
6984 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6985 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6986
6987 @item set record full memory-query
6988 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6989 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6990 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6991 case.
6992
6993 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6994 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6995 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6996 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6997 results.
6998
6999 @item show record full memory-query
7000 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7001
7002 @kindex set record btrace
7003 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7004 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7005 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7006 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7007 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7008 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7009 You can use the following command for that:
7010
7011 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7012 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7013 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7014 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7015 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7016 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7017 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7018 position.
7019
7020 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7021 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7022 errata when decoding the trace.
7023
7024 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7025 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7026 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7027 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7028 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7029 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7030 which the trace was recorded.
7031
7032 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7033 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7034 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7035 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7036 disable the workarounds.
7037
7038 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7039 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
7040 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7041 (default).
7042
7043 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7044 identifiers are currently supported:
7045
7046 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7047
7048 @item @code{intel}
7049 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7050
7051 @end multitable
7052
7053 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7054 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7055
7056 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7057 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7058 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7059
7060 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7061 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7062 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7063 supports.
7064
7065 @smallexample
7066 (gdb) info record
7067 Active record target: record-btrace
7068 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7069 Buffer size: 16kB.
7070 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7071 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7072 (gdb) info record
7073 Active record target: record-btrace
7074 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7075 Buffer size: 16kB.
7076 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7077 @end smallexample
7078
7079 @kindex show record btrace
7080 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7081 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7082
7083 @item show record btrace cpu
7084 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7085 workarounds.
7086
7087 @kindex set record btrace bts
7088 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7089 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7090 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7091 format. Default is 64KB.
7092
7093 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7094 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7095 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7096 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7097 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7098 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7099 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7100
7101 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7102 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7103
7104 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7105 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7106
7107 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7108 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7109 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7110
7111 @kindex set record btrace pt
7112 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7113 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7114 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7115 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7116
7117 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7118 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7119 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7120 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7121 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7122 actual buffer size for each thread.
7123
7124 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7125 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7126
7127 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7128 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7129
7130 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7131 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7132 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7133
7134 @kindex info record
7135 @item info record
7136 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7137 method:
7138
7139 @table @code
7140 @item full
7141 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7142 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7143
7144 @itemize @bullet
7145 @item
7146 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7147 @item
7148 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7149 @item
7150 Highest recorded instruction number.
7151 @item
7152 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7153 @item
7154 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7155 @item
7156 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7157 @end itemize
7158
7159 @item btrace
7160 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7161
7162 @itemize @bullet
7163 @item
7164 Recording format.
7165 @item
7166 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7167 @item
7168 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7169 instructions.
7170 @item
7171 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7172 @end itemize
7173
7174 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7175 @itemize @bullet
7176 @item
7177 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7178 @end itemize
7179
7180 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7181 @itemize @bullet
7182 @item
7183 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7184 @end itemize
7185 @end table
7186
7187 @kindex record delete
7188 @kindex rec del
7189 @item record delete
7190 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7191 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7192 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7193 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7194
7195 @kindex record instruction-history
7196 @kindex rec instruction-history
7197 @item record instruction-history
7198 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7199 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7200 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7201 are printed in execution order.
7202
7203 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7204 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7205 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7206
7207 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7208 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7209 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7210 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7211 @code{/p} modifier.
7212
7213 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7214 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7215 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7216
7217 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7218 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7219
7220 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7221 disassemble:
7222
7223 @table @code
7224 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7225 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7226 @var{insn}.
7227
7228 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7229 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7230 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7231 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7232 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7233 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7234
7235 @item record instruction-history
7236 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7237
7238 @item record instruction-history -
7239 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7240
7241 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7242 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7243 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7244 number @var{end} is included.
7245 @end table
7246
7247 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7248
7249 @kindex set record
7250 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7251 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7252 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7253 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7254 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7255
7256 @kindex show record
7257 @item show record instruction-history-size
7258 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7259 instruction-history} command.
7260
7261 @kindex record function-call-history
7262 @kindex rec function-call-history
7263 @item record function-call-history
7264 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7265 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7266 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7267 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7268 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7269 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7270 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7271 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7272 given together.
7273
7274 @smallexample
7275 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7276 1 void foo (void)
7277 2 @{
7278 3 @}
7279 4
7280 5 void bar (void)
7281 6 @{
7282 7 ...
7283 8 foo ();
7284 9 ...
7285 10 @}
7286 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7287 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7288 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7289 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7290 @end smallexample
7291
7292 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7293 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7294 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7295 to print:
7296
7297 @table @code
7298 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7299 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7300
7301 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7302 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7303 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7304 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7305 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7306
7307 @item record function-call-history
7308 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7309
7310 @item record function-call-history -
7311 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7312
7313 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7314 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7315 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7316 @end table
7317
7318 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7319
7320 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7321 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7322 Define how many lines to print in the
7323 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7324 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7325
7326 @item show record function-call-history-size
7327 Show how many lines to print in the
7328 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7329 @end table
7330
7331
7332 @node Stack
7333 @chapter Examining the Stack
7334
7335 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7336 stopped and how it got there.
7337
7338 @cindex call stack
7339 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7340 is generated.
7341 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7342 the arguments of the call,
7343 and the local variables of the function being called.
7344 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7345 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7346 stack}.
7347
7348 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7349 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7350
7351 @cindex selected frame
7352 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7353 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7354 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7355 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7356 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7357 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7358
7359 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7360 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7361 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7362
7363 @menu
7364 * Frames:: Stack frames
7365 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7366 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7367 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7368 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7369 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7370
7371 @end menu
7372
7373 @node Frames
7374 @section Stack Frames
7375
7376 @cindex frame, definition
7377 @cindex stack frame
7378 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7379 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7380 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7381 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7382 which the function is executing.
7383
7384 @cindex initial frame
7385 @cindex outermost frame
7386 @cindex innermost frame
7387 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7388 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7389 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7390 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7391 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7392 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7393 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7394 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7395
7396 @cindex frame pointer
7397 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7398 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7399 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7400 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7401 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7402 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7403
7404 @cindex frame number
7405 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7406 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7407 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7408 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7409 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7410
7411 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7412 @c underflow problems.
7413 @cindex frameless execution
7414 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7415 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7416 @smallexample
7417 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7418 @end smallexample
7419 generates functions without a frame.)
7420 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7421 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7422 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7423 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7424 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7425 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7426 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7427
7428 @node Backtrace
7429 @section Backtraces
7430
7431 @cindex traceback
7432 @cindex call stack traces
7433 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7434 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7435 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7436 stack.
7437
7438 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7439 @kindex backtrace
7440 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7441 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7442 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7443 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7444 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7445 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7446
7447 @table @code
7448 @item backtrace [@var{args}@dots{}]
7449 @itemx bt [@var{args}@dots{}]
7450 Print the backtrace of the entire stack. The optional @var{args} can
7451 be one of the following:
7452
7453 @table @code
7454 @item @var{n}
7455 @itemx @var{n}
7456 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7457 number.
7458
7459 @item -@var{n}
7460 @itemx -@var{n}
7461 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7462 number.
7463
7464 @item full
7465 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7466 with a number to limit the number of frames shown.
7467
7468 @item no-filters
7469 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7470 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7471 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7472 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7473 support.
7474
7475 @item hide
7476 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7477 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7478 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{hide}
7479 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7480 @end table
7481 @end table
7482
7483 @kindex where
7484 @kindex info stack
7485 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7486 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7487
7488 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7489 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7490 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7491 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7492 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7493 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7494 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7495 multi-threaded program.
7496
7497 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7498 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7499 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7500 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7501 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7502 line number.
7503
7504 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7505 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7506
7507 @smallexample
7508 @group
7509 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7510 at builtin.c:993
7511 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7512 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7513 at macro.c:71
7514 (More stack frames follow...)
7515 @end group
7516 @end smallexample
7517
7518 @noindent
7519 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7520 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7521 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7522
7523 @noindent
7524 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7525 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7526 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7527 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7528 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7529
7530 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7531 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7532 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7533 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7534 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7535 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7536 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7537 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7538 such a backtrace might look like:
7539
7540 @smallexample
7541 @group
7542 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7543 at builtin.c:993
7544 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7545 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7546 at macro.c:71
7547 (More stack frames follow...)
7548 @end group
7549 @end smallexample
7550
7551 @noindent
7552 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7553 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7554
7555 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7556 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7557 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7558
7559 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7560 @cindex program entry point
7561 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7562 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7563 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7564 @code{main}@footnote{
7565 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7566 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7567 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7568 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7569 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7570 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7571
7572 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7573 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7574
7575 @table @code
7576 @item set backtrace past-main
7577 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7578 @kindex set backtrace
7579 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7580
7581 @item set backtrace past-main off
7582 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7583 default.
7584
7585 @item show backtrace past-main
7586 @kindex show backtrace
7587 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7588
7589 @item set backtrace past-entry
7590 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7591 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7592 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7593 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7594
7595 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7596 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7597 application. This is the default.
7598
7599 @item show backtrace past-entry
7600 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7601
7602 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7603 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7604 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7605 @cindex backtrace limit
7606 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7607 or zero means unlimited levels.
7608
7609 @item show backtrace limit
7610 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7611 @end table
7612
7613 You can control how file names are displayed.
7614
7615 @table @code
7616 @item set filename-display
7617 @itemx set filename-display relative
7618 @cindex filename-display
7619 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7620
7621 @item set filename-display basename
7622 Display only basename of a filename.
7623
7624 @item set filename-display absolute
7625 Display an absolute filename.
7626
7627 @item show filename-display
7628 Show the current way to display filenames.
7629 @end table
7630
7631 @node Selection
7632 @section Selecting a Frame
7633
7634 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7635 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7636 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7637 of the stack frame just selected.
7638
7639 @table @code
7640 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7641 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7642 @item frame @var{n}
7643 @itemx f @var{n}
7644 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7645 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7646 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7647 @code{main}.
7648
7649 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7650 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7651 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7652 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7653 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7654 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7655 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7656 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7657
7658 @kindex up
7659 @item up @var{n}
7660 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7661 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7662 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7663
7664 @kindex down
7665 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7666 @item down @var{n}
7667 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7668 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7669 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7670 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7671 @end table
7672
7673 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7674 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7675 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7676 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7677
7678 @need 1000
7679 For example:
7680
7681 @smallexample
7682 @group
7683 (@value{GDBP}) up
7684 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7685 at env.c:10
7686 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7687 @end group
7688 @end smallexample
7689
7690 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7691 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7692 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7693 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7694 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7695 for details.
7696
7697 @table @code
7698 @kindex select-frame
7699 @item select-frame
7700 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7701 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7702 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7703 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7704
7705 @kindex down-silently
7706 @kindex up-silently
7707 @item up-silently @var{n}
7708 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7709 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7710 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7711 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7712 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7713 distracting.
7714 @end table
7715
7716 @node Frame Info
7717 @section Information About a Frame
7718
7719 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7720 stack frame.
7721
7722 @table @code
7723 @item frame
7724 @itemx f
7725 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7726 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7727 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7728 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7729 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7730
7731 @kindex info frame
7732 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7733 @item info frame
7734 @itemx info f
7735 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7736 including:
7737
7738 @itemize @bullet
7739 @item
7740 the address of the frame
7741 @item
7742 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7743 @item
7744 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7745 @item
7746 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7747 @item
7748 the address of the frame's arguments
7749 @item
7750 the address of the frame's local variables
7751 @item
7752 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7753 @item
7754 which registers were saved in the frame
7755 @end itemize
7756
7757 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7758 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7759 the usual conventions.
7760
7761 @item info frame @var{addr}
7762 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7763 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7764 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7765 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7766 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7767 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7768
7769 @kindex info args
7770 @item info args
7771 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7772
7773 @item info locals
7774 @kindex info locals
7775 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7776 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7777 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7778
7779 @end table
7780
7781 @node Frame Apply
7782 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
7783 @kindex frame apply
7784 @cindex apply command to several frames
7785 @table @code
7786 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
7787 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
7788 @var{command} to one or more frames.
7789
7790 @table @code
7791 @item @code{all}
7792 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
7793
7794 @item @var{count}
7795 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
7796 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7797
7798 @item @var{-count}
7799 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
7800 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7801
7802 @item @code{level}
7803 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
7804 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
7805 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
7806 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
7807 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
7808 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
7809
7810 @end table
7811
7812 @end table
7813
7814 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
7815 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
7816 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}. See
7817 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
7818
7819 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
7820 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a frame. @var{flag}
7821 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
7822 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
7823 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
7824
7825 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
7826 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
7827 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
7828 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
7829
7830 @table @code
7831 @item -c
7832 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
7833 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
7834 @code{frame apply} then continues.
7835 @item -s
7836 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
7837 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
7838 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
7839 are not printed.
7840 @item -q
7841 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
7842 information.
7843 @end table
7844
7845 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
7846 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
7847 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
7848 @code{#1 main} frame.
7849
7850 @smallexample
7851 @group
7852 (gdb) frame apply all p j
7853 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7854 No symbol "j" in current context.
7855 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
7856 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7857 No symbol "j" in current context.
7858 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7859 $1 = 5
7860 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
7861 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7862 $2 = 5
7863 (gdb)
7864 @end group
7865 @end smallexample
7866
7867 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
7868 information before the command output:
7869
7870 @smallexample
7871 @group
7872 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
7873 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7874 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
7875 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7876 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
7877 (gdb)
7878 @end group
7879 @end smallexample
7880
7881 If flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
7882 @smallexample
7883 @group
7884 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
7885 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
7886 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
7887 (gdb)
7888 @end group
7889 @end smallexample
7890
7891 @table @code
7892
7893 @kindex faas
7894 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
7895 @item faas @var{command}
7896 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
7897 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
7898
7899 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
7900 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
7901 is, using:
7902 @smallexample
7903 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
7904 @end smallexample
7905
7906 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
7907 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
7908 @end table
7909
7910
7911 @node Frame Filter Management
7912 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7913 @cindex managing frame filters
7914
7915 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7916 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7917
7918 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7919 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7920
7921 @table @code
7922 @kindex info frame-filter
7923 @item info frame-filter
7924 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7925 their name, priority and enabled status.
7926
7927 @kindex disable frame-filter
7928 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7929 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7930 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7931 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7932 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7933 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7934 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7935 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7936 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7937 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7938 may be enabled again later.
7939
7940 @kindex enable frame-filter
7941 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7942 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7943 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7944 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7945 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7946 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7947 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7948 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7949 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7950
7951 Example:
7952
7953 @smallexample
7954 (gdb) info frame-filter
7955
7956 global frame-filters:
7957 Priority Enabled Name
7958 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7959 100 Yes Reverse
7960
7961 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7962 Priority Enabled Name
7963 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7964
7965 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7966 Priority Enabled Name
7967 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7968
7969 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7970 (gdb) info frame-filter
7971
7972 global frame-filters:
7973 Priority Enabled Name
7974 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7975 100 Yes Reverse
7976
7977 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7978 Priority Enabled Name
7979 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7980
7981 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7982 Priority Enabled Name
7983 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7984
7985 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7986 (gdb) info frame-filter
7987
7988 global frame-filters:
7989 Priority Enabled Name
7990 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7991 100 Yes Reverse
7992
7993 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7994 Priority Enabled Name
7995 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7996
7997 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7998 Priority Enabled Name
7999 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8000 @end smallexample
8001
8002 @kindex set frame-filter priority
8003 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
8004 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8005 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8006 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8007 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8008 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8009
8010 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8011 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8012 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8013 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8014 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8015 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8016 dictionary resides.
8017
8018 Example:
8019
8020 @smallexample
8021 (gdb) info frame-filter
8022
8023 global frame-filters:
8024 Priority Enabled Name
8025 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8026 100 Yes Reverse
8027
8028 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8029 Priority Enabled Name
8030 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8031
8032 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8033 Priority Enabled Name
8034 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8035
8036 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8037 (gdb) info frame-filter
8038
8039 global frame-filters:
8040 Priority Enabled Name
8041 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8042 50 Yes Reverse
8043
8044 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8045 Priority Enabled Name
8046 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8047
8048 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8049 Priority Enabled Name
8050 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8051 @end smallexample
8052 @end table
8053
8054 @node Source
8055 @chapter Examining Source Files
8056
8057 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8058 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8059 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8060 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8061 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8062 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8063 source files by explicit command.
8064
8065 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8066 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8067 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8068
8069 @menu
8070 * List:: Printing source lines
8071 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8072 * Edit:: Editing source files
8073 * Search:: Searching source files
8074 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8075 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8076 @end menu
8077
8078 @node List
8079 @section Printing Source Lines
8080
8081 @kindex list
8082 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8083 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8084 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8085 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8086 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8087
8088 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8089
8090 @table @code
8091 @item list @var{linenum}
8092 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8093 current source file.
8094
8095 @item list @var{function}
8096 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8097 @var{function}.
8098
8099 @item list
8100 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8101 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8102 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8103 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8104 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8105
8106 @item list -
8107 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8108 @end table
8109
8110 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8111 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8112 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8113
8114 @table @code
8115 @kindex set listsize
8116 @item set listsize @var{count}
8117 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8118 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8119 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8120 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8121
8122 @kindex show listsize
8123 @item show listsize
8124 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8125 @end table
8126
8127 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8128 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8129 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8130 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8131 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8132
8133 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8134 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8135 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8136 to specify some source line.
8137
8138 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8139
8140 @table @code
8141 @item list @var{location}
8142 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8143
8144 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8145 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8146 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8147 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8148 the same source file as the first location.
8149
8150 @item list ,@var{last}
8151 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8152
8153 @item list @var{first},
8154 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8155
8156 @item list +
8157 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8158
8159 @item list -
8160 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8161
8162 @item list
8163 As described in the preceding table.
8164 @end table
8165
8166 @node Specify Location
8167 @section Specifying a Location
8168 @cindex specifying location
8169 @cindex location
8170 @cindex source location
8171
8172 @menu
8173 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8174 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8175 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8176 @end menu
8177
8178 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8179 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8180 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8181 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8182 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8183
8184 @node Linespec Locations
8185 @subsection Linespec Locations
8186 @cindex linespec locations
8187
8188 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8189 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8190 specifying a linespec:
8191
8192 @table @code
8193 @item @var{linenum}
8194 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8195
8196 @item -@var{offset}
8197 @itemx +@var{offset}
8198 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8199 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8200 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8201 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8202 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8203 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8204 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8205 linespec.
8206
8207 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8208 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8209 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8210 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8211 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8212 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8213 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8214
8215 @item @var{function}
8216 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8217 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8218
8219 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8220 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8221 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8222 means in all packages.
8223
8224 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8225 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8226 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8227
8228 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8229 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8230 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8231 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8232
8233 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8234
8235 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8236 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8237
8238 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8239 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8240 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8241 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8242 functions in different source files.
8243
8244 @item @var{label}
8245 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8246 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8247 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8248 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8249
8250 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8251 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8252 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8253 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8254 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8255 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8256
8257 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8258 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8259 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8260 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8261 each one of those probes.
8262 @end table
8263
8264 @node Explicit Locations
8265 @subsection Explicit Locations
8266 @cindex explicit locations
8267
8268 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8269 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8270
8271 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8272 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8273 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8274 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8275 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8276
8277 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8278 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8279 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8280 the symbol table to know.
8281
8282 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8283 following table:
8284
8285 @table @code
8286 @item -source @var{filename}
8287 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8288 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8289 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8290 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8291 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8292
8293 @item -function @var{function}
8294 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8295 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8296 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8297 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8298
8299 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8300 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8301 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8302 means in all packages.
8303
8304 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8305 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8306 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8307 breakpoint on both symbols.
8308
8309 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8310
8311 @item -qualified
8312
8313 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8314 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8315
8316 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8317 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8318 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8319
8320 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8321 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8322 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8323
8324 @item -label @var{label}
8325 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8326 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8327 selected stack frame.
8328
8329 @item -line @var{number}
8330 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8331 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8332 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8333 relative to the current line.
8334 @end table
8335
8336 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8337 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8338
8339 @node Address Locations
8340 @subsection Address Locations
8341 @cindex address locations
8342
8343 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8344 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8345
8346 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8347 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8348 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8349 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8350 source files.
8351
8352 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8353 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8354 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8355 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8356 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8357 of @var{address}:
8358
8359 @table @code
8360 @item @var{expression}
8361 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8362
8363 @item @var{funcaddr}
8364 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8365 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8366 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8367 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8368 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8369 (although the Pascal form also works).
8370
8371 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8372 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8373
8374 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8375 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8376 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8377 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8378 functions with identical names in different source files.
8379 @end table
8380
8381 @node Edit
8382 @section Editing Source Files
8383 @cindex editing source files
8384
8385 @kindex edit
8386 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8387 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8388 The editing program of your choice
8389 is invoked with the current line set to
8390 the active line in the program.
8391 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8392 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8393
8394 @table @code
8395 @item edit @var{location}
8396 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8397 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8398 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8399 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8400 command most commonly used:
8401
8402 @table @code
8403 @item edit @var{number}
8404 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8405
8406 @item edit @var{function}
8407 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8408 @end table
8409
8410 @end table
8411
8412 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8413 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8414 @footnote{
8415 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8416 following command-line syntax:
8417 @smallexample
8418 ex +@var{number} file
8419 @end smallexample
8420 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8421 the file where to start editing.}.
8422 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8423 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8424 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8425 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8426 @smallexample
8427 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8428 export EDITOR
8429 gdb @dots{}
8430 @end smallexample
8431 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8432 @smallexample
8433 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8434 gdb @dots{}
8435 @end smallexample
8436
8437 @node Search
8438 @section Searching Source Files
8439 @cindex searching source files
8440
8441 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8442 regular expression.
8443
8444 @table @code
8445 @kindex search
8446 @kindex forward-search
8447 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8448 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8449 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8450 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8451 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8452 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8453 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8454 @code{fo}.
8455
8456 @kindex reverse-search
8457 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8458 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8459 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8460 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8461 this command as @code{rev}.
8462 @end table
8463
8464 @node Source Path
8465 @section Specifying Source Directories
8466
8467 @cindex source path
8468 @cindex directories for source files
8469 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8470 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8471 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8472 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8473 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8474 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8475 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8476
8477 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8478 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8479 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8480 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8481 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8482 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8483 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8484 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8485 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8486 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8487 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8488
8489 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8490 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8491 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8492 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8493 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8494 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8495
8496 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8497 source files.
8498
8499 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8500 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8501 each line is in the file.
8502
8503 @kindex directory
8504 @kindex dir
8505 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8506 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8507 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8508
8509 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8510 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8511
8512 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8513 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8514 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8515 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8516 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8517 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8518 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8519 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8520 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8521 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8522 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8523 name to look up the sources.
8524
8525 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8526 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8527 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8528 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8529 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8530 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8531 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8532 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8533
8534 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8535 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8536 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8537 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8538 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8539 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8540 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8541
8542 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8543 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8544 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8545 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8546 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8547 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8548 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8549 command.
8550
8551 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8552 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8553 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8554 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8555 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8556 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8557 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8558
8559 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8560 @cindex default source path substitution
8561 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8562 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8563 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8564 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8565 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8566 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8567 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8568 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8569 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8570 together.
8571
8572 @table @code
8573 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8574 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8575 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8576 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8577 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8578 part of absolute file names) or
8579 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8580 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8581
8582 @kindex cdir
8583 @kindex cwd
8584 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8585 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8586 @cindex compilation directory
8587 @cindex current directory
8588 @cindex working directory
8589 @cindex directory, current
8590 @cindex directory, compilation
8591 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8592 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8593 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8594 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8595 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8596 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8597
8598 @item directory
8599 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8600
8601 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8602 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8603
8604 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8605 @kindex set directories
8606 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8607 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8608
8609 @item show directories
8610 @kindex show directories
8611 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8612
8613 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8614 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8615 @kindex set substitute-path
8616 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8617 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8618 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8619
8620 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8621 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8622
8623 @smallexample
8624 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8625 @end smallexample
8626
8627 @noindent
8628 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8629 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8630 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8631
8632 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8633 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8634 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8635 the substitution.
8636
8637 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8638
8639 @smallexample
8640 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8641 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8642 @end smallexample
8643
8644 @noindent
8645 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8646 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8647 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8648 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8649
8650
8651 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8652 @kindex unset substitute-path
8653 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8654 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8655 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8656
8657 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8658
8659 @item show substitute-path [path]
8660 @kindex show substitute-path
8661 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8662 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8663
8664 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8665 rules.
8666
8667 @end table
8668
8669 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8670 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8671 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8672
8673 @enumerate
8674 @item
8675 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8676
8677 @item
8678 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8679 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8680 directories in one command.
8681 @end enumerate
8682
8683 @node Machine Code
8684 @section Source and Machine Code
8685 @cindex source line and its code address
8686
8687 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8688 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8689 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8690 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8691 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8692 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8693 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8694 well as hex.
8695
8696 @table @code
8697 @kindex info line
8698 @item info line
8699 @itemx info line @var{location}
8700 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8701 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8702 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
8703 information about the current source line is printed.
8704 @end table
8705
8706 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8707 the object code for the first line of function
8708 @code{m4_changequote}:
8709
8710 @smallexample
8711 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8712 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
8713 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
8714 @end smallexample
8715
8716 @noindent
8717 @cindex code address and its source line
8718 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8719 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8720 @smallexample
8721 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8722 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
8723 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
8724 @end smallexample
8725
8726 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8727 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8728 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8729 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8730 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8731 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8732 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8733 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8734 Variables}).
8735
8736 @cindex info line, repeated calls
8737 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
8738 specifying a location will display information about the next source
8739 line.
8740
8741 @table @code
8742 @kindex disassemble
8743 @cindex assembly instructions
8744 @cindex instructions, assembly
8745 @cindex machine instructions
8746 @cindex listing machine instructions
8747 @item disassemble
8748 @itemx disassemble /m
8749 @itemx disassemble /s
8750 @itemx disassemble /r
8751 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8752 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8753 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8754 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8755 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8756 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8757 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8758 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8759 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8760 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8761
8762 @table @code
8763 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8764 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8765 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8766 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8767 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8768 @end table
8769
8770 @noindent
8771 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8772 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8773
8774 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8775 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8776
8777 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8778 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8779 @end table
8780
8781 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8782 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8783
8784 @smallexample
8785 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8786 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8787 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8788 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8789 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8790 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8791 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8792 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8793 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8794 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8795 End of assembler dump.
8796 @end smallexample
8797
8798 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8799 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8800 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8801
8802 @smallexample
8803 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8804 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8805 5 @{
8806 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8807 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8808 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8809 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8810 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8811
8812 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8813 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8814 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8815
8816 7 return 0;
8817 8 @}
8818 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8819 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8820 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8821
8822 End of assembler dump.
8823 @end smallexample
8824
8825 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8826 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8827 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8828 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8829 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8830 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8831 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8832 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8833 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8834
8835 @file{foo.h}:
8836
8837 @smallexample
8838 int
8839 foo (int a)
8840 @{
8841 if (a < 0)
8842 return a * 2;
8843 if (a == 0)
8844 return 1;
8845 return a + 10;
8846 @}
8847 @end smallexample
8848
8849 @file{foo.c}:
8850
8851 @smallexample
8852 #include "foo.h"
8853 volatile int x, y;
8854 int
8855 main ()
8856 @{
8857 x = foo (y);
8858 return 0;
8859 @}
8860 @end smallexample
8861
8862 @smallexample
8863 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8864 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8865 5 @{
8866
8867 6 x = foo (y);
8868 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8869 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8870
8871 7 return 0;
8872 8 @}
8873 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8874 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8875 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8876 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8877
8878 End of assembler dump.
8879 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8880 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8881 foo.c:
8882 5 @{
8883 6 x = foo (y);
8884 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8885
8886 foo.h:
8887 4 if (a < 0)
8888 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8889 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8890
8891 6 if (a == 0)
8892 7 return 1;
8893 8 return a + 10;
8894 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8895 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8896 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8897 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8898
8899 foo.c:
8900 6 x = foo (y);
8901 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8902
8903 7 return 0;
8904 8 @}
8905 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8906 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8907
8908 foo.h:
8909 5 return a * 2;
8910 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8911 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8912 End of assembler dump.
8913 @end smallexample
8914
8915 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8916
8917 @smallexample
8918 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8919 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8920 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8921 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8922 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8923 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8924 End of assembler dump.
8925 @end smallexample
8926
8927 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8928 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8929 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8930 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8931
8932 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8933 mnemonics or other syntax.
8934
8935 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8936 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8937 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8938 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8939 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8940
8941 @table @code
8942 @kindex set disassembler-options
8943 @cindex disassembler options
8944 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
8945 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
8946 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
8947 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
8948 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
8949 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
8950 The default value is the empty string.
8951
8952 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
8953 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
8954 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
8955 and S/390.
8956
8957 @kindex show disassembler-options
8958 @item show disassembler-options
8959 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
8960 @end table
8961
8962 @table @code
8963 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8964 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8965 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8966 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8967 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8968 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8969
8970 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8971 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8972 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8973 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8974
8975 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8976 @item show disassembly-flavor
8977 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8978 @end table
8979
8980 @table @code
8981 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8982 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8983 @item set disassemble-next-line
8984 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8985 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8986 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8987 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8988 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8989 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8990 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8991 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8992 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8993 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8994 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8995 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8996 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8997 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8998 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8999 instruction.
9000 @end table
9001
9002
9003 @node Data
9004 @chapter Examining Data
9005
9006 @cindex printing data
9007 @cindex examining data
9008 @kindex print
9009 @kindex inspect
9010 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9011 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9012 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9013 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9014 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9015 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9016
9017 @table @code
9018 @item print @var{expr}
9019 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
9020 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9021 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9022 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9023 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9024 Formats}.
9025
9026 @item print
9027 @itemx print /@var{f}
9028 @cindex reprint the last value
9029 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9030 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9031 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9032 @end table
9033
9034 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9035 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9036 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9037
9038 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9039 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9040 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9041 Table}.
9042
9043 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9044 @kindex explore
9045 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9046 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9047 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9048 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9049 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9050 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9051 embedded in the higher level data types.
9052
9053 @table @code
9054 @item explore @var{arg}
9055 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9056 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9057 @end table
9058
9059 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9060 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9061 C program as
9062
9063 @smallexample
9064 struct SimpleStruct
9065 @{
9066 int i;
9067 double d;
9068 @};
9069
9070 struct ComplexStruct
9071 @{
9072 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9073 int arr[10];
9074 @};
9075 @end smallexample
9076
9077 @noindent
9078 followed by variable declarations as
9079
9080 @smallexample
9081 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9082 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9083 @end smallexample
9084
9085 @noindent
9086 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9087 @code{explore} command as follows.
9088
9089 @smallexample
9090 (gdb) explore cs
9091 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9092 the following fields:
9093
9094 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9095 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
9096
9097 Enter the field number of choice:
9098 @end smallexample
9099
9100 @noindent
9101 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
9102 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
9103 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
9104 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
9105 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
9106 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
9107 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
9108 field will be explored as if it were an array.
9109
9110 @smallexample
9111 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
9112 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
9113 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
9114 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
9115
9116 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
9117 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
9118
9119 Press enter to return to parent value:
9120 @end smallexample
9121
9122 @noindent
9123 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
9124 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
9125 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
9126 to explore.
9127
9128 @smallexample
9129 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
9130 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
9131
9132 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
9133
9134 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
9135
9136 Press enter to return to parent value:
9137 @end smallexample
9138
9139 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
9140 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
9141 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
9142 level data structure).
9143
9144 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
9145 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
9146 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
9147 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
9148 same example as above, your can explore the type
9149 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
9150 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
9151
9152 @smallexample
9153 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
9154 @end smallexample
9155
9156 @noindent
9157 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
9158 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
9159 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
9160 example.
9161
9162 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
9163 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
9164 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
9165 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
9166 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
9167
9168 @table @code
9169 @item explore value @var{expr}
9170 @cindex explore value
9171 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
9172 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
9173 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
9174 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
9175 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
9176
9177 @item explore type @var{arg}
9178 @cindex explore type
9179 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
9180 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
9181 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
9182 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
9183 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
9184 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
9185 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
9186 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
9187 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
9188 @end table
9189
9190 @menu
9191 * Expressions:: Expressions
9192 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9193 * Variables:: Program variables
9194 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9195 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9196 * Memory:: Examining memory
9197 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9198 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9199 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9200 * Value History:: Value history
9201 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9202 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9203 * Registers:: Registers
9204 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9205 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9206 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9207 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9208 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9209 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9210 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9211 character set than GDB does
9212 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9213 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9214 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9215 @end menu
9216
9217 @node Expressions
9218 @section Expressions
9219
9220 @cindex expressions
9221 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9222 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9223 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9224 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9225 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9226 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9227 @ref{Compilation}.
9228
9229 @cindex arrays in expressions
9230 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9231 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9232 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9233 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9234 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9235 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9236
9237 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9238 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9239 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9240 languages.
9241
9242 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9243 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9244
9245 @cindex casts, in expressions
9246 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9247 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9248 at that address in memory.
9249 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9250
9251 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9252 to programming languages:
9253
9254 @table @code
9255 @item @@
9256 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9257 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9258
9259 @item ::
9260 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9261 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9262
9263 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9264 @cindex type casting memory
9265 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9266 @cindex casts, to view memory
9267 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9268 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9269 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9270 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9271 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9272 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9273 @end table
9274
9275 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9276 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9277 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9278
9279 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9280 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9281 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9282 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9283 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9284 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9285 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9286
9287 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9288 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9289 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9290 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9291 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9292 as well.
9293
9294 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9295 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9296 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9297 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9298 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9299 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9300 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9301 choices.
9302
9303 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9304 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9305 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9306
9307 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9308 @smallexample
9309 @group
9310 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9311 [0] cancel
9312 [1] all
9313 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9314 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9315 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9316 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9317 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9318 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9319 > 2 4 6
9320 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9321 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9322 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9323 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9324 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9325 breakpoints.
9326 (@value{GDBP})
9327 @end group
9328 @end smallexample
9329
9330 @table @code
9331 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9332 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9333 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9334
9335 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9336 is ambiguous.
9337
9338 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9339 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9340 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9341 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9342 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9343 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9344 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9345 in the use of the menu.
9346
9347 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9348 when an ambiguity is detected.
9349
9350 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9351 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9352
9353 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9354 @item show multiple-symbols
9355 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9356 @end table
9357
9358 @node Variables
9359 @section Program Variables
9360
9361 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9362 in your program.
9363
9364 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9365 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9366
9367 @itemize @bullet
9368 @item
9369 global (or file-static)
9370 @end itemize
9371
9372 @noindent or
9373
9374 @itemize @bullet
9375 @item
9376 visible according to the scope rules of the
9377 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9378 @end itemize
9379
9380 @noindent This means that in the function
9381
9382 @smallexample
9383 foo (a)
9384 int a;
9385 @{
9386 bar (a);
9387 @{
9388 int b = test ();
9389 bar (b);
9390 @}
9391 @}
9392 @end smallexample
9393
9394 @noindent
9395 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9396 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9397 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9398 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9399
9400 @cindex variable name conflict
9401 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9402 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9403 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9404 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9405 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9406 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9407 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9408
9409 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9410 @ifnotinfo
9411 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9412 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9413 @end ifnotinfo
9414 @smallexample
9415 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9416 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9417 @end smallexample
9418
9419 @noindent
9420 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9421 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9422 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9423 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9424
9425 @smallexample
9426 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9427 @end smallexample
9428
9429 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9430 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9431 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9432 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9433 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9434
9435 @smallexample
9436 void
9437 foo (int a)
9438 @{
9439 if (a < 10)
9440 bar (a);
9441 else
9442 process (a); /* Stop here */
9443 @}
9444
9445 int
9446 bar (int a)
9447 @{
9448 foo (a + 5);
9449 @}
9450 @end smallexample
9451
9452 @noindent
9453 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9454 here is what you might see
9455 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9456
9457 @smallexample
9458 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9459 $1 = 10
9460 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9461 $2 = 5
9462 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9463 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9464 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9465 $3 = 5
9466 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9467 $4 = 0
9468 @end smallexample
9469
9470 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9471 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9472 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9473 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9474 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9475
9476 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9477 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9478 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9479 @code{some_global}.
9480
9481 @smallexample
9482 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9483 $1 = 23
9484 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9485 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9486 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9487 $2 = 27
9488 @end smallexample
9489
9490 @cindex wrong values
9491 @cindex variable values, wrong
9492 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9493 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9494 @quotation
9495 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9496 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9497 scope, and just before exit.
9498 @end quotation
9499 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9500 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9501 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9502 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9503 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9504 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9505 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9506 variable definitions may be gone.
9507
9508 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9509 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9510 when compiling.
9511
9512 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9513 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9514 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9515 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9516 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9517 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9518 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9519
9520 @smallexample
9521 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9522 @end smallexample
9523
9524 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9525 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9526 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9527 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9528 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9529
9530 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9531 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9532 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9533 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9534
9535 @cindex no debug info variables
9536 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9537 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9538 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9539 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9540 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9541 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9542 example, in a C program:
9543
9544 @smallexample
9545 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9546 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9547 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9548 $1 = 3.14
9549 @end smallexample
9550
9551 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9552 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9553 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9554 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9555 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9556
9557 @smallexample
9558 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9559 29 i++;
9560 (gdb) next
9561 30 e (i);
9562 (gdb) print i
9563 $1 = 31
9564 (gdb) print i@@entry
9565 $2 = 30
9566 @end smallexample
9567
9568 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9569 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9570 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9571 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9572 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9573 For program code
9574
9575 @smallexample
9576 char var0[] = "A";
9577 signed char var1[] = "A";
9578 @end smallexample
9579
9580 You get during debugging
9581 @smallexample
9582 (gdb) print var0
9583 $1 = "A"
9584 (gdb) print var1
9585 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9586 @end smallexample
9587
9588 @node Arrays
9589 @section Artificial Arrays
9590
9591 @cindex artificial array
9592 @cindex arrays
9593 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9594 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9595 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9596 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9597 program.
9598
9599 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9600 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9601 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9602 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9603 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9604 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9605 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9606 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9607 example. If a program says
9608
9609 @smallexample
9610 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9611 @end smallexample
9612
9613 @noindent
9614 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9615
9616 @smallexample
9617 p *array@@len
9618 @end smallexample
9619
9620 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9621 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9622 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9623 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9624 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9625
9626 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9627 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9628 The value need not be in memory:
9629 @smallexample
9630 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9631 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9632 @end smallexample
9633
9634 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9635 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9636 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9637 @smallexample
9638 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9639 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9640 @end smallexample
9641
9642 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9643 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9644 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9645 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9646 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9647 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9648 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9649 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9650 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9651 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9652
9653 @smallexample
9654 set $i = 0
9655 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9656 @key{RET}
9657 @key{RET}
9658 @dots{}
9659 @end smallexample
9660
9661 @node Output Formats
9662 @section Output Formats
9663
9664 @cindex formatted output
9665 @cindex output formats
9666 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9667 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9668 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9669 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9670 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9671
9672 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9673 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9674 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9675 letters supported are:
9676
9677 @table @code
9678 @item x
9679 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9680 hexadecimal.
9681
9682 @item d
9683 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9684
9685 @item u
9686 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9687
9688 @item o
9689 Print as integer in octal.
9690
9691 @item t
9692 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9693 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9694 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9695 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9696
9697 @item a
9698 @cindex unknown address, locating
9699 @cindex locate address
9700 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9701 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9702 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9703
9704 @smallexample
9705 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9706 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9707 @end smallexample
9708
9709 @noindent
9710 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9711 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9712
9713 @item c
9714 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9715 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9716 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9717 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9718
9719 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9720 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9721 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9722 data.
9723
9724 @item f
9725 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9726 using typical floating point syntax.
9727
9728 @item s
9729 @cindex printing strings
9730 @cindex printing byte arrays
9731 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9732 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9733 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9734 natural types.
9735
9736 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9737 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9738 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9739 array.
9740
9741 @item z
9742 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9743 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9744 to the size of the integer type.
9745
9746 @item r
9747 @cindex raw printing
9748 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9749 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9750 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9751 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9752 pretty-printer which might exist.
9753 @end table
9754
9755 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9756
9757 @smallexample
9758 p/x $pc
9759 @end smallexample
9760
9761 @noindent
9762 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9763 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9764
9765 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9766 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9767 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9768
9769 @node Memory
9770 @section Examining Memory
9771
9772 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9773 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9774
9775 @cindex examining memory
9776 @table @code
9777 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9778 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9779 @itemx x @var{addr}
9780 @itemx x
9781 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9782 @end table
9783
9784 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9785 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9786 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9787 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9788 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9789
9790 @table @r
9791 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9792 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9793 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9794 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9795 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9796 @c 4.1.2.
9797
9798 @item @var{f}, the display format
9799 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9800 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9801 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9802 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9803 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9804
9805 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9806 The unit size is any of
9807
9808 @table @code
9809 @item b
9810 Bytes.
9811 @item h
9812 Halfwords (two bytes).
9813 @item w
9814 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9815 @item g
9816 Giant words (eight bytes).
9817 @end table
9818
9819 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9820 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9821 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9822 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9823 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9824 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9825 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9826 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9827 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9828 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9829 be altered.
9830
9831 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9832 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9833 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9834 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9835 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9836 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9837 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9838 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9839 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9840 a value from memory).
9841 @end table
9842
9843 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9844 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9845 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9846 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9847 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9848
9849 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9850 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9851 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9852
9853 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9854 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9855 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9856 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9857 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9858
9859 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9860 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9861 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9862 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9863 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9864 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9865 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9866 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9867 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9868
9869 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9870 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9871 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9872 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9873 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9874 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9875
9876 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9877 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9878 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9879 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9880 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9881 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9882 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9883
9884 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9885 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9886
9887 @smallexample
9888 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9889 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9890 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9891 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9892 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9893 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9894 @end smallexample
9895
9896 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9897 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9898 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9899 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9900 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9901 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9902 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9903 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9904 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9905
9906 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9907 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9908 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9909
9910 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9911 @cindex addressable memory unit
9912 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9913 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9914 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9915 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9916 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9917 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9918 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9919 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9920 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9921
9922 @cindex remote memory comparison
9923 @cindex target memory comparison
9924 @cindex verify remote memory image
9925 @cindex verify target memory image
9926 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9927 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9928 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9929 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9930 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9931 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9932
9933 @table @code
9934 @kindex compare-sections
9935 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9936 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9937 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9938 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9939 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9940 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9941
9942 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9943 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9944 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9945 @end table
9946
9947 @node Auto Display
9948 @section Automatic Display
9949 @cindex automatic display
9950 @cindex display of expressions
9951
9952 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9953 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9954 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9955 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9956 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9957 The automatic display looks like this:
9958
9959 @smallexample
9960 2: foo = 38
9961 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9962 @end smallexample
9963
9964 @noindent
9965 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9966 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9967 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9968 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9969 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9970 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9971
9972 @table @code
9973 @kindex display
9974 @item display @var{expr}
9975 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9976 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9977
9978 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9979
9980 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9981 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9982 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9983 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9984 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9985
9986 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9987 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9988 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9989 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9990 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9991 @end table
9992
9993 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9994 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9995 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9996
9997 @table @code
9998 @kindex delete display
9999 @kindex undisplay
10000 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
10001 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10002 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
10003 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
10004 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
10005 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
10006 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10007
10008 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10009 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10010
10011 @kindex disable display
10012 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10013 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10014 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10015 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10016 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10017 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10018 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10019 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10020
10021 @kindex enable display
10022 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10023 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10024 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10025 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10026 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10027 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10028 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10029
10030 @item display
10031 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10032 done when your program stops.
10033
10034 @kindex info display
10035 @item info display
10036 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10037 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10038 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10039 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10040 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10041 @end table
10042
10043 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10044 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10045 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10046 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10047 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10048 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10049 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10050 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10051 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10052 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10053 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10054
10055 @node Print Settings
10056 @section Print Settings
10057
10058 @cindex format options
10059 @cindex print settings
10060 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10061 and symbols are printed.
10062
10063 @noindent
10064 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10065
10066 @table @code
10067 @kindex set print
10068 @item set print address
10069 @itemx set print address on
10070 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10071 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10072 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10073 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10074 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10075 @code{set print address on}:
10076
10077 @smallexample
10078 @group
10079 (@value{GDBP}) f
10080 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10081 at input.c:530
10082 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10083 @end group
10084 @end smallexample
10085
10086 @item set print address off
10087 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10088 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10089
10090 @smallexample
10091 @group
10092 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10093 (@value{GDBP}) f
10094 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
10095 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10096 @end group
10097 @end smallexample
10098
10099 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
10100 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
10101 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
10102 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
10103
10104 @kindex show print
10105 @item show print address
10106 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
10107 @end table
10108
10109 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
10110 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
10111 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
10112 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
10113 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
10114 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
10115 it prints a symbolic address:
10116
10117 @table @code
10118 @item set print symbol-filename on
10119 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
10120 @cindex symbol, source file and line
10121 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
10122 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10123
10124 @item set print symbol-filename off
10125 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
10126 default.
10127
10128 @item show print symbol-filename
10129 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
10130 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10131 @end table
10132
10133 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
10134 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
10135 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
10136
10137 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
10138 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
10139
10140 @table @code
10141 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
10142 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
10143 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
10144 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
10145 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
10146 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
10147 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
10148 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
10149
10150 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
10151 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
10152 symbolic address.
10153 @end table
10154
10155 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
10156 @cindex pointer, finding referent
10157 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
10158 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
10159 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
10160 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
10161 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
10162 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
10163
10164 @smallexample
10165 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
10166 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
10167 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
10168 @end smallexample
10169
10170 @quotation
10171 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
10172 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
10173 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
10174 @end quotation
10175
10176 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
10177 @samp{set print symbol on}:
10178
10179 @table @code
10180 @item set print symbol on
10181 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
10182 one exists.
10183
10184 @item set print symbol off
10185 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
10186 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
10187 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
10188
10189 @item show print symbol
10190 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
10191 address.
10192 @end table
10193
10194 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10195
10196 @table @code
10197 @item set print array
10198 @itemx set print array on
10199 @cindex pretty print arrays
10200 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10201 but uses more space. The default is off.
10202
10203 @item set print array off
10204 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10205
10206 @item show print array
10207 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10208 arrays.
10209
10210 @cindex print array indexes
10211 @item set print array-indexes
10212 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10213 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10214 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10215 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10216
10217 @item set print array-indexes off
10218 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10219
10220 @item show print array-indexes
10221 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10222 arrays.
10223
10224 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10225 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10226 @cindex number of array elements to print
10227 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10228 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10229 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10230 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10231 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10232 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10233 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10234 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10235
10236 @item show print elements
10237 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10238 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10239
10240 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10241 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10242 @cindex printing frame argument values
10243 @cindex print all frame argument values
10244 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10245 @cindex do not print frame argument values
10246 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10247 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10248 values are:
10249
10250 @table @code
10251 @item all
10252 The values of all arguments are printed.
10253
10254 @item scalars
10255 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10256 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10257 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10258 only scalar arguments are shown:
10259
10260 @smallexample
10261 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10262 at frame-args.c:23
10263 @end smallexample
10264
10265 @item none
10266 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10267 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10268
10269 @smallexample
10270 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10271 at frame-args.c:23
10272 @end smallexample
10273 @end table
10274
10275 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10276 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10277 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10278 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10279 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10280 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10281 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10282 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10283 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
10284 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10285
10286 @item show print frame-arguments
10287 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10288
10289 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
10290 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10291
10292 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
10293 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10294 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10295 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10296 This is the default.
10297
10298 @item show print raw frame-arguments
10299 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10300
10301 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10302 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10303 @kindex set print entry-values
10304 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10305 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10306 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10307 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10308 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10309
10310 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10311 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10312 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10313 @code{no} setting.
10314
10315 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10316 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10317 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10318 this information.
10319
10320 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10321
10322 @table @code
10323 @item no
10324 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10325 point.
10326 @smallexample
10327 #0 equal (val=5)
10328 #0 different (val=6)
10329 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10330 #0 born (val=10)
10331 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10332 @end smallexample
10333
10334 @item only
10335 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10336 values are never printed.
10337 @smallexample
10338 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10339 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10340 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10341 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10342 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10343 @end smallexample
10344
10345 @item preferred
10346 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10347 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10348 value for such parameter.
10349 @smallexample
10350 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10351 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10352 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10353 #0 born (val=10)
10354 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10355 @end smallexample
10356
10357 @item if-needed
10358 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10359 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10360 parameter.
10361 @smallexample
10362 #0 equal (val=5)
10363 #0 different (val=6)
10364 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10365 #0 born (val=10)
10366 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10367 @end smallexample
10368
10369 @item both
10370 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10371 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10372 optimizations.
10373 @smallexample
10374 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10375 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10376 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10377 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10378 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10379 @end smallexample
10380
10381 @item compact
10382 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10383 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10384 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10385 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10386 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10387 @smallexample
10388 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10389 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10390 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10391 #0 born (val=10)
10392 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10393 @end smallexample
10394
10395 @item default
10396 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10397 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10398 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10399 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10400 @smallexample
10401 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10402 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10403 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10404 #0 born (val=10)
10405 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10406 @end smallexample
10407 @end table
10408
10409 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10410 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10411
10412 @item show print entry-values
10413 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10414 entry.
10415
10416 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10417 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10418 @cindex repeated array elements
10419 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10420 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10421 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10422 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10423 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10424 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10425 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10426 is 10.
10427
10428 @item show print repeats
10429 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10430 elements.
10431
10432 @item set print null-stop
10433 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10434 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10435 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10436 contain only short strings.
10437 The default is off.
10438
10439 @item show print null-stop
10440 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10441 @sc{null} character.
10442
10443 @item set print pretty on
10444 @cindex print structures in indented form
10445 @cindex indentation in structure display
10446 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10447 per line, like this:
10448
10449 @smallexample
10450 @group
10451 $1 = @{
10452 next = 0x0,
10453 flags = @{
10454 sweet = 1,
10455 sour = 1
10456 @},
10457 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10458 @}
10459 @end group
10460 @end smallexample
10461
10462 @item set print pretty off
10463 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10464
10465 @smallexample
10466 @group
10467 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10468 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10469 @end group
10470 @end smallexample
10471
10472 @noindent
10473 This is the default format.
10474
10475 @item show print pretty
10476 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10477
10478 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10479 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10480 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10481 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10482 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10483 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10484 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10485 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10486
10487 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10488 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10489 international character sets, and is the default.
10490
10491 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10492 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10493
10494 @item set print union on
10495 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10496 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10497 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10498
10499 @item set print union off
10500 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10501 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10502 instead.
10503
10504 @item show print union
10505 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10506 structures and other unions.
10507
10508 For example, given the declarations
10509
10510 @smallexample
10511 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10512 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10513 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10514 Bug_forms;
10515
10516 struct thing @{
10517 Species it;
10518 union @{
10519 Tree_forms tree;
10520 Bug_forms bug;
10521 @} form;
10522 @};
10523
10524 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10525 @end smallexample
10526
10527 @noindent
10528 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10529
10530 @smallexample
10531 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10532 @end smallexample
10533
10534 @noindent
10535 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10536
10537 @smallexample
10538 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10539 @end smallexample
10540
10541 @noindent
10542 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10543 and in Pascal.
10544 @end table
10545
10546 @need 1000
10547 @noindent
10548 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10549
10550 @table @code
10551 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10552 @item set print demangle
10553 @itemx set print demangle on
10554 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10555 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10556 linkage. The default is on.
10557
10558 @item show print demangle
10559 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10560
10561 @item set print asm-demangle
10562 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10563 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10564 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10565 The default is off.
10566
10567 @item show print asm-demangle
10568 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10569 or demangled form.
10570
10571 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10572 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10573 @kindex set demangle-style
10574 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10575 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10576 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10577
10578 @table @code
10579 @item auto
10580 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10581 This is the default.
10582
10583 @item gnu
10584 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10585
10586 @item hp
10587 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10588
10589 @item lucid
10590 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10591
10592 @item arm
10593 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10594 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10595 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10596 require further enhancement to permit that.
10597
10598 @end table
10599 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10600
10601 @item show demangle-style
10602 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10603
10604 @item set print object
10605 @itemx set print object on
10606 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10607 @cindex display derived types
10608 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10609 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10610 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10611 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10612 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10613 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10614 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10615
10616 @item set print object off
10617 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10618 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10619
10620 @item show print object
10621 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10622
10623 @item set print static-members
10624 @itemx set print static-members on
10625 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10626 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10627
10628 @item set print static-members off
10629 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10630
10631 @item show print static-members
10632 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10633
10634 @item set print pascal_static-members
10635 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10636 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10637 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10638 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10639
10640 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10641 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10642
10643 @item show print pascal_static-members
10644 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10645
10646 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10647 @item set print vtbl
10648 @itemx set print vtbl on
10649 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10650 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10651 @cindex VTBL display
10652 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10653 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10654 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10655
10656 @item set print vtbl off
10657 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10658
10659 @item show print vtbl
10660 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10661 @end table
10662
10663 @node Pretty Printing
10664 @section Pretty Printing
10665
10666 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10667 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10668 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10669
10670 @menu
10671 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10672 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10673 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10674 @end menu
10675
10676 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10677 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10678
10679 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10680 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10681 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10682
10683 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10684 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10685 pretty-printers with their names.
10686 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10687 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10688 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10689 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10690
10691 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10692 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10693 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10694 do anything special.
10695
10696 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10697
10698 @itemize @bullet
10699 @item
10700 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10701 all inferiors.
10702
10703 @item
10704 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10705 when debugging that program.
10706 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10707
10708 @item
10709 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10710 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10711 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10712 @end itemize
10713
10714 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10715 pretty-printers are selected,
10716
10717 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10718 for new types.
10719
10720 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10721 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10722
10723 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10724
10725 @smallexample
10726 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10727 $1 = @{
10728 static npos = 4294967295,
10729 _M_dataplus = @{
10730 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10731 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10732 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10733 @},
10734 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10735 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10736 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10737 @}
10738 @}
10739 @end smallexample
10740
10741 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10742
10743 @smallexample
10744 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10745 $2 = "abcd"
10746 @end smallexample
10747
10748 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10749 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10750 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10751
10752 @table @code
10753 @kindex info pretty-printer
10754 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10755 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10756 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10757
10758 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10759 whose pretty-printers to list.
10760 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10761 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10762 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10763 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10764 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10765
10766 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10767 to list.
10768
10769 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10770 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10771 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10772 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10773
10774 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10775 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10776 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10777 @end table
10778
10779 Example:
10780
10781 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10782 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10783 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10784 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10785
10786 @smallexample
10787 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10788 library1.so:
10789 foo
10790 library2.so:
10791 bar
10792 bar1
10793 bar2
10794 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10795 library2.so:
10796 bar
10797 bar1
10798 bar2
10799 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10800 1 printer disabled
10801 2 of 3 printers enabled
10802 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10803 library1.so:
10804 foo [disabled]
10805 library2.so:
10806 bar
10807 bar1
10808 bar2
10809 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
10810 1 printer disabled
10811 1 of 3 printers enabled
10812 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10813 library1.so:
10814 foo [disabled]
10815 library2.so:
10816 bar
10817 bar1 [disabled]
10818 bar2
10819 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10820 1 printer disabled
10821 0 of 3 printers enabled
10822 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10823 library1.so:
10824 foo [disabled]
10825 library2.so:
10826 bar [disabled]
10827 bar1 [disabled]
10828 bar2
10829 @end smallexample
10830
10831 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10832 as can each individual subprinter.
10833
10834 @node Value History
10835 @section Value History
10836
10837 @cindex value history
10838 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10839 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10840 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10841 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10842 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10843 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10844 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10845 symbol table.
10846
10847 @cindex @code{$}
10848 @cindex @code{$$}
10849 @cindex history number
10850 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10851 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10852 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10853 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10854 history number.
10855
10856 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10857 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10858 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10859 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10860 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10861 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10862 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10863
10864 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10865 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10866
10867 @smallexample
10868 p *$
10869 @end smallexample
10870
10871 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10872 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10873
10874 @smallexample
10875 p *$.next
10876 @end smallexample
10877
10878 @noindent
10879 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10880 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10881
10882 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10883 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10884
10885 @smallexample
10886 print x
10887 set x=5
10888 @end smallexample
10889
10890 @noindent
10891 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10892 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10893
10894 @table @code
10895 @kindex show values
10896 @item show values
10897 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10898 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10899 values} does not change the history.
10900
10901 @item show values @var{n}
10902 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10903
10904 @item show values +
10905 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10906 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10907 @end table
10908
10909 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10910 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10911
10912 @node Convenience Vars
10913 @section Convenience Variables
10914
10915 @cindex convenience variables
10916 @cindex user-defined variables
10917 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10918 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10919 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10920 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10921 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10922
10923 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10924 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10925 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10926 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10927 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10928
10929 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10930 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10931 For example:
10932
10933 @smallexample
10934 set $foo = *object_ptr
10935 @end smallexample
10936
10937 @noindent
10938 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10939 @code{object_ptr}.
10940
10941 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10942 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10943 value with another assignment at any time.
10944
10945 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10946 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10947 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10948 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10949
10950 @table @code
10951 @kindex show convenience
10952 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10953 @item show convenience
10954 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10955 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10956 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10957
10958 @kindex init-if-undefined
10959 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10960 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10961 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10962 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10963 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10964 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10965 override default values used in a command script.
10966
10967 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10968 any side-effects do not occur.
10969 @end table
10970
10971 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10972 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10973 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10974
10975 @smallexample
10976 set $i = 0
10977 print bar[$i++]->contents
10978 @end smallexample
10979
10980 @noindent
10981 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10982
10983 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10984 values likely to be useful.
10985
10986 @table @code
10987 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10988 @item $_
10989 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10990 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10991 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10992 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10993 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10994 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10995 to the type of @code{$__}.
10996
10997 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10998 @item $__
10999 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
11000 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
11001 to match the format in which the data was printed.
11002
11003 @item $_exitcode
11004 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11005 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
11006 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
11007 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
11008
11009 @item $_exitsignal
11010 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11011 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
11012 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
11013 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
11014
11015 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
11016 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
11017 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
11018 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
11019 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
11020
11021 @smallexample
11022 #include <signal.h>
11023
11024 int
11025 main (int argc, char *argv[])
11026 @{
11027 raise (SIGALRM);
11028 return 0;
11029 @}
11030 @end smallexample
11031
11032 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
11033 or signalled would be:
11034
11035 @smallexample
11036 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
11037 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
11038 End with a line saying just ``end''.
11039 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
11040 >echo The program has exited\n
11041 >else
11042 >echo The program has signalled\n
11043 >end
11044 >end
11045 (@value{GDBP}) run
11046 Starting program:
11047
11048 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
11049 The program no longer exists.
11050 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11051 The program has signalled
11052 @end smallexample
11053
11054 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
11055 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
11056 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
11057 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
11058
11059 @smallexample
11060 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11061 The program has exited
11062 @end smallexample
11063
11064 @item $_exception
11065 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
11066 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11067
11068 @item $_probe_argc
11069 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
11070 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11071
11072 @item $_sdata
11073 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
11074 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
11075 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
11076 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
11077 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
11078
11079 @item $_siginfo
11080 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
11081 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
11082 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
11083 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
11084 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
11085
11086 @item $_tlb
11087 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
11088 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
11089 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
11090 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
11091 @xref{General Query Packets}.
11092 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
11093
11094 @item $_inferior
11095 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
11096 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
11097
11098 @item $_thread
11099 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
11100
11101 @item $_gthread
11102 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
11103
11104 @end table
11105
11106 @node Convenience Funs
11107 @section Convenience Functions
11108
11109 @cindex convenience functions
11110 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
11111 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
11112 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
11113 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
11114 @value{GDBN}.
11115
11116 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11117 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
11118
11119 @table @code
11120
11121 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
11122 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
11123 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
11124 returns zero.
11125
11126 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
11127 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
11128 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
11129 it is @code{void}:
11130
11131 @smallexample
11132 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11133 $1 = void
11134 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11135 $2 = 1
11136 (@value{GDBP}) run
11137 Starting program: ./a.out
11138 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
11139 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11140 $3 = 0
11141 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11142 $4 = 0
11143 @end smallexample
11144
11145 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
11146 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
11147 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
11148 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
11149 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
11150 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
11151 anymore.
11152
11153 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
11154 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
11155
11156 @smallexample
11157 void
11158 foo (void)
11159 @{
11160 @}
11161 @end smallexample
11162
11163 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
11164
11165 @smallexample
11166 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
11167 $1 = void
11168 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
11169 $2 = 1
11170 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
11171 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
11172 $3 = void
11173 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
11174 $4 = 1
11175 @end smallexample
11176
11177 @end table
11178
11179 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11180 @code{Python} support.
11181
11182 @table @code
11183
11184 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
11185 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
11186 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
11187 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
11188 Otherwise it returns zero.
11189
11190 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
11191 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11192 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11193 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11194 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11195 regular expression support.
11196
11197 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11198 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11199 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
11200 Otherwise it returns zero.
11201
11202 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
11203 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
11204 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
11205
11206 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11207 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11208 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11209 Otherwise it returns zero.
11210
11211 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11212 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11213 The default is 1.
11214
11215 Example:
11216
11217 @smallexample
11218 (gdb) backtrace
11219 #0 bottom_func ()
11220 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
11221 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
11222 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
11223 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
11224 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
11225 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
11226 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
11227 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
11228 $1 = 1
11229 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
11230 $1 = 1
11231 @end smallexample
11232
11233 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11234 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11235 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
11236 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11237
11238 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11239 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11240 The default is 1.
11241
11242 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11243 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11244 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11245 Otherwise it returns zero.
11246
11247 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11248 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11249 The default is 1.
11250
11251 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
11252 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11253 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
11254 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11255
11256 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11257 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11258 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
11259 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11260
11261 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11262 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11263 The default is 1.
11264
11265 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
11266 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11267 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
11268 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11269
11270 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
11271 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
11272 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
11273
11274 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
11275 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
11276 an enumerated type:
11277
11278 @smallexample
11279 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
11280 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
11281 @end smallexample
11282
11283 @end table
11284
11285 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
11286 convenience functions.
11287
11288 @table @code
11289 @item help function
11290 @kindex help function
11291 @cindex show all convenience functions
11292 Print a list of all convenience functions.
11293 @end table
11294
11295 @node Registers
11296 @section Registers
11297
11298 @cindex registers
11299 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
11300 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
11301 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
11302 your machine.
11303
11304 @table @code
11305 @kindex info registers
11306 @item info registers
11307 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11308 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11309
11310 @kindex info all-registers
11311 @cindex floating point registers
11312 @item info all-registers
11313 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11314 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11315
11316 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
11317 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
11318 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
11319 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
11320
11321 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11322 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11323 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11324 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11325 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11326 @end table
11327
11328 @anchor{standard registers}
11329 @cindex stack pointer register
11330 @cindex program counter register
11331 @cindex process status register
11332 @cindex frame pointer register
11333 @cindex standard registers
11334 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11335 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11336 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11337 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11338 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11339 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11340 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11341 you could print the program counter in hex with
11342
11343 @smallexample
11344 p/x $pc
11345 @end smallexample
11346
11347 @noindent
11348 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11349
11350 @smallexample
11351 x/i $pc
11352 @end smallexample
11353
11354 @noindent
11355 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11356 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11357 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11358 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11359 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11360 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11361 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11362
11363 @smallexample
11364 set $sp += 4
11365 @end smallexample
11366
11367 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11368 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11369 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11370 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11371 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11372 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11373 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11374
11375 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11376 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11377 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11378 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11379 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11380 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11381 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11382
11383 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11384 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11385 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11386 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11387 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11388 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11389 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11390 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11391 prints the data in both formats.
11392
11393 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11394 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11395 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11396 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11397 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11398 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11399 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11400
11401 @smallexample
11402 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11403 $1 = @{
11404 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11405 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11406 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11407 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11408 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11409 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11410 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11411 @}
11412 @end smallexample
11413
11414 @noindent
11415 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11416 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11417 value to a @code{struct} member:
11418
11419 @smallexample
11420 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11421 @end smallexample
11422
11423 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11424 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11425 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11426 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11427 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11428 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11429
11430 @cindex caller-saved registers
11431 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11432 @cindex volatile registers
11433 @cindex <not saved> values
11434 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11435 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11436 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11437 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11438 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11439 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11440 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11441 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11442 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11443 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11444 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11445 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11446 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11447 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11448 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11449 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11450 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11451 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11452 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11453 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11454 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11455 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11456 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11457
11458 @node Floating Point Hardware
11459 @section Floating Point Hardware
11460 @cindex floating point
11461
11462 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11463 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11464
11465 @table @code
11466 @kindex info float
11467 @item info float
11468 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11469 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11470 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11471 the ARM and x86 machines.
11472 @end table
11473
11474 @node Vector Unit
11475 @section Vector Unit
11476 @cindex vector unit
11477
11478 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11479 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11480
11481 @table @code
11482 @kindex info vector
11483 @item info vector
11484 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11485 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11486 @end table
11487
11488 @node OS Information
11489 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11490 @cindex OS information
11491
11492 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11493 you debug your program.
11494
11495 @cindex auxiliary vector
11496 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11497 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11498 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11499 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11500 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11501 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11502 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11503 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11504 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11505 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11506 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11507 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11508
11509 @table @code
11510 @kindex info auxv
11511 @item info auxv
11512 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11513 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11514 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11515 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11516 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11517 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11518 an unrecognized tag.
11519 @end table
11520
11521 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11522 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11523 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11524 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11525 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11526 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11527 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11528
11529 @table @code
11530 @kindex info os
11531 @item info os @var{infotype}
11532
11533 Display OS information of the requested type.
11534
11535 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11536
11537 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11538 @table @code
11539 @kindex info os cpus
11540 @item cpus
11541 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11542 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11543 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11544 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11545 kernel initialization.
11546
11547 @kindex info os files
11548 @item files
11549 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11550 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11551 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11552 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11553
11554 @kindex info os modules
11555 @item modules
11556 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11557 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11558 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11559 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11560 in memory.
11561
11562 @kindex info os msg
11563 @item msg
11564 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11565 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11566 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11567 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11568 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11569 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11570 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11571 the message queue was last changed.
11572
11573 @kindex info os processes
11574 @item processes
11575 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11576 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11577 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11578 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11579 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11580 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11581
11582 @kindex info os procgroups
11583 @item procgroups
11584 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11585 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11586 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11587 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11588 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11589 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11590 and the process group leader is listed first.
11591
11592 @kindex info os semaphores
11593 @item semaphores
11594 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11595 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11596 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11597 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11598 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11599
11600 @kindex info os shm
11601 @item shm
11602 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11603 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11604 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11605 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11606 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11607 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11608 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11609
11610 @kindex info os sockets
11611 @item sockets
11612 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11613 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11614 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11615 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11616 connection.
11617
11618 @kindex info os threads
11619 @item threads
11620 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11621 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11622 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11623 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11624 process is not listed.
11625 @end table
11626
11627 @item info os
11628 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11629 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11630 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11631 types, this command will report an error.
11632 @end table
11633
11634 @node Memory Region Attributes
11635 @section Memory Region Attributes
11636 @cindex memory region attributes
11637
11638 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11639 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11640 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11641 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11642 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11643 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11644 user can override the fetched regions.
11645
11646 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11647 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11648 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11649 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11650 all memory.
11651
11652 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11653 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11654
11655 @table @code
11656 @kindex mem
11657 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11658 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11659 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11660 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11661 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11662 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11663
11664 @item mem auto
11665 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11666 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11667
11668 @kindex delete mem
11669 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11670 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11671 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11672
11673 @kindex disable mem
11674 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11675 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11676 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11677 It may be enabled again later.
11678
11679 @kindex enable mem
11680 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11681 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11682
11683 @kindex info mem
11684 @item info mem
11685 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11686 for each region:
11687
11688 @table @emph
11689 @item Memory Region Number
11690 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11691 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11692 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11693
11694 @item Lo Address
11695 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11696
11697 @item Hi Address
11698 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11699
11700 @item Attributes
11701 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11702 @end table
11703 @end table
11704
11705
11706 @subsection Attributes
11707
11708 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11709 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11710 write accesses to a memory region.
11711
11712 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11713 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11714 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11715
11716 @table @code
11717 @item ro
11718 Memory is read only.
11719 @item wo
11720 Memory is write only.
11721 @item rw
11722 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11723 @end table
11724
11725 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11726 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11727 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11728 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11729 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11730
11731 @table @code
11732 @item 8
11733 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11734 @item 16
11735 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11736 @item 32
11737 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11738 @item 64
11739 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11740 @end table
11741
11742 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11743 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11744 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11745 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11746 @c
11747 @c @table @code
11748 @c @item hwbreak
11749 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11750 @c @item swbreak (default)
11751 @c @end table
11752
11753 @subsubsection Data Cache
11754 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11755 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11756 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11757 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11758 registers.
11759
11760 @table @code
11761 @item cache
11762 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11763 @item nocache
11764 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11765 @end table
11766
11767 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11768 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11769 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11770 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11771 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11772
11773 @table @code
11774 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11775 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11776 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11777 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11778 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11779 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11780 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11781 The default value is @code{on}.
11782 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11783 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11784 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11785 @end table
11786
11787
11788 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11789 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11790 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11791 @c
11792 @c @table @code
11793 @c @item verify
11794 @c @item noverify (default)
11795 @c @end table
11796
11797 @node Dump/Restore Files
11798 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11799 @cindex dump/restore files
11800 @cindex append data to a file
11801 @cindex dump data to a file
11802 @cindex restore data from a file
11803
11804 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11805 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11806 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11807 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11808 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11809 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11810 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11811
11812 @table @code
11813
11814 @kindex dump
11815 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11816 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11817 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11818 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11819
11820 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11821 @table @code
11822 @item binary
11823 Raw binary form.
11824 @item ihex
11825 Intel hex format.
11826 @item srec
11827 Motorola S-record format.
11828 @item tekhex
11829 Tektronix Hex format.
11830 @item verilog
11831 Verilog Hex format.
11832 @end table
11833
11834 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11835 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11836 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11837 form.
11838
11839 @kindex append
11840 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11841 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11842 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11843 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11844 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11845
11846 @kindex restore
11847 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11848 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11849 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11850 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11851 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11852
11853 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11854 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11855 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11856 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11857 from that location.
11858
11859 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11860 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11861 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11862 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11863
11864 @end table
11865
11866 @node Core File Generation
11867 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11868 @cindex dump core from inferior
11869
11870 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11871 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11872 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11873 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11874 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11875 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11876 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11877
11878 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11879 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11880 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11881
11882 @table @code
11883 @kindex gcore
11884 @kindex generate-core-file
11885 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11886 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11887 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11888 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11889 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11890 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11891
11892 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11893 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11894
11895 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11896 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11897 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
11898 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
11899 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
11900
11901 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11902 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11903 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11904 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11905 Enable or disable the use of the file
11906 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11907 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11908 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11909 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11910
11911 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11912 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11913 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11914 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11915 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11916 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11917 about the bits that can be set in the
11918 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11919 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11920
11921 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11922 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11923 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11924 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11925 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11926 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11927 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11928 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11929
11930 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
11931 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
11932 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
11933 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
11934 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
11935 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
11936 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
11937
11938 The default value is @code{off}.
11939 @end table
11940
11941 @node Character Sets
11942 @section Character Sets
11943 @cindex character sets
11944 @cindex charset
11945 @cindex translating between character sets
11946 @cindex host character set
11947 @cindex target character set
11948
11949 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11950 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11951 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11952 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11953 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11954 @dfn{target character set}.
11955
11956 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11957 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11958 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11959 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11960 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11961 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11962 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11963 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11964 character and string literals in expressions.
11965
11966 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11967 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11968 target-charset} command, described below.
11969
11970 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11971 support:
11972
11973 @table @code
11974 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11975 @kindex set target-charset
11976 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11977 list of supported target character sets, type
11978 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11979
11980 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11981 @kindex set host-charset
11982 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11983
11984 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11985 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11986 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11987 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11988 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11989
11990 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11991 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11992 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11993
11994 @item set charset @var{charset}
11995 @kindex set charset
11996 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11997 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11998 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11999 for both host and target.
12000
12001 @item show charset
12002 @kindex show charset
12003 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
12004
12005 @item show host-charset
12006 @kindex show host-charset
12007 Show the name of the current host character set.
12008
12009 @item show target-charset
12010 @kindex show target-charset
12011 Show the name of the current target character set.
12012
12013 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
12014 @kindex set target-wide-charset
12015 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
12016 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
12017 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
12018 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12019
12020 @item show target-wide-charset
12021 @kindex show target-wide-charset
12022 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
12023 @end table
12024
12025 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
12026 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
12027 @file{charset-test.c}:
12028
12029 @smallexample
12030 #include <stdio.h>
12031
12032 char ascii_hello[]
12033 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
12034 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
12035 char ibm1047_hello[]
12036 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
12037 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
12038
12039 main ()
12040 @{
12041 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12042 @}
12043 @end smallexample
12044
12045 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
12046 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
12047 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
12048
12049 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
12050
12051 @smallexample
12052 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
12053 $ gdb -nw charset-test
12054 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
12055 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12056 @dots{}
12057 (@value{GDBP})
12058 @end smallexample
12059
12060 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
12061 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
12062 strings:
12063
12064 @smallexample
12065 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12066 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
12067 (@value{GDBP})
12068 @end smallexample
12069
12070 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
12071 initial character set:
12072 @smallexample
12073 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
12074 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12075 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
12076 (@value{GDBP})
12077 @end smallexample
12078
12079 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
12080 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
12081 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
12082 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
12083 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
12084
12085 @smallexample
12086 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12087 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
12088 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12089 $2 = 72 'H'
12090 (@value{GDBP})
12091 @end smallexample
12092
12093 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
12094 literals you use in expressions:
12095
12096 @smallexample
12097 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12098 $3 = 43 '+'
12099 (@value{GDBP})
12100 @end smallexample
12101
12102 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
12103 character.
12104
12105 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
12106 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
12107 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
12108
12109 @smallexample
12110 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12111 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
12112 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12113 $5 = 200 '\310'
12114 (@value{GDBP})
12115 @end smallexample
12116
12117 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
12118 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
12119
12120 @smallexample
12121 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12122 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
12123 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12124 @end smallexample
12125
12126 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
12127 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
12128 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
12129 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
12130 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
12131
12132 @smallexample
12133 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
12134 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12135 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
12136 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
12137 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12138 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
12139 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12140 $7 = 72 '\110'
12141 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12142 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
12143 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12144 $9 = 200 'H'
12145 (@value{GDBP})
12146 @end smallexample
12147
12148 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
12149 string literals you use in expressions:
12150
12151 @smallexample
12152 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12153 $10 = 78 '+'
12154 (@value{GDBP})
12155 @end smallexample
12156
12157 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
12158 character.
12159
12160 @node Caching Target Data
12161 @section Caching Data of Targets
12162 @cindex caching data of targets
12163
12164 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
12165 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
12166 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
12167 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
12168 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
12169 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
12170 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
12171 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
12172 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
12173 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
12174 is executing.
12175 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
12176 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
12177 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
12178 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
12179 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
12180 in the code segment.
12181 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
12182 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
12183
12184 @table @code
12185 @kindex set remotecache
12186 @item set remotecache on
12187 @itemx set remotecache off
12188 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
12189 with old scripts.
12190
12191 @kindex show remotecache
12192 @item show remotecache
12193 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
12194
12195 @kindex set stack-cache
12196 @item set stack-cache on
12197 @itemx set stack-cache off
12198 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
12199 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
12200
12201 @kindex show stack-cache
12202 @item show stack-cache
12203 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
12204
12205 @kindex set code-cache
12206 @item set code-cache on
12207 @itemx set code-cache off
12208 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
12209 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
12210 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
12211
12212 @kindex show code-cache
12213 @item show code-cache
12214 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
12215 accesses.
12216
12217 @kindex info dcache
12218 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
12219 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
12220 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
12221 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
12222 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
12223 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
12224
12225 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
12226 printed in hex.
12227
12228 @item set dcache size @var{size}
12229 @cindex dcache size
12230 @kindex set dcache size
12231 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
12232
12233 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
12234 @cindex dcache line-size
12235 @kindex set dcache line-size
12236 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
12237 Must be a power of 2.
12238
12239 @item show dcache size
12240 @kindex show dcache size
12241 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
12242
12243 @item show dcache line-size
12244 @kindex show dcache line-size
12245 Show default size of dcache lines.
12246
12247 @end table
12248
12249 @node Searching Memory
12250 @section Search Memory
12251 @cindex searching memory
12252
12253 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
12254 @code{find} command.
12255
12256 @table @code
12257 @kindex find
12258 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12259 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12260 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
12261 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
12262 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
12263 @end table
12264
12265 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
12266 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
12267
12268 @table @r
12269 @item @var{s}, search query size
12270 The size of each search query value.
12271
12272 @table @code
12273 @item b
12274 bytes
12275 @item h
12276 halfwords (two bytes)
12277 @item w
12278 words (four bytes)
12279 @item g
12280 giant words (eight bytes)
12281 @end table
12282
12283 All values are interpreted in the current language.
12284 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
12285 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
12286 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
12287 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
12288
12289 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
12290 value's type in the current language.
12291 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
12292 pattern as a mixture of types.
12293 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
12294 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
12295 which is typically four bytes.
12296
12297 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
12298 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
12299 @end table
12300
12301 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
12302 (@code{"}).
12303 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
12304 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
12305
12306 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
12307 number of matches found.
12308
12309 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
12310 @samp{$_}.
12311 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
12312
12313 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
12314
12315 @smallexample
12316 void
12317 hello ()
12318 @{
12319 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
12320 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
12321 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12322 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12323 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12324 @}
12325 @end smallexample
12326
12327 @noindent
12328 you get during debugging:
12329
12330 @smallexample
12331 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12332 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12333 1 pattern found
12334 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12335 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12336 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12337 2 patterns found.
12338 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12339 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12340 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12341 2 patterns found.
12342 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12343 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12344 1 pattern found
12345 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12346 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12347 1 pattern found
12348 (gdb) print $numfound
12349 $1 = 1
12350 (gdb) print $_
12351 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12352 @end smallexample
12353
12354 @node Value Sizes
12355 @section Value Sizes
12356
12357 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12358 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12359 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12360 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12361 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12362
12363 @table @code
12364 @kindex set max-value-size
12365 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12366 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12367 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12368 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12369 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12370
12371 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12372 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12373
12374 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12375 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12376 currently 16 bytes.
12377
12378 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12379 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12380 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12381 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12382 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12383 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12384 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12385 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12386
12387 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12388
12389 @kindex show max-value-size
12390 @item show max-value-size
12391 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12392 allocate for the contents of a value.
12393 @end table
12394
12395 @node Optimized Code
12396 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12397 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12398 @cindex debugging optimized code
12399
12400 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12401 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12402 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12403 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12404 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12405 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12406 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12407
12408 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12409 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12410 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12411 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12412
12413 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12414 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12415 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12416 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12417 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12418 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12419
12420 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12421 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12422 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12423 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12424 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12425
12426 @menu
12427 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12428 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12429 @end menu
12430
12431 @node Inline Functions
12432 @section Inline Functions
12433 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12434
12435 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12436 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12437 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12438 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12439 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12440 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12441 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12442 @code{info frame} command.
12443
12444 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12445 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12446 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12447 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12448 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12449 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12450 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12451 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12452 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12453 local variables in the caller.
12454
12455 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12456 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12457 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12458 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12459 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12460 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12461 instructions are executed.
12462
12463 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12464 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12465 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12466 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12467
12468 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12469 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12470
12471 @itemize @bullet
12472 @item
12473 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12474 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12475 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12476 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12477 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12478 or inside the inlined function instead.
12479
12480 @item
12481 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12482 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12483 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12484 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12485
12486 @end itemize
12487
12488 @node Tail Call Frames
12489 @section Tail Call Frames
12490 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12491
12492 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12493 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12494 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12495 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12496 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12497
12498 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12499 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12500 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12501 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12502 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12503 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12504 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12505
12506 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12507 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12508 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12509 this information.
12510
12511 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12512 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12513
12514 @smallexample
12515 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12516 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12517 (gdb) info frame
12518 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12519 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12520 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12521 source language c++.
12522 Arglist at unknown address.
12523 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12524 @end smallexample
12525
12526 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12527 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12528 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12529 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12530 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12531 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12532
12533 @table @code
12534 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12535 @item set debug entry-values
12536 @kindex set debug entry-values
12537 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12538 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12539 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12540 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12541 result.
12542
12543 @item show debug entry-values
12544 @kindex show debug entry-values
12545 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12546 values at function entry and tail calls.
12547 @end table
12548
12549 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12550 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12551 reference by variable @code{x}):
12552
12553 @smallexample
12554 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12555 void (*x) (void) = c;
12556 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12557 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12558 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12559
12560 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12561 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12562 a () at t.c:3
12563 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12564 (gdb) bt
12565 #0 a () at t.c:3
12566 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12567 @end smallexample
12568
12569 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12570
12571 @smallexample
12572 int i;
12573 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12574 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12575 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12576 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12577 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12578 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12579 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12580 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12581
12582 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12583 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12584 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12585 (gdb) bt
12586 #0 f () at t.c:2
12587 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12588 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12589 @end smallexample
12590
12591 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12592 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12593
12594 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12595 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12596 @set ARROW @click{}
12597 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12598 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12599 @end ifset
12600 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12601 @set ARROW ->
12602 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12603 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12604 @end ifclear
12605
12606 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12607 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12608 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12609
12610 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12611 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12612 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12613 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12614 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12615 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12616
12617 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12618 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12619 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12620 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12621 omitted.
12622
12623 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12624 entry may fail:
12625
12626 @smallexample
12627 int v;
12628 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12629 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12630 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12631 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12632 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12633 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12634
12635 (gdb) bt
12636 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12637 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12638 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12639 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12640 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12641 @end smallexample
12642
12643 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12644 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12645 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12646 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12647 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12648
12649 @node Macros
12650 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12651
12652 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12653 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12654 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12655 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12656 where it was defined.
12657
12658 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12659 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12660 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12661 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12662
12663 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12664 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12665 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12666 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12667 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12668 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12669 see @ref{List}.
12670
12671 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12672 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12673 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12674
12675 @table @code
12676
12677 @kindex macro expand
12678 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12679 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12680 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12681 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12682 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12683 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12684 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12685 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12686 it can be any string of tokens.
12687
12688 @kindex macro exp1
12689 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12690 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12691 @cindex expand macro once
12692 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12693 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12694 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12695 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12696 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12697 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12698 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12699 can be any string of tokens.
12700
12701 @kindex info macro
12702 @cindex macro definition, showing
12703 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12704 @cindex macros, from debug info
12705 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12706 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12707 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12708 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12709 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12710 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12711
12712 @kindex info macros
12713 @item info macros @var{location}
12714 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12715 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12716 command-line where those definitions were established.
12717
12718 @kindex macro define
12719 @cindex user-defined macros
12720 @cindex defining macros interactively
12721 @cindex macros, user-defined
12722 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12723 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12724 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12725 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12726 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12727 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12728 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12729 @var{arglist}.
12730
12731 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12732 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12733 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12734 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12735 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12736
12737 @kindex macro undef
12738 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12739 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12740 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12741 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12742 in the program being debugged.
12743
12744 @kindex macro list
12745 @item macro list
12746 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12747 @end table
12748
12749 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12750 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12751 show our source files:
12752
12753 @smallexample
12754 $ cat sample.c
12755 #include <stdio.h>
12756 #include "sample.h"
12757
12758 #define M 42
12759 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12760
12761 main ()
12762 @{
12763 #define N 28
12764 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12765 #undef N
12766 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12767 #define N 1729
12768 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12769 @}
12770 $ cat sample.h
12771 #define Q <
12772 $
12773 @end smallexample
12774
12775 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12776 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12777 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12778 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12779 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12780 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12781 information.
12782
12783 @smallexample
12784 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12785 $
12786 @end smallexample
12787
12788 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12789
12790 @smallexample
12791 $ gdb -nw sample
12792 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12793 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12794 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12795 (@value{GDBP})
12796 @end smallexample
12797
12798 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12799 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12800 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12801
12802 @smallexample
12803 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12804 3
12805 4 #define M 42
12806 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12807 6
12808 7 main ()
12809 8 @{
12810 9 #define N 28
12811 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12812 11 #undef N
12813 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12814 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12815 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12816 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12817 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12818 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12819 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12820 #define Q <
12821 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12822 expands to: (42 + 1)
12823 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12824 expands to: once (M + 1)
12825 (@value{GDBP})
12826 @end smallexample
12827
12828 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12829 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12830 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12831 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12832
12833 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12834 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12835
12836 @smallexample
12837 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12838 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12839 (@value{GDBP}) run
12840 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12841
12842 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12843 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12844 (@value{GDBP})
12845 @end smallexample
12846
12847 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12848
12849 @smallexample
12850 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12851 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12852 #define N 28
12853 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12854 expands to: 28 < 42
12855 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12856 $1 = 1
12857 (@value{GDBP})
12858 @end smallexample
12859
12860 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12861 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12862 thereof) in force at each point:
12863
12864 @smallexample
12865 (@value{GDBP}) next
12866 Hello, world!
12867 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12868 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12869 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12870 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12871 (@value{GDBP}) next
12872 We're so creative.
12873 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12874 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12875 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12876 #define N 1729
12877 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12878 expands to: 1729 < 42
12879 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12880 $2 = 0
12881 (@value{GDBP})
12882 @end smallexample
12883
12884 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12885 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12886 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12887 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12888
12889 @smallexample
12890 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12891 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12892 -D__STDC__=1
12893 (@value{GDBP})
12894 @end smallexample
12895
12896
12897 @node Tracepoints
12898 @chapter Tracepoints
12899 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12900 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12901
12902 @cindex tracepoints
12903 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12904 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12905 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12906 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12907 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12908 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12909 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12910
12911 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12912 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12913 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12914 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12915 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12916 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12917 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12918 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12919 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12920 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12921 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12922
12923 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12924 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12925 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12926 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12927 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12928 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12929 Packets}.
12930
12931 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12932 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12933 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12934
12935 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12936
12937 @menu
12938 * Set Tracepoints::
12939 * Analyze Collected Data::
12940 * Tracepoint Variables::
12941 * Trace Files::
12942 @end menu
12943
12944 @node Set Tracepoints
12945 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12946
12947 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12948 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12949 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12950 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12951 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12952 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12953 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12954
12955 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12956 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12957 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12958 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12959 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12960 tracepoint was hit.
12961
12962 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12963 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12964 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12965 either.
12966
12967 @cindex fast tracepoints
12968 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12969 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12970 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12971
12972 @cindex static tracepoints
12973 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12974 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12975 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12976 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12977 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12978 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12979 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12980 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12981 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12982 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12983 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12984 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12985 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12986 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12987 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12988 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12989 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12990 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12991 static tracepoint marker.
12992
12993 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12994 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12995
12996 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12997 conditions and actions.
12998
12999 @menu
13000 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
13001 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
13002 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
13003 * Tracepoint Conditions::
13004 * Trace State Variables::
13005 * Tracepoint Actions::
13006 * Listing Tracepoints::
13007 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
13008 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
13009 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
13010 @end menu
13011
13012 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
13013 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
13014
13015 @table @code
13016 @cindex set tracepoint
13017 @kindex trace
13018 @item trace @var{location}
13019 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
13020 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
13021 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
13022 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
13023 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
13024 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
13025 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
13026 in tracing}).
13027 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
13028 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
13029 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
13030 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
13031 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
13032 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
13033 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
13034 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
13035 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
13036 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
13037 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
13038 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
13039
13040 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
13041
13042 @smallexample
13043 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
13044
13045 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
13046
13047 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
13048
13049 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
13050
13051 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
13052 @end smallexample
13053
13054 @noindent
13055 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
13056
13057 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
13058 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
13059 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
13060 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
13061 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
13062 information on tracepoint conditions.
13063
13064 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13065 @cindex set fast tracepoint
13066 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
13067 @kindex ftrace
13068 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
13069 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
13070 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
13071 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
13072 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
13073 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
13074 message.
13075
13076 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
13077 @code{trace}.
13078
13079 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
13080 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
13081 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
13082 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
13083 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
13084 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
13085 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
13086 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
13087
13088 @example
13089 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
13090 @end example
13091
13092 @noindent
13093 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
13094 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
13095
13096 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13097 @cindex set static tracepoint
13098 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
13099 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
13100 @kindex strace
13101 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
13102 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
13103 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
13104 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
13105 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
13106
13107 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
13108 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
13109 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
13110 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
13111 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
13112 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
13113 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
13114 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
13115 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
13116 tracing engine:
13117
13118 @smallexample
13119 main ()
13120 @{
13121 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
13122 @}
13123 @end smallexample
13124
13125 @noindent
13126 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
13127 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
13128
13129 @smallexample
13130 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13131 Cnt Enb ID Address What
13132 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
13133 Data: "str %s"
13134 [etc...]
13135 @end smallexample
13136
13137 @noindent
13138 so you may probe the marker above with:
13139
13140 @smallexample
13141 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
13142 @end smallexample
13143
13144 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
13145 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
13146 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
13147 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
13148 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
13149 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
13150 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
13151 the @samp{Data:} field.
13152
13153 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
13154 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
13155 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
13156
13157 @vindex $tpnum
13158 @cindex last tracepoint number
13159 @cindex recent tracepoint number
13160 @cindex tracepoint number
13161 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
13162 of the most recently set tracepoint.
13163
13164 @kindex delete tracepoint
13165 @cindex tracepoint deletion
13166 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13167 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
13168 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
13169 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
13170
13171 Examples:
13172
13173 @smallexample
13174 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
13175
13176 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
13177 @end smallexample
13178
13179 @noindent
13180 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
13181 @end table
13182
13183 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13184 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13185
13186 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
13187
13188 @table @code
13189 @kindex disable tracepoint
13190 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13191 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
13192 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
13193 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
13194 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
13195 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
13196 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
13197 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
13198 next trace experiment.
13199
13200 @kindex enable tracepoint
13201 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13202 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
13203 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
13204 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
13205 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
13206 next time a trace experiment is run.
13207 @end table
13208
13209 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
13210 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
13211
13212 @table @code
13213 @kindex passcount
13214 @cindex tracepoint pass count
13215 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
13216 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
13217 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
13218 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
13219 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
13220 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
13221 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
13222 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
13223 user.
13224
13225 Examples:
13226
13227 @smallexample
13228 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
13229 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
13230
13231 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
13232 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
13233 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13234 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
13235 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
13236 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
13237 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
13238 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
13239 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
13240 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
13241 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
13242 @end smallexample
13243 @end table
13244
13245 @node Tracepoint Conditions
13246 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
13247 @cindex conditional tracepoints
13248 @cindex tracepoint conditions
13249
13250 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
13251 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
13252 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
13253 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
13254 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
13255 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
13256 is true.
13257
13258 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
13259 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
13260 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
13261 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
13262 just as with breakpoints.
13263
13264 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
13265 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
13266 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
13267 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
13268 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
13269 accesses, and so forth.
13270
13271 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
13272 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
13273 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
13274 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
13275 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
13276 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
13277 search through.
13278
13279 @smallexample
13280 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
13281 @end smallexample
13282
13283 @node Trace State Variables
13284 @subsection Trace State Variables
13285 @cindex trace state variables
13286
13287 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
13288 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
13289 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
13290 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
13291 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
13292 integers.
13293
13294 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
13295 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
13296 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
13297 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
13298
13299 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
13300 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
13301 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
13302 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
13303 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
13304 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
13305 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
13306 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
13307 variable with the same name.
13308
13309 @table @code
13310
13311 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
13312 @kindex tvariable
13313 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
13314 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
13315 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
13316 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
13317 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
13318 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
13319 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
13320 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
13321 value. The default initial value is 0.
13322
13323 @item info tvariables
13324 @kindex info tvariables
13325 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13326 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13327 currently running.
13328
13329 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13330 @kindex delete tvariable
13331 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13332 are specified.
13333
13334 @end table
13335
13336 @node Tracepoint Actions
13337 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13338
13339 @table @code
13340 @kindex actions
13341 @cindex tracepoint actions
13342 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13343 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13344 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13345 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13346 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13347 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13348 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13349 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13350 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13351 @code{while-stepping}.
13352
13353 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13354 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13355 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13356
13357 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13358 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13359 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13360
13361 @smallexample
13362 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13363
13364 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13365
13366 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13367 @end smallexample
13368
13369 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13370 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13371 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13372 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13373 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13374 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13375 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13376 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13377
13378 @smallexample
13379 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13380 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13381 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13382 > collect bar,baz
13383 > collect $regs
13384 > while-stepping 12
13385 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13386 > end
13387 end
13388 @end smallexample
13389
13390 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13391 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13392 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13393 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13394 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13395 special arguments are supported:
13396
13397 @table @code
13398 @item $regs
13399 Collect all registers.
13400
13401 @item $args
13402 Collect all function arguments.
13403
13404 @item $locals
13405 Collect all local variables.
13406
13407 @item $_ret
13408 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13409 of a backtrace.
13410
13411 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13412 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13413 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13414 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13415 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13416 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13417
13418 @item $_probe_argc
13419 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13420 tracepoint is located.
13421 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13422
13423 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13424 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13425 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13426 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13427
13428 @item $_sdata
13429 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13430 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13431 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13432 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13433 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13434 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13435 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13436 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13437 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13438
13439 @smallexample
13440 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13441 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13442 @end smallexample
13443
13444 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13445 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13446 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13447 @value{GDBN}.
13448 @end table
13449
13450 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13451 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13452 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13453
13454 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13455 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13456 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13457 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13458 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13459 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13460 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13461 @samp{mystr}.
13462
13463 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13464 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13465
13466 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13467 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13468 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13469 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13470 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13471 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13472 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13473 action were used.
13474
13475 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13476 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13477 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13478 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13479 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13480 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13481
13482 @smallexample
13483 > while-stepping 12
13484 > collect $regs, myglobal
13485 > end
13486 >
13487 @end smallexample
13488
13489 @noindent
13490 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13491 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13492 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13493 @code{stepping}.
13494
13495 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13496 @kindex set default-collect
13497 @cindex default collection action
13498 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13499 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13500 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13501 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13502 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13503 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13504
13505 @item show default-collect
13506 @kindex show default-collect
13507 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13508 tracepoint hit.
13509
13510 @end table
13511
13512 @node Listing Tracepoints
13513 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13514
13515 @table @code
13516 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13517 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13518 @cindex information about tracepoints
13519 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13520 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13521 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13522 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13523 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13524 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13525
13526 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13527 tracing:
13528
13529 @itemize @bullet
13530 @item
13531 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13532
13533 @item
13534 the state about installed on target of each location
13535 @end itemize
13536
13537 @smallexample
13538 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13539 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13540 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13541 while-stepping 20
13542 collect globfoo, $regs
13543 end
13544 collect globfoo2
13545 end
13546 pass count 1200
13547 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13548 collect $eip
13549 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13550 installed on target
13551 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13552 installed on target
13553 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13554 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13555 not installed on target
13556 (@value{GDBP})
13557 @end smallexample
13558
13559 @noindent
13560 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13561 @end table
13562
13563 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13564 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13565
13566 @table @code
13567 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13568 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13569 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13570 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13571 program.
13572
13573 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13574
13575 @table @emph
13576 @item Count
13577 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13578 stable identifier.
13579 @item ID
13580 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13581 @item Enabled or Disabled
13582 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13583 that are not enabled.
13584 @item Address
13585 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13586 @item What
13587 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13588 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13589 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13590 will be left blank.
13591 @end table
13592
13593 @noindent
13594 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13595
13596 @table @emph
13597 @item Data
13598 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13599 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13600 marker call.
13601 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13602 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13603 @end table
13604
13605 @smallexample
13606 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13607 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13608 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13609 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13610 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13611 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13612 Data: str %s
13613 (@value{GDBP})
13614 @end smallexample
13615 @end table
13616
13617 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13618 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13619
13620 @table @code
13621 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13622 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13623 @cindex collected data discarded
13624 @item tstart
13625 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13626 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13627 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13628 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13629 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13630 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13631 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13632 information, and so forth.
13633
13634 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13635 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13636 @item tstop
13637 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13638 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13639 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13640 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13641 needs to be stopped quickly.
13642
13643 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13644 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13645 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13646
13647 @kindex tstatus
13648 @cindex status of trace data collection
13649 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13650 @item tstatus
13651 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13652 collection.
13653 @end table
13654
13655 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13656
13657 @smallexample
13658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13659 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13660 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13661 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13662 > while-stepping 11
13663 > collect $regs
13664 > end
13665 > end
13666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13667 [time passes @dots{}]
13668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13669 @end smallexample
13670
13671 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13672 @cindex disconnected tracing
13673 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13674 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13675 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13676 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13677 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13678 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13679 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13680 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13681
13682 @table @code
13683 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13684 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13685 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13686 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13687 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13688 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13689 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13690 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13691
13692 @item show disconnected-tracing
13693 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13694 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13695
13696 @end table
13697
13698 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13699 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13700 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13701 it will continue after reconnection.
13702
13703 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13704 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13705 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13706 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13707 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13708 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13709 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13710 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13711 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13712 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13713
13714 @cindex circular trace buffer
13715 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13716 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13717 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13718 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13719 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13720 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13721 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13722 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13723 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13724 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13725 the next run.
13726
13727 @table @code
13728 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13729 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13730 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13731 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13732 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13733 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13734 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13735
13736 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13737 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13738 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13739 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13740 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13741 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13742
13743 @end table
13744
13745 @table @code
13746 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13747 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13748 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13749 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13750 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13751 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13752 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13753 likes. This is also the default.
13754
13755 @item show trace-buffer-size
13756 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13757 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13758 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13759 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13760 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13761 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13762 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13763 @end table
13764
13765 @table @code
13766 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13767 @kindex set trace-user
13768
13769 @item show trace-user
13770 @kindex show trace-user
13771
13772 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13773 @kindex set trace-notes
13774 Set the trace run's notes.
13775
13776 @item show trace-notes
13777 @kindex show trace-notes
13778 Show the trace run's notes.
13779
13780 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13781 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13782 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13783 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13784 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13785
13786 @item show trace-stop-notes
13787 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13788 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13789
13790 @end table
13791
13792 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13793 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13794
13795 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13796 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13797 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13798 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13799 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13800 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13801 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13802 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13803 mentioned here.
13804
13805 @itemize @bullet
13806
13807 @item
13808 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13809 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13810 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13811 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13812 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13813 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13814 cannot be collected either.
13815
13816 @item
13817 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13818 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13819 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13820 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13821 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13822 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13823 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13824 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13825 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13826 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13827
13828 @item
13829 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13830 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13831 in a misleading way.
13832
13833 @item
13834 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13835 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13836 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13837 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13838 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13839 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13840 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13841 by @code{ptr}.
13842
13843 @item
13844 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13845 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13846 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13847 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13848 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13849 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13850 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13851 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13852 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13853 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13854 invalid address.
13855
13856 @item
13857 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13858 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13859 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13860 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13861 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13862 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13863 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13864 it to zero.
13865
13866 @end itemize
13867
13868 @node Analyze Collected Data
13869 @section Using the Collected Data
13870
13871 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13872 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13873 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13874 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13875 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13876 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13877 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13878 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13879 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13880 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13881 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13882 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13883 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13884 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13885 the buffer will fail.
13886
13887 @menu
13888 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13889 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13890 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13891 @end menu
13892
13893 @node tfind
13894 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13895
13896 @kindex tfind
13897 @cindex select trace snapshot
13898 @cindex find trace snapshot
13899 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13900 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13901 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13902 snapshot is selected.
13903
13904 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13905
13906 @table @code
13907 @item tfind start
13908 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13909 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13910
13911 @item tfind none
13912 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13913
13914 @item tfind end
13915 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13916
13917 @item tfind
13918 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13919 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13920
13921 @item tfind -
13922 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13923 retracing earlier steps.
13924
13925 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13926 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13927 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13928 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13929 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13930
13931 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13932 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13933 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13934 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13935 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13936
13937 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13938 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13939 addresses (exclusive).
13940
13941 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13942 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13943 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13944
13945 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13946 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13947 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13948 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13949 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13950 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13951 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13952 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13953 @end table
13954
13955 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13956 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13957 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13958 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13959 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13960 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13961 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13962 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13963 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13964 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13965 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13966 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13967 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13968 tracepoint as the current one.
13969
13970 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13971 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13972 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13973 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13974 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13975
13976 @smallexample
13977 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13978 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13979 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13980 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13981 > tfind
13982 > end
13983
13984 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13985 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13986 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13987 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13988 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13989 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13990 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13991 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13992 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13993 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13994 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13995 @end smallexample
13996
13997 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13998 the buffer:
13999
14000 @smallexample
14001 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14002 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14003 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
14004 > tfind line
14005 > end
14006
14007 Frame 0, X = 1
14008 Frame 7, X = 2
14009 Frame 13, X = 255
14010 @end smallexample
14011
14012 @node tdump
14013 @subsection @code{tdump}
14014 @kindex tdump
14015 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
14016 @cindex tracepoint data, display
14017
14018 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
14019 the current trace snapshot.
14020
14021 @smallexample
14022 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
14023 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14024 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
14025 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
14026 > end
14027
14028 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14029
14030 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
14031 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
14032 at gdb_test.c:444
14033 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
14034
14035 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
14036 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
14037 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
14038 d1 0x18 24
14039 d2 0x80 128
14040 d3 0x33 51
14041 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
14042 d5 0x22 34
14043 d6 0xe0 224
14044 d7 0x380035 3670069
14045 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
14046 a1 0x3000668 50333288
14047 a2 0x100 256
14048 a3 0x322000 3284992
14049 a4 0x3000698 50333336
14050 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
14051 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
14052 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
14053 ps 0x0 0
14054 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
14055 fpcontrol 0x0 0
14056 fpstatus 0x0 0
14057 fpiaddr 0x0 0
14058 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
14059 p1 = (void *) 0x11
14060 p2 = (void *) 0x22
14061 p3 = (void *) 0x33
14062 p4 = (void *) 0x44
14063 p5 = (void *) 0x55
14064 p6 = (void *) 0x66
14065 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
14066
14067 (@value{GDBP})
14068 @end smallexample
14069
14070 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
14071 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
14072 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
14073 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
14074
14075 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
14076 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
14077 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
14078 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
14079 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
14080 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
14081 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
14082 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
14083 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
14084 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
14085
14086 @node save tracepoints
14087 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
14088 @kindex save tracepoints
14089 @kindex save-tracepoints
14090 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
14091
14092 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
14093 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
14094 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
14095 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
14096 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
14097 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
14098
14099 @node Tracepoint Variables
14100 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
14101 @cindex tracepoint variables
14102 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
14103
14104 @table @code
14105 @vindex $trace_frame
14106 @item (int) $trace_frame
14107 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
14108 snapshot is selected.
14109
14110 @vindex $tracepoint
14111 @item (int) $tracepoint
14112 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
14113
14114 @vindex $trace_line
14115 @item (int) $trace_line
14116 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
14117
14118 @vindex $trace_file
14119 @item (char []) $trace_file
14120 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
14121
14122 @vindex $trace_func
14123 @item (char []) $trace_func
14124 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
14125 @end table
14126
14127 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
14128 use @code{output} instead.
14129
14130 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
14131 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
14132 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
14133 which are managed by the target.
14134
14135 @smallexample
14136 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14137
14138 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
14139 > output $trace_file
14140 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
14141 > tfind
14142 > end
14143 @end smallexample
14144
14145 @node Trace Files
14146 @section Using Trace Files
14147 @cindex trace files
14148
14149 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
14150 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
14151 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
14152 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
14153 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
14154
14155 @table @code
14156
14157 @kindex tsave
14158 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
14159 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
14160 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
14161 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
14162 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
14163 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
14164 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
14165 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
14166 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
14167 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
14168 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
14169 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
14170 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
14171 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
14172 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
14173
14174 @kindex target tfile
14175 @kindex tfile
14176 @kindex target ctf
14177 @kindex ctf
14178 @item target tfile @var{filename}
14179 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
14180 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
14181 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
14182 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
14183 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
14184 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
14185 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
14186 the host.
14187
14188 @smallexample
14189 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
14190 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
14191 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
14192 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
14193 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
14194 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
14195 i = 0
14196 a = 0
14197 b = 1 '\001'
14198 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
14199 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
14200 (@value{GDBP}) p b
14201 $1 = 1
14202 @end smallexample
14203
14204 @end table
14205
14206 @node Overlays
14207 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
14208 @cindex overlays
14209
14210 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
14211 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
14212 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
14213 use overlays.
14214
14215 @menu
14216 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
14217 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
14218 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
14219 mapped by asking the inferior.
14220 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
14221 @end menu
14222
14223 @node How Overlays Work
14224 @section How Overlays Work
14225 @cindex mapped overlays
14226 @cindex unmapped overlays
14227 @cindex load address, overlay's
14228 @cindex mapped address
14229 @cindex overlay area
14230
14231 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
14232 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
14233 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
14234 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
14235 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
14236
14237 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
14238 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
14239 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
14240 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
14241 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
14242 largest overlay as well.
14243
14244 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
14245 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
14246 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
14247 there.
14248
14249 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
14250 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
14251 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
14252
14253 @smallexample
14254 @group
14255 Data Instruction Larger
14256 Address Space Address Space Address Space
14257 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
14258 | | | | | |
14259 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
14260 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
14261 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
14262 | and heap | | | | | |
14263 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
14264 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
14265 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
14266 | | | | | |
14267 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
14268 address | | | | | |
14269 | overlay | <-' | | |
14270 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
14271 | | <---. | | load address
14272 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
14273 | | | |
14274 +-----------+ | |
14275 +-----------+
14276 | |
14277 +-----------+
14278
14279 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
14280 @end group
14281 @end smallexample
14282
14283 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
14284 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
14285 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
14286 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
14287 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
14288 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
14289 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
14290 program and the overlay area.
14291
14292 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
14293 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
14294 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
14295 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
14296 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
14297 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
14298 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
14299
14300 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
14301 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
14302 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
14303
14304 @itemize @bullet
14305
14306 @item
14307 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
14308 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
14309 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
14310 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
14311
14312 @item
14313 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
14314 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
14315 your program's performance.
14316
14317 @item
14318 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
14319 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
14320 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
14321 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14322 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14323 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14324 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14325
14326 @item
14327 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14328 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14329 instruction and data spaces.
14330
14331 @end itemize
14332
14333 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14334 improved in many ways:
14335
14336 @itemize @bullet
14337
14338 @item
14339 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14340 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14341 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14342 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14343 area in the usual way.
14344
14345 @item
14346 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14347 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14348
14349 @item
14350 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14351 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14352 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14353 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14354 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14355 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14356 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14357
14358 @end itemize
14359
14360
14361 @node Overlay Commands
14362 @section Overlay Commands
14363
14364 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14365 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14366 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14367 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14368 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14369 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14370
14371 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14372 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14373
14374 @table @code
14375 @item overlay off
14376 @kindex overlay
14377 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14378 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14379 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14380 overlay support is disabled.
14381
14382 @item overlay manual
14383 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14384 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14385 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14386 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14387 commands described below.
14388
14389 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14390 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14391 @cindex map an overlay
14392 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14393 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14394 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14395 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14396 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14397 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14398
14399 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14400 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14401 @cindex unmap an overlay
14402 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14403 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14404 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14405 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14406
14407 @item overlay auto
14408 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14409 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14410 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14411 Overlay Debugging}.
14412
14413 @item overlay load-target
14414 @itemx overlay load
14415 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14416 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14417 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14418 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14419 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14420 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14421
14422 @item overlay list-overlays
14423 @itemx overlay list
14424 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14425 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14426 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14427
14428 @end table
14429
14430 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14431 of the function the address falls in:
14432
14433 @smallexample
14434 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14435 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14436 @end smallexample
14437 @noindent
14438 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14439 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14440 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14441 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14442
14443 @smallexample
14444 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14445 No sections are mapped.
14446 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14447 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14448 @end smallexample
14449 @noindent
14450 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14451 name normally:
14452
14453 @smallexample
14454 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14455 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14456 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14457 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14458 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14459 @end smallexample
14460
14461 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14462 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14463 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14464 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14465 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14466
14467 @itemize @bullet
14468 @item
14469 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14470 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14471 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14472 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14473 @item
14474 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14475 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14476 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14477 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14478 breakpoints properly.
14479 @end itemize
14480
14481
14482 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14483 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14484 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14485
14486 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14487 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14488 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14489 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14490 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14491 current state of the overlays.
14492
14493 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14494 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14495
14496 @table @asis
14497
14498 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14499 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14500
14501 @smallexample
14502 struct
14503 @{
14504 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14505 unsigned long vma;
14506
14507 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14508 unsigned long size;
14509
14510 /* The overlay's load address. */
14511 unsigned long lma;
14512
14513 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14514 zero otherwise. */
14515 unsigned long mapped;
14516 @}
14517 @end smallexample
14518
14519 @item @code{_novlys}:
14520 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14521 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14522
14523 @end table
14524
14525 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14526 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14527 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14528 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14529 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14530 currently mapped.
14531
14532 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14533 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14534 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14535 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14536 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14537 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14538 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14539 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14540 are not being executed.
14541
14542 @node Overlay Sample Program
14543 @section Overlay Sample Program
14544 @cindex overlay example program
14545
14546 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14547 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14548 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14549 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14550 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14551 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14552 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14553
14554 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14555 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14556 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14557 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14558
14559 @table @file
14560 @item overlays.c
14561 The main program file.
14562 @item ovlymgr.c
14563 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14564 @item foo.c
14565 @itemx bar.c
14566 @itemx baz.c
14567 @itemx grbx.c
14568 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14569 @item d10v.ld
14570 @itemx m32r.ld
14571 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14572 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14573 @end table
14574
14575 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14576 cross-compiler like this:
14577
14578 @smallexample
14579 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14580 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14581 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14582 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14583 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14584 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14585 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14586 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14587 @end smallexample
14588
14589 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14590 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14591 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14592
14593
14594 @node Languages
14595 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14596 @cindex languages
14597
14598 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14599 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14600 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14601 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14602 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14603 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14604
14605 @cindex working language
14606 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14607 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14608 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14609 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14610 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14611 language}.
14612
14613 @menu
14614 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14615 * Show:: Displaying the language
14616 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14617 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14618 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14619 @end menu
14620
14621 @node Setting
14622 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14623
14624 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14625 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14626 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14627 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14628 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14629 are printed, etc.
14630
14631 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14632 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14633 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14634 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14635 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14636 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14637 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14638 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14639 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14640 Displaying the Language}.
14641
14642 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14643 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14644 another language. In that case, make the
14645 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14646 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14647 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14648
14649 @menu
14650 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14651 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14652 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14653 @end menu
14654
14655 @node Filenames
14656 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14657
14658 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14659 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14660
14661 @table @file
14662 @item .ada
14663 @itemx .ads
14664 @itemx .adb
14665 @itemx .a
14666 Ada source file.
14667
14668 @item .c
14669 C source file
14670
14671 @item .C
14672 @itemx .cc
14673 @itemx .cp
14674 @itemx .cpp
14675 @itemx .cxx
14676 @itemx .c++
14677 C@t{++} source file
14678
14679 @item .d
14680 D source file
14681
14682 @item .m
14683 Objective-C source file
14684
14685 @item .f
14686 @itemx .F
14687 Fortran source file
14688
14689 @item .mod
14690 Modula-2 source file
14691
14692 @item .s
14693 @itemx .S
14694 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14695 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14696 @end table
14697
14698 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14699 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14700
14701 @node Manually
14702 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14703
14704 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14705 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14706 your program.
14707
14708 @kindex set language
14709 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14710 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14711 a language, such as
14712 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14713 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14714
14715 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14716 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14717 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14718 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14719 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14720 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14721 command such as:
14722
14723 @smallexample
14724 print a = b + c
14725 @end smallexample
14726
14727 @noindent
14728 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14729 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14730 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14731 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14732
14733 @node Automatically
14734 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14735
14736 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14737 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14738 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14739 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14740 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14741 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14742 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14743 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14744 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14745
14746 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14747 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14748 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14749 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14750 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14751
14752 @node Show
14753 @section Displaying the Language
14754
14755 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14756 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14757
14758 @table @code
14759 @item show language
14760 @anchor{show language}
14761 @kindex show language
14762 Display the current working language. This is the
14763 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14764 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14765
14766 @item info frame
14767 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14768 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14769 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14770 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14771 information listed here.
14772
14773 @item info source
14774 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14775 Display the source language of this source file.
14776 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14777 information listed here.
14778 @end table
14779
14780 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14781 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14782 with a language explicitly:
14783
14784 @table @code
14785 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14786 @kindex set extension-language
14787 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14788 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14789
14790 @item info extensions
14791 @kindex info extensions
14792 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14793 @end table
14794
14795 @node Checks
14796 @section Type and Range Checking
14797
14798 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14799 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14800 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14801 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14802 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14803 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14804 errors when your program is running.
14805
14806 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14807 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14808 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14809 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14810
14811 @menu
14812 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14813 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14814 @end menu
14815
14816 @cindex type checking
14817 @cindex checks, type
14818 @node Type Checking
14819 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14820
14821 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14822 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14823 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14824 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14825
14826 @smallexample
14827 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14828
14829 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14830 $1 = 2
14831 @exdent but
14832 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14833 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14834 @end smallexample
14835
14836 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14837 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14838
14839 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14840 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14841 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14842 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14843 expressions like the second example above.
14844
14845 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14846 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14847 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14848 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14849 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14850 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14851
14852 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14853
14854 @kindex set check type
14855 @kindex show check type
14856 @table @code
14857 @item set check type on
14858 @itemx set check type off
14859 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14860 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14861 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14862
14863 @item show check type
14864 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14865 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14866 @end table
14867
14868 @cindex range checking
14869 @cindex checks, range
14870 @node Range Checking
14871 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14872
14873 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14874 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14875 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14876 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14877 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14878
14879 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14880 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14881 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14882 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14883
14884 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14885 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14886 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14887 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14888 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14889 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14890
14891 @smallexample
14892 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14893 @end smallexample
14894
14895 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14896 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14897 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14898
14899 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14900
14901 @kindex set check range
14902 @kindex show check range
14903 @table @code
14904 @item set check range auto
14905 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14906 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14907 each language.
14908
14909 @item set check range on
14910 @itemx set check range off
14911 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14912 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14913 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14914 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14915
14916 @item set check range warn
14917 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14918 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14919 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14920 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14921 systems).
14922
14923 @item show range
14924 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14925 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14926 @end table
14927
14928 @node Supported Languages
14929 @section Supported Languages
14930
14931 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14932 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14933 @c This is false ...
14934 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14935 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14936 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14937 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14938 language.
14939
14940 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14941 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14942 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14943 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14944 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14945 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14946 language reference or tutorial.
14947
14948 @menu
14949 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14950 * D:: D
14951 * Go:: Go
14952 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14953 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14954 * Fortran:: Fortran
14955 * Pascal:: Pascal
14956 * Rust:: Rust
14957 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14958 * Ada:: Ada
14959 @end menu
14960
14961 @node C
14962 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14963
14964 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14965 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14966
14967 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14968 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14969 together.
14970
14971 @cindex C@t{++}
14972 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14973 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14974 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14975 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14976 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14977 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14978 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14979
14980 @menu
14981 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14982 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14983 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14984 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14985 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14986 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14987 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14988 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14989 @end menu
14990
14991 @node C Operators
14992 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14993
14994 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14995
14996 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14997 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14998 often defined on groups of types.
14999
15000 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
15001
15002 @itemize @bullet
15003
15004 @item
15005 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
15006 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
15007
15008 @item
15009 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
15010 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
15011
15012 @item
15013 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
15014
15015 @item
15016 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
15017
15018 @end itemize
15019
15020 @noindent
15021 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
15022 in order of increasing precedence:
15023
15024 @table @code
15025 @item ,
15026 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
15027 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
15028 expression being the last expression evaluated.
15029
15030 @item =
15031 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
15032 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
15033
15034 @item @var{op}=
15035 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
15036 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
15037 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
15038 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
15039 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
15040
15041 @item ?:
15042 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
15043 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
15044 should be of an integral type.
15045
15046 @item ||
15047 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15048
15049 @item &&
15050 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15051
15052 @item |
15053 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15054
15055 @item ^
15056 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15057
15058 @item &
15059 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15060
15061 @item ==@r{, }!=
15062 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
15063 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
15064
15065 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
15066 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
15067 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
15068 and non-zero for true.
15069
15070 @item <<@r{, }>>
15071 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
15072
15073 @item @@
15074 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15075
15076 @item +@r{, }-
15077 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
15078 pointer types.
15079
15080 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
15081 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
15082 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
15083 integral types.
15084
15085 @item ++@r{, }--
15086 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
15087 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
15088 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
15089 operation takes place.
15090
15091 @item *
15092 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
15093 @code{++}.
15094
15095 @item &
15096 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
15097
15098 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
15099 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
15100 to examine the address
15101 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
15102 stored.
15103
15104 @item -
15105 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
15106 precedence as @code{++}.
15107
15108 @item !
15109 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15110 @code{++}.
15111
15112 @item ~
15113 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15114 @code{++}.
15115
15116
15117 @item .@r{, }->
15118 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
15119 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
15120 pointer based on the stored type information.
15121 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
15122
15123 @item .*@r{, }->*
15124 Dereferences of pointers to members.
15125
15126 @item []
15127 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
15128 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15129
15130 @item ()
15131 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15132
15133 @item ::
15134 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
15135 and @code{class} types.
15136
15137 @item ::
15138 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
15139 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
15140 above.
15141 @end table
15142
15143 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
15144 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
15145 predefined meaning.
15146
15147 @node C Constants
15148 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
15149
15150 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
15151
15152 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
15153 following ways:
15154
15155 @itemize @bullet
15156 @item
15157 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
15158 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
15159 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
15160 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
15161 @code{long} value.
15162
15163 @item
15164 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
15165 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
15166 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
15167 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
15168 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
15169 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
15170 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
15171 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
15172 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
15173 constant.
15174
15175 @item
15176 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
15177 integral equivalents.
15178
15179 @item
15180 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
15181 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
15182 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
15183 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
15184 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
15185 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
15186 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
15187 @samp{\n} for newline.
15188
15189 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
15190 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
15191 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
15192 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15193
15194 @item
15195 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
15196 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
15197 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
15198 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
15199 characters.
15200
15201 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
15202 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
15203 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15204
15205 @item
15206 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
15207 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
15208
15209 @item
15210 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
15211 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
15212 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
15213 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
15214 @end itemize
15215
15216 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
15217 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
15218
15219 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
15220 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
15221
15222 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
15223 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
15224 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
15225 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
15226 @quotation
15227 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
15228 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
15229 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
15230 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
15231 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
15232 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
15233 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
15234 code. @xref{Compilation}.
15235 @end quotation
15236
15237 @enumerate
15238
15239 @cindex member functions
15240 @item
15241 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
15242
15243 @smallexample
15244 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
15245 @end smallexample
15246
15247 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
15248 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
15249 @item
15250 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
15251 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
15252 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
15253 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
15254 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
15255
15256 @cindex call overloaded functions
15257 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
15258 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
15259 @item
15260 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
15261 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
15262 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
15263 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
15264 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
15265 default arguments.
15266
15267 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
15268 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
15269 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
15270 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
15271 number of function arguments.
15272
15273 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
15274 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
15275 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
15276
15277 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
15278 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
15279 @smallexample
15280 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
15281 @end smallexample
15282
15283 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
15284 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
15285
15286 @cindex reference declarations
15287 @item
15288 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
15289 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
15290 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
15291
15292 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
15293 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
15294 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
15295 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
15296 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
15297
15298 @item
15299 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
15300 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
15301 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
15302 necessary, for example in an expression like
15303 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
15304 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
15305 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
15306
15307 @item
15308 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
15309 specification.
15310 @end enumerate
15311
15312 @node C Defaults
15313 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
15314
15315 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
15316
15317 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
15318 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
15319 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15320 selects the working language.
15321
15322 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15323 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15324 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15325 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15326 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15327 for further details.
15328
15329 @node C Checks
15330 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15331
15332 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15333
15334 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15335 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15336 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15337 constants to pointers.
15338
15339 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15340 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15341 that is not itself an array.
15342
15343 @node Debugging C
15344 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15345
15346 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15347 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15348 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15349 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15350
15351 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15352 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15353 ,Expressions}.
15354
15355 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15356 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15357
15358 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15359
15360 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15361 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15362
15363 @table @code
15364 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15365 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15366 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15367 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15368 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15369 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15370
15371 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15372 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15373 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15374 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15375 classes.
15376 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15377
15378 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15379 @item catch throw
15380 @itemx catch rethrow
15381 @itemx catch catch
15382 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15383 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15384
15385 @cindex inheritance
15386 @item ptype @var{typename}
15387 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15388 @var{typename}.
15389 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15390
15391 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15392 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15393 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15394 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15395 multiple inheritance is in use.
15396
15397 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15398 @item demangle @var{name}
15399 Demangle @var{name}.
15400 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15401
15402 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15403 @item set print demangle
15404 @itemx show print demangle
15405 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15406 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15407 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15408 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15409 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15410
15411 @item set print object
15412 @itemx show print object
15413 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15414 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15415
15416 @item set print vtbl
15417 @itemx show print vtbl
15418 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15419 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15420 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15421 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15422
15423 @kindex set overload-resolution
15424 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15425 @item set overload-resolution on
15426 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15427 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15428 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15429 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15430 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15431 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15432
15433 @item set overload-resolution off
15434 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15435 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15436 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15437 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15438 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15439 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15440 argument types.
15441
15442 @kindex show overload-resolution
15443 @item show overload-resolution
15444 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15445
15446 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15447 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15448 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15449 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15450 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15451 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15452 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15453
15454 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
15455
15456 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
15457 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
15458 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
15459 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
15460 for more detail.
15461
15462 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
15463 function that returns a std::string:
15464
15465 @smallexample
15466 std::string function(int);
15467 @end smallexample
15468
15469 @noindent
15470 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
15471 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
15472
15473 @smallexample
15474 function[abi:cxx11](int)
15475 @end smallexample
15476
15477 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
15478 tag. For example:
15479
15480 @smallexample
15481 (gdb) b function(int)
15482 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
15483 (gdb) info breakpoints
15484 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15485 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
15486 at main.cc:10
15487 @end smallexample
15488
15489 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
15490 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
15491 name, like:
15492
15493 @smallexample
15494 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
15495 @end smallexample
15496 @end table
15497
15498 @node Decimal Floating Point
15499 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15500 @cindex decimal floating point format
15501
15502 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15503 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15504 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15505 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15506
15507 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15508 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15509 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15510 configured target.
15511
15512 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15513 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15514 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15515
15516 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15517 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15518 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15519
15520 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15521 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15522 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15523
15524 @node D
15525 @subsection D
15526
15527 @cindex D
15528 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15529 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15530 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15531
15532 @node Go
15533 @subsection Go
15534
15535 @cindex Go (programming language)
15536 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15537 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15538
15539 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15540
15541 @table @code
15542 @cindex current Go package
15543 @item The current Go package
15544 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15545 specifying global variables and functions.
15546
15547 For example, given the program:
15548
15549 @example
15550 package main
15551 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15552 func main () @{
15553 // ...
15554 @}
15555 @end example
15556
15557 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15558
15559 @example
15560 (gdb) p myglob
15561 (gdb) p main.myglob
15562 @end example
15563
15564 @cindex builtin Go types
15565 @item Builtin Go types
15566 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15567 as a string.
15568
15569 @cindex builtin Go functions
15570 @item Builtin Go functions
15571 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15572 function and handles it internally.
15573
15574 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15575 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15576 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15577 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15578 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15579 @end table
15580
15581 @node Objective-C
15582 @subsection Objective-C
15583
15584 @cindex Objective-C
15585 This section provides information about some commands and command
15586 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15587 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15588 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15589
15590 @menu
15591 * Method Names in Commands::
15592 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15593 @end menu
15594
15595 @node Method Names in Commands
15596 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15597
15598 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15599 names as line specifications:
15600
15601 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15602 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15603 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15604 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15605 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15606 @itemize
15607 @item @code{clear}
15608 @item @code{break}
15609 @item @code{info line}
15610 @item @code{jump}
15611 @item @code{list}
15612 @end itemize
15613
15614 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15615
15616 @smallexample
15617 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15618 @end smallexample
15619
15620 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15621 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15622 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15623 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15624 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15625 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15626 debugged, enter:
15627
15628 @smallexample
15629 break -[Fruit create]
15630 @end smallexample
15631
15632 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15633 enter:
15634
15635 @smallexample
15636 list +[NSText initialize]
15637 @end smallexample
15638
15639 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15640 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15641 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15642 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15643
15644 @smallexample
15645 break create
15646 @end smallexample
15647
15648 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15649 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15650 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15651 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15652 none apply.
15653
15654 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15655 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15656
15657 @smallexample
15658 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15659 @end smallexample
15660
15661 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15662 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15663 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15664 @kindex print-object
15665 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15666
15667 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15668
15669 @smallexample
15670 print -[@var{object} hash]
15671 @end smallexample
15672
15673 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15674 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15675 @noindent
15676 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15677 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15678 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15679 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15680 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15681 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15682
15683 @node OpenCL C
15684 @subsection OpenCL C
15685
15686 @cindex OpenCL C
15687 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15688
15689 @menu
15690 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15691 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15692 * OpenCL C Operators::
15693 @end menu
15694
15695 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15696 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15697
15698 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15699 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15700 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15701 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15702 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15703
15704 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15705 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15706
15707 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15708 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15709 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15710 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15711
15712 @node OpenCL C Operators
15713 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15714
15715 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15716 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15717 vector data types.
15718
15719 @node Fortran
15720 @subsection Fortran
15721 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15722
15723 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15724 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15725
15726 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15727 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15728 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15729 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15730 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15731 underscore.
15732
15733 @menu
15734 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15735 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15736 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15737 @end menu
15738
15739 @node Fortran Operators
15740 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15741
15742 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15743
15744 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15745 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15746 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15747
15748 @table @code
15749 @item **
15750 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15751 of the second one.
15752
15753 @item :
15754 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15755 represent a section of array.
15756
15757 @item %
15758 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15759 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15760 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15761 union type.
15762 @end table
15763
15764 @node Fortran Defaults
15765 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15766
15767 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15768
15769 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15770 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15771 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15772 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15773
15774 @node Special Fortran Commands
15775 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15776
15777 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15778
15779 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15780 such as displaying common blocks.
15781
15782 @table @code
15783 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15784 @kindex info common
15785 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15786 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15787 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15788 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15789 printed.
15790 @end table
15791
15792 @node Pascal
15793 @subsection Pascal
15794
15795 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15796 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15797 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15798 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15799 syntax.
15800
15801 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15802 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15803 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15804
15805 @node Rust
15806 @subsection Rust
15807
15808 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15809 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15810 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15811 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15812
15813 @itemize @bullet
15814 @item
15815 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15816 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15817 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15818
15819 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15820 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15821 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15822 @samp{B}.
15823
15824 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15825 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15826
15827 @item
15828 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15829 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15830 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15831 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15832 @samp{K::x::y}.
15833
15834 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15835 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15836 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15837 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15838 scope.
15839
15840 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15841 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15842
15843 @item
15844 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15845 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15846
15847 @item
15848 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15849
15850 @item
15851 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15852 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15853 never be destroyed.
15854
15855 @item
15856 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15857 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15858 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15859
15860 @item
15861 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15862 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15863 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15864 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15865 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15866 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15867 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15868 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15869
15870 @item
15871 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15872 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15873 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15874 @itemize @bullet
15875
15876 @item
15877 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15878
15879 @item
15880 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15881
15882 @item
15883 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15884 type names.
15885
15886 @item
15887 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15888
15889 @item
15890 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15891 available in the crate.
15892 @end itemize
15893 @end itemize
15894
15895 @node Modula-2
15896 @subsection Modula-2
15897
15898 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15899
15900 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15901 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15902 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15903 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15904 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15905 table.
15906
15907 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15908 @menu
15909 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15910 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15911 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15912 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15913 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15914 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15915 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15916 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15917 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15918 @end menu
15919
15920 @node M2 Operators
15921 @subsubsection Operators
15922 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15923
15924 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15925 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15926 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15927 following definitions hold:
15928
15929 @itemize @bullet
15930
15931 @item
15932 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15933 their subranges.
15934
15935 @item
15936 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15937
15938 @item
15939 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15940
15941 @item
15942 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15943 @var{type}}.
15944
15945 @item
15946 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15947
15948 @item
15949 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15950
15951 @item
15952 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15953 @end itemize
15954
15955 @noindent
15956 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15957 increasing precedence:
15958
15959 @table @code
15960 @item ,
15961 Function argument or array index separator.
15962
15963 @item :=
15964 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15965 @var{value}.
15966
15967 @item <@r{, }>
15968 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15969 types.
15970
15971 @item <=@r{, }>=
15972 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15973 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15974 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15975
15976 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15977 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15978 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15979 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15980 comment character.
15981
15982 @item IN
15983 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15984 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15985
15986 @item OR
15987 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15988
15989 @item AND@r{, }&
15990 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15991
15992 @item @@
15993 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15994
15995 @item +@r{, }-
15996 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15997 and difference on set types.
15998
15999 @item *
16000 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
16001 on set types.
16002
16003 @item /
16004 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
16005 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
16006
16007 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
16008 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
16009 precedence as @code{*}.
16010
16011 @item -
16012 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
16013
16014 @item ^
16015 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
16016
16017 @item NOT
16018 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
16019 @code{^}.
16020
16021 @item .
16022 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
16023 precedence as @code{^}.
16024
16025 @item []
16026 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
16027
16028 @item ()
16029 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
16030 as @code{^}.
16031
16032 @item ::@r{, }.
16033 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
16034 @end table
16035
16036 @quotation
16037 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
16038 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
16039 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
16040 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
16041 @end quotation
16042
16043
16044 @node Built-In Func/Proc
16045 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
16046 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
16047
16048 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
16049 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
16050
16051 @table @var
16052
16053 @item a
16054 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
16055
16056 @item c
16057 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
16058
16059 @item i
16060 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
16061
16062 @item m
16063 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
16064 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
16065 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
16066
16067 @item n
16068 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
16069
16070 @item r
16071 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
16072
16073 @item t
16074 represents a type.
16075
16076 @item v
16077 represents a variable.
16078
16079 @item x
16080 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
16081 explanation of the function for details.
16082 @end table
16083
16084 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
16085
16086 @table @code
16087 @item ABS(@var{n})
16088 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
16089
16090 @item CAP(@var{c})
16091 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
16092 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
16093
16094 @item CHR(@var{i})
16095 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16096
16097 @item DEC(@var{v})
16098 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16099
16100 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
16101 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16102 new value.
16103
16104 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16105 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
16106 set.
16107
16108 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
16109 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
16110
16111 @item HIGH(@var{a})
16112 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
16113
16114 @item INC(@var{v})
16115 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16116
16117 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
16118 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16119 new value.
16120
16121 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16122 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
16123 there. Returns the new set.
16124
16125 @item MAX(@var{t})
16126 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
16127
16128 @item MIN(@var{t})
16129 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
16130
16131 @item ODD(@var{i})
16132 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
16133
16134 @item ORD(@var{x})
16135 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
16136 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
16137 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
16138 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
16139
16140 @item SIZE(@var{x})
16141 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16142 variable or a type.
16143
16144 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
16145 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
16146
16147 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
16148 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16149 variable or a type.
16150
16151 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
16152 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16153 @end table
16154
16155 @quotation
16156 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
16157 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
16158 an error.
16159 @end quotation
16160
16161 @cindex Modula-2 constants
16162 @node M2 Constants
16163 @subsubsection Constants
16164
16165 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
16166 ways:
16167
16168 @itemize @bullet
16169
16170 @item
16171 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
16172 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
16173 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
16174 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
16175
16176 @item
16177 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
16178 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
16179 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
16180 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
16181 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
16182 digits.
16183
16184 @item
16185 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
16186 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
16187 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
16188 followed by a @samp{C}.
16189
16190 @item
16191 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
16192 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
16193 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
16194 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
16195 sequences.
16196
16197 @item
16198 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
16199
16200 @item
16201 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
16202 @code{FALSE}.
16203
16204 @item
16205 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
16206
16207 @item
16208 Set constants are not yet supported.
16209 @end itemize
16210
16211 @node M2 Types
16212 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
16213 @cindex Modula-2 types
16214
16215 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
16216 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
16217 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
16218 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
16219 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
16220 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
16221
16222 The first example contains the following section of code:
16223
16224 @smallexample
16225 VAR
16226 s: SET OF CHAR ;
16227 r: [20..40] ;
16228 @end smallexample
16229
16230 @noindent
16231 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
16232 @code{r} and @code{s}.
16233
16234 @smallexample
16235 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16236 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
16237 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16238 SET OF CHAR
16239 (@value{GDBP}) print r
16240 21
16241 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
16242 [20..40]
16243 @end smallexample
16244
16245 @noindent
16246 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
16247
16248 @smallexample
16249 VAR
16250 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
16251 @end smallexample
16252
16253 @noindent
16254 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
16255
16256 @smallexample
16257 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16258 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
16259 @end smallexample
16260
16261 @noindent
16262 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
16263 expressions using the debugger.
16264
16265 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
16266 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
16267
16268 @smallexample
16269 VAR
16270 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
16271 @end smallexample
16272
16273 @smallexample
16274 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16275 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
16276 @end smallexample
16277
16278 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
16279 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
16280 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
16281 above.
16282
16283 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
16284
16285 @smallexample
16286 TYPE
16287 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
16288 t = [blue..yellow] ;
16289 VAR
16290 s: t ;
16291 BEGIN
16292 s := blue ;
16293 @end smallexample
16294
16295 @noindent
16296 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
16297 and value of a variable.
16298
16299 @smallexample
16300 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16301 $1 = blue
16302 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
16303 type = [blue..yellow]
16304 @end smallexample
16305
16306 @noindent
16307 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
16308 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
16309 their @code{C} counterparts.
16310
16311 @smallexample
16312 VAR
16313 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16314 BEGIN
16315 s[1] := 1 ;
16316 @end smallexample
16317
16318 @smallexample
16319 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16320 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
16321 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16322 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16323 @end smallexample
16324
16325 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
16326 pointer types as shown in this example:
16327
16328 @smallexample
16329 VAR
16330 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16331 BEGIN
16332 NEW(s) ;
16333 s^[1] := 1 ;
16334 @end smallexample
16335
16336 @noindent
16337 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
16338
16339 @smallexample
16340 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16341 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16342 @end smallexample
16343
16344 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
16345 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
16346 types:
16347
16348 @smallexample
16349 TYPE
16350 foo = RECORD
16351 f1: CARDINAL ;
16352 f2: CHAR ;
16353 f3: myarray ;
16354 END ;
16355
16356 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
16357 myrange = [-2..2] ;
16358 VAR
16359 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
16360 @end smallexample
16361
16362 @noindent
16363 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16364 below.
16365
16366 @smallexample
16367 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16368 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16369 f1 : CARDINAL;
16370 f2 : CHAR;
16371 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16372 END
16373 @end smallexample
16374
16375 @node M2 Defaults
16376 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16377 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16378
16379 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16380 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16381 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16382 selected the working language.
16383
16384 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16385 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16386 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16387 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16388
16389 @node Deviations
16390 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16391 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16392
16393 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16394 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16395
16396 @itemize @bullet
16397 @item
16398 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16399 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16400 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16401 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16402 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16403 returned a pointer.)
16404
16405 @item
16406 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16407 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16408 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16409 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16410
16411 @item
16412 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16413 argument.
16414
16415 @item
16416 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16417 @end itemize
16418
16419 @node M2 Checks
16420 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16421 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16422
16423 @quotation
16424 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16425 range checking.
16426 @end quotation
16427 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16428
16429 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16430
16431 @itemize @bullet
16432 @item
16433 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16434 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16435
16436 @item
16437 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16438 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16439 @end itemize
16440
16441 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16442 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16443
16444 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16445 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16446
16447 @node M2 Scope
16448 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16449 @cindex scope
16450 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16451 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16452 @ifinfo
16453 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16454 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16455 @end ifinfo
16456 @ifnotinfo
16457 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16458 @end ifnotinfo
16459
16460 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16461 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16462 similar syntax:
16463
16464 @smallexample
16465
16466 @var{module} . @var{id}
16467 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16468 @end smallexample
16469
16470 @noindent
16471 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16472 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16473 identifier within your program, except another module.
16474
16475 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16476 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16477 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16478 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16479
16480 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16481 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16482 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16483 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16484 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16485 @var{module}.
16486
16487 @node GDB/M2
16488 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16489
16490 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16491 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16492 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16493 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16494 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16495 analogue in Modula-2.
16496
16497 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16498 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16499 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16500 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16501 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16502 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16503
16504 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16505 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16506 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16507
16508 @node Ada
16509 @subsection Ada
16510 @cindex Ada
16511
16512 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16513 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16514 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16515 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16516 to be difficult.
16517
16518
16519 @cindex expressions in Ada
16520 @menu
16521 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16522 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16523 in @value{GDBN}.
16524 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16525 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16526 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16527 subprograms.
16528 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16529 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16530 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16531 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16532 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16533 Profile
16534 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
16535 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16536 @end menu
16537
16538 @node Ada Mode Intro
16539 @subsubsection Introduction
16540 @cindex Ada mode, general
16541
16542 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16543 syntax, with some extensions.
16544 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16545
16546 @itemize @bullet
16547 @item
16548 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16549 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16550 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16551 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16552
16553 @item
16554 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16555 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16556
16557 @item
16558 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16559 @end itemize
16560
16561 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16562 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16563 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16564 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16565 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16566
16567 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16568 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16569 was translated from an Ada source file.
16570
16571 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16572 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16573 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16574 middle (to allow based literals).
16575
16576 @node Omissions from Ada
16577 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16578 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16579
16580 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16581
16582 @itemize @bullet
16583 @item
16584 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16585
16586 @itemize @minus
16587 @item
16588 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16589 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16590
16591 @item
16592 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16593
16594 @item
16595 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16596
16597 @item
16598 @t{'Tag}.
16599
16600 @item
16601 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16602 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16603
16604 @item
16605 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16606 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16607
16608 @item
16609 @t{'Address}.
16610 @end itemize
16611
16612 @item
16613 The names in
16614 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16615 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16616 not currently available.
16617
16618 @item
16619 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16620 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16621 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16622 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16623 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16624 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16625 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16626 indeterminate values.
16627
16628 @item
16629 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16630 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16631 are not implemented.
16632
16633 @item
16634 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16635 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16636 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16637 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16638 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16639
16640 @smallexample
16641 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16642 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16643 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16644 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16645 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16646 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16647 @end smallexample
16648
16649 Changing a
16650 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16651 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16652 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16653 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16654 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16655 declared to have a type such as:
16656
16657 @smallexample
16658 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16659 Id : Integer;
16660 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16661 end record;
16662 @end smallexample
16663
16664 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16665 assignments:
16666
16667 @smallexample
16668 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16669 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16670 @end smallexample
16671
16672 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16673 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16674 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16675 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16676 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16677 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16678 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16679 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16680
16681 @item
16682 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16683
16684 @item
16685 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16686 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16687 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16688 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16689 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16690 the proper resolution.
16691
16692 @item
16693 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16694
16695 @item
16696 Entry calls are not implemented.
16697
16698 @item
16699 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16700 formats are not supported.
16701
16702 @item
16703 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16704
16705 @item
16706 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16707 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16708 context.
16709 Should your program
16710 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16711 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16712 @end itemize
16713
16714 @node Additions to Ada
16715 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16716 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16717
16718 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16719 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16720
16721 @itemize @bullet
16722 @item
16723 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16724 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16725 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16726 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16727 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16728 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16729 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16730 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16731
16732 @item
16733 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16734 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16735 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16736
16737 @item
16738 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16739 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16740
16741 @item
16742 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16743 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16744 @end itemize
16745
16746 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16747 additions specific to Ada:
16748
16749 @itemize @bullet
16750 @item
16751 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16752 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16753
16754 @smallexample
16755 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16756 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16757 @end smallexample
16758
16759 @item
16760 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16761 the value of its right-hand operand.
16762 This allows, for example,
16763 complex conditional breaks:
16764
16765 @smallexample
16766 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16767 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16768 @end smallexample
16769
16770 @item
16771 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16772 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16773 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16774 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16775 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16776 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16777 in strings. For example,
16778 @smallexample
16779 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16780 @end smallexample
16781 @noindent
16782 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16783 after each period.
16784
16785 @item
16786 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16787 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16788 to write
16789
16790 @smallexample
16791 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16792 @end smallexample
16793
16794 @item
16795 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16796 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16797 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16798 of 3 might print as
16799
16800 @smallexample
16801 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16802 @end smallexample
16803
16804 @noindent
16805 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16806 clause.
16807
16808 @item
16809 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16810 multi-character subsequence of
16811 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16812 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16813 in place of @t{a'length}.
16814
16815 @item
16816 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16817 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16818 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16819 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16820 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16821 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16822 For example,
16823 @smallexample
16824 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16825 @end smallexample
16826
16827 @item
16828 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16829 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16830 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16831 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16832 object.
16833
16834 @end itemize
16835
16836 @node Overloading support for Ada
16837 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16838 @cindex overloading, Ada
16839
16840 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16841 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16842 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16843 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16844 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16845 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16846
16847 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16848 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16849 use, for instance:
16850
16851 @smallexample
16852 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16853 Multiple matches for f
16854 [0] cancel
16855 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16856 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16857 >
16858 @end smallexample
16859
16860 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16861 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16862 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16863
16864 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16865 case:
16866
16867 @table @code
16868
16869 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16870 @item set ada print-signatures
16871 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16872 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16873 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16874
16875 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16876 @item show ada print-signatures
16877 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16878 overloads selection menu.
16879 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16880
16881 @end table
16882
16883 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16884 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16885
16886 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16887 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16888 before reaching the main procedure.
16889 As defined in the Ada Reference
16890 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16891 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16892 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16893 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16894
16895 @node Ada Exceptions
16896 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16897
16898 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16899
16900 @table @code
16901 @kindex info exceptions
16902 @item info exceptions
16903 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16904 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16905 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16906 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16907 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16908 @end table
16909
16910 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16911 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16912 argument.
16913
16914 @smallexample
16915 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16916 All defined Ada exceptions:
16917 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16918 program_error: 0x613d20
16919 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16920 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16921 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16922 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16923 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16924 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16925 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16926 @end smallexample
16927
16928 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16929 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16930
16931 @node Ada Tasks
16932 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16933 @cindex Ada, tasking
16934
16935 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16936 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16937
16938 @table @code
16939 @kindex info tasks
16940 @item info tasks
16941 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16942
16943
16944 @smallexample
16945 @iftex
16946 @leftskip=0.5cm
16947 @end iftex
16948 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16949 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16950 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16951 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16952 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16953 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16954
16955 @end smallexample
16956
16957 @noindent
16958 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16959 task currently being inspected.
16960
16961 @table @asis
16962 @item ID
16963 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16964
16965 @item TID
16966 The Ada task ID.
16967
16968 @item P-ID
16969 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16970
16971 @item Pri
16972 The base priority of the task.
16973
16974 @item State
16975 Current state of the task.
16976
16977 @table @code
16978 @item Unactivated
16979 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16980 executing.
16981
16982 @item Runnable
16983 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16984 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16985
16986 @item Terminated
16987 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16988 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16989 terminated themselves.
16990
16991 @item Child Activation Wait
16992 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16993
16994 @item Accept Statement
16995 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16996
16997 @item Waiting on entry call
16998 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16999
17000 @item Async Select Wait
17001 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
17002 select statement.
17003
17004 @item Delay Sleep
17005 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
17006 alternative open.
17007
17008 @item Child Termination Wait
17009 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
17010 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
17011 waiting on a terminate Phase.
17012
17013 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
17014 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
17015 finish terminating.
17016
17017 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
17018 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
17019 @end table
17020
17021 @item Name
17022 Name of the task in the program.
17023
17024 @end table
17025
17026 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
17027 @item info task @var{taskno}
17028 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
17029 the following example:
17030 @smallexample
17031 @iftex
17032 @leftskip=0.5cm
17033 @end iftex
17034 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17035 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17036 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17037 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
17038 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
17039 Ada Task: 0x807c468
17040 Name: task_1
17041 Thread: 0x807f378
17042 Parent: 1 (main_task)
17043 Base Priority: 15
17044 State: Runnable
17045 @end smallexample
17046
17047 @item task
17048 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
17049 @cindex current Ada task ID
17050 This command prints the ID of the current task.
17051
17052 @smallexample
17053 @iftex
17054 @leftskip=0.5cm
17055 @end iftex
17056 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17057 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17058 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17059 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17060 (@value{GDBP}) task
17061 [Current task is 2]
17062 @end smallexample
17063
17064 @item task @var{taskno}
17065 @cindex Ada task switching
17066 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
17067 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
17068 from the current task to the given task.
17069
17070 @smallexample
17071 @iftex
17072 @leftskip=0.5cm
17073 @end iftex
17074 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17075 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17076 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17077 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17078 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
17079 [Switching to task 1]
17080 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17081 (@value{GDBP}) bt
17082 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17083 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
17084 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
17085 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
17086 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
17087 @end smallexample
17088
17089 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
17090 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
17091 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
17092 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
17093 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
17094 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
17095 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
17096 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
17097 in @ref{Specify Location}.
17098
17099 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
17100 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
17101 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
17102 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
17103 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
17104
17105 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
17106 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
17107 program.
17108
17109 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
17110 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
17111 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
17112
17113 For example,
17114
17115 @smallexample
17116 @iftex
17117 @leftskip=0.5cm
17118 @end iftex
17119 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17120 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17121 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17122 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
17123 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17124 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
17125 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
17126 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
17127 (@value{GDBP}) cont
17128 Continuing.
17129 task # 1 running
17130 task # 2 running
17131
17132 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
17133 15 flush;
17134 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17135 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17136 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17137 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
17138 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17139 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
17140 @end smallexample
17141 @end table
17142
17143 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
17144 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17145 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
17146
17147 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
17148 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
17149 the platform being used.
17150 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
17151 switching is not supported.
17152
17153 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
17154 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
17155 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
17156 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
17157 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
17158 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
17159
17160 @node Ravenscar Profile
17161 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
17162 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
17163
17164 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
17165 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
17166 requirements.
17167
17168 @table @code
17169 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
17170 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
17171 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
17172 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17173 Profile. This is the default.
17174
17175 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
17176 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
17177 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17178 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
17179 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
17180 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
17181 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
17182
17183 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
17184 @item show ravenscar task-switching
17185 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
17186 using the Ravenscar Profile.
17187
17188 @end table
17189
17190 @node Ada Settings
17191 @subsubsection Ada Settings
17192 @cindex Ada settings
17193
17194 @table @code
17195 @kindex set varsize-limit
17196 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
17197 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
17198 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
17199 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
17200 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
17201 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
17202 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
17203
17204 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17205 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
17206 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
17207 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
17208 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
17209 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
17210 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
17211 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
17212 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
17213 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
17214 size is less than @var{size}.
17215
17216 @kindex show varsize-limit
17217 @item show varsize-limit
17218 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
17219 @end table
17220
17221 @node Ada Glitches
17222 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
17223 @cindex Ada, problems
17224
17225 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
17226 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
17227 @value{GDBN},
17228 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
17229 and the GNU Ada compiler.
17230
17231 @itemize @bullet
17232 @item
17233 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
17234 storage are invisible to the debugger.
17235
17236 @item
17237 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
17238 argument lists are treated as positional).
17239
17240 @item
17241 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
17242
17243 @item
17244 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
17245 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
17246 the host machine.
17247
17248 @item
17249 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
17250 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
17251 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
17252 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
17253 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
17254 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
17255 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
17256 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
17257 you can usually resolve the confusion
17258 by qualifying the problematic names with package
17259 @code{Standard} explicitly.
17260 @end itemize
17261
17262 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
17263 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
17264 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
17265 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
17266 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
17267 enabled.
17268
17269 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17270 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17271 @table @code
17272
17273 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
17274 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
17275 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
17276 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
17277 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
17278 This is the default.
17279
17280 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
17281 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
17282 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
17283 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
17284 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
17285 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
17286 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
17287
17288 @end table
17289
17290 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
17291 @cindex GNAT encoding
17292 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
17293 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
17294 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
17295 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
17296 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
17297 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
17298
17299 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
17300 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
17301 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
17302 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
17303 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
17304 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
17305 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
17306 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
17307
17308 @table @code
17309
17310 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
17311 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
17312 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
17313 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
17314
17315 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17316 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17317 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
17318
17319 @end table
17320
17321 @node Unsupported Languages
17322 @section Unsupported Languages
17323
17324 @cindex unsupported languages
17325 @cindex minimal language
17326 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
17327 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
17328 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
17329 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
17330 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
17331 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
17332
17333 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
17334 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
17335 language.
17336
17337 @node Symbols
17338 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
17339
17340 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
17341 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
17342 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
17343 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
17344 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
17345 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
17346 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17347
17348 @cindex symbol names
17349 @cindex names of symbols
17350 @cindex quoting names
17351 @anchor{quoting names}
17352 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
17353 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
17354 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
17355 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
17356 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
17357 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
17358 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
17359 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
17360
17361 @smallexample
17362 p 'foo.c'::x
17363 @end smallexample
17364
17365 @noindent
17366 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
17367
17368 @table @code
17369 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
17370 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
17371 @kindex set case-sensitive
17372 @item set case-sensitive on
17373 @itemx set case-sensitive off
17374 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
17375 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
17376 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
17377 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
17378 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
17379 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
17380 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
17381 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
17382 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
17383 case-insensitive matches.
17384
17385 @kindex show case-sensitive
17386 @item show case-sensitive
17387 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
17388 lookups.
17389
17390 @kindex set print type methods
17391 @item set print type methods
17392 @itemx set print type methods on
17393 @itemx set print type methods off
17394 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17395 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17396 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17397 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17398 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17399 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17400
17401 @kindex show print type methods
17402 @item show print type methods
17403 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17404 classes.
17405
17406 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
17407 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
17408 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
17409 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
17410 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
17411 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
17412 types defined in classes.
17413
17414 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
17415 @item show print type nested-type-limit
17416 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
17417 printing classes.
17418
17419 @kindex set print type typedefs
17420 @item set print type typedefs
17421 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17422 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17423
17424 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17425 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17426 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17427 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17428 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17429 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17430 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17431 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17432 types.
17433
17434 @kindex show print type typedefs
17435 @item show print type typedefs
17436 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17437 printing classes.
17438
17439 @kindex info address
17440 @cindex address of a symbol
17441 @item info address @var{symbol}
17442 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17443 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17444 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17445 is always stored.
17446
17447 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17448 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17449 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17450
17451 @kindex info symbol
17452 @cindex symbol from address
17453 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17454 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17455 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17456 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17457 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17458
17459 @smallexample
17460 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17461 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17462 @end smallexample
17463
17464 @noindent
17465 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17466 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17467
17468 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17469 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17470
17471 @smallexample
17472 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17473 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17474 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17475 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17476 @end smallexample
17477
17478 @kindex demangle
17479 @cindex demangle
17480 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17481 Demangle @var{name}.
17482 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17483 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17484
17485 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17486 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17487
17488 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17489 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17490
17491 @kindex whatis
17492 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17493 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17494 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17495 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17496
17497 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17498 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17499 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17500
17501 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17502 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17503 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17504 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17505 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17506 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17507 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17508 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17509 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17510
17511 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17512 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17513 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17514 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17515 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17516 unroll it.
17517
17518 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17519 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17520 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17521
17522 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17523 Available flags are:
17524
17525 @table @code
17526 @item r
17527 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17528 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17529 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17530
17531 @item m
17532 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17533
17534 @item M
17535 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17536 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17537
17538 @item t
17539 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17540 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17541 names are substituted when printing other types.
17542
17543 @item T
17544 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17545 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17546
17547 @item o
17548 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
17549 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
17550
17551 For example, given the following declarations:
17552
17553 @smallexample
17554 struct tuv
17555 @{
17556 int a1;
17557 char *a2;
17558 int a3;
17559 @};
17560
17561 struct xyz
17562 @{
17563 int f1;
17564 char f2;
17565 void *f3;
17566 struct tuv f4;
17567 @};
17568
17569 union qwe
17570 @{
17571 struct tuv fff1;
17572 struct xyz fff2;
17573 @};
17574
17575 struct tyu
17576 @{
17577 int a1 : 1;
17578 int a2 : 3;
17579 int a3 : 23;
17580 char a4 : 2;
17581 int64_t a5;
17582 int a6 : 5;
17583 int64_t a7 : 3;
17584 @};
17585 @end smallexample
17586
17587 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
17588
17589 @smallexample
17590 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
17591 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
17592 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17593 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17594 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17595 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17596
17597 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17598 @}
17599 @end smallexample
17600
17601 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
17602 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
17603 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
17604 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
17605 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
17606 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
17607 its fields.
17608
17609 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
17610
17611 @smallexample
17612 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
17613 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
17614 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
17615 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17616 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17617 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17618 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17619
17620 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17621 @} fff1;
17622 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
17623 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
17624 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
17625 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
17626 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
17627 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
17628 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
17629 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17630 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
17631 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
17632
17633 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17634 @} f4;
17635
17636 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17637 @} fff2;
17638
17639 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17640 @}
17641 @end smallexample
17642
17643 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
17644 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
17645 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
17646 of these structures' fields.
17647
17648 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
17649 bitfields:
17650
17651 @smallexample
17652 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
17653 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
17654 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
17655 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
17656 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
17657 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
17658 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
17659 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17660 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
17661 /* 16:27 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
17662 /* 16:56 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
17663
17664 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17665 @}
17666 @end smallexample
17667
17668 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include how
17669 many bits are left to be used in each bitfield.
17670 @end table
17671
17672 @kindex ptype
17673 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17674 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17675 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17676 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17677
17678 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17679 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17680 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17681 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17682 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17683 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17684 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17685 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17686
17687 For example, for this variable declaration:
17688
17689 @smallexample
17690 typedef double real_t;
17691 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17692 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17693 complex_t var;
17694 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17695 @end smallexample
17696
17697 @noindent
17698 the two commands give this output:
17699
17700 @smallexample
17701 @group
17702 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17703 type = complex_t
17704 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17705 type = struct complex @{
17706 real_t real;
17707 double imag;
17708 @}
17709 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17710 type = struct complex
17711 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17712 type = struct complex
17713 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17714 type = struct complex @{
17715 real_t real;
17716 double imag;
17717 @}
17718 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17719 type = real_t *
17720 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17721 type = double *
17722 @end group
17723 @end smallexample
17724
17725 @noindent
17726 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17727 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17728
17729 @cindex incomplete type
17730 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17731 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17732 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17733 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17734 given these declarations:
17735
17736 @smallexample
17737 struct foo;
17738 struct foo *fooptr;
17739 @end smallexample
17740
17741 @noindent
17742 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17743
17744 @smallexample
17745 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17746 $1 = <incomplete type>
17747 @end smallexample
17748
17749 @noindent
17750 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17751 completely specified.
17752
17753 @cindex unknown type
17754 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17755 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17756 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17757 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17758 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17759 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17760 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17761 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17762
17763 @smallexample
17764 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17765 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17766 @end smallexample
17767
17768 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17769 of such variables.
17770
17771 @kindex info types
17772 @item info types @var{regexp}
17773 @itemx info types
17774 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17775 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17776 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17777 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17778 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17779 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17780 name is @code{value}.
17781
17782 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17783 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17784 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
17785
17786 @kindex info type-printers
17787 @item info type-printers
17788 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17789 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17790 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17791 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17792 type printers.
17793
17794 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17795
17796 @kindex enable type-printer
17797 @kindex disable type-printer
17798 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17799 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17800 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17801
17802 @kindex info scope
17803 @cindex local variables
17804 @item info scope @var{location}
17805 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17806 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17807 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17808 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17809 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17810
17811 @smallexample
17812 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17813 Scope for command_line_handler:
17814 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17815 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17816 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17817 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17818 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17819 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17820 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17821 @end smallexample
17822
17823 @noindent
17824 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17825 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17826 collect}.
17827
17828 @kindex info source
17829 @item info source
17830 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17831 the function containing the current point of execution:
17832 @itemize @bullet
17833 @item
17834 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17835 @item
17836 the directory it was compiled in,
17837 @item
17838 its length, in lines,
17839 @item
17840 which programming language it is written in,
17841 @item
17842 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17843 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17844 @item
17845 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17846 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17847 @item
17848 whether the debugging information includes information about
17849 preprocessor macros.
17850 @end itemize
17851
17852
17853 @kindex info sources
17854 @item info sources
17855 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17856 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17857 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17858
17859 @kindex info functions
17860 @item info functions
17861 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17862 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
17863 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
17864 number.
17865
17866 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17867 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types of
17868 functions whose names contain a match for regular expression
17869 @var{regexp}. Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
17870 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17871 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
17872 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17873 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17874
17875 @kindex info variables
17876 @item info variables
17877 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17878 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17879 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
17880 their respective source line numbers.
17881
17882 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17883 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the names and data types of
17884 non-local variables whose names contain a match for regular expression
17885 @var{regexp}.
17886
17887 @kindex info classes
17888 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17889 @item info classes
17890 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17891 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17892 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17893 expression.
17894
17895 @kindex info selectors
17896 @item info selectors
17897 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17898 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17899 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17900 expression.
17901
17902 @ignore
17903 This was never implemented.
17904 @kindex info methods
17905 @item info methods
17906 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17907 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17908 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17909 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17910 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17911 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17912 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17913 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17914 @end ignore
17915
17916 @cindex opaque data types
17917 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17918 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17919 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17920 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17921 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17922 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17923 another source file. The default is on.
17924
17925 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17926 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17927
17928 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17929 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17930 is printed as follows:
17931 @smallexample
17932 @{<no data fields>@}
17933 @end smallexample
17934
17935 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17936 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17937 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17938
17939 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17940 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17941 @item set print symbol-loading
17942 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17943 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17944 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17945 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17946 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17947 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17948 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17949 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17950 can be annoying.
17951 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17952 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17953 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17954 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17955
17956 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17957 @item show print symbol-loading
17958 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17959 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17960
17961 @kindex maint print symbols
17962 @cindex symbol dump
17963 @kindex maint print psymbols
17964 @cindex partial symbol dump
17965 @kindex maint print msymbols
17966 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17967 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17968 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17969 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17970 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17971 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17972 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17973 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17974 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17975 that objfile.
17976 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17977 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17978 @code{main}.
17979 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17980 source file.
17981
17982 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17983 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17984 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17985 tables.
17986 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17987 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17988 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17989 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17990 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17991 ``ELF symbols''.
17992
17993 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17994 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17995
17996 @kindex maint info symtabs
17997 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17998 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17999 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18000 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18001 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18002 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18003 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18004
18005 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
18006 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18007 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
18008 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
18009 structure in more detail. For example:
18010
18011 @smallexample
18012 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
18013 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18014 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18015 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18016 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
18017 readin no
18018 fullname (null)
18019 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
18020 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
18021 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
18022 dependencies (none)
18023 @}
18024 @}
18025 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18026 (@value{GDBP})
18027 @end smallexample
18028 @noindent
18029 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
18030 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
18031 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
18032 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
18033 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
18034
18035 @smallexample
18036 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
18037 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
18038 line 1574.
18039 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18040 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18041 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18042 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18043 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
18044 dirname (null)
18045 fullname (null)
18046 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
18047 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
18048 debugformat DWARF 2
18049 @}
18050 @}
18051 (@value{GDBP})
18052 @end smallexample
18053
18054 @kindex maint info line-table
18055 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
18056 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18057 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18058
18059 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
18060 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18061 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
18062
18063 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
18064 @cindex symbol cache size
18065 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
18066 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
18067 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
18068 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
18069 with different sizes.
18070
18071 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
18072 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
18073 Show the size of the symbol cache.
18074
18075 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
18076 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
18077 @item maint print symbol-cache
18078 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
18079 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
18080
18081 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18082 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
18083 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18084 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
18085 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
18086
18087 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
18088 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
18089 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
18090 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
18091 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
18092 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
18093
18094 @end table
18095
18096 @node Altering
18097 @chapter Altering Execution
18098
18099 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
18100 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
18101 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
18102 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
18103 program.
18104
18105 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
18106 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
18107 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
18108
18109 @menu
18110 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
18111 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
18112 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
18113 * Returning:: Returning from a function
18114 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
18115 * Patching:: Patching your program
18116 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18117 @end menu
18118
18119 @node Assignment
18120 @section Assignment to Variables
18121
18122 @cindex assignment
18123 @cindex setting variables
18124 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
18125 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
18126
18127 @smallexample
18128 print x=4
18129 @end smallexample
18130
18131 @noindent
18132 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
18133 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
18134 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
18135 information on operators in supported languages.
18136
18137 @kindex set variable
18138 @cindex variables, setting
18139 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
18140 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
18141 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
18142 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
18143 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
18144
18145 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
18146 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
18147 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
18148 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
18149 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
18150 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
18151 command @code{set width}:
18152
18153 @smallexample
18154 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
18155 type = double
18156 (@value{GDBP}) p width
18157 $4 = 13
18158 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
18159 Invalid syntax in expression.
18160 @end smallexample
18161
18162 @noindent
18163 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
18164 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
18165
18166 @smallexample
18167 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
18168 @end smallexample
18169
18170 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
18171 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
18172 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
18173 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
18174 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
18175 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
18176
18177 @smallexample
18178 @group
18179 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
18180 type = double
18181 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18182 $1 = 1
18183 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
18184 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18185 $2 = 1
18186 (@value{GDBP}) r
18187 The program being debugged has been started already.
18188 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
18189 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
18190 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
18191 Invalid bfd target.
18192 (@value{GDBP}) show g
18193 The current BFD target is "=4".
18194 @end group
18195 @end smallexample
18196
18197 @noindent
18198 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
18199 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
18200 @code{g}, use
18201
18202 @smallexample
18203 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
18204 @end smallexample
18205
18206 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
18207 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
18208 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
18209 same length or shorter.
18210 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
18211 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
18212
18213 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
18214 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
18215 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
18216 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
18217 and representation in memory), and
18218
18219 @smallexample
18220 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
18221 @end smallexample
18222
18223 @noindent
18224 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
18225
18226 @node Jumping
18227 @section Continuing at a Different Address
18228
18229 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
18230 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
18231 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
18232
18233 @table @code
18234 @kindex jump
18235 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
18236 @item jump @var{location}
18237 @itemx j @var{location}
18238 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
18239 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
18240 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
18241 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
18242 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
18243
18244 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
18245 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
18246 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
18247 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
18248 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
18249 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
18250 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
18251 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
18252 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
18253 @end table
18254
18255 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
18256 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
18257 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
18258 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
18259 example,
18260
18261 @smallexample
18262 set $pc = 0x485
18263 @end smallexample
18264
18265 @noindent
18266 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
18267 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
18268 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
18269
18270 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
18271 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
18272 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
18273 detail.
18274
18275 @c @group
18276 @node Signaling
18277 @section Giving your Program a Signal
18278 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
18279
18280 @table @code
18281 @kindex signal
18282 @item signal @var{signal}
18283 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
18284 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
18285 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
18286 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18287
18288 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
18289 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
18290 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18291 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
18292 signal.
18293
18294 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
18295 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
18296 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
18297 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
18298 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
18299 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
18300 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
18301 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
18302
18303 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
18304 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
18305 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
18306 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
18307 passes the signal directly to your program.
18308
18309 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
18310 after executing the command.
18311
18312 @kindex queue-signal
18313 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
18314 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
18315 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
18316 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
18317 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18318 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
18319 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
18320 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
18321 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
18322
18323 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
18324 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
18325 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
18326 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18327 @code{continue} command.
18328
18329 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
18330 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
18331 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
18332 (@pxref{Signals}).
18333 @end table
18334 @c @end group
18335
18336 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
18337 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
18338
18339 @node Returning
18340 @section Returning from a Function
18341
18342 @table @code
18343 @cindex returning from a function
18344 @kindex return
18345 @item return
18346 @itemx return @var{expression}
18347 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
18348 command. If you give an
18349 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
18350 value.
18351 @end table
18352
18353 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
18354 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
18355 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
18356 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
18357
18358 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
18359 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
18360 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
18361 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
18362 of functions.
18363
18364 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
18365 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
18366 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
18367 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
18368 selected stack frame returns naturally.
18369
18370 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
18371 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
18372 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
18373 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
18374 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
18375 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
18376 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
18377 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
18378 assignment into the right register(s).
18379
18380 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
18381 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
18382 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
18383 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
18384 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
18385 into a @code{long long int}:
18386
18387 @smallexample
18388 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
18389 29 return 31;
18390 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18391 Make func return now? (y or n) y
18392 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
18393 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
18394 (@value{GDBP})
18395 @end smallexample
18396
18397 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
18398 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
18399 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
18400 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
18401 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
18402 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
18403 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
18404 an appropriate cast explicitly:
18405
18406 @smallexample
18407 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
18408 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18409 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
18410 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
18411 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
18412 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
18413 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
18414 (@value{GDBP})
18415 @end smallexample
18416
18417 @node Calling
18418 @section Calling Program Functions
18419
18420 @table @code
18421 @cindex calling functions
18422 @cindex inferior functions, calling
18423 @item print @var{expr}
18424 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
18425 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
18426 debugged.
18427
18428 @kindex call
18429 @item call @var{expr}
18430 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
18431 returned values.
18432
18433 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
18434 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
18435 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
18436 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
18437 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
18438 value history.
18439 @end table
18440
18441 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
18442 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
18443 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
18444 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
18445
18446 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
18447 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
18448 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
18449 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
18450 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
18451 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
18452 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
18453 in that case is controlled by the
18454 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
18455
18456 @table @code
18457 @item set unwindonsignal
18458 @kindex set unwindonsignal
18459 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
18460 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
18461 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
18462 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
18463 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
18464 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
18465 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
18466 received.
18467
18468 @item show unwindonsignal
18469 @kindex show unwindonsignal
18470 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18471 @value{GDBN}.
18472
18473 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18474 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18475 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
18476 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
18477 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
18478 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
18479 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
18480 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
18481 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
18482 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
18483
18484 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18485 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18486 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18487 @value{GDBN}.
18488
18489 @end table
18490
18491 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
18492
18493 @cindex no debug info functions
18494 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
18495 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
18496 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
18497 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
18498 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
18499 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
18500
18501 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
18502 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
18503 declared return type. For example:
18504
18505 @smallexample
18506 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
18507 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
18508 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
18509 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
18510 @end smallexample
18511
18512 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
18513 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
18514 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
18515 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
18516
18517 @smallexample
18518 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
18519 @end smallexample
18520
18521 @noindent
18522 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
18523
18524 @smallexample
18525 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
18526 @end smallexample
18527
18528 @noindent
18529 these calls are equivalent:
18530
18531 @smallexample
18532 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
18533 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18534 @end smallexample
18535
18536 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18537 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18538 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18539 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18540 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18541 float parameters, and no debug info:
18542
18543 @smallexample
18544 float
18545 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18546 float v1, v2;
18547 @{
18548 return v1 * v2;
18549 @}
18550 @end smallexample
18551
18552 @noindent
18553 you call it like this:
18554
18555 @smallexample
18556 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18557 @end smallexample
18558
18559 @node Patching
18560 @section Patching Programs
18561
18562 @cindex patching binaries
18563 @cindex writing into executables
18564 @cindex writing into corefiles
18565
18566 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18567 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18568 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18569 patching your program's binary.
18570
18571 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18572 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18573 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18574 repairs.
18575
18576 @table @code
18577 @kindex set write
18578 @item set write on
18579 @itemx set write off
18580 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18581 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18582 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18583
18584 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18585 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18586 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18587
18588 @item show write
18589 @kindex show write
18590 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18591 as well as reading.
18592 @end table
18593
18594 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18595 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18596 @cindex injecting code
18597 @cindex writing into executables
18598 @cindex compiling code
18599
18600 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18601 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18602 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18603 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18604
18605 @table @code
18606 @kindex compile code
18607 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18608 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18609 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18610 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18611 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18612 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18613 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18614 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18615 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18616 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18617 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18618 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18619
18620 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18621 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18622 E.g.:
18623
18624 @smallexample
18625 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18626 @end smallexample
18627
18628 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18629 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18630 from actual source code. E.g.:
18631
18632 @smallexample
18633 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18634 @end smallexample
18635
18636 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18637 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18638 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18639 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18640 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18641 editor.
18642
18643 @smallexample
18644 compile code
18645 >printf ("hello\n");
18646 >printf ("world\n");
18647 >end
18648 @end smallexample
18649
18650 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18651 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18652 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18653 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18654 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18655 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18656 inferior symbols otherwise.
18657
18658 @kindex compile file
18659 @item compile file @var{filename}
18660 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18661 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18662
18663 @smallexample
18664 compile file /home/user/example.c
18665 @end smallexample
18666 @end table
18667
18668 @table @code
18669 @item compile print @var{expr}
18670 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18671 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18672 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18673 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18674 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18675 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18676 Formats}.
18677
18678 @item compile print
18679 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18680 @cindex reprint the last value
18681 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18682 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18683 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18684 multiple-line editor.
18685 @end table
18686
18687 @noindent
18688 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18689
18690 @table @code
18691 @anchor{set debug compile}
18692 @item set debug compile
18693 @cindex compile command debugging info
18694 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18695 injecting the code. The default is off.
18696
18697 @item show debug compile
18698 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18699 compiling and injecting the code.
18700
18701 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
18702 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
18703 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
18704 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
18705 The default is off.
18706
18707 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
18708 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
18709 C@t{++} type conversion.
18710 @end table
18711
18712 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18713
18714 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18715 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18716 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18717 injecting process.
18718
18719 @noindent
18720 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18721
18722 @table @asis
18723 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18724 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18725 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18726 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18727
18728 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18729 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18730 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18731 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18732 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18733 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18734 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18735 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18736
18737 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18738 @end table
18739
18740 @noindent
18741 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18742
18743 @table @code
18744 @item set compile-args
18745 @cindex compile command options override
18746 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18747 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18748 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18749 compilation.
18750
18751 @item show compile-args
18752 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18753 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18754 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18755 @end table
18756
18757 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18758
18759 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18760 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18761 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18762
18763 @table @asis
18764 @item C code examples and caveats
18765 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18766 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18767 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18768 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18769 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18770
18771 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18772 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18773 much like any other normal debugging session.
18774
18775 @smallexample
18776 void function1 (void)
18777 @{
18778 int i = 42;
18779 printf ("function 1\n");
18780 @}
18781
18782 void function2 (void)
18783 @{
18784 int j = 12;
18785 function1 ();
18786 @}
18787
18788 int main(void)
18789 @{
18790 int k = 6;
18791 int *p;
18792 function2 ();
18793 return 0;
18794 @}
18795 @end smallexample
18796
18797 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18798 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18799 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18800
18801 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18802 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18803 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18804 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18805 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18806
18807 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18808 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18809 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18810 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18811 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18812 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18813 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18814 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18815 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18816 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18817
18818 @smallexample
18819 compile code k = 3;
18820 @end smallexample
18821
18822 @noindent
18823 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18824 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18825 @code{compile} command changes it.
18826
18827 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18828 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18829 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18830 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18831 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18832
18833 @smallexample
18834 compile code j = 3;
18835 @end smallexample
18836
18837 @noindent
18838 will result in a compilation error message.
18839
18840 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18841 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18842 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18843
18844 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18845 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18846 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18847 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18848
18849 @smallexample
18850 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18851 @end smallexample
18852
18853 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18854 command has completed:
18855
18856 @smallexample
18857 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18858 @end smallexample
18859
18860 @noindent
18861 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18862 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18863 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18864 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18865 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18866
18867 @smallexample
18868 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18869 @end smallexample
18870
18871 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18872 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18873 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18874 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18875 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18876 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18877 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18878 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18879
18880 @smallexample
18881 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18882 @end smallexample
18883
18884 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18885 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18886 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18887 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18888 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18889 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18890 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18891
18892 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18893 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18894 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18895 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18896 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18897 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18898
18899 @smallexample
18900 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18901 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18902 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18903 Compilation failed.
18904 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18905 42
18906 @end smallexample
18907
18908 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18909 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18910 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18911 will print to the console.
18912 @end table
18913
18914 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18915
18916 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
18917 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
18918 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
18919 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18920 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
18921 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
18922 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
18923 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
18924
18925
18926 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18927 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18928 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18929 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18930 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18931 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18932 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18933
18934 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
18935 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
18936 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
18937 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
18938 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
18939 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
18940 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
18941
18942 @table @code
18943 @item set compile-gcc
18944 @cindex compile command driver filename override
18945 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
18946 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
18947 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
18948 default.
18949
18950 @item show compile-gcc
18951 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
18952 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
18953 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
18954 @end table
18955
18956 @node GDB Files
18957 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18958
18959 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18960 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18961 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18962 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18963
18964 @menu
18965 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18966 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18967 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18968 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18969 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18970 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18971 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18972 @end menu
18973
18974 @node Files
18975 @section Commands to Specify Files
18976
18977 @cindex symbol table
18978 @cindex core dump file
18979
18980 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18981 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18982 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18983 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18984
18985 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18986 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18987 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18988 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18989 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18990 new files are useful.
18991
18992 @table @code
18993 @cindex executable file
18994 @kindex file
18995 @item file @var{filename}
18996 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18997 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18998 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18999 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
19000 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
19001 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
19002 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
19003 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
19004
19005 @cindex unlinked object files
19006 @cindex patching object files
19007 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
19008 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
19009 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
19010 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
19011 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
19012 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
19013 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
19014 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
19015
19016 @item file
19017 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
19018 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
19019
19020 @kindex exec-file
19021 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
19022 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
19023 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
19024 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
19025 discard information on the executable file.
19026
19027 @kindex symbol-file
19028 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
19029 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
19030 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
19031 table and program to run from the same file.
19032
19033 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19034 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
19035 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
19036 enabled.
19037
19038 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
19039 program's symbol table.
19040
19041 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
19042 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
19043 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
19044 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
19045 @value{GDBN}.
19046
19047 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
19048 executing it once.
19049
19050 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
19051 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
19052 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
19053 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
19054 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
19055 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
19056 optimized code.
19057
19058 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
19059 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
19060 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
19061 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
19062 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
19063
19064 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
19065 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
19066 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
19067 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
19068 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
19069 Warnings and Messages}.)
19070
19071 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
19072 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
19073 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
19074 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
19075 in stabs format.
19076
19077 @kindex readnow
19078 @cindex reading symbols immediately
19079 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
19080 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19081 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19082 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
19083 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
19084 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
19085 entire symbol table available.
19086
19087 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
19088 @cindex never read symbols
19089 @cindex symbols, never read
19090 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19091 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19092 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
19093 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
19094 @xref{--readnever}.
19095
19096 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
19097 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
19098 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
19099 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
19100 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
19101 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
19102 @c files.
19103
19104 @kindex core-file
19105 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19106 @itemx core
19107 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
19108 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
19109 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
19110 executable file itself for other parts.
19111
19112 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
19113 to be used.
19114
19115 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
19116 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
19117 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
19118 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
19119 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
19120
19121 @kindex add-symbol-file
19122 @cindex dynamic linking
19123 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
19124 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
19125 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
19126 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
19127 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
19128 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
19129 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
19130 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
19131 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
19132 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
19133 can be given as an expression.
19134
19135 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19136 address of each section, except those for which the address was
19137 specified explicitly.
19138
19139 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
19140 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
19141 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
19142 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
19143
19144 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
19145
19146 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
19147 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
19148 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
19149 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
19150 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
19151 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
19152 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
19153 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
19154 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
19155
19156 @itemize @bullet
19157 @item
19158 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
19159 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
19160 @item
19161 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
19162 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
19163 @item
19164 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
19165 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19166 @end itemize
19167
19168 @noindent
19169 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
19170 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
19171 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
19172 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
19173 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
19174 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
19175 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
19176 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
19177 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
19178 way.
19179
19180 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19181
19182 @kindex remove-symbol-file
19183 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
19184 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
19185 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
19186 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
19187 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
19188
19189 @smallexample
19190 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
19191 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
19192 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
19193 (y or n) y
19194 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
19195 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
19196 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
19197 (gdb)
19198 @end smallexample
19199
19200
19201 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19202
19203 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
19204 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
19205 @cindex load symbols from memory
19206 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
19207 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
19208 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
19209 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
19210 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
19211 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
19212 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
19213 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
19214 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
19215
19216 @kindex section
19217 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
19218 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
19219 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
19220 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
19221 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
19222 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
19223 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
19224 their addresses.
19225
19226 @kindex info files
19227 @kindex info target
19228 @item info files
19229 @itemx info target
19230 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
19231 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
19232 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
19233 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
19234 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
19235 current ones.
19236
19237 @kindex maint info sections
19238 @item maint info sections
19239 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
19240 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
19241 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
19242 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
19243 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
19244 may be arbitrarily combined):
19245
19246 @table @code
19247 @item ALLOBJ
19248 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
19249 @item @var{sections}
19250 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
19251 @item @var{section-flags}
19252 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
19253 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
19254 @table @code
19255 @item ALLOC
19256 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
19257 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
19258 @item LOAD
19259 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
19260 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
19261 @item RELOC
19262 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
19263 @item READONLY
19264 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
19265 @item CODE
19266 Section contains executable code only.
19267 @item DATA
19268 Section contains data only (no executable code).
19269 @item ROM
19270 Section will reside in ROM.
19271 @item CONSTRUCTOR
19272 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
19273 @item HAS_CONTENTS
19274 Section is not empty.
19275 @item NEVER_LOAD
19276 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
19277 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
19278 A notification to the linker that the section contains
19279 COFF shared library information.
19280 @item IS_COMMON
19281 Section contains common symbols.
19282 @end table
19283 @end table
19284 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
19285 @cindex read-only sections
19286 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
19287 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
19288 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
19289 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
19290 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
19291 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
19292 enhancement to debugging performance.
19293
19294 The default is off.
19295
19296 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
19297 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
19298 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
19299 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
19300
19301 @item show trust-readonly-sections
19302 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
19303 @end table
19304
19305 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
19306 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
19307 name and remembers it that way.
19308
19309 @cindex shared libraries
19310 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
19311 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
19312 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
19313 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
19314
19315 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
19316 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
19317
19318 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
19319 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
19320 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
19321 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
19322 debugging a core file).
19323
19324 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
19325 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
19326 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
19327
19328 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
19329 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
19330 particularly large or there are many of them.
19331
19332 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
19333 commands:
19334
19335 @table @code
19336 @kindex set auto-solib-add
19337 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
19338 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
19339 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
19340 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
19341 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
19342 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
19343 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
19344
19345 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
19346 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
19347 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
19348 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
19349 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
19350 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
19351 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
19352 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
19353 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
19354
19355 @kindex show auto-solib-add
19356 @item show auto-solib-add
19357 Display the current autoloading mode.
19358 @end table
19359
19360 @cindex load shared library
19361 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
19362 command:
19363
19364 @table @code
19365 @kindex info sharedlibrary
19366 @kindex info share
19367 @item info share @var{regex}
19368 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19369 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
19370 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
19371 all shared libraries that are loaded.
19372
19373 @kindex info dll
19374 @item info dll @var{regex}
19375 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
19376
19377 @kindex sharedlibrary
19378 @kindex share
19379 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19380 @itemx share @var{regex}
19381 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
19382 Unix regular expression.
19383 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
19384 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
19385 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
19386 loaded.
19387
19388 @item nosharedlibrary
19389 @kindex nosharedlibrary
19390 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
19391 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
19392 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
19393 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
19394 discarded.
19395 @end table
19396
19397 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
19398 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
19399 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
19400 Catchpoints}).
19401
19402 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
19403 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
19404 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
19405 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
19406
19407 @table @code
19408 @item set stop-on-solib-events
19409 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
19410 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
19411 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
19412 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
19413 shared library.
19414
19415 @item show stop-on-solib-events
19416 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
19417 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
19418 library events happen.
19419 @end table
19420
19421 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
19422 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
19423 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
19424 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
19425 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
19426 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
19427 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
19428 not.
19429
19430 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
19431 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
19432 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
19433 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
19434 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
19435
19436 @table @code
19437 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
19438 @cindex system root, alternate
19439 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
19440 @kindex set sysroot
19441 @item set sysroot @var{path}
19442 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
19443 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
19444 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
19445 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
19446 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
19447 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
19448 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
19449 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
19450 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
19451 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
19452 @var{path}.
19453
19454 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
19455 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
19456 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
19457 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
19458 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
19459 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
19460 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
19461 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
19462 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
19463 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
19464 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
19465 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
19466 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
19467 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
19468
19469 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
19470 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
19471 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
19472 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
19473 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
19474
19475 @smallexample
19476 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
19477 @end smallexample
19478
19479 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
19480 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
19481 system:
19482
19483 @smallexample
19484 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
19485 @end smallexample
19486
19487 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
19488 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
19489 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
19490 colons:
19491
19492 @smallexample
19493 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
19494 @end smallexample
19495
19496 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
19497 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
19498 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
19499 @samp{z}):
19500
19501 @smallexample
19502 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
19503 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19504 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19505 @end smallexample
19506
19507 @noindent
19508 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
19509 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
19510 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
19511
19512 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
19513 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
19514
19515 @smallexample
19516 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
19517 @end smallexample
19518
19519 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
19520 if you don't want or need to.
19521
19522 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
19523 sysroot}.
19524
19525 @cindex default system root
19526 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
19527 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
19528 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
19529 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19530 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
19531 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19532 location.
19533
19534 @kindex show sysroot
19535 @item show sysroot
19536 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
19537
19538 @kindex set solib-search-path
19539 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
19540 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19541 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
19542 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
19543 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
19544 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
19545 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
19546 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
19547 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
19548 of shared library symbols.
19549
19550 @kindex show solib-search-path
19551 @item show solib-search-path
19552 Display the current shared library search path.
19553
19554 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
19555 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
19556 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
19557 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
19558 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
19559
19560 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
19561 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
19562 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19563 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19564 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19565 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19566 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19567 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19568 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19569 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19570 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19571 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19572 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19573 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19574 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19575 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19576 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19577 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19578 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19579 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19580 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19581 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19582
19583 @table @code
19584 @item unix
19585 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19586 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19587 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19588 the forward slash.
19589
19590 @item dos-based
19591 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19592 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19593 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19594 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19595 considered directory separators.
19596
19597 @item auto
19598 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19599 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19600 This is the default.
19601 @end table
19602 @end table
19603
19604 @cindex file name canonicalization
19605 @cindex base name differences
19606 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19607 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19608 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19609 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19610 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19611 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19612 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19613 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19614 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19615 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19616 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19617 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19618 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19619 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19620 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19621
19622 @table @code
19623 @item set basenames-may-differ
19624 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19625 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19626
19627 @item show basenames-may-differ
19628 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19629 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19630 @end table
19631
19632 @node File Caching
19633 @section File Caching
19634 @cindex caching of opened files
19635 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19636
19637 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19638 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19639 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19640 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19641
19642 @table @code
19643 @kindex maint info bfds
19644 @item maint info bfds
19645 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19646 @value{GDBN}.
19647
19648 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19649 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19650 @kindex bfd caching
19651 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19652 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19653 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19654 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19655 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19656 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19657 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19658 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19659 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19660
19661 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19662 @kindex bfd caching
19663 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19664 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19665
19666 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19667 @kindex bfd caching
19668 @item show debug bfd-cache
19669 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19670 @end table
19671
19672 @node Separate Debug Files
19673 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19674 @cindex separate debugging information files
19675 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19676 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19677 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19678 @cindex global debugging information directories
19679 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19680 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19681
19682 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19683 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19684 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19685 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19686 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19687 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19688 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19689
19690 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19691 file:
19692
19693 @itemize @bullet
19694 @item
19695 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19696 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19697 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19698 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19699 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19700 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19701 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19702 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19703
19704 @item
19705 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19706 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19707 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19708 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19709 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19710 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
19711 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19712 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19713 below.
19714 @end itemize
19715
19716 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19717 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19718
19719 @itemize @bullet
19720 @item
19721 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19722 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19723 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19724 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19725 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19726
19727 @item
19728 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19729 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19730 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19731 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19732 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19733 hex characters, not 10.)
19734 @end itemize
19735
19736 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19737 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19738 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19739 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19740 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19741 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19742
19743 @itemize @minus
19744 @item
19745 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19746 @item
19747 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19748 @item
19749 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19750 @item
19751 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19752 @end itemize
19753
19754 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19755 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19756 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19757 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19758 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19759
19760 @table @code
19761
19762 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19763 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19764 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19765 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19766 concatenating them by a path separator.
19767
19768 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19769 @item show debug-file-directory
19770 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19771 information files.
19772
19773 @end table
19774
19775 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19776 @cindex debug link sections
19777 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19778 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19779
19780 @itemize
19781 @item
19782 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19783 a zero byte,
19784 @item
19785 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19786 boundary within the section, and
19787 @item
19788 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19789 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19790 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19791 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19792 @end itemize
19793
19794 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19795 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19796 described above.
19797
19798 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19799 @cindex build ID sections
19800 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19801 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19802 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19803 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19804 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19805 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19806 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19807 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19808 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19809
19810 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19811 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19812 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19813 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19814 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19815 in an ordinary executable.
19816
19817 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19818 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19819 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19820 following commands:
19821
19822 @smallexample
19823 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19824 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19825 @end smallexample
19826
19827 @noindent
19828 These commands remove the debugging
19829 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19830 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19831 two files:
19832
19833 @itemize @bullet
19834 @item
19835 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19836 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19837
19838 @smallexample
19839 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19840 @end smallexample
19841
19842 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19843 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19844 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19845 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19846
19847 @item
19848 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19849 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19850 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19851 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19852 @end itemize
19853
19854 @noindent
19855
19856 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19857 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19858 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19859
19860 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19861 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19862 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19863 @c different ways!
19864 @ifhtml
19865 @display
19866 @html
19867 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19868 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19869 @end html
19870 @end display
19871 @end ifhtml
19872 @ifnothtml
19873 @display
19874 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19875 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19876 @end display
19877 @end ifnothtml
19878
19879 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19880 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19881 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19882 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19883 CRC.
19884
19885 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19886 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19887 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19888 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19889 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19890
19891 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19892 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19893 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19894 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19895 @code{0xffffffff}.
19896
19897 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19898 @smallexample
19899 unsigned long
19900 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19901 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19902 @{
19903 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19904 @{
19905 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19906 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19907 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19908 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19909 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19910 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19911 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19912 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19913 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19914 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19915 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19916 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19917 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19918 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19919 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19920 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19921 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19922 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19923 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19924 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19925 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19926 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19927 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19928 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19929 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19930 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19931 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19932 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19933 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19934 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19935 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19936 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19937 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19938 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19939 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19940 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19941 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19942 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19943 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19944 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19945 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19946 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19947 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19948 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19949 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19950 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19951 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19952 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19953 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19954 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19955 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19956 0x2d02ef8d
19957 @};
19958 unsigned char *end;
19959
19960 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19961 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19962 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19963 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19964 @}
19965 @end smallexample
19966
19967 @noindent
19968 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19969
19970 @node MiniDebugInfo
19971 @section Debugging information in a special section
19972 @cindex separate debug sections
19973 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19974
19975 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19976 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19977 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19978 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19979
19980 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19981 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19982 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19983 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19984 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19985 debugging information might be included in the section.
19986
19987 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19988 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19989 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19990
19991 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19992 standard utilities:
19993
19994 @smallexample
19995 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19996 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19997 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19998 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19999
20000 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
20001 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
20002 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
20003 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20004 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
20005 | sort > funcsyms
20006
20007 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
20008 # table.
20009 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
20010
20011 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
20012 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
20013
20014 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
20015 # removing some unnecessary sections.
20016 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
20017 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
20018
20019 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
20020 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
20021
20022 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
20023 # original binary.
20024 xz mini_debuginfo
20025 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
20026 @end smallexample
20027
20028 @node Index Files
20029 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
20030 @cindex index files
20031 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
20032
20033 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
20034 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
20035 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
20036 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
20037 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
20038 startup.
20039
20040 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
20041 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
20042 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
20043
20044 @smallexample
20045 $ gdb-add-index symfile
20046 @end smallexample
20047
20048 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
20049
20050 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
20051 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
20052
20053 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
20054 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
20055 using @command{objcopy}.
20056
20057 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
20058
20059 @table @code
20060 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
20061 @kindex save gdb-index
20062 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
20063 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
20064 default creates it produces a single file
20065 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
20066 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
20067 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
20068 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
20069 given @var{directory}.
20070 @end table
20071
20072 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
20073 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
20074
20075 @smallexample
20076 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
20077 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
20078 @end smallexample
20079
20080 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
20081
20082 @smallexample
20083 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
20084 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
20085 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
20086 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
20087 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
20088 @end smallexample
20089
20090 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
20091 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
20092 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
20093 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
20094 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
20095 The default is @code{off}.
20096 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
20097 @xref{Index Section Format}.
20098
20099 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
20100 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
20101
20102 @smallexample
20103 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20104 @end smallexample
20105
20106 Instead you must do, for example,
20107
20108 @smallexample
20109 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20110 @end smallexample
20111
20112 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
20113 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
20114 currently work for programs using Ada.
20115
20116 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
20117
20118 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
20119 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
20120 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache on}. The
20121 following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
20122
20123 @table @code
20124
20125 @item set index-cache on
20126 @itemx set index-cache off
20127 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
20128
20129 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
20130 @itemx show index-cache directory
20131 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved.
20132
20133 The default value for this directory depends on the host platform. On
20134 most systems, the index is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of
20135 the directory pointed to by the @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment
20136 variable, if it is defined, else in the @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory
20137 of your home directory. However, on some systems, the default may
20138 differ according to local convention.
20139
20140 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
20141 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
20142
20143 @item show index-cache stats
20144 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
20145
20146 @end table
20147
20148 @node Symbol Errors
20149 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
20150
20151 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
20152 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
20153 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
20154 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
20155 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
20156 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
20157 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
20158 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
20159 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
20160 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20161 Messages}).
20162
20163 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
20164
20165 @table @code
20166 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
20167
20168 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
20169 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
20170 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
20171 in its outer scope blocks.
20172
20173 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
20174 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
20175 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
20176 function.
20177
20178 @item block at @var{address} out of order
20179
20180 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
20181 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
20182 do so.
20183
20184 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
20185 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
20186 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
20187 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20188 Messages}.)
20189
20190 @item bad block start address patched
20191
20192 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
20193 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
20194 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
20195
20196 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
20197 starting on the previous source line.
20198
20199 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
20200
20201 @cindex foo
20202 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
20203 larger than the size of the string table.
20204
20205 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
20206 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
20207 with this name.
20208
20209 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
20210
20211 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
20212 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
20213 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
20214
20215 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
20216 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
20217 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
20218 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
20219 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
20220 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
20221
20222 @item stub type has NULL name
20223
20224 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
20225
20226 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
20227 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
20228 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
20229 it.
20230
20231 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
20232
20233 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
20234
20235 @end table
20236
20237 @node Data Files
20238 @section GDB Data Files
20239
20240 @cindex prefix for data files
20241 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
20242 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
20243
20244 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
20245 is currently using.
20246
20247 @table @code
20248 @kindex set data-directory
20249 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
20250 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
20251 to @var{directory}.
20252
20253 @kindex show data-directory
20254 @item show data-directory
20255 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
20256 @end table
20257
20258 @cindex default data directory
20259 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
20260 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
20261 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
20262 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20263 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
20264 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20265 location.
20266
20267 The data directory may also be specified with the
20268 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
20269 @xref{Mode Options}.
20270
20271 @node Targets
20272 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
20273
20274 @cindex debugging target
20275 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
20276
20277 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
20278 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
20279 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
20280 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
20281 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
20282 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
20283 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
20284 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
20285
20286 @cindex target architecture
20287 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
20288 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
20289 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
20290 command.
20291
20292 @table @code
20293 @kindex set architecture
20294 @kindex show architecture
20295 @item set architecture @var{arch}
20296 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
20297 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
20298 supported architectures.
20299
20300 @item show architecture
20301 Show the current target architecture.
20302
20303 @item set processor
20304 @itemx processor
20305 @kindex set processor
20306 @kindex show processor
20307 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
20308 and @code{show architecture}.
20309 @end table
20310
20311 @menu
20312 * Active Targets:: Active targets
20313 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
20314 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
20315 @end menu
20316
20317 @node Active Targets
20318 @section Active Targets
20319
20320 @cindex stacking targets
20321 @cindex active targets
20322 @cindex multiple targets
20323
20324 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
20325 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
20326 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
20327 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
20328 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
20329 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
20330 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
20331 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
20332 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
20333
20334 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
20335 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
20336 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
20337 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
20338
20339 @node Target Commands
20340 @section Commands for Managing Targets
20341
20342 @table @code
20343 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
20344 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
20345 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
20346 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
20347 protocol of the target machine.
20348
20349 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
20350 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
20351 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
20352
20353 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
20354 after executing the command.
20355
20356 @kindex help target
20357 @item help target
20358 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
20359 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
20360 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
20361
20362 @item help target @var{name}
20363 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
20364 select it.
20365
20366 @kindex set gnutarget
20367 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
20368 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
20369 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
20370 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
20371 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
20372 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
20373
20374 @quotation
20375 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
20376 you must know the actual BFD name.
20377 @end quotation
20378
20379 @noindent
20380 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
20381
20382 @kindex show gnutarget
20383 @item show gnutarget
20384 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
20385 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
20386 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
20387 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
20388 @end table
20389
20390 @cindex common targets
20391 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
20392 configuration):
20393
20394 @table @code
20395 @kindex target
20396 @item target exec @var{program}
20397 @cindex executable file target
20398 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
20399 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
20400
20401 @item target core @var{filename}
20402 @cindex core dump file target
20403 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
20404 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
20405
20406 @item target remote @var{medium}
20407 @cindex remote target
20408 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
20409 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
20410 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
20411
20412 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
20413 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
20414
20415 @smallexample
20416 target remote /dev/ttya
20417 @end smallexample
20418
20419 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
20420 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
20421 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
20422 clobbered by the download.
20423
20424 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20425 @cindex built-in simulator target
20426 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
20427 In general,
20428 @smallexample
20429 target sim
20430 load
20431 run
20432 @end smallexample
20433 @noindent
20434 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
20435 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
20436 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
20437 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
20438 Processors}.
20439
20440 @item target native
20441 @cindex native target
20442 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
20443 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
20444 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
20445 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
20446
20447 @end table
20448
20449 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
20450 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
20451
20452 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
20453 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
20454 various aspects of this process.
20455
20456 @table @code
20457
20458 @item set hash
20459 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20460 @cindex hash mark while downloading
20461 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
20462 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
20463 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
20464 monitor.
20465
20466 @item show hash
20467 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20468 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
20469
20470 @item set debug monitor
20471 @kindex set debug monitor
20472 @cindex display remote monitor communications
20473 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
20474 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20475
20476 @item show debug monitor
20477 @kindex show debug monitor
20478 Show the current status of displaying communications between
20479 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20480 @end table
20481
20482 @table @code
20483
20484 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20485 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20486 @anchor{load}
20487 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
20488 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
20489 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
20490 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
20491 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
20492 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20493
20494 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
20495 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
20496 target is @dots{}}''
20497
20498 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
20499 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
20500 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
20501 specifies a fixed address.
20502 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
20503
20504 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
20505 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
20506 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
20507
20508 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
20509 load programs into flash memory.
20510
20511 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
20512 @end table
20513
20514 @table @code
20515
20516 @kindex flash-erase
20517 @item flash-erase
20518 @anchor{flash-erase}
20519
20520 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
20521
20522 @end table
20523
20524 @node Byte Order
20525 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
20526
20527 @cindex choosing target byte order
20528 @cindex target byte order
20529
20530 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
20531 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
20532 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
20533 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
20534 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
20535 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
20536
20537 @table @code
20538 @kindex set endian
20539 @item set endian big
20540 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
20541
20542 @item set endian little
20543 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
20544
20545 @item set endian auto
20546 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
20547 executable.
20548
20549 @item show endian
20550 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
20551
20552 @end table
20553
20554 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
20555 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
20556 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
20557 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
20558 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
20559 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
20560 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
20561 and @code{big} otherwise.
20562
20563 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
20564 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
20565 target system.
20566
20567
20568 @node Remote Debugging
20569 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
20570 @cindex remote debugging
20571
20572 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
20573 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
20574 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
20575 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
20576 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
20577
20578 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
20579 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
20580 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
20581 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
20582 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
20583 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
20584
20585 Other remote targets may be available in your
20586 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
20587
20588 @menu
20589 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
20590 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
20591 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
20592 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
20593 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
20594 @end menu
20595
20596 @node Connecting
20597 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
20598 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
20599 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
20600 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
20601 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
20602 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
20603 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
20604
20605 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
20606 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
20607 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
20608 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
20609
20610 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
20611
20612 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
20613 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
20614 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
20615 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
20616
20617 @table @asis
20618
20619 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
20620 @item Result of detach or program exit
20621 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
20622 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
20623 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
20624
20625 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
20626 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
20627 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
20628 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
20629
20630 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20631 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20632 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20633 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20634
20635 @item Specifying the program to debug
20636 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20637 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20638 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20639 target.
20640
20641 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20642 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20643 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20644
20645 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20646 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20647 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20648 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20649
20650 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20651 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20652 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20653 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20654 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20655 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20656 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20657 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20658 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20659
20660 @item The @code{run} command
20661 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20662 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20663 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20664 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20665 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20666
20667 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20668 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20669 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20670 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20671 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20672
20673 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20674 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20675 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20676 @code{target remote} mode.
20677
20678 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20679 @item Attaching
20680 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20681 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20682 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20683
20684 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20685 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20686 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20687 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20688 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20689
20690 @end table
20691
20692 @anchor{Host and target files}
20693 @subsection Host and Target Files
20694 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20695 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20696
20697 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20698 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20699 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20700 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20701 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20702
20703 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20704 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20705 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20706 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20707 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20708
20709 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20710 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20711 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20712 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20713 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20714 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20715 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20716 target libraries.
20717
20718 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20719 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20720 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20721 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20722 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20723 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20724 programs.
20725
20726 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20727 @cindex remote connection commands
20728 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
20729 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20730 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20731 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20732 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20733 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20734 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20735
20736 @table @code
20737
20738 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20739 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20740 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20741 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20742 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20743
20744 @smallexample
20745 target remote /dev/ttyb
20746 @end smallexample
20747
20748 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20749 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20750 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20751 @code{target} command.
20752
20753 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20754 @itemx target remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20755 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20756 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20757 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20758 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20759 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20760 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20761 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20762 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20763 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20764 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20765 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20766 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20767 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20768 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20769 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
20770 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
20771 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
20772 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
20773 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
20774 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
20775
20776 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20777 @code{manyfarms}:
20778
20779 @smallexample
20780 target remote manyfarms:2828
20781 @end smallexample
20782
20783 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
20784 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
20785 square bracket syntax:
20786
20787 @smallexample
20788 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
20789 @end smallexample
20790
20791 @noindent
20792 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
20793
20794 @smallexample
20795 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
20796 @end smallexample
20797
20798 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
20799 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
20800 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
20801 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
20802 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
20803 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
20804
20805 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20806 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20807 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20808 port 1234 on your local machine:
20809
20810 @smallexample
20811 target remote :1234
20812 @end smallexample
20813 @noindent
20814
20815 Note that the colon is still required here.
20816
20817 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20818 @itemx target remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20819 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20820 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20821 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20822 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20823 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20824 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20825 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20826 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20827 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
20828 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
20829 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
20830
20831 @smallexample
20832 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
20833 @end smallexample
20834
20835 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
20836 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
20837 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
20838 cause havoc with your debugging session.
20839
20840 @item target remote | @var{command}
20841 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
20842 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
20843 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
20844 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
20845 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
20846 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
20847 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
20848 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
20849 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
20850
20851 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
20852 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
20853 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
20854
20855 @end table
20856
20857 @cindex interrupting remote programs
20858 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
20859 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
20860 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
20861 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
20862 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
20863 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
20864
20865 @smallexample
20866 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
20867 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
20868 @end smallexample
20869
20870 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
20871 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
20872 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
20873 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
20874
20875 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
20876 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
20877
20878 @table @code
20879 @kindex detach (remote)
20880 @item detach
20881 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
20882 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
20883 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
20884 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
20885 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
20886 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
20887 still connected to the target.
20888
20889 @kindex disconnect
20890 @item disconnect
20891 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
20892 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
20893 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
20894 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
20895 another target.
20896
20897 @cindex send command to remote monitor
20898 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
20899 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
20900 @kindex monitor
20901 @item monitor @var{cmd}
20902 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
20903 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
20904 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
20905 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
20906 and implement.
20907 @end table
20908
20909 @node File Transfer
20910 @section Sending files to a remote system
20911 @cindex remote target, file transfer
20912 @cindex file transfer
20913 @cindex sending files to remote systems
20914
20915 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
20916 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
20917 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
20918 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
20919 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
20920 the only way to upload or download files.
20921
20922 Not all remote targets support these commands.
20923
20924 @table @code
20925 @kindex remote put
20926 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
20927 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
20928 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
20929
20930 @kindex remote get
20931 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20932 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20933 on the host system.
20934
20935 @kindex remote delete
20936 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20937 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20938
20939 @end table
20940
20941 @node Server
20942 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
20943
20944 @kindex gdbserver
20945 @cindex remote connection without stubs
20946 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
20947 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
20948 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
20949 linking in the usual debugging stub.
20950
20951 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
20952 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
20953 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
20954 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20955 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20956 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
20957 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20958 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20959 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20960 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20961 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20962 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20963 choice for debugging.
20964
20965 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20966 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20967 protocol.
20968
20969 @quotation
20970 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20971 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20972 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20973 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20974 @code{gdbserver}.
20975 @end quotation
20976
20977 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20978 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20979 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20980 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20981
20982 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20983 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20984 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20985 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20986 system does all the symbol handling.
20987
20988 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20989 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20990 syntax is:
20991
20992 @smallexample
20993 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20994 @end smallexample
20995
20996 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20997 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20998 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20999 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
21000 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
21001 @file{/dev/com1}:
21002
21003 @smallexample
21004 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
21005 @end smallexample
21006
21007 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
21008 with it.
21009
21010 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
21011
21012 @smallexample
21013 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
21014 @end smallexample
21015
21016 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
21017 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
21018 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
21019 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
21020 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
21021 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
21022 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
21023 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
21024 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
21025 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
21026 @code{target remote} command.
21027
21028 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
21029 with ssh:
21030
21031 @smallexample
21032 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
21033 @end smallexample
21034
21035 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
21036 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
21037 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
21038 You could elide it if you want to.
21039
21040 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
21041 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
21042 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
21043 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
21044
21045 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
21046 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
21047 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
21048 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
21049
21050 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
21051 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
21052
21053 @smallexample
21054 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
21055 @end smallexample
21056
21057 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
21058 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
21059
21060 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
21061 @value{GDBN} attach command
21062 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
21063
21064 @pindex pidof
21065 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
21066 @code{pidof} utility:
21067
21068 @smallexample
21069 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
21070 @end smallexample
21071
21072 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
21073 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
21074 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
21075
21076 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
21077
21078 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
21079 port.
21080
21081 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
21082 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
21083 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
21084 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
21085 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
21086 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
21087 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
21088 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
21089
21090 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
21091 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
21092 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
21093
21094 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
21095 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
21096 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
21097 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
21098 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
21099 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
21100 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
21101 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
21102 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
21103 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
21104 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
21105 instance closes its port after the first connection.
21106
21107 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
21108 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
21109
21110 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
21111 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
21112 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
21113 program. For more information,
21114 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
21115
21116 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21117 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
21118 status information about the debugging process.
21119 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21120 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
21121 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
21122 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
21123
21124 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
21125 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
21126 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
21127 Possible options are:
21128
21129 @table @code
21130 @item none
21131 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21132 @item all
21133 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21134 @item timestamps
21135 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21136 @end table
21137
21138 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21139 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21140
21141 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
21142 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
21143 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
21144 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
21145 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
21146
21147 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
21148 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
21149 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
21150 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
21151
21152 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
21153 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
21154 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
21155 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
21156
21157 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
21158 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
21159 environment:
21160
21161 @smallexample
21162 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
21163 @end smallexample
21164
21165 @cindex @option{--selftest}
21166 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
21167
21168 @smallexample
21169 $ gdbserver --selftest
21170 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
21171 @end smallexample
21172
21173 These tests are disabled in release.
21174 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
21175
21176 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
21177 @itemize
21178
21179 @item
21180 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
21181
21182 @item
21183 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
21184 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
21185 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
21186 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
21187 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
21188 @code{--with-sysroot}).
21189
21190 @item
21191 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21192 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
21193 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
21194 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
21195 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
21196 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
21197 program is already on the target.
21198
21199 @end itemize
21200
21201 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
21202 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
21203 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
21204
21205 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
21206 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
21207 Here are the available commands.
21208
21209 @table @code
21210 @item monitor help
21211 List the available monitor commands.
21212
21213 @item monitor set debug 0
21214 @itemx monitor set debug 1
21215 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
21216
21217 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
21218 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
21219 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
21220 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
21221
21222 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
21223 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
21224 Possible options are:
21225
21226 @table @code
21227 @item none
21228 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21229 @item all
21230 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21231 @item timestamps
21232 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21233 @end table
21234
21235 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21236 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21237
21238 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
21239 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
21240 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
21241 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
21242 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
21243 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
21244
21245 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
21246 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
21247
21248 @item monitor exit
21249 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
21250 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
21251 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
21252 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
21253 of a multi-process mode debug session.
21254
21255 @end table
21256
21257 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21258 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21259
21260 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
21261 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
21262
21263 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
21264 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
21265 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
21266 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
21267 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
21268 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
21269 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
21270 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
21271 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
21272 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
21273 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
21274 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
21275
21276 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
21277
21278 @table @code
21279 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
21280
21281 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
21282 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
21283 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
21284
21285 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
21286
21287 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
21288 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
21289 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
21290 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
21291 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
21292 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
21293
21294 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
21295
21296 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
21297 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
21298 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
21299 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
21300 command for that. For example:
21301
21302 @smallexample
21303 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
21304 @end smallexample
21305
21306 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
21307 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
21308 @end table
21309
21310 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
21311 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
21312 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
21313 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
21314 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
21315 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
21316 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
21317 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
21318 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
21319 @code{gdbserver} like so:
21320
21321 @smallexample
21322 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
21323 @end smallexample
21324
21325 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
21326
21327 @smallexample
21328 $ gdb myprogram
21329 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
21330 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
21331 (@value{GDBP}) b main
21332 (@value{GDBP}) continue
21333 @end smallexample
21334
21335 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
21336 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
21337 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
21338 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
21339 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
21340 tracing.
21341
21342 @node Remote Configuration
21343 @section Remote Configuration
21344
21345 @kindex set remote
21346 @kindex show remote
21347 This section documents the configuration options available when
21348 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
21349 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
21350 system-call-allowed}.
21351
21352 @table @code
21353 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
21354 @cindex address size for remote targets
21355 @cindex bits in remote address
21356 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
21357 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
21358 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
21359 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
21360
21361 @item show remoteaddresssize
21362 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
21363
21364 @item set serial baud @var{n}
21365 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
21366 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
21367 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
21368 remote targets.
21369
21370 @item show serial baud
21371 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
21372
21373 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
21374 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
21375 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
21376
21377 @item show serial parity
21378 Show the current parity of the serial port.
21379
21380 @item set remotebreak
21381 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21382 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
21383 @anchor{set remotebreak}
21384 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
21385 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
21386 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
21387 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
21388 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
21389
21390 @item show remotebreak
21391 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
21392 interrupt the remote program.
21393
21394 @item set remoteflow on
21395 @itemx set remoteflow off
21396 @kindex set remoteflow
21397 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
21398 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
21399
21400 @item show remoteflow
21401 @kindex show remoteflow
21402 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
21403
21404 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
21405 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
21406 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
21407 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
21408 @code{ascii}.
21409
21410 @item show remotelogbase
21411 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
21412 protocol.
21413
21414 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
21415 @cindex record serial communications on file
21416 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
21417 default is not to record at all.
21418
21419 @item show remotelogfile.
21420 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
21421 serial communications.
21422
21423 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
21424 @cindex timeout for serial communications
21425 @cindex remote timeout
21426 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
21427 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
21428
21429 @item show remotetimeout
21430 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
21431 responses.
21432
21433 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
21434 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
21435 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
21436 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
21437 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
21438 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
21439 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
21440 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
21441 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
21442 watchpoints or breakpoints.
21443
21444 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
21445 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
21446 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
21447 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
21448
21449 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
21450 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
21451 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
21452 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
21453 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
21454 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
21455 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
21456 length.
21457
21458 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
21459 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
21460 a remote hardware watchpoint.
21461
21462 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
21463 @itemx show remote exec-file
21464 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
21465 @cindex executable file, for remote target
21466 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
21467 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
21468 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
21469 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
21470
21471 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
21472 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21473 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
21474 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
21475 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
21476 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
21477 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
21478 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
21479 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
21480 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
21481
21482 @item show interrupt-sequence
21483 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
21484 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
21485 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
21486 also known as Magic SysRq g.
21487
21488 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
21489 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
21490 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
21491 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
21492 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
21493 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
21494
21495 @item show interrupt-on-connect
21496 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
21497 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
21498
21499 @kindex set tcp
21500 @kindex show tcp
21501 @item set tcp auto-retry on
21502 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
21503 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
21504 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
21505 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
21506 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
21507 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
21508 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
21509 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
21510
21511 @item set tcp auto-retry off
21512 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
21513
21514 @item show tcp auto-retry
21515 Show the current auto-retry setting.
21516
21517 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
21518 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
21519 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
21520 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
21521 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
21522 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
21523 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
21524 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
21525 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
21526 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
21527 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
21528
21529 @item show tcp connect-timeout
21530 Show the current connection timeout setting.
21531 @end table
21532
21533 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
21534 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
21535 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
21536 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
21537 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
21538 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
21539 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
21540 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
21541 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
21542
21543 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
21544 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
21545 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
21546 @value{GDBN} developers.
21547
21548 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
21549 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
21550 are:
21551
21552 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
21553 @item Command Name
21554 @tab Remote Packet
21555 @tab Related Features
21556
21557 @item @code{fetch-register}
21558 @tab @code{p}
21559 @tab @code{info registers}
21560
21561 @item @code{set-register}
21562 @tab @code{P}
21563 @tab @code{set}
21564
21565 @item @code{binary-download}
21566 @tab @code{X}
21567 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
21568
21569 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
21570 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
21571 @tab @code{info auxv}
21572
21573 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
21574 @tab @code{qSymbol}
21575 @tab Detecting multiple threads
21576
21577 @item @code{attach}
21578 @tab @code{vAttach}
21579 @tab @code{attach}
21580
21581 @item @code{verbose-resume}
21582 @tab @code{vCont}
21583 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
21584
21585 @item @code{run}
21586 @tab @code{vRun}
21587 @tab @code{run}
21588
21589 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
21590 @tab @code{Z0}
21591 @tab @code{break}
21592
21593 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
21594 @tab @code{Z1}
21595 @tab @code{hbreak}
21596
21597 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
21598 @tab @code{Z2}
21599 @tab @code{watch}
21600
21601 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
21602 @tab @code{Z3}
21603 @tab @code{rwatch}
21604
21605 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
21606 @tab @code{Z4}
21607 @tab @code{awatch}
21608
21609 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
21610 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
21611 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
21612
21613 @item @code{target-features}
21614 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
21615 @tab @code{set architecture}
21616
21617 @item @code{library-info}
21618 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
21619 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
21620
21621 @item @code{memory-map}
21622 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
21623 @tab @code{info mem}
21624
21625 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
21626 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
21627 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
21628
21629 @item @code{read-spu-object}
21630 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
21631 @tab @code{info spu}
21632
21633 @item @code{write-spu-object}
21634 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
21635 @tab @code{info spu}
21636
21637 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
21638 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
21639 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
21640
21641 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
21642 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
21643 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
21644
21645 @item @code{threads}
21646 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
21647 @tab @code{info threads}
21648
21649 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
21650 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
21651 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
21652
21653 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
21654 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
21655 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
21656
21657 @item @code{search-memory}
21658 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
21659 @tab @code{find}
21660
21661 @item @code{supported-packets}
21662 @tab @code{qSupported}
21663 @tab Remote communications parameters
21664
21665 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
21666 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
21667 @tab @code{catch syscall}
21668
21669 @item @code{pass-signals}
21670 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
21671 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21672
21673 @item @code{program-signals}
21674 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
21675 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21676
21677 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
21678 @tab @code{vFile:close}
21679 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21680
21681 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
21682 @tab @code{vFile:open}
21683 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21684
21685 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
21686 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
21687 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21688
21689 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
21690 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
21691 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21692
21693 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
21694 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
21695 @tab @code{remote delete}
21696
21697 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
21698 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
21699 @tab Host I/O
21700
21701 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
21702 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
21703 @tab Host I/O
21704
21705 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
21706 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
21707 @tab Host I/O
21708
21709 @item @code{noack-packet}
21710 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
21711 @tab Packet acknowledgment
21712
21713 @item @code{osdata}
21714 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
21715 @tab @code{info os}
21716
21717 @item @code{query-attached}
21718 @tab @code{qAttached}
21719 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
21720
21721 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
21722 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
21723 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
21724
21725 @item @code{trace-status}
21726 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21727 @tab @code{tstatus}
21728
21729 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21730 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21731 @tab Traceframe info
21732
21733 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21734 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21735 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21736
21737 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21738 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21739 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21740
21741 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21742 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21743 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21744
21745 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21746 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21747 @tab @code{set environment}
21748
21749 @item @code{environment-unset}
21750 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21751 @tab @code{unset environment}
21752
21753 @item @code{environment-reset}
21754 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21755 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21756
21757 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21758 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21759 @tab @code{set cwd}
21760
21761 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21762 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21763 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21764
21765 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21766 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21767 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21768
21769 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21770 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21771 @tab @code{break}
21772
21773 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21774 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21775 @tab @code{hbreak}
21776
21777 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21778 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21779 @tab @code{fork}
21780
21781 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21782 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21783 @tab @code{vfork}
21784
21785 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21786 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21787 @tab @code{exec}
21788
21789 @item @code{thread-events}
21790 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21791 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21792
21793 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21794 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21795 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21796
21797 @end multitable
21798
21799 @node Remote Stub
21800 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21801
21802 @cindex debugging stub, example
21803 @cindex remote stub, example
21804 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21805 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21806 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21807 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21808 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21809 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21810 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21811 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21812
21813 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21814 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21815 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
21816 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
21817 program, you need:
21818
21819 @enumerate
21820 @item
21821 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
21822 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
21823 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
21824
21825 @item
21826 A C subroutine library to support your program's
21827 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
21828
21829 @item
21830 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
21831 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
21832 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
21833 documentation.
21834 @end enumerate
21835
21836 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
21837 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
21838 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
21839
21840 @table @emph
21841 @item On the host,
21842 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
21843 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
21844 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
21845
21846 @item On the target,
21847 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
21848 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
21849 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
21850
21851 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
21852 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
21853 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
21854 @end table
21855
21856 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
21857 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
21858 @sc{sparc} boards.
21859
21860 @cindex remote serial stub list
21861 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
21862
21863 @table @code
21864
21865 @item i386-stub.c
21866 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
21867 @cindex Intel
21868 @cindex i386
21869 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
21870
21871 @item m68k-stub.c
21872 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
21873 @cindex Motorola 680x0
21874 @cindex m680x0
21875 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
21876
21877 @item sh-stub.c
21878 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
21879 @cindex Renesas
21880 @cindex SH
21881 For Renesas SH architectures.
21882
21883 @item sparc-stub.c
21884 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
21885 @cindex Sparc
21886 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
21887
21888 @item sparcl-stub.c
21889 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
21890 @cindex Fujitsu
21891 @cindex SparcLite
21892 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
21893
21894 @end table
21895
21896 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
21897 recently added stubs.
21898
21899 @menu
21900 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
21901 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
21902 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
21903 @end menu
21904
21905 @node Stub Contents
21906 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
21907
21908 @cindex remote serial stub
21909 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
21910 subroutines:
21911
21912 @table @code
21913 @item set_debug_traps
21914 @findex set_debug_traps
21915 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
21916 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
21917 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
21918 program's startup code.
21919
21920 @item handle_exception
21921 @findex handle_exception
21922 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
21923 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
21924 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
21925 run when a trap is triggered.
21926
21927 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
21928 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
21929 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
21930 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
21931 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
21932 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
21933 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
21934 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
21935 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
21936 machine.
21937
21938 @item breakpoint
21939 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
21940 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
21941 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
21942 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
21943 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
21944 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
21945 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
21946 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
21947 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
21948 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
21949 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
21950
21951 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
21952 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
21953 start of your debugging session.
21954 @end table
21955
21956 @node Bootstrapping
21957 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
21958
21959 @cindex remote stub, support routines
21960 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
21961 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
21962 debugging target machine.
21963
21964 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
21965 serial port.
21966
21967 @table @code
21968 @item int getDebugChar()
21969 @findex getDebugChar
21970 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
21971 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
21972 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21973
21974 @item void putDebugChar(int)
21975 @findex putDebugChar
21976 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
21977 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
21978 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21979 @end table
21980
21981 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
21982 @cindex interrupting remote targets
21983 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
21984 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
21985 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
21986 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
21987 remote system to stop.
21988
21989 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
21990 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21991 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21992 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21993
21994 Other routines you need to supply are:
21995
21996 @table @code
21997 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21998 @findex exceptionHandler
21999 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
22000 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
22001 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
22002 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
22003 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
22004 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
22005 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
22006 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
22007 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
22008 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
22009 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
22010 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
22011 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
22012
22013 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
22014 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
22015 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
22016 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
22017 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
22018
22019 @item void flush_i_cache()
22020 @findex flush_i_cache
22021 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
22022 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
22023 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
22024
22025 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
22026 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
22027 @end table
22028
22029 @noindent
22030 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
22031
22032 @table @code
22033 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
22034 @findex memset
22035 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
22036 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
22037 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
22038 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
22039 @end table
22040
22041 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
22042 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
22043 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
22044 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
22045
22046
22047 @node Debug Session
22048 @subsection Putting it All Together
22049
22050 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
22051 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
22052 steps.
22053
22054 @enumerate
22055 @item
22056 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
22057 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
22058 @display
22059 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
22060 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
22061 @end display
22062
22063 @item
22064 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
22065 procedure is called:
22066
22067 @smallexample
22068 set_debug_traps();
22069 breakpoint();
22070 @end smallexample
22071
22072 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
22073 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
22074 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
22075 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
22076 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
22077 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
22078 progress.
22079
22080 @item
22081 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
22082 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
22083
22084 @smallexample
22085 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
22086 @end smallexample
22087
22088 @noindent
22089 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
22090 function in your program, that function is called when
22091 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
22092 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
22093 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
22094
22095 @item
22096 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
22097 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
22098
22099 @item
22100 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
22101 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
22102
22103 @item
22104 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
22105 @c document that. FIXME.
22106 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
22107 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
22108
22109 @item
22110 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
22111 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22112
22113 @end enumerate
22114
22115 @node Configurations
22116 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
22117
22118 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
22119 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
22120 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
22121
22122 There are three major categories of configurations: native
22123 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
22124 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
22125 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
22126 are quite different from each other.
22127
22128 @menu
22129 * Native::
22130 * Embedded OS::
22131 * Embedded Processors::
22132 * Architectures::
22133 @end menu
22134
22135 @node Native
22136 @section Native
22137
22138 This section describes details specific to particular native
22139 configurations.
22140
22141 @menu
22142 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
22143 * Process Information:: Process information
22144 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
22145 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
22146 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
22147 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
22148 @end menu
22149
22150 @node BSD libkvm Interface
22151 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
22152
22153 @cindex libkvm
22154 @cindex kernel memory image
22155 @cindex kernel crash dump
22156
22157 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
22158 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
22159 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
22160 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
22161 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
22162 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
22163 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
22164 @code{kvm} target:
22165
22166 @smallexample
22167 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
22168 @end smallexample
22169
22170 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
22171 argument:
22172
22173 @smallexample
22174 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
22175 @end smallexample
22176
22177 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
22178 available:
22179
22180 @table @code
22181 @kindex kvm
22182 @item kvm pcb
22183 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
22184
22185 @item kvm proc
22186 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
22187 modern FreeBSD systems.
22188 @end table
22189
22190 @node Process Information
22191 @subsection Process Information
22192 @cindex /proc
22193 @cindex examine process image
22194 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
22195
22196 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
22197 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
22198 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
22199 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
22200 to report information about the process running your program, or about
22201 any process running on your system.
22202
22203 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
22204 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
22205 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
22206 systems.
22207
22208 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
22209 information.
22210
22211 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
22212 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
22213 information available from a live process. Process information is
22214 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
22215 systems.
22216
22217 @table @code
22218 @kindex info proc
22219 @cindex process ID
22220 @item info proc
22221 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
22222 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
22223 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
22224 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
22225 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
22226 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
22227 executable file's absolute file name.
22228
22229 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
22230 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
22231 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
22232 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
22233 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
22234 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
22235
22236 @item info proc cmdline
22237 @cindex info proc cmdline
22238 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
22239 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22240
22241 @item info proc cwd
22242 @cindex info proc cwd
22243 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
22244 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22245
22246 @item info proc exe
22247 @cindex info proc exe
22248 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
22249 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22250
22251 @item info proc files
22252 @cindex info proc files
22253 Show the file descriptors open by the process. For each open file
22254 descriptor, @value{GDBN} shows its number, type (file, directory,
22255 character device, socket), file pointer offset, and the name of the
22256 resource open on the descriptor. The resource name can be a file name
22257 (for files, directories, and devices) or a protocol followed by socket
22258 address (for network connections). This command is supported on
22259 FreeBSD.
22260
22261 This example shows the open file descriptors for a process using a
22262 tty for standard input and output as well as two network sockets:
22263
22264 @smallexample
22265 (gdb) info proc files 22136
22266 process 22136
22267 Open files:
22268
22269 FD Type Offset Flags Name
22270 text file - r-------- /usr/bin/ssh
22271 ctty chr - rw------- /dev/pts/20
22272 cwd dir - r-------- /usr/home/john
22273 root dir - r-------- /
22274 0 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22275 1 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22276 2 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22277 3 socket 0x0 rw----n-- tcp4 10.0.1.2:53014 -> 10.0.1.10:22
22278 4 socket 0x0 rw------- unix stream:/tmp/ssh-FIt89oAzOn5f/agent.2456
22279 @end smallexample
22280
22281 @item info proc mappings
22282 @cindex memory address space mappings
22283 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program. On
22284 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
22285 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
22286 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
22287 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
22288
22289 @item info proc stat
22290 @itemx info proc status
22291 @cindex process detailed status information
22292 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
22293 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
22294 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
22295 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
22296 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22297
22298 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
22299 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
22300
22301 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
22302 proc status}.
22303
22304 @item info proc all
22305 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
22306 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
22307
22308 @ignore
22309 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
22310 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
22311 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
22312 @kindex info proc times
22313 @item info proc times
22314 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
22315 its children.
22316
22317 @kindex info proc id
22318 @item info proc id
22319 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
22320 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
22321 @end ignore
22322
22323 @item set procfs-trace
22324 @kindex set procfs-trace
22325 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
22326 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
22327
22328 @item show procfs-trace
22329 @kindex show procfs-trace
22330 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
22331
22332 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
22333 @kindex set procfs-file
22334 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
22335 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
22336 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
22337 standard output.
22338
22339 @item show procfs-file
22340 @kindex show procfs-file
22341 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
22342
22343 @item proc-trace-entry
22344 @itemx proc-trace-exit
22345 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
22346 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
22347 @kindex proc-trace-entry
22348 @kindex proc-trace-exit
22349 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
22350 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
22351 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
22352 from the @code{syscall} interface.
22353
22354 @item info pidlist
22355 @kindex info pidlist
22356 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
22357 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
22358 processes and all the threads within each process.
22359
22360 @item info meminfo
22361 @kindex info meminfo
22362 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
22363 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
22364 @end table
22365
22366 @node DJGPP Native
22367 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
22368 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
22369 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
22370 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
22371
22372 @cindex DPMI
22373 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
22374 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
22375 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
22376 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
22377
22378 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
22379 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
22380 subsection describes those commands.
22381
22382 @table @code
22383 @kindex info dos
22384 @item info dos
22385 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
22386 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22387
22388 @kindex sysinfo
22389 @cindex MS-DOS system info
22390 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
22391 @item info dos sysinfo
22392 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
22393 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
22394 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
22395
22396 @cindex GDT
22397 @cindex LDT
22398 @cindex IDT
22399 @cindex segment descriptor tables
22400 @cindex descriptor tables display
22401 @item info dos gdt
22402 @itemx info dos ldt
22403 @itemx info dos idt
22404 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
22405 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
22406 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
22407 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
22408 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
22409 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
22410 rights.
22411
22412 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
22413 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
22414 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
22415 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
22416 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
22417
22418 @cindex garbled pointers
22419 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
22420 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
22421 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
22422 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
22423 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
22424 debugged program's data segment:
22425
22426 @smallexample
22427 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
22428 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
22429 @end smallexample
22430
22431 @noindent
22432 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
22433 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
22434
22435 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
22436 @item info dos pde
22437 @itemx info dos pte
22438 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
22439 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
22440 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
22441 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
22442 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
22443 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
22444 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
22445 that is currently in use.
22446
22447 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
22448 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
22449 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
22450 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
22451 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
22452 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
22453 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
22454
22455 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
22456 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
22457 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
22458 controller.
22459
22460 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
22461
22462 @cindex physical address from linear address
22463 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
22464 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
22465 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
22466 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
22467 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
22468 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
22469 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
22470
22471 @smallexample
22472 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
22473 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
22474 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
22475 @end smallexample
22476
22477 @noindent
22478 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
22479 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
22480 attributes of that page.
22481
22482 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
22483 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
22484 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
22485 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
22486 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
22487 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
22488
22489 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
22490 transfer buffer:
22491
22492 @smallexample
22493 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
22494 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
22495 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
22496 @end smallexample
22497
22498 @noindent
22499 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
22500 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
22501 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
22502 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
22503 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
22504
22505 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
22506 @end table
22507
22508 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
22509 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
22510 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
22511 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
22512
22513 @table @code
22514 @kindex set com1base
22515 @kindex set com1irq
22516 @kindex set com2base
22517 @kindex set com2irq
22518 @kindex set com3base
22519 @kindex set com3irq
22520 @kindex set com4base
22521 @kindex set com4irq
22522 @item set com1base @var{addr}
22523 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
22524 port.
22525
22526 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
22527 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
22528 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
22529
22530 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
22531 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
22532 other 3 COM ports.
22533
22534 @kindex show com1base
22535 @kindex show com1irq
22536 @kindex show com2base
22537 @kindex show com2irq
22538 @kindex show com3base
22539 @kindex show com3irq
22540 @kindex show com4base
22541 @kindex show com4irq
22542 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
22543 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
22544 lines used by the COM ports.
22545
22546 @item info serial
22547 @kindex info serial
22548 @cindex DOS serial port status
22549 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
22550 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
22551 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
22552 counts of various errors encountered so far.
22553 @end table
22554
22555
22556 @node Cygwin Native
22557 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
22558 @cindex MS Windows debugging
22559 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
22560 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
22561
22562 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
22563 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
22564
22565 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
22566 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
22567 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
22568 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
22569 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
22570 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
22571 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
22572 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
22573
22574 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
22575 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
22576 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
22577
22578 @table @code
22579 @kindex info w32
22580 @item info w32
22581 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
22582 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22583
22584 @item info w32 selector
22585 This command displays information returned by
22586 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
22587 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
22588 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
22589 Without argument, this command displays information
22590 about the six segment registers.
22591
22592 @item info w32 thread-information-block
22593 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
22594 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
22595 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
22596
22597 @kindex signal-event
22598 @item signal-event @var{id}
22599 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
22600 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
22601
22602 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
22603 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
22604 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
22605 (for x86_64 versions):
22606
22607 @itemize @minus
22608 @item
22609 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
22610 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
22611 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
22612
22613 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
22614 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
22615 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
22616 to attach.
22617
22618 @item
22619 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
22620 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
22621 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
22622 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
22623 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
22624 @end itemize
22625
22626 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
22627 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
22628 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
22629 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
22630 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
22631 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
22632 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
22633 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
22634 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
22635 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
22636 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
22637
22638 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
22639 @item show cygwin-exceptions
22640 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
22641 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
22642
22643 @kindex set new-console
22644 @item set new-console @var{mode}
22645 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
22646 be started in a new console on next start.
22647 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
22648 be started in the same console as the debugger.
22649
22650 @kindex show new-console
22651 @item show new-console
22652 Displays whether a new console is used
22653 when the debuggee is started.
22654
22655 @kindex set new-group
22656 @item set new-group @var{mode}
22657 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
22658 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
22659 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
22660 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
22661
22662 @kindex show new-group
22663 @item show new-group
22664 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
22665
22666 @kindex set debugevents
22667 @item set debugevents
22668 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
22669 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
22670 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
22671 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
22672 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
22673
22674 @kindex set debugexec
22675 @item set debugexec
22676 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
22677 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
22678
22679 @kindex set debugexceptions
22680 @item set debugexceptions
22681 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
22682 debuggee seen by the debugger.
22683
22684 @kindex set debugmemory
22685 @item set debugmemory
22686 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
22687 and writes by the debugger.
22688
22689 @kindex set shell
22690 @item set shell
22691 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
22692 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
22693
22694 @kindex show shell
22695 @item show shell
22696 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
22697
22698 @end table
22699
22700 @menu
22701 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
22702 @end menu
22703
22704 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
22705 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
22706 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
22707 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
22708
22709 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
22710 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
22711 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
22712 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
22713 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
22714 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
22715 ``minimal symbols''.
22716
22717 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
22718 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
22719 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
22720 program run once to completion.
22721
22722 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
22723
22724 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
22725 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
22726 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
22727 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
22728 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
22729 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
22730 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
22731 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
22732 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
22733
22734 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
22735 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
22736 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
22737 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
22738 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
22739 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
22740
22741 @smallexample
22742 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
22743 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
22744
22745 Non-debugging symbols:
22746 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
22747 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
22748 @end smallexample
22749
22750 @smallexample
22751 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
22752 All functions matching regular expression "!":
22753
22754 Non-debugging symbols:
22755 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
22756 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
22757 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
22758 [etc...]
22759 @end smallexample
22760
22761 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
22762
22763 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
22764 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
22765 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
22766 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
22767 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
22768 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22769 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22770
22771 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22772 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22773 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22774 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22775 problem:
22776
22777 @smallexample
22778 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
22779 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22780 @end smallexample
22781
22782 @smallexample
22783 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
22784 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22785 @end smallexample
22786
22787 And two possible solutions:
22788
22789 @smallexample
22790 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
22791 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22792 @end smallexample
22793
22794 @smallexample
22795 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
22796 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
22797 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
22798 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
22799 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
22800 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22801 @end smallexample
22802
22803 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
22804 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
22805 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
22806 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
22807 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
22808
22809 @smallexample
22810 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
22811 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
22812 @end smallexample
22813
22814 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
22815 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
22816 safe.
22817
22818 @node Hurd Native
22819 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
22820 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
22821
22822 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
22823 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
22824
22825 @table @code
22826 @item set signals
22827 @itemx set sigs
22828 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
22829 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22830 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
22831 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
22832 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
22833 @code{signals}.
22834
22835 @item show signals
22836 @itemx show sigs
22837 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
22838 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22839 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
22840
22841 @item set signal-thread
22842 @itemx set sigthread
22843 @kindex set signal-thread
22844 @kindex set sigthread
22845 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
22846 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
22847 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
22848 signal-thread}.
22849
22850 @item show signal-thread
22851 @itemx show sigthread
22852 @kindex show signal-thread
22853 @kindex show sigthread
22854 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
22855 delivered a signal.
22856
22857 @item set stopped
22858 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22859 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
22860 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
22861 continued by delivering a signal to it.
22862
22863 @item show stopped
22864 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22865 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
22866 stopped.
22867
22868 @item set exceptions
22869 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22870 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
22871 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
22872 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
22873 trapping on.
22874
22875 @item show exceptions
22876 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22877 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
22878
22879 @item set task pause
22880 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
22881 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22882 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22883 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
22884 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
22885 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
22886 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
22887 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
22888 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
22889
22890 @item show task pause
22891 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
22892 Show the current state of task suspension.
22893
22894 @item set task detach-suspend-count
22895 @cindex task suspend count
22896 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22897 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
22898 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
22899
22900 @item show task detach-suspend-count
22901 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
22902
22903 @item set task exception-port
22904 @itemx set task excp
22905 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22906 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
22907 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
22908 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
22909
22910 @item set noninvasive
22911 @cindex noninvasive task options
22912 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
22913 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
22914 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
22915 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
22916
22917 @item info send-rights
22918 @itemx info receive-rights
22919 @itemx info port-rights
22920 @itemx info port-sets
22921 @itemx info dead-names
22922 @itemx info ports
22923 @itemx info psets
22924 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22925 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22926 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22927 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22928 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22929 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
22930 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
22931 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
22932 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
22933
22934 @item set thread pause
22935 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
22936 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22937 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22938 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
22939 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
22940 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
22941 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
22942 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
22943 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
22944 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
22945 only the current thread.
22946
22947 @item show thread pause
22948 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
22949 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
22950
22951 @item set thread run
22952 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22953
22954 @item show thread run
22955 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22956
22957 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
22958 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22959 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22960 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
22961 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
22962 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
22963 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
22964
22965 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
22966 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
22967 detaching.
22968
22969 @item set thread exception-port
22970 @itemx set thread excp
22971 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
22972 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
22973 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
22974
22975 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
22976 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
22977 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
22978 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
22979
22980 @item set thread default
22981 @itemx show thread default
22982 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22983 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
22984 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
22985 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
22986 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
22987 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
22988 the non-default commands.
22989 @end table
22990
22991 @node Darwin
22992 @subsection Darwin
22993 @cindex Darwin
22994
22995 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
22996
22997 @table @code
22998 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
22999 @kindex set debug darwin
23000 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
23001 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
23002
23003 @item show debug darwin
23004 @kindex show debug darwin
23005 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
23006
23007 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
23008 @kindex set debug mach-o
23009 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
23010 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
23011 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
23012 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
23013 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
23014 usage.
23015
23016 @item show debug mach-o
23017 @kindex show debug mach-o
23018 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
23019
23020 @item set mach-exceptions on
23021 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
23022 @kindex set mach-exceptions
23023 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
23024 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
23025 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
23026 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
23027
23028 @item show mach-exceptions
23029 @kindex show mach-exceptions
23030 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
23031 @end table
23032
23033
23034 @node Embedded OS
23035 @section Embedded Operating Systems
23036
23037 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
23038 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
23039 architectures.
23040
23041 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
23042 various real-time operating systems.
23043
23044 @node Embedded Processors
23045 @section Embedded Processors
23046
23047 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
23048 configurations.
23049
23050 @cindex send command to simulator
23051 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
23052 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
23053
23054 @table @code
23055 @item sim @var{command}
23056 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
23057 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
23058 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
23059 acceptable commands.
23060 @end table
23061
23062
23063 @menu
23064 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
23065 * ARM:: ARM
23066 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
23067 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
23068 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
23069 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
23070 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
23071 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
23072 * CRIS:: CRIS
23073 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
23074 @end menu
23075
23076 @node ARC
23077 @subsection Synopsys ARC
23078 @cindex Synopsys ARC
23079 @cindex ARC specific commands
23080 @cindex ARC600
23081 @cindex ARC700
23082 @cindex ARC EM
23083 @cindex ARC HS
23084
23085 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
23086
23087 @table @code
23088 @item set debug arc
23089 @kindex set debug arc
23090 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
23091 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
23092
23093 @item show debug arc
23094 @kindex show debug arc
23095 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
23096
23097 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
23098 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
23099 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
23100
23101 @end table
23102
23103 @node ARM
23104 @subsection ARM
23105
23106 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
23107
23108 @table @code
23109 @item set arm disassembler
23110 @kindex set arm
23111 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
23112 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
23113
23114 @item show arm disassembler
23115 @kindex show arm
23116 Show the current disassembly style.
23117
23118 @item set arm apcs32
23119 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
23120 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
23121
23122 @item show arm apcs32
23123 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
23124
23125 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
23126 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
23127 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
23128
23129 @table @code
23130 @item auto
23131 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
23132 @item softfpa
23133 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
23134 processors.
23135 @item fpa
23136 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
23137 @item softvfp
23138 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
23139 @item vfp
23140 VFP co-processor.
23141 @end table
23142
23143 @item show arm fpu
23144 Show the current type of the FPU.
23145
23146 @item set arm abi
23147 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
23148
23149 @item show arm abi
23150 Show the currently used ABI.
23151
23152 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23153 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
23154 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
23155 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
23156 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
23157 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
23158 register).
23159
23160 @item show arm fallback-mode
23161 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
23162
23163 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23164 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
23165 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
23166 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
23167 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
23168
23169 @item show arm force-mode
23170 Show the current forced instruction mode.
23171
23172 @item set debug arm
23173 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
23174 target support subsystem.
23175
23176 @item show debug arm
23177 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23178 @end table
23179
23180 @table @code
23181 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
23182 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
23183
23184 @table @code
23185 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
23186 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
23187 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
23188 The default value is @code{all}.
23189
23190 @table @code
23191 @item none
23192 @item demon
23193 @item angel
23194 @item redboot
23195 @item all
23196 @end table
23197 @end table
23198 @end table
23199
23200 @node M68K
23201 @subsection M68k
23202
23203 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
23204
23205 @node MicroBlaze
23206 @subsection MicroBlaze
23207 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
23208 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
23209
23210 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
23211 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
23212 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
23213 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
23214 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
23215 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
23216 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
23217 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
23218 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
23219 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
23220 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
23221
23222 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
23223
23224 @table @code
23225 @item target remote :1234
23226 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
23227 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
23228
23229 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
23230 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
23231 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
23232
23233 @item load
23234 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
23235
23236 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
23237 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
23238
23239 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
23240 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
23241 @end table
23242
23243 @node MIPS Embedded
23244 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
23245
23246 @noindent
23247 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
23248
23249 @table @code
23250 @item set mipsfpu double
23251 @itemx set mipsfpu single
23252 @itemx set mipsfpu none
23253 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
23254 @itemx show mipsfpu
23255 @kindex set mipsfpu
23256 @kindex show mipsfpu
23257 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
23258 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
23259 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
23260 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
23261 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
23262 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
23263 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
23264 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
23265 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
23266 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
23267 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
23268 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
23269 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
23270
23271 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
23272 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
23273 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
23274
23275 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
23276 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
23277 @end table
23278
23279 @node OpenRISC 1000
23280 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
23281 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
23282
23283 @noindent
23284 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
23285 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
23286 FPGA's.
23287
23288 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
23289 a target:
23290
23291 @table @code
23292
23293 @kindex target sim
23294 @item target sim
23295
23296 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
23297 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
23298 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
23299 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
23300
23301 Example: @code{target sim}
23302
23303 @item set debug or1k
23304 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
23305 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
23306
23307 @item show debug or1k
23308 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23309 @end table
23310
23311 @node PowerPC Embedded
23312 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
23313
23314 @cindex DVC register
23315 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
23316 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
23317
23318 @smallexample
23319 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
23320 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
23321 @end smallexample
23322
23323 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
23324 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
23325 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
23326 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
23327 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
23328 or newer.
23329
23330 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
23331 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
23332 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
23333 watching variables of scalar types.
23334
23335 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
23336 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
23337
23338 @smallexample
23339 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
23340 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
23341 @end smallexample
23342
23343 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
23344 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
23345
23346 @cindex ranged breakpoint
23347 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
23348 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
23349 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
23350 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
23351 use the @code{break-range} command.
23352
23353 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
23354
23355 @table @code
23356 @kindex break-range
23357 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
23358 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
23359 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
23360 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
23361 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
23362 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
23363 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
23364 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
23365 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
23366
23367 @kindex set powerpc
23368 @item set powerpc soft-float
23369 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
23370 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
23371 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
23372 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23373
23374 @item set powerpc vector-abi
23375 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
23376 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
23377 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
23378 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
23379 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
23380 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
23381 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23382
23383 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
23384 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
23385 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
23386 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
23387 address of its first byte.
23388
23389 @end table
23390
23391 @node AVR
23392 @subsection Atmel AVR
23393 @cindex AVR
23394
23395 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
23396 following AVR-specific commands:
23397
23398 @table @code
23399 @item info io_registers
23400 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
23401 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
23402 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
23403 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
23404 @end table
23405
23406 @node CRIS
23407 @subsection CRIS
23408 @cindex CRIS
23409
23410 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
23411 following CRIS-specific commands:
23412
23413 @table @code
23414 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
23415 @cindex CRIS version
23416 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
23417 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
23418 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
23419
23420 @item show cris-version
23421 Show the current CRIS version.
23422
23423 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
23424 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
23425 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
23426 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
23427 @code{R59}.
23428
23429 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
23430 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
23431
23432 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
23433 @cindex CRIS mode
23434 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
23435 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
23436 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
23437
23438 @item show cris-mode
23439 Show the current CRIS mode.
23440 @end table
23441
23442 @node Super-H
23443 @subsection Renesas Super-H
23444 @cindex Super-H
23445
23446 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
23447 commands:
23448
23449 @table @code
23450 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
23451 @kindex set sh calling-convention
23452 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
23453 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
23454 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
23455 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
23456 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
23457 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
23458 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
23459 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
23460 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
23461 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
23462
23463 @item show sh calling-convention
23464 @kindex show sh calling-convention
23465 Show the current calling convention setting.
23466
23467 @end table
23468
23469
23470 @node Architectures
23471 @section Architectures
23472
23473 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
23474 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
23475
23476 @menu
23477 * AArch64::
23478 * i386::
23479 * Alpha::
23480 * MIPS::
23481 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
23482 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23483 * PowerPC::
23484 * Nios II::
23485 * Sparc64::
23486 @end menu
23487
23488 @node AArch64
23489 @subsection AArch64
23490 @cindex AArch64 support
23491
23492 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
23493 following special commands:
23494
23495 @table @code
23496 @item set debug aarch64
23497 @kindex set debug aarch64
23498 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
23499 messages are to be displayed.
23500
23501 @item show debug aarch64
23502 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
23503
23504 @end table
23505
23506 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
23507 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
23508
23509 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
23510 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
23511 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
23512 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
23513 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
23514 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
23515
23516 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
23517 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
23518 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
23519 target process.
23520
23521
23522 @node i386
23523 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
23524
23525 @table @code
23526 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
23527 @kindex set struct-convention
23528 @cindex struct return convention
23529 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
23530 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
23531 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
23532 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
23533 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
23534 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
23535 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
23536 be returned in a register.
23537
23538 @item show struct-convention
23539 @kindex show struct-convention
23540 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
23541 from functions.
23542 @end table
23543
23544
23545 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
23546 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
23547
23548 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
23549 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
23550 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
23551 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
23552 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
23553 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
23554 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
23555
23556 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
23557 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
23558 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
23559 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
23560 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
23561 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
23562
23563 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
23564 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
23565 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
23566
23567 @smallexample
23568 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
23569 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
23570 @end smallexample
23571
23572 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
23573 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
23574 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
23575 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
23576 the pointer.
23577
23578 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
23579 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
23580 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
23581 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
23582 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
23583
23584 @table @code
23585 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
23586 @kindex show mpx bound
23587 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
23588
23589 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
23590 @kindex set mpx bound
23591 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
23592 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
23593 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
23594 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
23595 @end table
23596
23597 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
23598 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
23599 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
23600 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
23601
23602 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
23603 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
23604 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
23605 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
23606 function.
23607
23608 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
23609 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
23610 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
23611 continuing the execution. For example:
23612
23613 @smallexample
23614 $ break *upper
23615 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
23616 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
23617 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
23618 $ print $bnd0
23619 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
23620 @end smallexample
23621
23622 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
23623 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
23624 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
23625
23626 @node Alpha
23627 @subsection Alpha
23628
23629 See the following section.
23630
23631 @node MIPS
23632 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
23633
23634 @cindex stack on Alpha
23635 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
23636 @cindex Alpha stack
23637 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
23638 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
23639 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
23640 find the beginning of a function.
23641
23642 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
23643 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
23644 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
23645 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
23646 commands:
23647
23648 @table @code
23649 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
23650 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
23651 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
23652 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
23653 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
23654 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
23655 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
23656 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
23657
23658 @item show heuristic-fence-post
23659 Display the current limit.
23660 @end table
23661
23662 @noindent
23663 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
23664 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
23665
23666 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
23667 programs:
23668
23669 @table @code
23670 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
23671 @kindex set mips abi
23672 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
23673 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
23674 values of @var{arg} are:
23675
23676 @table @samp
23677 @item auto
23678 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
23679 default).
23680 @item o32
23681 @item o64
23682 @item n32
23683 @item n64
23684 @item eabi32
23685 @item eabi64
23686 @end table
23687
23688 @item show mips abi
23689 @kindex show mips abi
23690 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23691
23692 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
23693 @kindex set mips compression
23694 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
23695 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
23696 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
23697 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
23698 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
23699 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
23700 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
23701 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
23702 provided by the executable.
23703
23704 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
23705 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
23706 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
23707 identified as such.
23708
23709 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
23710 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
23711 implicitly from an executable.
23712
23713 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
23714 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
23715 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
23716 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
23717 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
23718
23719 @item show mips compression
23720 @kindex show mips compression
23721 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
23722 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23723
23724 @item set mipsfpu
23725 @itemx show mipsfpu
23726 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
23727
23728 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
23729 @kindex set mips mask-address
23730 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
23731 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
23732 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
23733 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
23734 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
23735
23736 @item show mips mask-address
23737 @kindex show mips mask-address
23738 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
23739 not.
23740
23741 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23742 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23743 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
23744 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
23745 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
23746 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
23747
23748 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23749 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23750 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
23751
23752 @item set debug mips
23753 @kindex set debug mips
23754 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
23755 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23756
23757 @item show debug mips
23758 @kindex show debug mips
23759 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
23760 @end table
23761
23762
23763 @node HPPA
23764 @subsection HPPA
23765 @cindex HPPA support
23766
23767 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
23768 following special commands:
23769
23770 @table @code
23771 @item set debug hppa
23772 @kindex set debug hppa
23773 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
23774 messages are to be displayed.
23775
23776 @item show debug hppa
23777 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
23778
23779 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
23780 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
23781 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
23782 given @var{address}.
23783
23784 @end table
23785
23786
23787 @node SPU
23788 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23789 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
23790 @cindex SPU
23791
23792 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
23793 it provides the following special commands:
23794
23795 @table @code
23796 @item info spu event
23797 @kindex info spu
23798 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
23799 and pending event status.
23800
23801 @item info spu signal
23802 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
23803 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
23804 notification channels.
23805
23806 @item info spu mailbox
23807 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
23808 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
23809 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
23810
23811 @item info spu dma
23812 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23813 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23814 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23815
23816 @item info spu proxydma
23817 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23818 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23819 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23820
23821 @end table
23822
23823 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
23824 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
23825 special commands:
23826
23827 @table @code
23828 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
23829 @kindex set spu
23830 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
23831 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
23832 function. The default is @code{off}.
23833
23834 @item show spu stop-on-load
23835 @kindex show spu
23836 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
23837
23838 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
23839 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
23840 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
23841 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
23842 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
23843 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
23844
23845 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
23846 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
23847
23848 @end table
23849
23850 @node PowerPC
23851 @subsection PowerPC
23852 @cindex PowerPC architecture
23853
23854 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
23855 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
23856 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
23857 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
23858 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
23859
23860 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
23861 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
23862 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
23863
23864 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
23865 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
23866
23867 @node Nios II
23868 @subsection Nios II
23869 @cindex Nios II architecture
23870
23871 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
23872 it provides the following special commands:
23873
23874 @table @code
23875
23876 @item set debug nios2
23877 @kindex set debug nios2
23878 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
23879 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23880
23881 @item show debug nios2
23882 @kindex show debug nios2
23883 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
23884 @end table
23885
23886 @node Sparc64
23887 @subsection Sparc64
23888 @cindex Sparc64 support
23889 @cindex Application Data Integrity
23890 @subsubsection ADI Support
23891
23892 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
23893 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
23894 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
23895 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
23896 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
23897 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
23898 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
23899 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
23900 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
23901 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
23902 signal.
23903
23904 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
23905 ADI-enabled.
23906
23907 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
23908 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
23909
23910
23911 @table @code
23912 @kindex adi examine
23913 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
23914
23915 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
23916 cacheline.
23917
23918 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
23919 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
23920 block size, to display.
23921
23922 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23923 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
23924
23925 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
23926
23927 @smallexample
23928 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23929 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
23930 @end smallexample
23931
23932 @kindex adi assign
23933 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
23934
23935 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
23936 to an address.
23937
23938 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
23939 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
23940 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
23941
23942 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23943 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
23944
23945 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
23946
23947 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
23948 variable "shmaddr":
23949
23950 @smallexample
23951 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
23952 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23953 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
23954 @end smallexample
23955
23956 @end table
23957
23958 @node Controlling GDB
23959 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
23960
23961 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
23962 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
23963 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
23964 described here.
23965
23966 @menu
23967 * Prompt:: Prompt
23968 * Editing:: Command editing
23969 * Command History:: Command history
23970 * Screen Size:: Screen size
23971 * Numbers:: Numbers
23972 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
23973 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
23974 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
23975 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
23976 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
23977 @end menu
23978
23979 @node Prompt
23980 @section Prompt
23981
23982 @cindex prompt
23983
23984 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
23985 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
23986 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
23987 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
23988 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
23989 which one you are talking to.
23990
23991 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
23992 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
23993 or a prompt that does not.
23994
23995 @table @code
23996 @kindex set prompt
23997 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
23998 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
23999
24000 @kindex show prompt
24001 @item show prompt
24002 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
24003 @end table
24004
24005 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
24006 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
24007 are:
24008
24009 @table @code
24010 @kindex set extended-prompt
24011 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
24012 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
24013 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
24014 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
24015 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
24016 is displayed.
24017
24018 For example:
24019
24020 @smallexample
24021 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
24022 @end smallexample
24023
24024 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
24025 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
24026
24027 @kindex show extended-prompt
24028 @item show extended-prompt
24029 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
24030 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
24031 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
24032 @end table
24033
24034 @node Editing
24035 @section Command Editing
24036 @cindex readline
24037 @cindex command line editing
24038
24039 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
24040 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
24041 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
24042 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
24043 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
24044 debugging sessions.
24045
24046 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
24047 command @code{set}.
24048
24049 @table @code
24050 @kindex set editing
24051 @cindex editing
24052 @item set editing
24053 @itemx set editing on
24054 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
24055
24056 @item set editing off
24057 Disable command line editing.
24058
24059 @kindex show editing
24060 @item show editing
24061 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
24062 @end table
24063
24064 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24065 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
24066 @end ifset
24067 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24068 @xref{Command Line Editing},
24069 @end ifclear
24070 for more details about the Readline
24071 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
24072 encouraged to read that chapter.
24073
24074 @node Command History
24075 @section Command History
24076 @cindex command history
24077
24078 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
24079 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
24080 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
24081 history facility.
24082
24083 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
24084 package, to provide the history facility.
24085 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24086 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
24087 @end ifset
24088 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24089 @xref{Using History Interactively},
24090 @end ifclear
24091 for the detailed description of the History library.
24092
24093 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
24094 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
24095 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
24096 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
24097 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
24098 pressed on a line by itself.
24099
24100 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
24101 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24102 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24103 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24104
24105 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
24106 history.
24107
24108 @table @code
24109 @cindex history substitution
24110 @cindex history file
24111 @kindex set history filename
24112 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
24113 @item set history filename @var{fname}
24114 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
24115 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
24116 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
24117 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
24118 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
24119 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
24120 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
24121 is not set.
24122
24123 @cindex save command history
24124 @kindex set history save
24125 @item set history save
24126 @itemx set history save on
24127 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
24128 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
24129
24130 @item set history save off
24131 Stop recording command history in a file.
24132
24133 @cindex history size
24134 @kindex set history size
24135 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
24136 @item set history size @var{size}
24137 @itemx set history size unlimited
24138 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
24139 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
24140 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
24141 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
24142 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
24143 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
24144
24145 @cindex remove duplicate history
24146 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
24147 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
24148 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
24149 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
24150 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
24151 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
24152 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
24153 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
24154 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
24155
24156 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
24157 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
24158
24159 @end table
24160
24161 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
24162 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24163 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
24164 @end ifset
24165 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24166 @xref{Event Designators},
24167 @end ifclear
24168 for more details.
24169
24170 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
24171 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
24172 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
24173 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
24174 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
24175 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
24176 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
24177 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
24178
24179 The commands to control history expansion are:
24180
24181 @table @code
24182 @item set history expansion on
24183 @itemx set history expansion
24184 @kindex set history expansion
24185 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
24186
24187 @item set history expansion off
24188 Disable history expansion.
24189
24190 @c @group
24191 @kindex show history
24192 @item show history
24193 @itemx show history filename
24194 @itemx show history save
24195 @itemx show history size
24196 @itemx show history expansion
24197 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
24198 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
24199 @c @end group
24200 @end table
24201
24202 @table @code
24203 @kindex show commands
24204 @cindex show last commands
24205 @cindex display command history
24206 @item show commands
24207 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
24208
24209 @item show commands @var{n}
24210 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
24211
24212 @item show commands +
24213 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
24214 @end table
24215
24216 @node Screen Size
24217 @section Screen Size
24218 @cindex size of screen
24219 @cindex screen size
24220 @cindex pagination
24221 @cindex page size
24222 @cindex pauses in output
24223
24224 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
24225 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
24226 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
24227 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
24228 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
24229 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
24230 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
24231 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
24232 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
24233 following line.
24234
24235 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
24236 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
24237 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
24238 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
24239 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
24240 width} commands:
24241
24242 @table @code
24243 @kindex set height
24244 @kindex set width
24245 @kindex show width
24246 @kindex show height
24247 @item set height @var{lpp}
24248 @itemx set height unlimited
24249 @itemx show height
24250 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
24251 @itemx set width unlimited
24252 @itemx show width
24253 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
24254 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
24255 commands display the current settings.
24256
24257 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
24258 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
24259 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
24260 buffer.
24261
24262 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
24263 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
24264
24265 @item set pagination on
24266 @itemx set pagination off
24267 @kindex set pagination
24268 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
24269 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
24270 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
24271 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
24272
24273 @item show pagination
24274 @kindex show pagination
24275 Show the current pagination mode.
24276 @end table
24277
24278 @node Numbers
24279 @section Numbers
24280 @cindex number representation
24281 @cindex entering numbers
24282
24283 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
24284 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
24285 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
24286 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
24287 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
24288 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
24289 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
24290 both input and output with the commands described below.
24291
24292 @table @code
24293 @kindex set input-radix
24294 @item set input-radix @var{base}
24295 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
24296 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24297 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
24298 example, any of
24299
24300 @smallexample
24301 set input-radix 012
24302 set input-radix 10.
24303 set input-radix 0xa
24304 @end smallexample
24305
24306 @noindent
24307 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
24308 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
24309 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
24310 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
24311 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
24312 change the radix.
24313
24314 @kindex set output-radix
24315 @item set output-radix @var{base}
24316 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
24317 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24318 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
24319
24320 @kindex show input-radix
24321 @item show input-radix
24322 Display the current default base for numeric input.
24323
24324 @kindex show output-radix
24325 @item show output-radix
24326 Display the current default base for numeric display.
24327
24328 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
24329 @itemx show radix
24330 @kindex set radix
24331 @kindex show radix
24332 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
24333 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
24334 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
24335 default value of 10.
24336
24337 @end table
24338
24339 @node ABI
24340 @section Configuring the Current ABI
24341
24342 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
24343 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
24344 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
24345 current ABI.
24346
24347 @cindex OS ABI
24348 @kindex set osabi
24349 @kindex show osabi
24350 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
24351
24352 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
24353 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
24354 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
24355 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
24356 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
24357 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
24358 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
24359 platform provides.
24360
24361 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
24362 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
24363 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
24364 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
24365
24366 @table @code
24367 @item show osabi
24368 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
24369
24370 @item set osabi
24371 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
24372
24373 @item set osabi @var{abi}
24374 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
24375 @end table
24376
24377 @cindex float promotion
24378
24379 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
24380 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
24381 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
24382 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
24383 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
24384 @code{double} and then passed.
24385
24386 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
24387 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
24388 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
24389
24390 @table @code
24391 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
24392 @item set coerce-float-to-double
24393 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
24394 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
24395 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
24396
24397 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
24398 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
24399 functions.
24400
24401 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
24402 @item show coerce-float-to-double
24403 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
24404 @end table
24405
24406 @kindex set cp-abi
24407 @kindex show cp-abi
24408 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
24409 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
24410 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
24411 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
24412 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
24413 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
24414 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
24415 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
24416 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
24417 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
24418 ``auto''.
24419
24420 @table @code
24421 @item show cp-abi
24422 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
24423
24424 @item set cp-abi
24425 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
24426
24427 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
24428 @itemx set cp-abi auto
24429 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
24430 @end table
24431
24432 @node Auto-loading
24433 @section Automatically loading associated files
24434 @cindex auto-loading
24435
24436 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
24437 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
24438 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
24439 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
24440 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
24441 sources).
24442
24443 @menu
24444 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24445 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
24446
24447 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
24448 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
24449 @end menu
24450
24451 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
24452 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
24453 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24454
24455 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
24456 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
24457 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24458
24459 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
24460 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
24461
24462 @table @code
24463 @anchor{set auto-load off}
24464 @kindex set auto-load off
24465 @item set auto-load off
24466 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
24467 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
24468 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
24469 @smallexample
24470 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
24471 @end smallexample
24472
24473 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
24474 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
24475 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
24476 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
24477 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
24478 @code{set auto-load no}.
24479
24480 @anchor{show auto-load}
24481 @kindex show auto-load
24482 @item show auto-load
24483 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
24484 or disabled.
24485
24486 @smallexample
24487 (gdb) show auto-load
24488 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
24489 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
24490 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
24491 is on.
24492 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
24493 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24494 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24495 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
24496 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24497 @end smallexample
24498
24499 @anchor{info auto-load}
24500 @kindex info auto-load
24501 @item info auto-load
24502 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
24503 not.
24504
24505 @smallexample
24506 (gdb) info auto-load
24507 gdb-scripts:
24508 Loaded Script
24509 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
24510 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
24511 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
24512 loaded.
24513 python-scripts:
24514 Loaded Script
24515 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
24516 @end smallexample
24517 @end table
24518
24519 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
24520
24521 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
24522 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
24523 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
24524 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
24525 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
24526 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
24527 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
24528 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24529 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24530 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24531 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24532 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24533 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24534 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
24535 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24536 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
24537 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24538 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
24539 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24540 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
24541 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24542 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
24543 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24544 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
24545 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24546 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24547 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24548 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
24549 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24550 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
24551 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
24552 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24553 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
24554 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24555 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
24556 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24557 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
24558 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
24559 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
24560 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
24561 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
24562 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
24563 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
24564 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
24565 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
24566 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
24567 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
24568 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
24569 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
24570 @end multitable
24571
24572 @node Init File in the Current Directory
24573 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
24574 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
24575
24576 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
24577 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
24578 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
24579
24580 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
24581 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24582
24583 @table @code
24584 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
24585 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
24586 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
24587 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
24588 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
24589
24590 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
24591 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
24592 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
24593 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24594 current directory is enabled or disabled.
24595
24596 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24597 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
24598 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
24599 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24600 current directory have been auto-loaded.
24601 @end table
24602
24603 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
24604 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
24605 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
24606
24607 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
24608
24609 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
24610 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
24611
24612 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
24613 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
24614 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
24615 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
24616 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
24617 library.
24618
24619 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
24620 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24621
24622 @table @code
24623 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
24624 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
24625 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
24626 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
24627
24628 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
24629 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
24630 @item show auto-load libthread-db
24631 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
24632 enabled or disabled.
24633
24634 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
24635 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
24636 @item info auto-load libthread-db
24637 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
24638 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
24639 @end table
24640
24641 @node Auto-loading safe path
24642 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
24643 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
24644
24645 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
24646 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
24647 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
24648 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
24649 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
24650
24651 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
24652 get loaded:
24653
24654 @smallexample
24655 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
24656 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
24657 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
24658 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24659 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24660 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
24661 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24662 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24663 @end smallexample
24664
24665 @noindent
24666 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
24667 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
24668
24669 @smallexample
24670 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
24671 @end smallexample
24672
24673 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
24674
24675 @table @code
24676 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
24677 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
24678 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24679 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
24680 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
24681 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
24682 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
24683 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24684 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
24685 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
24686
24687 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24688 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24689 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24690
24691 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
24692 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
24693 @item show auto-load safe-path
24694 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
24695 scripts.
24696
24697 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
24698 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
24699 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
24700 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
24701 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
24702 by the host platform path separator in use.
24703 @end table
24704
24705 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
24706 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
24707 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24708 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
24709 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
24710
24711 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
24712 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
24713 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
24714 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
24715 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
24716 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
24717 init file in the current directory
24718 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
24719
24720 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
24721 example, you could use one of the following ways:
24722
24723 @table @asis
24724 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
24725 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
24726 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
24727 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
24728
24729 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
24730 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
24731 @value{GDBN} session.
24732
24733 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
24734 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24735 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
24736 from trusted sources.
24737
24738 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
24739 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
24740 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
24741 trusted sources.
24742 @end table
24743
24744 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
24745 also suppresses any such warning messages:
24746
24747 @table @asis
24748 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
24749 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24750
24751 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
24752 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
24753 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
24754 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
24755 @end table
24756
24757 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
24758 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
24759 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
24760 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
24761 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
24762 recommended to be entered.
24763
24764 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
24765 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
24766 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
24767
24768 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
24769 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
24770 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
24771 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
24772 be printed.
24773
24774 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24775 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
24776 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
24777
24778 @smallexample
24779 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
24780 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
24781 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
24782 for objfile "/tmp/true".
24783 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
24784 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
24785 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
24786 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
24787 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
24788 @end smallexample
24789
24790 @table @code
24791 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
24792 @kindex set debug auto-load
24793 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
24794 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
24795
24796 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
24797 @kindex show debug auto-load
24798 @item show debug auto-load
24799 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
24800 on or off.
24801 @end table
24802
24803 @node Messages/Warnings
24804 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
24805
24806 @cindex verbose operation
24807 @cindex optional warnings
24808 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
24809 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
24810 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
24811 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
24812
24813 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
24814 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
24815 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24816
24817 @table @code
24818 @kindex set verbose
24819 @item set verbose on
24820 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24821
24822 @item set verbose off
24823 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24824
24825 @kindex show verbose
24826 @item show verbose
24827 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
24828 @end table
24829
24830 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
24831 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
24832 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
24833 Symbol Files}).
24834
24835 @table @code
24836
24837 @kindex set complaints
24838 @item set complaints @var{limit}
24839 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
24840 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
24841 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
24842 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
24843
24844 @kindex show complaints
24845 @item show complaints
24846 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
24847
24848 @end table
24849
24850 @anchor{confirmation requests}
24851 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
24852 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
24853 you try to run a program which is already running:
24854
24855 @smallexample
24856 (@value{GDBP}) run
24857 The program being debugged has been started already.
24858 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
24859 @end smallexample
24860
24861 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
24862 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
24863
24864 @table @code
24865
24866 @kindex set confirm
24867 @cindex flinching
24868 @cindex confirmation
24869 @cindex stupid questions
24870 @item set confirm off
24871 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
24872 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
24873 automatically disables confirmation requests.
24874
24875 @item set confirm on
24876 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
24877
24878 @kindex show confirm
24879 @item show confirm
24880 Displays state of confirmation requests.
24881
24882 @end table
24883
24884 @cindex command tracing
24885 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
24886 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
24887 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
24888 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
24889
24890 @table @code
24891 @kindex set trace-commands
24892 @cindex command scripts, debugging
24893 @item set trace-commands on
24894 Enable command tracing.
24895 @item set trace-commands off
24896 Disable command tracing.
24897 @item show trace-commands
24898 Display the current state of command tracing.
24899 @end table
24900
24901 @node Debugging Output
24902 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
24903 @cindex optional debugging messages
24904
24905 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
24906 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
24907 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
24908 section documents those commands.
24909
24910 @table @code
24911 @kindex set exec-done-display
24912 @item set exec-done-display
24913 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
24914 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
24915 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
24916 @kindex show exec-done-display
24917 @item show exec-done-display
24918 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
24919 notification.
24920 @kindex set debug
24921 @cindex ARM AArch64
24922 @item set debug aarch64
24923 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
24924 The default is off.
24925 @kindex show debug
24926 @item show debug aarch64
24927 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24928 ARM AArch64.
24929 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
24930 @cindex architecture debugging info
24931 @item set debug arch
24932 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
24933 @item show debug arch
24934 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
24935 @item set debug aix-solib
24936 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
24937 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
24938 support module. The default is off.
24939 @item show debug aix-thread
24940 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
24941 @item set debug aix-thread
24942 @cindex AIX threads
24943 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
24944 module.
24945 @item show debug aix-thread
24946 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
24947 @item set debug check-physname
24948 @cindex physname
24949 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
24950 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
24951 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
24952 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
24953 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
24954 both ways and display any discrepancies.
24955 @item show debug check-physname
24956 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
24957 @item set debug coff-pe-read
24958 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
24959 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
24960 exported symbols. The default is off.
24961 @item show debug coff-pe-read
24962 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24963 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24964 @item set debug dwarf-die
24965 @cindex DWARF DIEs
24966 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
24967 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
24968 A value of zero turns off the display.
24969 @item show debug dwarf-die
24970 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
24971 @item set debug dwarf-line
24972 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
24973 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24974 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
24975 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24976 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24977 @item show debug dwarf-line
24978 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
24979 @item set debug dwarf-read
24980 @cindex DWARF Reading
24981 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24982 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
24983 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24984 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24985 @item show debug dwarf-read
24986 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
24987 @item set debug displaced
24988 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
24989 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
24990 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
24991 @item show debug displaced
24992 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
24993 related to displaced stepping.
24994 @item set debug event
24995 @cindex event debugging info
24996 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
24997 default is off.
24998 @item show debug event
24999 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
25000 info.
25001 @item set debug expression
25002 @cindex expression debugging info
25003 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
25004 expression parsing. The default is off.
25005 @item show debug expression
25006 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
25007 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
25008 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
25009 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
25010 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
25011 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
25012 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
25013 @item set debug fbsd-nat
25014 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
25015 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
25016 @item show debug fbsd-nat
25017 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
25018 @item set debug frame
25019 @cindex frame debugging info
25020 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
25021 default is off.
25022 @item show debug frame
25023 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
25024 info.
25025 @item set debug gnu-nat
25026 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
25027 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
25028 @item show debug gnu-nat
25029 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
25030 @item set debug infrun
25031 @cindex inferior debugging info
25032 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
25033 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
25034 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
25035 @item show debug infrun
25036 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
25037 @item set debug jit
25038 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
25039 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
25040 @item show debug jit
25041 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
25042 @item set debug lin-lwp
25043 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
25044 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
25045 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
25046 @item show debug lin-lwp
25047 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
25048 @item set debug linux-namespaces
25049 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
25050 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
25051 @item show debug linux-namespaces
25052 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
25053 @item set debug mach-o
25054 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
25055 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
25056 processing. The default is off.
25057 @item show debug mach-o
25058 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25059 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25060 @item set debug notification
25061 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
25062 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
25063 The default is off.
25064 @item show debug notification
25065 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
25066 @item set debug observer
25067 @cindex observer debugging info
25068 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
25069 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
25070 @item show debug observer
25071 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
25072 @item set debug overload
25073 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
25074 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
25075 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
25076 is off.
25077 @item show debug overload
25078 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
25079 debugging info.
25080 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
25081 @cindex debug expression parser
25082 @item set debug parser
25083 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
25084 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
25085 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
25086 details. The default is off.
25087 @item show debug parser
25088 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
25089 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
25090 @cindex serial connections, debugging
25091 @cindex debug remote protocol
25092 @cindex remote protocol debugging
25093 @cindex display remote packets
25094 @item set debug remote
25095 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
25096 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
25097 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
25098 @item show debug remote
25099 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
25100
25101 @item set debug separate-debug-file
25102 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
25103 @item show debug separate-debug-file
25104 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
25105
25106 @item set debug serial
25107 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
25108 default is off.
25109 @item show debug serial
25110 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
25111 info.
25112 @item set debug solib-frv
25113 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
25114 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
25115 @item show debug solib-frv
25116 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
25117 messages.
25118 @item set debug symbol-lookup
25119 @cindex symbol lookup
25120 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
25121 The default is 0 (off).
25122 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25123 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25124 @item show debug symbol-lookup
25125 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
25126 @item set debug symfile
25127 @cindex symbol file functions
25128 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
25129 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
25130 @item show debug symfile
25131 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
25132 @item set debug symtab-create
25133 @cindex symbol table creation
25134 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
25135 The default is 0 (off).
25136 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25137 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25138 @item show debug symtab-create
25139 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
25140 @item set debug target
25141 @cindex target debugging info
25142 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
25143 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
25144 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
25145 value of large memory transfers.
25146 @item show debug target
25147 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
25148 info.
25149 @item set debug timestamp
25150 @cindex timestampping debugging info
25151 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
25152 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
25153 message.
25154 @item show debug timestamp
25155 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
25156 debugging info.
25157 @item set debug varobj
25158 @cindex variable object debugging info
25159 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
25160 info. The default is off.
25161 @item show debug varobj
25162 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
25163 debugging info.
25164 @item set debug xml
25165 @cindex XML parser debugging
25166 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
25167 @item show debug xml
25168 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
25169 @end table
25170
25171 @node Other Misc Settings
25172 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
25173 @cindex miscellaneous settings
25174
25175 @table @code
25176 @kindex set interactive-mode
25177 @item set interactive-mode
25178 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
25179 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
25180 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
25181 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
25182 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
25183 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
25184 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
25185 is, non-interactively otherwise.
25186
25187 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
25188 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
25189 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
25190 inside a cygwin window.
25191
25192 @kindex show interactive-mode
25193 @item show interactive-mode
25194 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
25195 @end table
25196
25197 @node Extending GDB
25198 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
25199 @cindex extending GDB
25200
25201 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
25202 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
25203 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
25204 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
25205 being debugged.
25206
25207 @menu
25208 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
25209 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
25210 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
25211 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
25212 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
25213 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
25214 @end menu
25215
25216 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
25217 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
25218 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
25219 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
25220 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25221 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
25222
25223 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
25224 setting:
25225
25226 @table @code
25227 @kindex set script-extension
25228 @kindex show script-extension
25229 @item set script-extension off
25230 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25231
25232 @item set script-extension soft
25233 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25234 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
25235 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
25236 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
25237
25238 @item set script-extension strict
25239 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25240 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
25241 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
25242
25243 @item show script-extension
25244 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
25245
25246 @end table
25247
25248 @node Sequences
25249 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
25250
25251 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
25252 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
25253 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
25254 files.
25255
25256 @menu
25257 * Define:: How to define your own commands
25258 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
25259 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
25260 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
25261 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
25262 @end menu
25263
25264 @node Define
25265 @subsection User-defined Commands
25266
25267 @cindex user-defined command
25268 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
25269 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
25270 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
25271 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
25272 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
25273 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
25274
25275 @smallexample
25276 define adder
25277 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25278 end
25279 @end smallexample
25280
25281 @noindent
25282 To execute the command use:
25283
25284 @smallexample
25285 adder 1 2 3
25286 @end smallexample
25287
25288 @noindent
25289 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
25290 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
25291 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
25292 functions calls.
25293
25294 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
25295 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
25296 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
25297 been passed.
25298
25299 @smallexample
25300 define adder
25301 if $argc == 2
25302 print $arg0 + $arg1
25303 end
25304 if $argc == 3
25305 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25306 end
25307 end
25308 @end smallexample
25309
25310 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
25311 to process a variable number of arguments:
25312
25313 @smallexample
25314 define adder
25315 set $i = 0
25316 set $sum = 0
25317 while $i < $argc
25318 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
25319 set $i = $i + 1
25320 end
25321 print $sum
25322 end
25323 @end smallexample
25324
25325 @table @code
25326
25327 @kindex define
25328 @item define @var{commandname}
25329 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
25330 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
25331 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
25332 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
25333 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
25334 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
25335
25336 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
25337 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
25338 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25339
25340 @kindex document
25341 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
25342 @item document @var{commandname}
25343 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
25344 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
25345 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
25346 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
25347 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
25348 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
25349
25350 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
25351 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
25352 does not change the documentation.
25353
25354 @kindex dont-repeat
25355 @cindex don't repeat command
25356 @item dont-repeat
25357 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
25358 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
25359 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
25360
25361 @kindex help user-defined
25362 @item help user-defined
25363 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
25364 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
25365 included (if any).
25366
25367 @kindex show user
25368 @item show user
25369 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
25370 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
25371 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
25372 definitions for all user-defined commands.
25373 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
25374
25375 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
25376 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
25377 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
25378 @item show max-user-call-depth
25379 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
25380 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
25381 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
25382 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
25383 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
25384 @end table
25385
25386 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
25387 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
25388
25389 When user-defined commands are executed, the
25390 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
25391 stops execution of the user-defined command.
25392
25393 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
25394 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
25395 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
25396 messages when used in a user-defined command.
25397
25398 @node Hooks
25399 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
25400 @cindex command hooks
25401 @cindex hooks, for commands
25402 @cindex hooks, pre-command
25403
25404 @kindex hook
25405 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
25406 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
25407 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
25408 before that command.
25409
25410 @cindex hooks, post-command
25411 @kindex hookpost
25412 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
25413 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
25414 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
25415 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
25416 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
25417
25418 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
25419 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
25420
25421 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
25422 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
25423
25424 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
25425 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
25426 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
25427 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
25428 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
25429
25430 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
25431 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
25432 you could define:
25433
25434 @smallexample
25435 define hook-stop
25436 handle SIGALRM nopass
25437 end
25438
25439 define hook-run
25440 handle SIGALRM pass
25441 end
25442
25443 define hook-continue
25444 handle SIGALRM pass
25445 end
25446 @end smallexample
25447
25448 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
25449 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
25450 you could define:
25451
25452 @smallexample
25453 define hook-echo
25454 echo <<<---
25455 end
25456
25457 define hookpost-echo
25458 echo --->>>\n
25459 end
25460
25461 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
25462 <<<---Hello World--->>>
25463 (@value{GDBP})
25464
25465 @end smallexample
25466
25467 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
25468 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
25469 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
25470 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
25471 @c or not?
25472 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
25473 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
25474 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
25475
25476 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
25477 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
25478 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
25479
25480 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
25481 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
25482
25483 @node Command Files
25484 @subsection Command Files
25485
25486 @cindex command files
25487 @cindex scripting commands
25488 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
25489 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
25490 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
25491 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
25492 terminal.
25493
25494 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
25495 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
25496 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
25497 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
25498 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
25499
25500 @table @code
25501 @kindex source
25502 @cindex execute commands from a file
25503 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
25504 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
25505 @end table
25506
25507 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
25508 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
25509 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
25510 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
25511 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
25512
25513 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
25514 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
25515 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
25516 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
25517 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
25518 is not relevant to scripts.
25519
25520 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
25521 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
25522 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
25523 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
25524 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25525 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
25526 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
25527 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
25528 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25529 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
25530 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
25531 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
25532 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
25533 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
25534
25535 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
25536 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
25537 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
25538
25539 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
25540 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
25541 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
25542 when called from command files.
25543
25544 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
25545 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
25546 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
25547 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
25548 the next command.
25549
25550 @smallexample
25551 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
25552 @end smallexample
25553
25554 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
25555 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
25556 would be directed to @file{log}.
25557
25558 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
25559 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
25560 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
25561 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
25562 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
25563 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
25564 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
25565 conditionally, etc.
25566
25567 @table @code
25568 @kindex if
25569 @kindex else
25570 @item if
25571 @itemx else
25572 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
25573 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
25574 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
25575 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
25576 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
25577 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
25578 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25579
25580 @kindex while
25581 @item while
25582 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
25583 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
25584 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
25585 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
25586 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
25587 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
25588
25589 @kindex loop_break
25590 @item loop_break
25591 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
25592 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
25593 line.
25594
25595 @kindex loop_continue
25596 @item loop_continue
25597 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
25598 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
25599 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
25600 the controlling expression.
25601
25602 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
25603 @item end
25604 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
25605 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
25606 @end table
25607
25608
25609 @node Output
25610 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
25611
25612 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
25613 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
25614 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
25615 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
25616 want.
25617
25618 @table @code
25619 @kindex echo
25620 @item echo @var{text}
25621 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
25622 @c because it is not in ANSI.
25623 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
25624 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
25625 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
25626 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
25627 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
25628 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
25629 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
25630 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
25631 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
25632
25633 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
25634 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
25635
25636 @smallexample
25637 echo This is some text\n\
25638 which is continued\n\
25639 onto several lines.\n
25640 @end smallexample
25641
25642 produces the same output as
25643
25644 @smallexample
25645 echo This is some text\n
25646 echo which is continued\n
25647 echo onto several lines.\n
25648 @end smallexample
25649
25650 @kindex output
25651 @item output @var{expression}
25652 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
25653 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
25654 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
25655 on expressions.
25656
25657 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
25658 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
25659 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
25660 Formats}, for more information.
25661
25662 @kindex printf
25663 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25664 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25665 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
25666 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
25667 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
25668 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
25669 executing the code below:
25670
25671 @smallexample
25672 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
25673 @end smallexample
25674
25675 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
25676 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
25677 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
25678 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
25679 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
25680 printed.
25681
25682 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
25683
25684 @smallexample
25685 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
25686 @end smallexample
25687
25688 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
25689 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
25690 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
25691
25692 @itemize @bullet
25693 @item
25694 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
25695
25696 @item
25697 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
25698 width.
25699
25700 @item
25701 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
25702 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
25703
25704 @item
25705 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
25706 supported.
25707
25708 @item
25709 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
25710
25711 @item
25712 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
25713 @end itemize
25714
25715 @noindent
25716 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
25717 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
25718 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
25719 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
25720
25721 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
25722 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
25723 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
25724 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
25725 supported.
25726
25727 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
25728 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
25729 together with a floating point specifier.
25730 letters:
25731
25732 @itemize @bullet
25733 @item
25734 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
25735
25736 @item
25737 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
25738
25739 @item
25740 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
25741 @end itemize
25742
25743 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
25744 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
25745 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
25746
25747 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
25748 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
25749
25750 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
25751 @smallexample
25752 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
25753 @end smallexample
25754
25755 @anchor{eval}
25756 @kindex eval
25757 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25758 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25759 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
25760
25761 @end table
25762
25763 @node Auto-loading sequences
25764 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
25765 @cindex native script auto-loading
25766
25767 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25768 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
25769 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
25770 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
25771
25772 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25773 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25774
25775 @table @code
25776 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
25777 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
25778 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
25779 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
25780
25781 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
25782 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
25783 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
25784 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
25785 disabled.
25786
25787 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
25788 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
25789 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
25790 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
25791 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
25792 auto-loaded.
25793 @end table
25794
25795 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
25796 matching names are printed.
25797
25798 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
25799 @include python.texi
25800
25801 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
25802 @include guile.texi
25803
25804 @node Auto-loading extensions
25805 @section Auto-loading extensions
25806 @cindex auto-loading extensions
25807
25808 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
25809 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25810 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
25811 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
25812 section of modern file formats like ELF.
25813
25814 @menu
25815 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25816 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25817 * Which flavor to choose?::
25818 @end menu
25819
25820 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
25821 debugging commands and features.
25822
25823 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25824 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25825 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
25826 for more information.
25827 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
25828 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
25829
25830 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25831 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25832
25833 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
25834 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25835 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25836 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25837 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25838
25839 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
25840 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
25841 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
25842 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
25843
25844 @table @code
25845 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25846 GDB's own command language
25847 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25848 Python
25849 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25850 Guile
25851 @end table
25852
25853 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
25854 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
25855 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
25856 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
25857 script in the specified extension language.
25858
25859 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
25860 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
25861
25862 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
25863 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25864
25865 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
25866 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
25867 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
25868 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
25869 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
25870 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
25871
25872 @table @code
25873 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
25874 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
25875 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25876 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
25877 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
25878 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
25879
25880 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
25881 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
25882
25883 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
25884 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
25885 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
25886 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
25887
25888 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
25889 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
25890 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
25891 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
25892 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
25893 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
25894 platform.
25895
25896 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25897 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25898 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25899
25900 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
25901 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
25902 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
25903 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25904
25905 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
25906 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
25907 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
25908 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
25909 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
25910 @end table
25911
25912 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
25913 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
25914 @var{objfile} is opened.
25915 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
25916 is evaluated more than once.
25917
25918 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
25919 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25920 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25921
25922 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
25923 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
25924 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25925 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
25926 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
25927 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
25928 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25929
25930 The following entries are supported:
25931
25932 @table @code
25933 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
25934 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
25935 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
25936 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
25937 @end table
25938
25939 @subsubsection Script File Entries
25940
25941 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
25942 in the current directory and then along the source search path
25943 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
25944 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
25945 directory is not relevant to scripts.
25946
25947 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
25948 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
25949
25950 @example
25951 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
25952 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
25953 asm("\
25954 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
25955 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
25956 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
25957 .popsection \n\
25958 ");
25959 @end example
25960
25961 @noindent
25962 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
25963 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
25964
25965 @example
25966 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
25967 @end example
25968
25969 The script name may include directories if desired.
25970
25971 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25972 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25973
25974 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
25975 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
25976 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
25977 will remove duplicates.
25978
25979 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
25980
25981 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
25982 itself instead of loading it from a file.
25983 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
25984 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
25985 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
25986 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
25987 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
25988 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
25989 on its name.
25990
25991 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
25992 testsuite.
25993
25994 @example
25995 #include "symcat.h"
25996 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
25997 asm(
25998 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
25999 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
26000 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
26001 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
26002 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
26003 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
26004 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
26005 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
26006 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
26007 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
26008 ".byte 0\n"
26009 ".popsection\n"
26010 );
26011 @end example
26012
26013 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
26014 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26015 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
26016 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
26017
26018 @node Which flavor to choose?
26019 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
26020
26021 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
26022 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
26023
26024 @noindent
26025 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
26026
26027 @itemize @bullet
26028 @item
26029 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
26030
26031 @item
26032 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
26033
26034 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
26035 in the source search path.
26036 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
26037 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
26038
26039 @item
26040 Doesn't require source code additions.
26041 @end itemize
26042
26043 @noindent
26044 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
26045
26046 @itemize @bullet
26047 @item
26048 Works with static linking.
26049
26050 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
26051 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
26052 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
26053 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
26054 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
26055
26056 @item
26057 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
26058
26059 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
26060 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
26061
26062 @item
26063 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
26064
26065 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
26066 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
26067 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
26068 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
26069 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
26070 top of the source tree to the source search path.
26071 @end itemize
26072
26073 @node Multiple Extension Languages
26074 @section Multiple Extension Languages
26075
26076 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
26077 and generally do not interfere with each other.
26078 There are some things to be aware of, however.
26079
26080 @subsection Python comes first
26081
26082 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
26083 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
26084 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
26085 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
26086 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
26087 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
26088 pretty-printed form of a value).
26089 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
26090 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
26091 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
26092
26093 @node Aliases
26094 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
26095 @cindex aliases for commands
26096
26097 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
26098 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
26099 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
26100 that involves less typing.
26101
26102 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
26103 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
26104 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
26105
26106 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
26107 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
26108 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
26109
26110 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
26111
26112 @table @code
26113
26114 @kindex alias
26115 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
26116
26117 @end table
26118
26119 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
26120 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
26121 underscores.
26122
26123 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
26124 that is being aliased.
26125
26126 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
26127 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
26128 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
26129
26130 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
26131 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
26132
26133 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
26134 of a command so that there is less to type.
26135 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
26136 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
26137 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
26138 The following will accomplish this.
26139
26140 @smallexample
26141 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
26142 @end smallexample
26143
26144 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
26145 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
26146 for it with the @samp{document} command.
26147 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
26148
26149 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
26150 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
26151 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
26152 of a command.
26153
26154 @smallexample
26155 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
26156 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
26157 (gdb) set p elms 20
26158 (gdb) show p elms
26159 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
26160 @end smallexample
26161
26162 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
26163 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
26164 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
26165
26166 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
26167 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
26168
26169 @smallexample
26170 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
26171 @end smallexample
26172
26173 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
26174 alias for a more complex command.
26175 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
26176
26177 @smallexample
26178 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
26179 (gdb) spe 20
26180 @end smallexample
26181
26182 @node Interpreters
26183 @chapter Command Interpreters
26184 @cindex command interpreters
26185
26186 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
26187 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
26188 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
26189
26190 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
26191 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
26192 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
26193 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
26194
26195 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
26196 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
26197 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
26198 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
26199
26200 @table @code
26201 @item console
26202 @cindex console interpreter
26203 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
26204 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
26205 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
26206
26207 @item mi
26208 @cindex mi interpreter
26209 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
26210 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
26211 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
26212 Interface}.
26213
26214 @item mi2
26215 @cindex mi2 interpreter
26216 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
26217
26218 @item mi1
26219 @cindex mi1 interpreter
26220 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
26221
26222 @end table
26223
26224 @cindex invoke another interpreter
26225
26226 @kindex interpreter-exec
26227 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
26228 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
26229 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
26230
26231 @smallexample
26232 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
26233 @end smallexample
26234
26235 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
26236 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
26237
26238 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
26239 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
26240 permanently.
26241
26242 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
26243
26244 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
26245 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
26246 device (usually a tty).
26247
26248 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
26249 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
26250 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
26251 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
26252 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
26253 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
26254 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
26255 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
26256 the separate MI interpreter.
26257
26258 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
26259 @code{new-ui} command:
26260
26261 @kindex new-ui
26262 @cindex new user interface
26263 @smallexample
26264 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
26265 @end smallexample
26266
26267 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
26268 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
26269 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
26270 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
26271 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
26272 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
26273
26274 @smallexample
26275 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
26276 @end smallexample
26277
26278 @noindent
26279 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
26280
26281 @node TUI
26282 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
26283 @cindex TUI
26284 @cindex Text User Interface
26285
26286 @menu
26287 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
26288 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
26289 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
26290 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
26291 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
26292 @end menu
26293
26294 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
26295 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
26296 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
26297 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
26298 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
26299 is available.
26300
26301 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
26302 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
26303 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
26304 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
26305 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
26306 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
26307
26308 @node TUI Overview
26309 @section TUI Overview
26310
26311 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
26312
26313 @table @emph
26314 @item command
26315 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
26316 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
26317 managed using readline.
26318
26319 @item source
26320 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
26321 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
26322
26323 @item assembly
26324 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
26325
26326 @item register
26327 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
26328 when their values change.
26329 @end table
26330
26331 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
26332 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
26333 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
26334 indicates the breakpoint type:
26335
26336 @table @code
26337 @item B
26338 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26339
26340 @item b
26341 Breakpoint which was never hit.
26342
26343 @item H
26344 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26345
26346 @item h
26347 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
26348 @end table
26349
26350 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
26351
26352 @table @code
26353 @item +
26354 Breakpoint is enabled.
26355
26356 @item -
26357 Breakpoint is disabled.
26358 @end table
26359
26360 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
26361 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
26362 changes.
26363
26364 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
26365 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
26366 layouts:
26367
26368 @itemize @bullet
26369 @item
26370 source only,
26371
26372 @item
26373 assembly only,
26374
26375 @item
26376 source and assembly,
26377
26378 @item
26379 source and registers, or
26380
26381 @item
26382 assembly and registers.
26383 @end itemize
26384
26385 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
26386
26387 @table @emph
26388 @item target
26389 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
26390 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
26391
26392 @item process
26393 Gives the current process or thread number.
26394 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
26395
26396 @item function
26397 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
26398 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
26399 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
26400 the string @code{??} is displayed.
26401
26402 @item line
26403 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
26404 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
26405
26406 @item pc
26407 Indicates the current program counter address.
26408 @end table
26409
26410 @node TUI Keys
26411 @section TUI Key Bindings
26412 @cindex TUI key bindings
26413
26414 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
26415 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26416 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
26417 @end ifset
26418 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26419 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
26420 @end ifclear
26421 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
26422 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
26423
26424 @table @kbd
26425 @kindex C-x C-a
26426 @item C-x C-a
26427 @kindex C-x a
26428 @itemx C-x a
26429 @kindex C-x A
26430 @itemx C-x A
26431 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
26432 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
26433 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
26434 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
26435 The screen is then refreshed.
26436
26437 @kindex C-x 1
26438 @item C-x 1
26439 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
26440 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
26441 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
26442
26443 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
26444
26445 @kindex C-x 2
26446 @item C-x 2
26447 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
26448 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
26449 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
26450 previous layout and the new one.
26451
26452 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
26453
26454 @kindex C-x o
26455 @item C-x o
26456 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
26457 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
26458 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
26459
26460 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
26461
26462 @kindex C-x s
26463 @item C-x s
26464 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
26465 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
26466 @end table
26467
26468 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
26469
26470 @table @asis
26471 @kindex PgUp
26472 @item @key{PgUp}
26473 Scroll the active window one page up.
26474
26475 @kindex PgDn
26476 @item @key{PgDn}
26477 Scroll the active window one page down.
26478
26479 @kindex Up
26480 @item @key{Up}
26481 Scroll the active window one line up.
26482
26483 @kindex Down
26484 @item @key{Down}
26485 Scroll the active window one line down.
26486
26487 @kindex Left
26488 @item @key{Left}
26489 Scroll the active window one column left.
26490
26491 @kindex Right
26492 @item @key{Right}
26493 Scroll the active window one column right.
26494
26495 @kindex C-L
26496 @item @kbd{C-L}
26497 Refresh the screen.
26498 @end table
26499
26500 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
26501 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
26502 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
26503 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
26504 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
26505
26506 @node TUI Single Key Mode
26507 @section TUI Single Key Mode
26508 @cindex TUI single key mode
26509
26510 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
26511 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
26512 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
26513
26514 @table @kbd
26515 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26516 @item c
26517 continue
26518
26519 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26520 @item d
26521 down
26522
26523 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26524 @item f
26525 finish
26526
26527 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26528 @item n
26529 next
26530
26531 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26532 @item o
26533 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
26534
26535 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26536 @item q
26537 exit the SingleKey mode.
26538
26539 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26540 @item r
26541 run
26542
26543 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26544 @item s
26545 step
26546
26547 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26548 @item i
26549 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
26550
26551 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26552 @item u
26553 up
26554
26555 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26556 @item v
26557 info locals
26558
26559 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26560 @item w
26561 where
26562 @end table
26563
26564 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
26565 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
26566 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
26567 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
26568 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
26569 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
26570
26571
26572 @node TUI Commands
26573 @section TUI-specific Commands
26574 @cindex TUI commands
26575
26576 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
26577 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
26578 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
26579 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
26580
26581 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
26582 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
26583 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
26584 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
26585 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
26586
26587 @table @code
26588 @item tui enable
26589 @kindex tui enable
26590 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
26591 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
26592 otherwise a default layout is used.
26593
26594 @item tui disable
26595 @kindex tui disable
26596 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
26597
26598 @item info win
26599 @kindex info win
26600 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
26601
26602 @item layout @var{name}
26603 @kindex layout
26604 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
26605 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
26606 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
26607
26608 @table @code
26609 @item next
26610 Display the next layout.
26611
26612 @item prev
26613 Display the previous layout.
26614
26615 @item src
26616 Display the source and command windows.
26617
26618 @item asm
26619 Display the assembly and command windows.
26620
26621 @item split
26622 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
26623
26624 @item regs
26625 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
26626 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
26627 register, assembler, and command windows.
26628 @end table
26629
26630 @item focus @var{name}
26631 @kindex focus
26632 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
26633 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
26634
26635 @table @code
26636 @item next
26637 Make the next window active for scrolling.
26638
26639 @item prev
26640 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
26641
26642 @item src
26643 Make the source window active for scrolling.
26644
26645 @item asm
26646 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
26647
26648 @item regs
26649 Make the register window active for scrolling.
26650
26651 @item cmd
26652 Make the command window active for scrolling.
26653 @end table
26654
26655 @item refresh
26656 @kindex refresh
26657 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
26658
26659 @item tui reg @var{group}
26660 @kindex tui reg
26661 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
26662 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
26663 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
26664 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
26665 following groups are available on most targets:
26666 @table @code
26667 @item next
26668 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26669 through all of the available register groups.
26670
26671 @item prev
26672 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26673 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
26674 @var{next}.
26675
26676 @item general
26677 Display the general registers.
26678 @item float
26679 Display the floating point registers.
26680 @item system
26681 Display the system registers.
26682 @item vector
26683 Display the vector registers.
26684 @item all
26685 Display all registers.
26686 @end table
26687
26688 @item update
26689 @kindex update
26690 Update the source window and the current execution point.
26691
26692 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
26693 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
26694 @kindex winheight
26695 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
26696 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
26697 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
26698 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
26699 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
26700
26701 @item tabset @var{nchars}
26702 @kindex tabset
26703 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
26704 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
26705 assembly windows.
26706 @end table
26707
26708 @node TUI Configuration
26709 @section TUI Configuration Variables
26710 @cindex TUI configuration variables
26711
26712 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
26713
26714 @table @code
26715 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
26716 @kindex set tui border-kind
26717 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
26718 The possible values are the following:
26719 @table @code
26720 @item space
26721 Use a space character to draw the border.
26722
26723 @item ascii
26724 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
26725
26726 @item acs
26727 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
26728 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
26729 @end table
26730
26731 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
26732 @kindex set tui border-mode
26733 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
26734 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
26735 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
26736 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
26737 @table @code
26738 @item normal
26739 Use normal attributes to display the border.
26740
26741 @item standout
26742 Use standout mode.
26743
26744 @item reverse
26745 Use reverse video mode.
26746
26747 @item half
26748 Use half bright mode.
26749
26750 @item half-standout
26751 Use half bright and standout mode.
26752
26753 @item bold
26754 Use extra bright or bold mode.
26755
26756 @item bold-standout
26757 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
26758 @end table
26759 @end table
26760
26761 @node Emacs
26762 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
26763
26764 @cindex Emacs
26765 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
26766 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
26767 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
26768 @value{GDBN}.
26769
26770 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
26771 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
26772 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
26773 created Emacs buffer.
26774 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
26775
26776 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
26777 things:
26778
26779 @itemize @bullet
26780 @item
26781 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
26782 the GUD buffer.
26783
26784 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
26785 and output done by the program you are debugging.
26786
26787 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
26788 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
26789 in this way.
26790
26791 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
26792 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
26793 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
26794 stop.
26795
26796 @item
26797 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
26798
26799 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
26800 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
26801 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
26802 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
26803 and the source.
26804
26805 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
26806 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
26807 @end itemize
26808
26809 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
26810 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
26811 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
26812 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
26813
26814 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
26815 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
26816 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
26817 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
26818 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
26819 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
26820 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
26821 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
26822 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
26823
26824 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
26825 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
26826 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
26827 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
26828
26829 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
26830 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
26831 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
26832 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
26833 one you want.
26834
26835 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
26836 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
26837
26838 @table @kbd
26839 @item C-h m
26840 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
26841
26842 @item C-c C-s
26843 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
26844 update the display window to show the current file and location.
26845
26846 @item C-c C-n
26847 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
26848 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
26849 to show the current file and location.
26850
26851 @item C-c C-i
26852 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
26853 display window accordingly.
26854
26855 @item C-c C-f
26856 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
26857 @code{finish} command.
26858
26859 @item C-c C-r
26860 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
26861 command.
26862
26863 @item C-c <
26864 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
26865 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
26866 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
26867
26868 @item C-c >
26869 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
26870 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
26871 @end table
26872
26873 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
26874 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
26875
26876 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
26877 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
26878 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
26879 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
26880 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
26881 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
26882 speedbar displays watch expressions.
26883
26884 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
26885 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
26886 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
26887 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
26888 frame.
26889
26890 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
26891 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
26892 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
26893 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
26894 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
26895 to correspond properly with the code.
26896
26897 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
26898 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
26899 Emacs Manual}).
26900
26901 @node GDB/MI
26902 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
26903
26904 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
26905
26906 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
26907 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
26908 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
26909 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
26910 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
26911 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
26912
26913 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
26914 in the form of a reference manual.
26915
26916 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
26917 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
26918 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
26919
26920 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
26921
26922 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
26923 This chapter uses the following notation:
26924
26925 @itemize @bullet
26926 @item
26927 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
26928
26929 @item
26930 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
26931 it may or may not be given.
26932
26933 @item
26934 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26935 may repeat zero or more times.
26936
26937 @item
26938 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26939 may repeat one or more times.
26940
26941 @item
26942 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
26943 @end itemize
26944
26945 @ignore
26946 @heading Dependencies
26947 @end ignore
26948
26949 @menu
26950 * GDB/MI General Design::
26951 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
26952 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
26953 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
26954 * GDB/MI Output Records::
26955 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
26956 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
26957 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
26958 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26959 * GDB/MI Program Context::
26960 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
26961 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
26962 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
26963 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
26964 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
26965 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
26966 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
26967 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
26968 * GDB/MI File Commands::
26969 @ignore
26970 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
26971 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
26972 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
26973 @end ignore
26974 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
26975 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
26976 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
26977 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
26978 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
26979 @end menu
26980
26981 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26982 @node GDB/MI General Design
26983 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
26984 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
26985
26986 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
26987 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
26988 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
26989 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
26990 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
26991 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
26992 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
26993 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
26994 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
26995 a command and reported as part of that command response.
26996
26997 The important examples of notifications are:
26998 @itemize @bullet
26999
27000 @item
27001 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
27002 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
27003 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
27004 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
27005 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
27006 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
27007 command itself was successfully executed.
27008
27009 @item
27010 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
27011 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
27012 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
27013 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
27014 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
27015 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
27016
27017 @item
27018 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
27019 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
27020 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
27021 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
27022 orthogonal frontend design.
27023
27024 @end itemize
27025
27026 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
27027 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
27028 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
27029 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
27030 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
27031 the user interface.
27032
27033
27034 @menu
27035 * Context management::
27036 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
27037 * Thread groups::
27038 @end menu
27039
27040 @node Context management
27041 @subsection Context management
27042
27043 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
27044
27045 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
27046 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
27047 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
27048 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
27049 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
27050 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
27051 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
27052 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
27053 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
27054
27055 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
27056 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
27057 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
27058 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
27059 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
27060 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
27061 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
27062 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
27063 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
27064 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
27065 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
27066
27067 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
27068 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
27069 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
27070 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
27071 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
27072 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
27073 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
27074 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
27075 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
27076 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
27077
27078 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
27079 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
27080 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
27081 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
27082 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
27083 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
27084 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
27085 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
27086 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
27087 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
27088 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
27089 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
27090 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
27091 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
27092 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
27093 @samp{--frame} options.
27094
27095 @subsubsection Language
27096
27097 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
27098 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
27099 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
27100 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
27101 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
27102 For instance:
27103
27104 @smallexample
27105 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
27106 ^done,value="4"
27107 (gdb)
27108 @end smallexample
27109
27110 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
27111 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
27112 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
27113
27114 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
27115 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
27116
27117 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
27118 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
27119 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
27120 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
27121 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
27122 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
27123 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
27124 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
27125 @code{-list-target-features} command.
27126
27127 @table @code
27128 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
27129 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
27130 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
27131
27132 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
27133 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
27134 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
27135
27136 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
27137 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
27138 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
27139 MI commands even while the target is running.
27140
27141 @item -gdb-show mi-async
27142 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
27143 @end table
27144
27145 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
27146 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
27147 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
27148 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
27149 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
27150 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
27151
27152 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
27153 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
27154 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
27155 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
27156 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
27157 are running.
27158
27159 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
27160 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
27161 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
27162 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
27163 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
27164 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
27165 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
27166 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
27167 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
27168 @samp{--thread} option).
27169
27170 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
27171 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
27172 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
27173 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
27174
27175 @node Thread groups
27176 @subsection Thread groups
27177 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
27178 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
27179 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
27180 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
27181 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
27182
27183 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
27184 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
27185 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
27186 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
27187 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
27188 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
27189 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
27190 into processes.
27191
27192 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
27193 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
27194 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
27195 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
27196 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
27197 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
27198 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
27199 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
27200 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
27201 the members of specific thread group.
27202
27203 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
27204 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
27205 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
27206 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
27207 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
27208 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
27209 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
27210 after attaching to that thread group.
27211
27212 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
27213 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
27214 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
27215 such thread groups.
27216
27217 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27218 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
27219 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
27220
27221 @menu
27222 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
27223 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
27224 @end menu
27225
27226 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
27227 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
27228
27229 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
27230 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
27231 @table @code
27232 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
27233 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
27234
27235 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
27236 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
27237 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
27238
27239 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
27240 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
27241 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
27242
27243 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27244 "any sequence of digits"
27245
27246 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
27247 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
27248
27249 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
27250 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
27251
27252 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
27253 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
27254
27255 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
27256 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
27257 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
27258
27259 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
27260 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
27261
27262 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27263 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27264 @end table
27265
27266 @noindent
27267 Notes:
27268
27269 @itemize @bullet
27270 @item
27271 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
27272 output is described below.
27273
27274 @item
27275 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
27276 finishes.
27277
27278 @item
27279 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
27280 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
27281 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
27282 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
27283 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
27284 @end itemize
27285
27286 Pragmatics:
27287
27288 @itemize @bullet
27289 @item
27290 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
27291
27292 @item
27293 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
27294 @end itemize
27295
27296 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
27297 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
27298
27299 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
27300 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
27301 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
27302 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
27303 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
27304 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
27305
27306 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
27307 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
27308 @var{token}.
27309
27310 @table @code
27311 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
27312 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
27313
27314 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
27315 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
27316
27317 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
27318 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
27319
27320 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
27321 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
27322
27323 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
27324 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
27325
27326 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
27327 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
27328
27329 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
27330 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
27331
27332 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
27333 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
27334
27335 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
27336 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
27337
27338 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
27339 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
27340 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
27341
27342 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
27343 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
27344
27345 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
27346 @code{ @var{string} }
27347
27348 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
27349 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
27350
27351 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
27352 @code{@var{c-string}}
27353
27354 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
27355 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
27356
27357 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
27358 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
27359 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
27360
27361 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
27362 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
27363
27364 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
27365 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
27366
27367 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
27368 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
27369
27370 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
27371 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
27372
27373 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27374 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27375
27376 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27377 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
27378 @end table
27379
27380 @noindent
27381 Notes:
27382
27383 @itemize @bullet
27384 @item
27385 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
27386
27387 @item
27388 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
27389 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
27390 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
27391 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
27392 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
27393 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
27394 prior command.
27395
27396 @item
27397 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27398 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
27399 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
27400 prefixed by @samp{+}.
27401
27402 @item
27403 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27404 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
27405 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
27406 @samp{*}.
27407
27408 @item
27409 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27410 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
27411 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
27412 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
27413
27414 @item
27415 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27416 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
27417 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
27418 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
27419
27420 @item
27421 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27422 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
27423 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
27424
27425 @item
27426 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27427 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
27428 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
27429 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
27430
27431 @item
27432 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27433 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
27434 @var{values}.
27435
27436
27437 @end itemize
27438
27439 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
27440 details about the various output records.
27441
27442 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27443 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
27444 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
27445
27446 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
27447 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
27448
27449 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
27450 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
27451 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
27452 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
27453 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
27454 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
27455
27456 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
27457 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
27458 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
27459
27460 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27461 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
27462 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
27463 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
27464
27465 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
27466 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
27467
27468 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
27469 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
27470 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
27471 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
27472 might change.
27473
27474 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
27475 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
27476 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
27477 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
27478
27479 @itemize @bullet
27480 @item
27481 New MI commands may be added.
27482
27483 @item
27484 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
27485
27486 @item
27487 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
27488 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
27489
27490 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
27491 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
27492
27493 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
27494 @c resolve inconsistencies.
27495 @end itemize
27496
27497 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
27498 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
27499 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
27500 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
27501 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
27502
27503 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
27504 @c version?
27505
27506 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
27507 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
27508 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
27509 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
27510 @cindex mailing lists
27511
27512 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27513 @node GDB/MI Output Records
27514 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
27515
27516 @menu
27517 * GDB/MI Result Records::
27518 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
27519 * GDB/MI Async Records::
27520 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
27521 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
27522 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
27523 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
27524 @end menu
27525
27526 @node GDB/MI Result Records
27527 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
27528
27529 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27530 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
27531 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
27532 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
27533
27534 @table @code
27535 @findex ^done
27536 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
27537 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
27538 values.
27539
27540 @item "^running"
27541 @findex ^running
27542 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
27543 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
27544 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
27545 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
27546 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
27547 which threads are resumed.
27548
27549 @item "^connected"
27550 @findex ^connected
27551 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
27552
27553 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
27554 @findex ^error
27555 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
27556 the corresponding error message.
27557
27558 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
27559 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
27560 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
27561
27562 @table @samp
27563 @item "undefined-command"
27564 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
27565 @end table
27566
27567 @item "^exit"
27568 @findex ^exit
27569 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
27570
27571 @end table
27572
27573 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
27574 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
27575
27576 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
27577 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27578 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
27579 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
27580 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
27581
27582 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
27583 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
27584 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
27585 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
27586 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
27587
27588 @table @code
27589 @item "~" @var{string-output}
27590 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
27591 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
27592
27593 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
27594 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
27595 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
27596 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
27597
27598 @item "&" @var{string-output}
27599 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
27600 internals.
27601 @end table
27602
27603 @node GDB/MI Async Records
27604 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
27605
27606 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27607 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
27608 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
27609 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
27610 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
27611 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
27612
27613 The following is the list of possible async records:
27614
27615 @table @code
27616
27617 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
27618 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
27619 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
27620 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
27621 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
27622 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
27623 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
27624 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
27625 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
27626 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
27627 it run freely.
27628
27629 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
27630 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
27631 following values:
27632
27633 @table @code
27634 @item breakpoint-hit
27635 A breakpoint was reached.
27636 @item watchpoint-trigger
27637 A watchpoint was triggered.
27638 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
27639 A read watchpoint was triggered.
27640 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
27641 An access watchpoint was triggered.
27642 @item function-finished
27643 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27644 @item location-reached
27645 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27646 @item watchpoint-scope
27647 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
27648 @item end-stepping-range
27649 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
27650 similar CLI command was accomplished.
27651 @item exited-signalled
27652 The inferior exited because of a signal.
27653 @item exited
27654 The inferior exited.
27655 @item exited-normally
27656 The inferior exited normally.
27657 @item signal-received
27658 A signal was received by the inferior.
27659 @item solib-event
27660 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
27661 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
27662 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
27663 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
27664 @item fork
27665 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
27666 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27667 @item vfork
27668 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
27669 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27670 @item syscall-entry
27671 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
27672 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27673 @item syscall-return
27674 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
27675 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27676 @item exec
27677 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
27678 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27679 @end table
27680
27681 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
27682 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
27683 Depending on whether all-stop
27684 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
27685 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
27686 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
27687 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
27688 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
27689 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
27690 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
27691 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
27692 if such information is not available.
27693
27694 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
27695 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
27696 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
27697 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
27698 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
27699 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
27700 cannot be used in any way.
27701
27702 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
27703 A thread group became associated with a running program,
27704 either because the program was just started or the thread group
27705 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
27706 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
27707 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
27708
27709 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
27710 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
27711 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
27712 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
27713 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
27714 only when the inferior exited with some code.
27715
27716 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27717 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27718 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
27719 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
27720 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
27721
27722 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
27723 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
27724 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
27725 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
27726 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
27727 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
27728 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
27729 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
27730 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
27731
27732 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
27733 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
27734
27735 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
27736 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
27737 that thread.
27738
27739 @item =library-loaded,...
27740 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
27741 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
27742 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
27743 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
27744 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
27745 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
27746 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
27747 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
27748 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
27749 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
27750 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
27751 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
27752 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
27753 to this library.
27754
27755 @item =library-unloaded,...
27756 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
27757 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
27758 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
27759 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
27760 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
27761 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
27762 thread groups.
27763
27764 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
27765 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
27766 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
27767 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
27768 frame is @var{tpnum}.
27769
27770 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
27771 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
27772 initial value @var{initial}.
27773
27774 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
27775 @itemx =tsv-deleted
27776 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
27777 trace state variables are deleted.
27778
27779 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
27780 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
27781 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
27782 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
27783 value of trace state variable is known.
27784
27785 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
27786 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
27787 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
27788 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
27789 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
27790 user.
27791
27792 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
27793 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
27794 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
27795
27796 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
27797 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
27798
27799 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
27800 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
27801 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
27802 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
27803 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
27804
27805 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
27806 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
27807 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
27808 for existing method and format values.
27809
27810 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
27811 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
27812 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
27813 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
27814 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
27815 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
27816
27817 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
27818 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
27819 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
27820 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
27821 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
27822 executable code.
27823 @end table
27824
27825 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
27826 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
27827
27828 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
27829 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
27830 following fields:
27831
27832 @table @code
27833 @item number
27834 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
27835 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
27836 @samp{1.2}.
27837
27838 @item type
27839 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
27840 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
27841
27842 @item catch-type
27843 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
27844 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
27845
27846 @item disp
27847 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
27848 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
27849 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
27850
27851 @item enabled
27852 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
27853 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
27854 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
27855
27856 @item addr
27857 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
27858 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
27859 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
27860 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
27861 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
27862
27863 @item func
27864 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
27865 If not known, this field is not present.
27866
27867 @item filename
27868 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
27869 If not known, this field is not present.
27870
27871 @item fullname
27872 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
27873 known. If not known, this field is not present.
27874
27875 @item line
27876 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
27877 If not known, this field is not present.
27878
27879 @item at
27880 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
27881 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
27882 by a symbol name.
27883
27884 @item pending
27885 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
27886 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
27887
27888 @item evaluated-by
27889 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
27890 @samp{target}.
27891
27892 @item thread
27893 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
27894 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
27895
27896 @item task
27897 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
27898 field will hold the task identifier.
27899
27900 @item cond
27901 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
27902
27903 @item ignore
27904 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
27905
27906 @item enable
27907 The enable count of the breakpoint.
27908
27909 @item traceframe-usage
27910 FIXME.
27911
27912 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
27913 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
27914
27915 @item mask
27916 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
27917
27918 @item pass
27919 A tracepoint's pass count.
27920
27921 @item original-location
27922 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
27923 This field is optional.
27924
27925 @item times
27926 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
27927
27928 @item installed
27929 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
27930 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
27931 is not.
27932
27933 @item what
27934 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
27935
27936 @end table
27937
27938 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
27939 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
27940
27941 @smallexample
27942 -> -break-insert main
27943 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27944 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27945 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27946 times="0"@}
27947 <- (gdb)
27948 @end smallexample
27949
27950 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
27951 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
27952
27953 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
27954 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
27955 fields:
27956
27957 @table @code
27958 @item level
27959 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
27960 zero. This field is always present.
27961
27962 @item func
27963 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
27964 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
27965
27966 @item addr
27967 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
27968
27969 @item file
27970 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
27971 address. This field may be absent.
27972
27973 @item line
27974 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
27975 may be absent.
27976
27977 @item from
27978 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
27979 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
27980
27981 @end table
27982
27983 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
27984 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
27985
27986 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
27987 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
27988 stated otherwise.
27989
27990 @table @code
27991 @item id
27992 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
27993
27994 @item target-id
27995 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
27996
27997 @item details
27998 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
27999 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
28000 frontend. This field is optional.
28001
28002 @item name
28003 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
28004 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
28005 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
28006 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
28007 field is omitted.
28008
28009 @item state
28010 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
28011 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
28012
28013 @item frame
28014 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
28015 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
28016 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
28017
28018 @item core
28019 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
28020 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
28021 @end table
28022
28023 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
28024 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
28025
28026 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
28027 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
28028 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
28029 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
28030 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
28031 the @code{exception-message} field.
28032
28033 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28034 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
28035 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
28036 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
28037
28038 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
28039 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
28040 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
28041 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
28042
28043 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
28044 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
28045
28046 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
28047
28048 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
28049 information of the breakpoint.
28050
28051 @smallexample
28052 -> -break-insert main
28053 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28054 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28055 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28056 times="0"@}
28057 <- (gdb)
28058 @end smallexample
28059
28060 @subheading Program Execution
28061
28062 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
28063 reason that execution stopped.
28064
28065 @smallexample
28066 -> -exec-run
28067 <- ^running
28068 <- (gdb)
28069 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
28070 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
28071 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
28072 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
28073 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28074 <- (gdb)
28075 -> -exec-continue
28076 <- ^running
28077 <- (gdb)
28078 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28079 <- (gdb)
28080 @end smallexample
28081
28082 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
28083
28084 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
28085
28086 @smallexample
28087 -> (gdb)
28088 <- -gdb-exit
28089 <- ^exit
28090 @end smallexample
28091
28092 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
28093 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
28094 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
28095 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
28096 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
28097 fails to exit in reasonable time.
28098
28099 @subheading A Bad Command
28100
28101 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
28102
28103 @smallexample
28104 -> -rubbish
28105 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
28106 <- (gdb)
28107 @end smallexample
28108
28109
28110 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28111 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
28112 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
28113
28114 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
28115 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
28116
28117 @subheading Motivation
28118
28119 The motivation for this collection of commands.
28120
28121 @subheading Introduction
28122
28123 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
28124
28125 @subheading Commands
28126
28127 For each command in the block, the following is described:
28128
28129 @subsubheading Synopsis
28130
28131 @smallexample
28132 -command @var{args}@dots{}
28133 @end smallexample
28134
28135 @subsubheading Result
28136
28137 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28138
28139 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
28140
28141 @subsubheading Example
28142
28143 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
28144 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
28145
28146
28147 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28148 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
28149 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
28150
28151 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
28152 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
28153 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28154 breakpoints.
28155
28156 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
28157 @findex -break-after
28158
28159 @subsubheading Synopsis
28160
28161 @smallexample
28162 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
28163 @end smallexample
28164
28165 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
28166 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
28167 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
28168 @samp{-break-list} command below.
28169
28170 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28171
28172 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
28173
28174 @subsubheading Example
28175
28176 @smallexample
28177 (gdb)
28178 -break-insert main
28179 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28180 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28181 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28182 times="0"@}
28183 (gdb)
28184 -break-after 1 3
28185 ~
28186 ^done
28187 (gdb)
28188 -break-list
28189 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28190 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28191 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28192 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28193 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28194 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28195 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28196 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28197 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28198 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28199 (gdb)
28200 @end smallexample
28201
28202 @ignore
28203 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
28204 @findex -break-catch
28205 @end ignore
28206
28207 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
28208 @findex -break-commands
28209
28210 @subsubheading Synopsis
28211
28212 @smallexample
28213 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
28214 @end smallexample
28215
28216 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
28217 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
28218 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
28219 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
28220 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
28221 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
28222
28223 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28224
28225 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
28226
28227 @subsubheading Example
28228
28229 @smallexample
28230 (gdb)
28231 -break-insert main
28232 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28233 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28234 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28235 times="0"@}
28236 (gdb)
28237 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
28238 ^done
28239 (gdb)
28240 @end smallexample
28241
28242 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
28243 @findex -break-condition
28244
28245 @subsubheading Synopsis
28246
28247 @smallexample
28248 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
28249 @end smallexample
28250
28251 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
28252 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
28253 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
28254 command below).
28255
28256 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28257
28258 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
28259
28260 @subsubheading Example
28261
28262 @smallexample
28263 (gdb)
28264 -break-condition 1 1
28265 ^done
28266 (gdb)
28267 -break-list
28268 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28269 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28270 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28271 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28272 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28273 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28274 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28275 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28276 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28277 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28278 (gdb)
28279 @end smallexample
28280
28281 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
28282 @findex -break-delete
28283
28284 @subsubheading Synopsis
28285
28286 @smallexample
28287 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28288 @end smallexample
28289
28290 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
28291 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
28292
28293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28294
28295 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
28296
28297 @subsubheading Example
28298
28299 @smallexample
28300 (gdb)
28301 -break-delete 1
28302 ^done
28303 (gdb)
28304 -break-list
28305 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28306 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28307 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28308 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28309 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28310 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28311 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28312 body=[]@}
28313 (gdb)
28314 @end smallexample
28315
28316 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
28317 @findex -break-disable
28318
28319 @subsubheading Synopsis
28320
28321 @smallexample
28322 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28323 @end smallexample
28324
28325 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
28326 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
28327
28328 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28329
28330 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
28331
28332 @subsubheading Example
28333
28334 @smallexample
28335 (gdb)
28336 -break-disable 2
28337 ^done
28338 (gdb)
28339 -break-list
28340 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28341 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28342 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28343 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28344 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28345 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28346 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28347 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28348 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28349 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28350 (gdb)
28351 @end smallexample
28352
28353 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
28354 @findex -break-enable
28355
28356 @subsubheading Synopsis
28357
28358 @smallexample
28359 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28360 @end smallexample
28361
28362 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
28363
28364 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28365
28366 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
28367
28368 @subsubheading Example
28369
28370 @smallexample
28371 (gdb)
28372 -break-enable 2
28373 ^done
28374 (gdb)
28375 -break-list
28376 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28377 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28378 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28379 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28380 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28381 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28382 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28383 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28384 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28385 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28386 (gdb)
28387 @end smallexample
28388
28389 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
28390 @findex -break-info
28391
28392 @subsubheading Synopsis
28393
28394 @smallexample
28395 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
28396 @end smallexample
28397
28398 @c REDUNDANT???
28399 Get information about a single breakpoint.
28400
28401 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
28402 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
28403 table.
28404
28405 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28406
28407 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
28408
28409 @subsubheading Example
28410 N.A.
28411
28412 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
28413 @findex -break-insert
28414 @anchor{-break-insert}
28415
28416 @subsubheading Synopsis
28417
28418 @smallexample
28419 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
28420 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28421 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
28422 @end smallexample
28423
28424 @noindent
28425 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
28426
28427 @table @var
28428 @item linespec location
28429 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
28430
28431 @item explicit location
28432 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
28433 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
28434 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
28435
28436 @table @samp
28437 @item --source @var{filename}
28438 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
28439 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
28440
28441 @item --function @var{function}
28442 The name of a function or method.
28443
28444 @item --label @var{label}
28445 The name of a label.
28446
28447 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
28448 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
28449 @end table
28450
28451 @item address location
28452 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
28453 @end table
28454
28455 @noindent
28456 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28457
28458 @table @samp
28459 @item -t
28460 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28461 @item -h
28462 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
28463 @item -f
28464 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
28465 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28466 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28467 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28468 cannot be parsed.
28469 @item -d
28470 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28471 @item -a
28472 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
28473 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
28474 @item -c @var{condition}
28475 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28476 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28477 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
28478 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28479 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28480 @var{thread-id}.
28481 @end table
28482
28483 @subsubheading Result
28484
28485 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28486 resulting breakpoint.
28487
28488 Note: this format is open to change.
28489 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28490
28491 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28492
28493 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
28494 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
28495
28496 @subsubheading Example
28497
28498 @smallexample
28499 (gdb)
28500 -break-insert main
28501 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
28502 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28503 times="0"@}
28504 (gdb)
28505 -break-insert -t foo
28506 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
28507 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28508 times="0"@}
28509 (gdb)
28510 -break-list
28511 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28512 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28513 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28514 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28515 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28516 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28517 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28518 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28519 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
28520 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28521 times="0"@},
28522 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28523 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
28524 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28525 times="0"@}]@}
28526 (gdb)
28527 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
28528 @c ~int foo(int, int);
28529 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
28530 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28531 @c times="0"@}
28532 @c (gdb)
28533 @end smallexample
28534
28535 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
28536 @findex -dprintf-insert
28537
28538 @subsubheading Synopsis
28539
28540 @smallexample
28541 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
28542 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28543 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
28544 [ @var{argument} ]
28545 @end smallexample
28546
28547 @noindent
28548 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
28549 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
28550
28551 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28552
28553 @table @samp
28554 @item -t
28555 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28556 @item -f
28557 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
28558 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28559 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28560 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28561 cannot be parsed.
28562 @item -d
28563 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28564 @item -c @var{condition}
28565 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28566 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28567 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
28568 to @var{ignore-count}.
28569 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28570 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28571 @var{thread-id}.
28572 @end table
28573
28574 @subsubheading Result
28575
28576 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28577 resulting breakpoint.
28578
28579 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28580
28581 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28582
28583 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
28584
28585 @subsubheading Example
28586
28587 @smallexample
28588 (gdb)
28589 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
28590 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28591 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28592 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
28593 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
28594 original-location="foo"@}
28595 (gdb)
28596 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
28597 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28598 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28599 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
28600 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
28601 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
28602 (gdb)
28603 @end smallexample
28604
28605 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
28606 @findex -break-list
28607
28608 @subsubheading Synopsis
28609
28610 @smallexample
28611 -break-list
28612 @end smallexample
28613
28614 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
28615
28616 @table @samp
28617 @item Number
28618 number of the breakpoint
28619 @item Type
28620 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
28621 @item Disposition
28622 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
28623 or @samp{nokeep}
28624 @item Enabled
28625 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
28626 @item Address
28627 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
28628 @item What
28629 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
28630 name, line number
28631 @item Thread-groups
28632 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
28633 @item Times
28634 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
28635 @end table
28636
28637 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
28638 @code{body} field is an empty list.
28639
28640 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28641
28642 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
28643
28644 @subsubheading Example
28645
28646 @smallexample
28647 (gdb)
28648 -break-list
28649 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28650 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28651 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28652 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28653 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28654 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28655 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28656 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28657 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28658 times="0"@},
28659 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28660 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28661 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28662 (gdb)
28663 @end smallexample
28664
28665 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
28666
28667 @smallexample
28668 (gdb)
28669 -break-list
28670 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28671 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28672 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28673 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28674 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28675 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28676 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28677 body=[]@}
28678 (gdb)
28679 @end smallexample
28680
28681 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
28682 @findex -break-passcount
28683
28684 @subsubheading Synopsis
28685
28686 @smallexample
28687 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
28688 @end smallexample
28689
28690 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
28691 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
28692 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
28693 command @samp{passcount}.
28694
28695 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
28696 @findex -break-watch
28697
28698 @subsubheading Synopsis
28699
28700 @smallexample
28701 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
28702 @end smallexample
28703
28704 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
28705 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
28706 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
28707 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
28708 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
28709 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
28710 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
28711 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
28712
28713 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
28714 breakpoints inserted.
28715
28716 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28717
28718 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
28719 @samp{rwatch}.
28720
28721 @subsubheading Example
28722
28723 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
28724
28725 @smallexample
28726 (gdb)
28727 -break-watch x
28728 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
28729 (gdb)
28730 -exec-continue
28731 ^running
28732 (gdb)
28733 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
28734 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
28735 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28736 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28737 (gdb)
28738 @end smallexample
28739
28740 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
28741 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
28742 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
28743
28744 @smallexample
28745 (gdb)
28746 -break-watch C
28747 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
28748 (gdb)
28749 -exec-continue
28750 ^running
28751 (gdb)
28752 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
28753 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28754 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28755 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28756 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
28757 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28758 (gdb)
28759 -exec-continue
28760 ^running
28761 (gdb)
28762 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
28763 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28764 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28765 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28766 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
28767 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28768 (gdb)
28769 @end smallexample
28770
28771 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
28772 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
28773 deleted.
28774
28775 @smallexample
28776 (gdb)
28777 -break-watch C
28778 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
28779 (gdb)
28780 -break-list
28781 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28782 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28783 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28784 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28785 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28786 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28787 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28788 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28789 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28790 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28791 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28792 times="1"@},
28793 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28794 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28795 (gdb)
28796 -exec-continue
28797 ^running
28798 (gdb)
28799 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
28800 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28801 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28802 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28803 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
28804 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28805 (gdb)
28806 -break-list
28807 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28808 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28809 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28810 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28811 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28812 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28813 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28814 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28815 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28816 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28817 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28818 times="1"@},
28819 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28820 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
28821 (gdb)
28822 -exec-continue
28823 ^running
28824 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
28825 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28826 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28827 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28828 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
28829 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28830 (gdb)
28831 -break-list
28832 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28833 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28834 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28835 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28836 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28837 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28838 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28839 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28840 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28841 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28842 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
28843 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
28844 (gdb)
28845 @end smallexample
28846
28847
28848 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28849 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28850 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
28851
28852 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28853 catchpoints.
28854
28855 @menu
28856 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28857 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28858 @end menu
28859
28860 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28861 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28862
28863 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
28864 @findex -catch-load
28865
28866 @subsubheading Synopsis
28867
28868 @smallexample
28869 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28870 @end smallexample
28871
28872 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
28873 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28874 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
28875 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28876 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
28877
28878
28879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28880
28881 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
28882
28883 @subsubheading Example
28884
28885 @smallexample
28886 -catch-load -t foo.so
28887 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28888 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
28889 (gdb)
28890 @end smallexample
28891
28892
28893 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
28894 @findex -catch-unload
28895
28896 @subsubheading Synopsis
28897
28898 @smallexample
28899 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28900 @end smallexample
28901
28902 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
28903 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28904 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
28905 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28906 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
28907
28908 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28909
28910 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
28911
28912 @subsubheading Example
28913
28914 @smallexample
28915 -catch-unload -d bar.so
28916 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28917 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
28918 (gdb)
28919 @end smallexample
28920
28921 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28922 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28923
28924 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
28925 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
28926
28927 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
28928 @findex -catch-assert
28929
28930 @subsubheading Synopsis
28931
28932 @smallexample
28933 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
28934 @end smallexample
28935
28936 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
28937
28938 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28939
28940 @table @samp
28941 @item -c @var{condition}
28942 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28943 @item -d
28944 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28945 @item -t
28946 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28947 @end table
28948
28949 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28950
28951 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
28952
28953 @subsubheading Example
28954
28955 @smallexample
28956 -catch-assert
28957 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28958 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
28959 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
28960 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
28961 (gdb)
28962 @end smallexample
28963
28964 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
28965 @findex -catch-exception
28966
28967 @subsubheading Synopsis
28968
28969 @smallexample
28970 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28971 [ -t ] [ -u ]
28972 @end smallexample
28973
28974 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
28975 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28976 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28977 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28978 catchpoints.
28979
28980 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28981
28982 @table @samp
28983 @item -c @var{condition}
28984 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28985 @item -d
28986 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28987 @item -e @var{exception-name}
28988 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
28989 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
28990 @item -t
28991 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28992 @item -u
28993 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
28994 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
28995 @end table
28996
28997 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28998
28999 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
29000 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
29001
29002 @subsubheading Example
29003
29004 @smallexample
29005 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
29006 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29007 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
29008 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
29009 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
29010 (gdb)
29011 @end smallexample
29012
29013 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
29014 @findex -catch-handlers
29015
29016 @subsubheading Synopsis
29017
29018 @smallexample
29019 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29020 [ -t ]
29021 @end smallexample
29022
29023 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
29024 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29025 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29026 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29027 catchpoints.
29028
29029 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29030
29031 @table @samp
29032 @item -c @var{condition}
29033 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29034 @item -d
29035 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29036 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29037 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
29038 @item -t
29039 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29040 @end table
29041
29042 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29043
29044 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
29045
29046 @subsubheading Example
29047
29048 @smallexample
29049 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
29050 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29051 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
29052 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
29053 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
29054 (gdb)
29055 @end smallexample
29056
29057 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29058 @node GDB/MI Program Context
29059 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
29060
29061 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
29062 @findex -exec-arguments
29063
29064
29065 @subsubheading Synopsis
29066
29067 @smallexample
29068 -exec-arguments @var{args}
29069 @end smallexample
29070
29071 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
29072 @samp{-exec-run}.
29073
29074 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29075
29076 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
29077
29078 @subsubheading Example
29079
29080 @smallexample
29081 (gdb)
29082 -exec-arguments -v word
29083 ^done
29084 (gdb)
29085 @end smallexample
29086
29087
29088 @ignore
29089 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
29090 @findex -exec-show-arguments
29091
29092 @subsubheading Synopsis
29093
29094 @smallexample
29095 -exec-show-arguments
29096 @end smallexample
29097
29098 Print the arguments of the program.
29099
29100 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29101
29102 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
29103
29104 @subsubheading Example
29105 N.A.
29106 @end ignore
29107
29108
29109 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
29110 @findex -environment-cd
29111
29112 @subsubheading Synopsis
29113
29114 @smallexample
29115 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
29116 @end smallexample
29117
29118 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
29119
29120 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29121
29122 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
29123
29124 @subsubheading Example
29125
29126 @smallexample
29127 (gdb)
29128 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29129 ^done
29130 (gdb)
29131 @end smallexample
29132
29133
29134 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
29135 @findex -environment-directory
29136
29137 @subsubheading Synopsis
29138
29139 @smallexample
29140 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29141 @end smallexample
29142
29143 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
29144 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
29145 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
29146 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29147 occurs as normal.
29148 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29149 multiple directories in a single command
29150 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29151 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29152 If blanks are needed as
29153 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29154 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29155 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29156 character must not be used
29157 in any directory name.
29158 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
29159
29160 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29161
29162 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
29163
29164 @subsubheading Example
29165
29166 @smallexample
29167 (gdb)
29168 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29169 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29170 (gdb)
29171 -environment-directory ""
29172 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29173 (gdb)
29174 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
29175 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
29176 (gdb)
29177 -environment-directory -r
29178 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
29179 (gdb)
29180 @end smallexample
29181
29182
29183 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
29184 @findex -environment-path
29185
29186 @subsubheading Synopsis
29187
29188 @smallexample
29189 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29190 @end smallexample
29191
29192 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
29193 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
29194 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
29195 supplied in addition to the
29196 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29197 occurs as normal.
29198 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29199 multiple directories in a single command
29200 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29201 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29202 If blanks are needed as
29203 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29204 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29205 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29206 character must not be used
29207 in any directory name.
29208 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
29209
29210
29211 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29212
29213 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
29214
29215 @subsubheading Example
29216
29217 @smallexample
29218 (gdb)
29219 -environment-path
29220 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
29221 (gdb)
29222 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
29223 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
29224 (gdb)
29225 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
29226 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
29227 (gdb)
29228 @end smallexample
29229
29230
29231 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
29232 @findex -environment-pwd
29233
29234 @subsubheading Synopsis
29235
29236 @smallexample
29237 -environment-pwd
29238 @end smallexample
29239
29240 Show the current working directory.
29241
29242 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29243
29244 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
29245
29246 @subsubheading Example
29247
29248 @smallexample
29249 (gdb)
29250 -environment-pwd
29251 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
29252 (gdb)
29253 @end smallexample
29254
29255 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29256 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
29257 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
29258
29259
29260 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
29261 @findex -thread-info
29262
29263 @subsubheading Synopsis
29264
29265 @smallexample
29266 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
29267 @end smallexample
29268
29269 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
29270 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
29271 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
29272 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
29273 current thread.
29274
29275 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29276
29277 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
29278 about all threads.
29279
29280 @subsubheading Result
29281
29282 The result contains the following attributes:
29283
29284 @table @samp
29285 @item threads
29286 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
29287 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
29288
29289 @item current-thread-id
29290 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
29291 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
29292 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
29293 the command.
29294
29295 @end table
29296
29297 @subsubheading Example
29298
29299 @smallexample
29300 -thread-info
29301 ^done,threads=[
29302 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29303 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
29304 args=[]@},state="running"@},
29305 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29306 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
29307 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29308 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29309 state="running"@}],
29310 current-thread-id="1"
29311 (gdb)
29312 @end smallexample
29313
29314 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
29315 @findex -thread-list-ids
29316
29317 @subsubheading Synopsis
29318
29319 @smallexample
29320 -thread-list-ids
29321 @end smallexample
29322
29323 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
29324 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
29325 threads.
29326
29327 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
29328 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
29329
29330 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29331
29332 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
29333
29334 @subsubheading Example
29335
29336 @smallexample
29337 (gdb)
29338 -thread-list-ids
29339 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29340 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
29341 (gdb)
29342 @end smallexample
29343
29344
29345 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
29346 @findex -thread-select
29347
29348 @subsubheading Synopsis
29349
29350 @smallexample
29351 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
29352 @end smallexample
29353
29354 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
29355 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
29356 topmost frame for that thread.
29357
29358 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
29359 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
29360
29361 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29362
29363 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
29364
29365 @subsubheading Example
29366
29367 @smallexample
29368 (gdb)
29369 -exec-next
29370 ^running
29371 (gdb)
29372 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
29373 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
29374 (gdb)
29375 -thread-list-ids
29376 ^done,
29377 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29378 number-of-threads="3"
29379 (gdb)
29380 -thread-select 3
29381 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
29382 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
29383 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
29384 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29385 (gdb)
29386 @end smallexample
29387
29388 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29389 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
29390 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
29391
29392 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
29393 @findex -ada-task-info
29394
29395 @subsubheading Synopsis
29396
29397 @smallexample
29398 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
29399 @end smallexample
29400
29401 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
29402 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
29403
29404 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29405
29406 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
29407 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
29408
29409 @subsubheading Result
29410
29411 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
29412 defined for each Ada task:
29413
29414 @table @samp
29415 @item current
29416 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
29417
29418 @item id
29419 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
29420
29421 @item task-id
29422 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
29423
29424 @item thread-id
29425 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
29426 task.
29427
29428 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
29429 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
29430 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
29431
29432 @item parent-id
29433 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
29434 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
29435
29436 @item priority
29437 The base priority of the task.
29438
29439 @item state
29440 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
29441 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
29442
29443 @item name
29444 The name of the task.
29445
29446 @end table
29447
29448 @subsubheading Example
29449
29450 @smallexample
29451 -ada-task-info
29452 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
29453 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
29454 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
29455 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
29456 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
29457 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
29458 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
29459 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
29460 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
29461 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
29462 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
29463 (gdb)
29464 @end smallexample
29465
29466 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29467 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
29468 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
29469
29470 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
29471 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
29472 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
29473 other cases.
29474
29475 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
29476 @findex -exec-continue
29477
29478 @subsubheading Synopsis
29479
29480 @smallexample
29481 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
29482 @end smallexample
29483
29484 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
29485 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
29486 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
29487 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
29488 @itemize @bullet
29489 @item
29490 breakpoints or watchpoints
29491 @item
29492 signals or exceptions
29493 @item
29494 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
29495 @item
29496 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
29497 @end itemize
29498 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
29499 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
29500 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
29501 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
29502 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
29503 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
29504
29505 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29506
29507 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
29508
29509 @subsubheading Example
29510
29511 @smallexample
29512 -exec-continue
29513 ^running
29514 (gdb)
29515 @@Hello world
29516 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
29517 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
29518 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29519 (gdb)
29520 @end smallexample
29521
29522
29523 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
29524 @findex -exec-finish
29525
29526 @subsubheading Synopsis
29527
29528 @smallexample
29529 -exec-finish [--reverse]
29530 @end smallexample
29531
29532 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
29533 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
29534 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
29535 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
29536 function was called.
29537
29538 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29539
29540 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
29541
29542 @subsubheading Example
29543
29544 Function returning @code{void}.
29545
29546 @smallexample
29547 -exec-finish
29548 ^running
29549 (gdb)
29550 @@hello from foo
29551 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29552 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29553 (gdb)
29554 @end smallexample
29555
29556 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
29557 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
29558 value itself.
29559
29560 @smallexample
29561 -exec-finish
29562 ^running
29563 (gdb)
29564 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
29565 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
29566 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
29567 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29568 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
29569 (gdb)
29570 @end smallexample
29571
29572
29573 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
29574 @findex -exec-interrupt
29575
29576 @subsubheading Synopsis
29577
29578 @smallexample
29579 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
29580 @end smallexample
29581
29582 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
29583 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
29584 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
29585 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
29586 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
29587
29588 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
29589 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
29590 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
29591 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
29592
29593 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
29594 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
29595 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
29596 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
29597
29598 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29599
29600 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
29601
29602 @subsubheading Example
29603
29604 @smallexample
29605 (gdb)
29606 111-exec-continue
29607 111^running
29608
29609 (gdb)
29610 222-exec-interrupt
29611 222^done
29612 (gdb)
29613 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
29614 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29615 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29616 (gdb)
29617
29618 (gdb)
29619 -exec-interrupt
29620 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
29621 (gdb)
29622 @end smallexample
29623
29624 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
29625 @findex -exec-jump
29626
29627 @subsubheading Synopsis
29628
29629 @smallexample
29630 -exec-jump @var{location}
29631 @end smallexample
29632
29633 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
29634 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
29635 different forms of @var{location}.
29636
29637 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29638
29639 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
29640
29641 @subsubheading Example
29642
29643 @smallexample
29644 -exec-jump foo.c:10
29645 *running,thread-id="all"
29646 ^running
29647 @end smallexample
29648
29649
29650 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
29651 @findex -exec-next
29652
29653 @subsubheading Synopsis
29654
29655 @smallexample
29656 -exec-next [--reverse]
29657 @end smallexample
29658
29659 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29660 of the next source line is reached.
29661
29662 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29663 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
29664 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
29665 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
29666 source line where the function was called.
29667
29668
29669 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29670
29671 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
29672
29673 @subsubheading Example
29674
29675 @smallexample
29676 -exec-next
29677 ^running
29678 (gdb)
29679 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
29680 (gdb)
29681 @end smallexample
29682
29683
29684 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
29685 @findex -exec-next-instruction
29686
29687 @subsubheading Synopsis
29688
29689 @smallexample
29690 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
29691 @end smallexample
29692
29693 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
29694 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
29695 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
29696 printed as well.
29697
29698 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29699 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
29700 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
29701 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
29702 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
29703
29704 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29705
29706 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
29707
29708 @subsubheading Example
29709
29710 @smallexample
29711 (gdb)
29712 -exec-next-instruction
29713 ^running
29714
29715 (gdb)
29716 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29717 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
29718 (gdb)
29719 @end smallexample
29720
29721
29722 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
29723 @findex -exec-return
29724
29725 @subsubheading Synopsis
29726
29727 @smallexample
29728 -exec-return
29729 @end smallexample
29730
29731 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
29732 Displays the new current frame.
29733
29734 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29735
29736 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
29737
29738 @subsubheading Example
29739
29740 @smallexample
29741 (gdb)
29742 200-break-insert callee4
29743 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
29744 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
29745 (gdb)
29746 000-exec-run
29747 000^running
29748 (gdb)
29749 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29750 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29751 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29752 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
29753 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29754 (gdb)
29755 205-break-delete
29756 205^done
29757 (gdb)
29758 111-exec-return
29759 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
29760 args=[@{name="strarg",
29761 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29762 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29763 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29764 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29765 (gdb)
29766 @end smallexample
29767
29768
29769 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
29770 @findex -exec-run
29771
29772 @subsubheading Synopsis
29773
29774 @smallexample
29775 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
29776 @end smallexample
29777
29778 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
29779 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
29780 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
29781 the program has exited exceptionally.
29782
29783 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
29784 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
29785 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
29786 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
29787 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
29788
29789 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
29790 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
29791 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
29792 (@pxref{Starting}).
29793
29794 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29795
29796 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
29797
29798 @subsubheading Examples
29799
29800 @smallexample
29801 (gdb)
29802 -break-insert main
29803 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
29804 (gdb)
29805 -exec-run
29806 ^running
29807 (gdb)
29808 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29809 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29810 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29811 (gdb)
29812 @end smallexample
29813
29814 @noindent
29815 Program exited normally:
29816
29817 @smallexample
29818 (gdb)
29819 -exec-run
29820 ^running
29821 (gdb)
29822 x = 55
29823 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
29824 (gdb)
29825 @end smallexample
29826
29827 @noindent
29828 Program exited exceptionally:
29829
29830 @smallexample
29831 (gdb)
29832 -exec-run
29833 ^running
29834 (gdb)
29835 x = 55
29836 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
29837 (gdb)
29838 @end smallexample
29839
29840 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
29841 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
29842
29843 @smallexample
29844 (gdb)
29845 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
29846 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
29847 @end smallexample
29848
29849
29850 @c @subheading -exec-signal
29851
29852
29853 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
29854 @findex -exec-step
29855
29856 @subsubheading Synopsis
29857
29858 @smallexample
29859 -exec-step [--reverse]
29860 @end smallexample
29861
29862 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29863 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
29864 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
29865 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
29866 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
29867 previously executed source line.
29868
29869 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29870
29871 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
29872
29873 @subsubheading Example
29874
29875 Stepping into a function:
29876
29877 @smallexample
29878 -exec-step
29879 ^running
29880 (gdb)
29881 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29882 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
29883 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
29884 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29885 (gdb)
29886 @end smallexample
29887
29888 Regular stepping:
29889
29890 @smallexample
29891 -exec-step
29892 ^running
29893 (gdb)
29894 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
29895 (gdb)
29896 @end smallexample
29897
29898
29899 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
29900 @findex -exec-step-instruction
29901
29902 @subsubheading Synopsis
29903
29904 @smallexample
29905 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
29906 @end smallexample
29907
29908 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
29909 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
29910 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
29911 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
29912 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
29913 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
29914 as well.
29915
29916 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29917
29918 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
29919
29920 @subsubheading Example
29921
29922 @smallexample
29923 (gdb)
29924 -exec-step-instruction
29925 ^running
29926
29927 (gdb)
29928 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29929 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29930 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29931 (gdb)
29932 -exec-step-instruction
29933 ^running
29934
29935 (gdb)
29936 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29937 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29938 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29939 (gdb)
29940 @end smallexample
29941
29942
29943 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
29944 @findex -exec-until
29945
29946 @subsubheading Synopsis
29947
29948 @smallexample
29949 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
29950 @end smallexample
29951
29952 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
29953 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
29954 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
29955 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
29956
29957 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29958
29959 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
29960
29961 @subsubheading Example
29962
29963 @smallexample
29964 (gdb)
29965 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
29966 ^running
29967 (gdb)
29968 x = 55
29969 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29970 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
29971 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29972 (gdb)
29973 @end smallexample
29974
29975 @ignore
29976 @subheading -file-clear
29977 Is this going away????
29978 @end ignore
29979
29980 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29981 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
29982 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
29983
29984 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
29985 @findex -enable-frame-filters
29986
29987 @smallexample
29988 -enable-frame-filters
29989 @end smallexample
29990
29991 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
29992 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
29993 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29994 request that this functionality be enabled.
29995
29996 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29997
29998 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29999 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30000
30001 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
30002 @findex -stack-info-frame
30003
30004 @subsubheading Synopsis
30005
30006 @smallexample
30007 -stack-info-frame
30008 @end smallexample
30009
30010 Get info on the selected frame.
30011
30012 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30013
30014 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
30015 (without arguments).
30016
30017 @subsubheading Example
30018
30019 @smallexample
30020 (gdb)
30021 -stack-info-frame
30022 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30023 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30024 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30025 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30026 (gdb)
30027 @end smallexample
30028
30029 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
30030 @findex -stack-info-depth
30031
30032 @subsubheading Synopsis
30033
30034 @smallexample
30035 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
30036 @end smallexample
30037
30038 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
30039 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
30040
30041 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30042
30043 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30044
30045 @subsubheading Example
30046
30047 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
30048
30049 @smallexample
30050 (gdb)
30051 -stack-info-depth
30052 ^done,depth="12"
30053 (gdb)
30054 -stack-info-depth 4
30055 ^done,depth="4"
30056 (gdb)
30057 -stack-info-depth 12
30058 ^done,depth="12"
30059 (gdb)
30060 -stack-info-depth 11
30061 ^done,depth="11"
30062 (gdb)
30063 -stack-info-depth 13
30064 ^done,depth="12"
30065 (gdb)
30066 @end smallexample
30067
30068 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
30069 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
30070 @findex -stack-list-arguments
30071
30072 @subsubheading Synopsis
30073
30074 @smallexample
30075 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30076 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30077 @end smallexample
30078
30079 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
30080 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
30081 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
30082 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
30083 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
30084 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
30085 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
30086 which case only existing frames will be returned.
30087
30088 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30089 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30090 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30091 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30092 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30093 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30094
30095 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
30096 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
30097 are still displayed, however.
30098
30099 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
30100 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30101
30102 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30103
30104 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
30105 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
30106 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
30107
30108 @subsubheading Example
30109
30110 @smallexample
30111 (gdb)
30112 -stack-list-frames
30113 ^done,
30114 stack=[
30115 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30116 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30117 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30118 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30119 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30120 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30121 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30122 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30123 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
30124 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30125 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
30126 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30127 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
30128 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30129 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
30130 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30131 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
30132 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30133 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
30134 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30135 (gdb)
30136 -stack-list-arguments 0
30137 ^done,
30138 stack-args=[
30139 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30140 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
30141 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
30142 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
30143 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30144 (gdb)
30145 -stack-list-arguments 1
30146 ^done,
30147 stack-args=[
30148 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30149 frame=@{level="1",
30150 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30151 frame=@{level="2",args=[
30152 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30153 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30154 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
30155 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30156 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
30157 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
30158 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30159 (gdb)
30160 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
30161 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
30162 (gdb)
30163 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
30164 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
30165 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30166 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
30167 (gdb)
30168 @end smallexample
30169
30170 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
30171
30172
30173 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
30174 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
30175 @findex -stack-list-frames
30176
30177 @subsubheading Synopsis
30178
30179 @smallexample
30180 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30181 @end smallexample
30182
30183 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
30184 following info:
30185
30186 @table @samp
30187 @item @var{level}
30188 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
30189 @item @var{addr}
30190 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
30191 @item @var{func}
30192 Function name.
30193 @item @var{file}
30194 File name of the source file where the function lives.
30195 @item @var{fullname}
30196 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
30197 @item @var{line}
30198 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
30199 @item @var{from}
30200 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
30201 if the frame's function is not known.
30202 @item @var{arch}
30203 Frame's architecture.
30204 @end table
30205
30206 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
30207 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
30208 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
30209 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
30210 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
30211 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
30212 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
30213 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30214 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30215
30216 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30217
30218 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
30219
30220 @subsubheading Example
30221
30222 Full stack backtrace:
30223
30224 @smallexample
30225 (gdb)
30226 -stack-list-frames
30227 ^done,stack=
30228 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
30229 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
30230 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30231 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30232 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30233 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30234 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30235 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30236 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30237 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30238 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30239 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30240 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30241 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30242 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30243 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30244 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30245 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30246 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30247 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30248 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30249 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30250 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30251 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30252 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30253 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30254 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30255 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30256 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30257 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30258 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30259 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30260 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30261 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
30262 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
30263 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30264 (gdb)
30265 @end smallexample
30266
30267 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
30268
30269 @smallexample
30270 (gdb)
30271 -stack-list-frames 3 5
30272 ^done,stack=
30273 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30274 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30275 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30276 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30277 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30278 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30279 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30280 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30281 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30282 (gdb)
30283 @end smallexample
30284
30285 Show a single frame:
30286
30287 @smallexample
30288 (gdb)
30289 -stack-list-frames 3 3
30290 ^done,stack=
30291 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30292 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30293 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30294 (gdb)
30295 @end smallexample
30296
30297
30298 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
30299 @findex -stack-list-locals
30300 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
30301
30302 @subsubheading Synopsis
30303
30304 @smallexample
30305 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30306 @end smallexample
30307
30308 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
30309 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30310 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30311 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30312 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30313 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
30314 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
30315 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
30316 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30317 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30318
30319 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30320 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
30321 variables are still displayed, however.
30322
30323 This command is deprecated in favor of the
30324 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30325
30326 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30327
30328 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
30329
30330 @subsubheading Example
30331
30332 @smallexample
30333 (gdb)
30334 -stack-list-locals 0
30335 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
30336 (gdb)
30337 -stack-list-locals --all-values
30338 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
30339 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
30340 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
30341 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
30342 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
30343 (gdb)
30344 @end smallexample
30345
30346 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
30347 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
30348 @findex -stack-list-variables
30349
30350 @subsubheading Synopsis
30351
30352 @smallexample
30353 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30354 @end smallexample
30355
30356 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
30357 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30358 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30359 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30360 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30361 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30362 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30363
30364 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30365 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
30366 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
30367
30368 @subsubheading Example
30369
30370 @smallexample
30371 (gdb)
30372 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
30373 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
30374 (gdb)
30375 @end smallexample
30376
30377
30378 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
30379 @findex -stack-select-frame
30380
30381 @subsubheading Synopsis
30382
30383 @smallexample
30384 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
30385 @end smallexample
30386
30387 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
30388 the stack.
30389
30390 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
30391 option to every command.
30392
30393 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30394
30395 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
30396 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
30397
30398 @subsubheading Example
30399
30400 @smallexample
30401 (gdb)
30402 -stack-select-frame 2
30403 ^done
30404 (gdb)
30405 @end smallexample
30406
30407 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30408 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
30409 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
30410
30411 @ignore
30412
30413 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30414
30415 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
30416 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
30417 used by @code{Insight}.
30418
30419 The two main reasons for that are:
30420
30421 @enumerate 1
30422 @item
30423 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
30424
30425 @item
30426 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
30427 now).
30428 @end enumerate
30429
30430 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
30431 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
30432 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
30433 hints about their use.
30434
30435 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
30436 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
30437 least, the following operations:
30438
30439 @itemize @bullet
30440 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
30441 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
30442 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
30443 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
30444 @end itemize
30445
30446 @end ignore
30447
30448 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
30449
30450 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30451
30452 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
30453 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
30454 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
30455 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
30456 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
30457 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
30458 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
30459 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
30460 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
30461 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
30462 object, or to change display format.
30463
30464 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
30465 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
30466 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
30467 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
30468 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
30469 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
30470 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
30471 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
30472 child will be created.
30473
30474 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
30475 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
30476 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
30477 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
30478 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
30479
30480 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
30481 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
30482 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
30483 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
30484 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
30485 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
30486 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
30487 variables that frontend has created.
30488
30489 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
30490 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
30491 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
30492 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
30493 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
30494 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
30495 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
30496 implicitly updated.
30497
30498 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
30499 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
30500 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
30501 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
30502 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
30503 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
30504 frame. Consider this example:
30505
30506 @smallexample
30507 void do_work(...)
30508 @{
30509 struct work_state state;
30510
30511 if (...)
30512 do_work(...);
30513 @}
30514 @end smallexample
30515
30516 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
30517 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
30518 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
30519 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
30520 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
30521
30522 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
30523 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
30524 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
30525 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
30526 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
30527 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
30528
30529 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
30530 access this functionality:
30531
30532 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
30533 @item @strong{Operation}
30534 @tab @strong{Description}
30535
30536 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
30537 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
30538 @item @code{-var-create}
30539 @tab create a variable object
30540 @item @code{-var-delete}
30541 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
30542 @item @code{-var-set-format}
30543 @tab set the display format of this variable
30544 @item @code{-var-show-format}
30545 @tab show the display format of this variable
30546 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
30547 @tab tells how many children this object has
30548 @item @code{-var-list-children}
30549 @tab return a list of the object's children
30550 @item @code{-var-info-type}
30551 @tab show the type of this variable object
30552 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
30553 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
30554 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
30555 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
30556 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
30557 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
30558 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
30559 @tab get the value of this variable
30560 @item @code{-var-assign}
30561 @tab set the value of this variable
30562 @item @code{-var-update}
30563 @tab update the variable and its children
30564 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
30565 @tab set frozeness attribute
30566 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
30567 @tab set range of children to display on update
30568 @end multitable
30569
30570 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
30571 how it can be used.
30572
30573 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
30574
30575 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
30576 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
30577
30578 @smallexample
30579 -enable-pretty-printing
30580 @end smallexample
30581
30582 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
30583 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
30584 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30585 request that this functionality be enabled.
30586
30587 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30588
30589 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30590 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30591
30592 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
30593 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
30594
30595 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
30596 @findex -var-create
30597
30598 @subsubheading Synopsis
30599
30600 @smallexample
30601 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
30602 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
30603 @end smallexample
30604
30605 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
30606 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
30607 register.
30608
30609 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
30610 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
30611 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
30612 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
30613 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
30614
30615 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
30616 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
30617 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
30618 object must be created.
30619
30620 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
30621 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
30622
30623 @itemize @bullet
30624 @item
30625 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
30626
30627 @item
30628 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
30629
30630 @item
30631 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
30632 @end itemize
30633
30634 @cindex dynamic varobj
30635 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
30636 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
30637 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
30638 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
30639 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
30640 compatibility for existing clients.
30641
30642 @subsubheading Result
30643
30644 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
30645 are:
30646
30647 @table @samp
30648 @item name
30649 The name of the varobj.
30650
30651 @item numchild
30652 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
30653 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
30654 @samp{has_more} attribute.
30655
30656 @item value
30657 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
30658 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
30659 will not be interesting.
30660
30661 @item type
30662 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
30663 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
30664 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30665 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30666 @emph{declared} one.
30667
30668 @item thread-id
30669 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
30670 thread's global identifier.
30671
30672 @item has_more
30673 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
30674 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
30675
30676 @item dynamic
30677 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30678 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30679 then this attribute will not be present.
30680
30681 @item displayhint
30682 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30683 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30684 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30685 @end table
30686
30687 Typical output will look like this:
30688
30689 @smallexample
30690 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
30691 has_more="@var{has_more}"
30692 @end smallexample
30693
30694
30695 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
30696 @findex -var-delete
30697
30698 @subsubheading Synopsis
30699
30700 @smallexample
30701 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
30702 @end smallexample
30703
30704 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
30705 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
30706
30707 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
30708
30709
30710 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
30711 @findex -var-set-format
30712
30713 @subsubheading Synopsis
30714
30715 @smallexample
30716 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
30717 @end smallexample
30718
30719 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
30720 @var{format-spec}.
30721
30722 @anchor{-var-set-format}
30723 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
30724
30725 @smallexample
30726 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
30727 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
30728 @end smallexample
30729
30730 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
30731 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
30732 for pointers, etc.).
30733
30734 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
30735 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
30736 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
30737 zero-hexadecimal format.
30738
30739 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
30740 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
30741
30742 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
30743 @findex -var-show-format
30744
30745 @subsubheading Synopsis
30746
30747 @smallexample
30748 -var-show-format @var{name}
30749 @end smallexample
30750
30751 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
30752
30753 @smallexample
30754 @var{format} @expansion{}
30755 @var{format-spec}
30756 @end smallexample
30757
30758
30759 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
30760 @findex -var-info-num-children
30761
30762 @subsubheading Synopsis
30763
30764 @smallexample
30765 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
30766 @end smallexample
30767
30768 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
30769
30770 @smallexample
30771 numchild=@var{n}
30772 @end smallexample
30773
30774 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
30775 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
30776 be available.
30777
30778
30779 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
30780 @findex -var-list-children
30781
30782 @subsubheading Synopsis
30783
30784 @smallexample
30785 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
30786 @end smallexample
30787 @anchor{-var-list-children}
30788
30789 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
30790 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
30791 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
30792 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
30793 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
30794 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
30795 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
30796 and unions.
30797
30798 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
30799 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
30800 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
30801 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
30802 reported.
30803
30804 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
30805 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
30806 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
30807 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
30808 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
30809 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
30810 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
30811 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
30812 the visible items.
30813
30814 For each child the following results are returned:
30815
30816 @table @var
30817
30818 @item name
30819 Name of the variable object created for this child.
30820
30821 @item exp
30822 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
30823 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
30824
30825 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
30826 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
30827
30828 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
30829 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
30830 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
30831 type and value are not present.
30832
30833 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
30834 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
30835 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
30836
30837 @item numchild
30838 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
30839 0.
30840
30841 @item type
30842 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
30843 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30844 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30845 @emph{declared} one.
30846
30847 @item value
30848 If values were requested, this is the value.
30849
30850 @item thread-id
30851 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
30852 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
30853
30854 @item frozen
30855 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
30856
30857 @item displayhint
30858 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30859 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30860 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30861
30862 @item dynamic
30863 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30864 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30865 then this attribute will not be present.
30866
30867 @end table
30868
30869 The result may have its own attributes:
30870
30871 @table @samp
30872 @item displayhint
30873 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30874 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30875 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30876
30877 @item has_more
30878 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
30879 remaining after the end of the selected range.
30880 @end table
30881
30882 @subsubheading Example
30883
30884 @smallexample
30885 (gdb)
30886 -var-list-children n
30887 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30888 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30889 (gdb)
30890 -var-list-children --all-values n
30891 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30892 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30893 @end smallexample
30894
30895
30896 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
30897 @findex -var-info-type
30898
30899 @subsubheading Synopsis
30900
30901 @smallexample
30902 -var-info-type @var{name}
30903 @end smallexample
30904
30905 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
30906 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
30907 @value{GDBN} CLI:
30908
30909 @smallexample
30910 type=@var{typename}
30911 @end smallexample
30912
30913
30914 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
30915 @findex -var-info-expression
30916
30917 @subsubheading Synopsis
30918
30919 @smallexample
30920 -var-info-expression @var{name}
30921 @end smallexample
30922
30923 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
30924 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
30925 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
30926
30927 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
30928 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
30929
30930 @smallexample
30931 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
30932 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
30933 @end smallexample
30934
30935 @noindent
30936 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
30937 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
30938
30939 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
30940 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
30941 is of limited use.
30942
30943 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
30944 @findex -var-info-path-expression
30945
30946 @subsubheading Synopsis
30947
30948 @smallexample
30949 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
30950 @end smallexample
30951
30952 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
30953 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
30954 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
30955 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
30956 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
30957 watchpoint from a variable object.
30958
30959 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
30960 and will give an error when invoked on one.
30961
30962 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
30963 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
30964 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
30965 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
30966 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
30967 @smallexample
30968 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
30969 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
30970 @end smallexample
30971
30972 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
30973 @findex -var-show-attributes
30974
30975 @subsubheading Synopsis
30976
30977 @smallexample
30978 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
30979 @end smallexample
30980
30981 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
30982
30983 @smallexample
30984 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
30985 @end smallexample
30986
30987 @noindent
30988 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
30989
30990 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
30991 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
30992
30993 @subsubheading Synopsis
30994
30995 @smallexample
30996 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
30997 @end smallexample
30998
30999 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
31000 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
31001 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
31002 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
31003 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
31004 the current display format will be used. The current display format
31005 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
31006
31007 @smallexample
31008 value=@var{value}
31009 @end smallexample
31010
31011 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
31012 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
31013
31014 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
31015 @findex -var-assign
31016
31017 @subsubheading Synopsis
31018
31019 @smallexample
31020 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
31021 @end smallexample
31022
31023 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
31024 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
31025 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
31026 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
31027
31028 @subsubheading Example
31029
31030 @smallexample
31031 (gdb)
31032 -var-assign var1 3
31033 ^done,value="3"
31034 (gdb)
31035 -var-update *
31036 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
31037 (gdb)
31038 @end smallexample
31039
31040 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
31041 @findex -var-update
31042
31043 @subsubheading Synopsis
31044
31045 @smallexample
31046 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
31047 @end smallexample
31048
31049 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
31050 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
31051 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
31052 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
31053 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
31054 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
31055 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
31056 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
31057 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
31058 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
31059 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
31060 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
31061 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
31062
31063 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
31064 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
31065 diagnostic.
31066
31067 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
31068 only the selected range of children will be reported.
31069
31070 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
31071 @samp{changelist}.
31072
31073 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
31074
31075 @table @samp
31076 @item name
31077 The name of the varobj.
31078
31079 @item value
31080 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
31081 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
31082
31083 @item in_scope
31084 @anchor{-var-update}
31085 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
31086
31087 @table @code
31088 @item "true"
31089 The variable object's current value is valid.
31090
31091 @item "false"
31092 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
31093 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
31094 scope.
31095
31096 @item "invalid"
31097 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
31098 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
31099 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
31100 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
31101 objects.
31102 @end table
31103
31104 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
31105 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
31106
31107 @item type_changed
31108 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
31109 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
31110 be @samp{false}.
31111
31112 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
31113 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
31114 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
31115 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
31116 unset.
31117
31118 @item new_type
31119 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
31120 hold the new type.
31121
31122 @item new_num_children
31123 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
31124 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
31125
31126 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
31127 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
31128 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
31129 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
31130 children which may be available.
31131
31132 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
31133 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
31134 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
31135 only happen at the end of the update range).
31136
31137 @item displayhint
31138 The display hint, if any.
31139
31140 @item has_more
31141 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
31142 available outside the varobj's update range.
31143
31144 @item dynamic
31145 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31146 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31147 then this attribute will not be present.
31148
31149 @item new_children
31150 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
31151 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
31152 be listed in this attribute.
31153 @end table
31154
31155 @subsubheading Example
31156
31157 @smallexample
31158 (gdb)
31159 -var-assign var1 3
31160 ^done,value="3"
31161 (gdb)
31162 -var-update --all-values var1
31163 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
31164 type_changed="false"@}]
31165 (gdb)
31166 @end smallexample
31167
31168 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
31169 @findex -var-set-frozen
31170 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
31171
31172 @subsubheading Synopsis
31173
31174 @smallexample
31175 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
31176 @end smallexample
31177
31178 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
31179 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
31180 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
31181 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
31182 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
31183 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
31184 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
31185 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
31186 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
31187 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
31188 @code{-var-update} does.
31189
31190 @subsubheading Example
31191
31192 @smallexample
31193 (gdb)
31194 -var-set-frozen V 1
31195 ^done
31196 (gdb)
31197 @end smallexample
31198
31199 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
31200 @findex -var-set-update-range
31201 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
31202
31203 @subsubheading Synopsis
31204
31205 @smallexample
31206 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
31207 @end smallexample
31208
31209 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
31210 @code{-var-update}.
31211
31212 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
31213 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
31214 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
31215 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
31216
31217 @subsubheading Example
31218
31219 @smallexample
31220 (gdb)
31221 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
31222 ^done
31223 @end smallexample
31224
31225 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
31226 @findex -var-set-visualizer
31227 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
31228
31229 @subsubheading Synopsis
31230
31231 @smallexample
31232 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
31233 @end smallexample
31234
31235 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
31236
31237 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
31238 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
31239
31240 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
31241 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
31242 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
31243 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
31244 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
31245 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
31246 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
31247
31248 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
31249 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
31250 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
31251 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
31252
31253 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
31254 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
31255 can be used to check this.
31256
31257 @subsubheading Example
31258
31259 Resetting the visualizer:
31260
31261 @smallexample
31262 (gdb)
31263 -var-set-visualizer V None
31264 ^done
31265 @end smallexample
31266
31267 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
31268
31269 @smallexample
31270 (gdb)
31271 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
31272 ^done
31273 @end smallexample
31274
31275 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
31276 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
31277
31278 @smallexample
31279 (gdb)
31280 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
31281 ^done
31282 @end smallexample
31283
31284 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31285 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
31286 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
31287
31288 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
31289 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
31290 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
31291 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
31292
31293 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
31294 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
31295
31296 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
31297 @c @subheading -data-assign
31298 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
31299 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
31300 @c set variable
31301 @c @subsubheading Example
31302 @c N.A.
31303
31304 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
31305 @findex -data-disassemble
31306
31307 @subsubheading Synopsis
31308
31309 @smallexample
31310 -data-disassemble
31311 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
31312 | [ -a @var{addr} ]
31313 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
31314 -- @var{mode}
31315 @end smallexample
31316
31317 @noindent
31318 Where:
31319
31320 @table @samp
31321 @item @var{start-addr}
31322 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
31323 @item @var{end-addr}
31324 is the end address
31325 @item @var{addr}
31326 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
31327 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
31328 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
31329 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
31330 @item @var{filename}
31331 is the name of the file to disassemble
31332 @item @var{linenum}
31333 is the line number to disassemble around
31334 @item @var{lines}
31335 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
31336 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
31337 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
31338 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
31339 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
31340 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
31341 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
31342 are displayed.
31343 @item @var{mode}
31344 is one of:
31345 @itemize @bullet
31346 @item 0 disassembly only
31347 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
31348 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
31349 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
31350 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
31351 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
31352 @end itemize
31353
31354 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
31355 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
31356 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
31357 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
31358 @end table
31359
31360 @subsubheading Result
31361
31362 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
31363 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
31364 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
31365
31366 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
31367 following fields:
31368
31369 @table @code
31370 @item address
31371 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
31372
31373 @item func-name
31374 The name of the function this instruction is within.
31375
31376 @item offset
31377 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
31378
31379 @item inst
31380 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
31381
31382 @item opcodes
31383 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
31384 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
31385
31386 @end table
31387
31388 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
31389 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
31390
31391 @table @code
31392 @item line
31393 The line number within @samp{file}.
31394
31395 @item file
31396 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
31397 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
31398 used.
31399
31400 @item fullname
31401 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
31402 using the source file search path
31403 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
31404 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
31405
31406 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
31407 present in the debug information.
31408
31409 @item line_asm_insn
31410 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
31411 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
31412 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
31413 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
31414 @samp{opcodes}.
31415
31416 @end table
31417
31418 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
31419 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
31420 adjust its format.
31421
31422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31423
31424 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
31425
31426 @subsubheading Example
31427
31428 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
31429
31430 @smallexample
31431 (gdb)
31432 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
31433 ^done,
31434 asm_insns=[
31435 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31436 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31437 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31438 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31439 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
31440 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
31441 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
31442 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31443 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
31444 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
31445 (gdb)
31446 @end smallexample
31447
31448 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
31449 @code{main}.
31450
31451 @smallexample
31452 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
31453 ^done,asm_insns=[
31454 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31455 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31456 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31457 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31458 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31459 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31460 [@dots{}]
31461 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
31462 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
31463 (gdb)
31464 @end smallexample
31465
31466 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
31467
31468 @smallexample
31469 (gdb)
31470 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
31471 ^done,asm_insns=[
31472 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31473 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31474 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31475 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31476 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31477 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
31478 (gdb)
31479 @end smallexample
31480
31481 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
31482
31483 @smallexample
31484 (gdb)
31485 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
31486 ^done,asm_insns=[
31487 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
31488 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31489 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31490 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
31491 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
31492 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
31493 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31494 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31495 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
31496 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31497 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31498 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
31499 (gdb)
31500 @end smallexample
31501
31502
31503 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
31504 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
31505
31506 @subsubheading Synopsis
31507
31508 @smallexample
31509 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
31510 @end smallexample
31511
31512 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
31513 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
31514 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
31515
31516 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31517
31518 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
31519 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
31520 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
31521
31522 @subsubheading Example
31523
31524 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
31525 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
31526 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
31527 output.
31528
31529 @smallexample
31530 211-data-evaluate-expression A
31531 211^done,value="1"
31532 (gdb)
31533 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
31534 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
31535 (gdb)
31536 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
31537 411^done,value="4"
31538 (gdb)
31539 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
31540 511^done,value="4"
31541 (gdb)
31542 @end smallexample
31543
31544
31545 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
31546 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
31547
31548 @subsubheading Synopsis
31549
31550 @smallexample
31551 -data-list-changed-registers
31552 @end smallexample
31553
31554 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
31555
31556 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31557
31558 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
31559 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
31560
31561 @subsubheading Example
31562
31563 On a PPC MBX board:
31564
31565 @smallexample
31566 (gdb)
31567 -exec-continue
31568 ^running
31569
31570 (gdb)
31571 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
31572 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
31573 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
31574 (gdb)
31575 -data-list-changed-registers
31576 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
31577 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
31578 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
31579 (gdb)
31580 @end smallexample
31581
31582
31583 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
31584 @findex -data-list-register-names
31585
31586 @subsubheading Synopsis
31587
31588 @smallexample
31589 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
31590 @end smallexample
31591
31592 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
31593 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
31594 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
31595 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
31596 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
31597 include empty register names.
31598
31599 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31600
31601 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
31602 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
31603 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
31604
31605 @subsubheading Example
31606
31607 For the PPC MBX board:
31608 @smallexample
31609 (gdb)
31610 -data-list-register-names
31611 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
31612 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
31613 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
31614 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
31615 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
31616 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
31617 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
31618 (gdb)
31619 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
31620 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
31621 (gdb)
31622 @end smallexample
31623
31624 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
31625 @findex -data-list-register-values
31626
31627 @subsubheading Synopsis
31628
31629 @smallexample
31630 -data-list-register-values
31631 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
31632 @end smallexample
31633
31634 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
31635 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
31636 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
31637 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
31638 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
31639 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
31640
31641 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
31642
31643 @table @code
31644 @item x
31645 Hexadecimal
31646 @item o
31647 Octal
31648 @item t
31649 Binary
31650 @item d
31651 Decimal
31652 @item r
31653 Raw
31654 @item N
31655 Natural
31656 @end table
31657
31658 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31659
31660 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
31661 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
31662
31663 @subsubheading Example
31664
31665 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
31666 don't appear in the actual output):
31667
31668 @smallexample
31669 (gdb)
31670 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
31671 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31672 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
31673 (gdb)
31674 -data-list-register-values x
31675 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
31676 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31677 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
31678 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
31679 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
31680 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
31681 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
31682 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
31683 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
31684 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31685 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
31686 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
31687 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
31688 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
31689 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
31690 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
31691 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
31692 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
31693 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
31694 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
31695 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
31696 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
31697 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
31698 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
31699 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
31700 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
31701 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
31702 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
31703 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
31704 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
31705 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
31706 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
31707 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31708 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
31709 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
31710 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
31711 (gdb)
31712 @end smallexample
31713
31714
31715 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
31716 @findex -data-read-memory
31717
31718 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
31719
31720 @subsubheading Synopsis
31721
31722 @smallexample
31723 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
31724 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
31725 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
31726 @end smallexample
31727
31728 @noindent
31729 where:
31730
31731 @table @samp
31732 @item @var{address}
31733 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
31734 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31735 quoted using the C convention.
31736
31737 @item @var{word-format}
31738 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
31739 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
31740 ,Output Formats}).
31741
31742 @item @var{word-size}
31743 The size of each memory word in bytes.
31744
31745 @item @var{nr-rows}
31746 The number of rows in the output table.
31747
31748 @item @var{nr-cols}
31749 The number of columns in the output table.
31750
31751 @item @var{aschar}
31752 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
31753 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
31754 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
31755 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
31756
31757 @item @var{byte-offset}
31758 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
31759 @end table
31760
31761 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
31762 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
31763 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
31764 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
31765 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
31766 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
31767 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
31768 @samp{addr}.
31769
31770 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
31771 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
31772 @samp{prev-page}.
31773
31774 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31775
31776 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
31777 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
31778
31779 @subsubheading Example
31780
31781 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
31782 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
31783 word. Display each word in hex.
31784
31785 @smallexample
31786 (gdb)
31787 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
31788 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
31789 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
31790 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
31791 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
31792 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
31793 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
31794 (gdb)
31795 @end smallexample
31796
31797 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
31798 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
31799
31800 @smallexample
31801 (gdb)
31802 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
31803 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
31804 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
31805 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
31806 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
31807 (gdb)
31808 @end smallexample
31809
31810 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
31811 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
31812 used as the non-printable character.
31813
31814 @smallexample
31815 (gdb)
31816 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
31817 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
31818 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
31819 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
31820 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31821 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31822 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31823 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31824 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
31825 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
31826 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
31827 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
31828 (gdb)
31829 @end smallexample
31830
31831 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
31832 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
31833
31834 @subsubheading Synopsis
31835
31836 @smallexample
31837 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
31838 @var{address} @var{count}
31839 @end smallexample
31840
31841 @noindent
31842 where:
31843
31844 @table @samp
31845 @item @var{address}
31846 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31847 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31848 quoted using the C convention.
31849
31850 @item @var{count}
31851 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
31852 literal.
31853
31854 @item @var{offset}
31855 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
31856 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
31857 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
31858 arithmetics itself.
31859
31860 @end table
31861
31862 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
31863 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
31864 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
31865 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
31866 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
31867 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
31868
31869 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
31870 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
31871 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
31872 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
31873 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
31874 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
31875 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
31876 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
31877
31878 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
31879 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
31880 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
31881 and has the following fields:
31882
31883 @table @code
31884 @item begin
31885 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31886
31887 @item end
31888 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31889
31890 @item offset
31891 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
31892 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
31893
31894 @item contents
31895 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
31896
31897 @end table
31898
31899
31900
31901 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31902
31903 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
31904
31905 @subsubheading Example
31906
31907 @smallexample
31908 (gdb)
31909 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
31910 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
31911 end="0xbffff15e",
31912 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
31913 (gdb)
31914 @end smallexample
31915
31916
31917 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
31918 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
31919
31920 @subsubheading Synopsis
31921
31922 @smallexample
31923 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
31924 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
31925 @end smallexample
31926
31927 @noindent
31928 where:
31929
31930 @table @samp
31931 @item @var{address}
31932 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31933 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
31934 be quoted using the C convention.
31935
31936 @item @var{contents}
31937 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
31938 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
31939
31940 @item @var{count}
31941 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
31942 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
31943 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
31944 @var{count} memory units.
31945
31946 @end table
31947
31948 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31949
31950 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31951
31952 @subsubheading Example
31953
31954 @smallexample
31955 (gdb)
31956 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
31957 ^done
31958 (gdb)
31959 @end smallexample
31960
31961 @smallexample
31962 (gdb)
31963 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
31964 ^done
31965 (gdb)
31966 @end smallexample
31967
31968 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31969 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
31970 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
31971
31972 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
31973 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
31974
31975 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
31976 @findex -trace-find
31977
31978 @subsubheading Synopsis
31979
31980 @smallexample
31981 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
31982 @end smallexample
31983
31984 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
31985 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
31986 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
31987
31988 @table @samp
31989
31990 @item none
31991 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
31992
31993 @item frame-number
31994 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
31995 that index.
31996
31997 @item tracepoint-number
31998 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
31999 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
32000
32001 @item pc
32002 An address is required as parameter. Finds
32003 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
32004 address.
32005
32006 @item pc-inside-range
32007 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
32008 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
32009 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32010
32011 @item pc-outside-range
32012 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
32013 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
32014 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32015
32016 @item line
32017 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
32018 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
32019 the specified location.
32020
32021 @end table
32022
32023 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
32024 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
32025
32026 @table @samp
32027 @item found
32028 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
32029 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
32030
32031 @item traceframe
32032 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
32033 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32034
32035 @item tracepoint
32036 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
32037 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32038
32039 @item frame
32040 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
32041 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
32042 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
32043
32044 @end table
32045
32046 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32047
32048 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
32049
32050 @subheading -trace-define-variable
32051 @findex -trace-define-variable
32052
32053 @subsubheading Synopsis
32054
32055 @smallexample
32056 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
32057 @end smallexample
32058
32059 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
32060 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
32061 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
32062 with the @samp{$} character.
32063
32064 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32065
32066 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
32067
32068 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
32069 @findex -trace-frame-collected
32070
32071 @subsubheading Synopsis
32072
32073 @smallexample
32074 -trace-frame-collected
32075 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
32076 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
32077 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
32078 [--memory-contents]
32079 @end smallexample
32080
32081 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
32082 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
32083 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
32084 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
32085 See the output description table below for more details.
32086
32087 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
32088 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
32089 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
32090 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
32091 memory range and which is a computed expression.
32092
32093 For instance, if the actions were
32094 @smallexample
32095 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
32096 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
32097 @end smallexample
32098
32099 @noindent
32100 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
32101 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
32102 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
32103 objects would be computed expressions.
32104
32105 An example output would be:
32106
32107 @smallexample
32108 (gdb)
32109 -trace-frame-collected
32110 ^done,
32111 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
32112 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
32113 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
32114 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
32115 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
32116 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
32117 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
32118 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
32119 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
32120 ...
32121 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
32122 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
32123 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
32124 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
32125 (gdb)
32126 @end smallexample
32127
32128 Where:
32129
32130 @table @code
32131 @item explicit-variables
32132 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
32133 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
32134 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
32135 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
32136 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
32137 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
32138 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
32139 arrays, structures and unions.
32140
32141 @item computed-expressions
32142 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
32143 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
32144 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
32145 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
32146
32147 @item registers
32148 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
32149 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
32150 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
32151 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
32152 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
32153
32154 @item tvars
32155 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
32156 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
32157 current value are returned.
32158
32159 @item memory
32160 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
32161 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
32162 collected memory range and has the following fields:
32163
32164 @table @code
32165 @item address
32166 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
32167
32168 @item length
32169 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
32170
32171 @item contents
32172 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
32173 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
32174
32175 @end table
32176
32177 @end table
32178
32179 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32180
32181 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32182
32183 @subsubheading Example
32184
32185 @subheading -trace-list-variables
32186 @findex -trace-list-variables
32187
32188 @subsubheading Synopsis
32189
32190 @smallexample
32191 -trace-list-variables
32192 @end smallexample
32193
32194 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
32195 table has the following fields:
32196
32197 @table @samp
32198 @item name
32199 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
32200
32201 @item initial
32202 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
32203 field is always present.
32204
32205 @item current
32206 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
32207 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
32208 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
32209 presently running.
32210
32211 @end table
32212
32213 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32214
32215 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
32216
32217 @subsubheading Example
32218
32219 @smallexample
32220 (gdb)
32221 -trace-list-variables
32222 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
32223 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32224 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
32225 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
32226 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
32227 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
32228 (gdb)
32229 @end smallexample
32230
32231 @subheading -trace-save
32232 @findex -trace-save
32233
32234 @subsubheading Synopsis
32235
32236 @smallexample
32237 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
32238 @end smallexample
32239
32240 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
32241 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
32242 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
32243 to perform the save.
32244
32245 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
32246 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
32247 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
32248
32249 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32250
32251 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
32252
32253
32254 @subheading -trace-start
32255 @findex -trace-start
32256
32257 @subsubheading Synopsis
32258
32259 @smallexample
32260 -trace-start
32261 @end smallexample
32262
32263 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
32264 have any fields.
32265
32266 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32267
32268 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
32269
32270 @subheading -trace-status
32271 @findex -trace-status
32272
32273 @subsubheading Synopsis
32274
32275 @smallexample
32276 -trace-status
32277 @end smallexample
32278
32279 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
32280 the following fields:
32281
32282 @table @samp
32283
32284 @item supported
32285 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
32286 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
32287 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
32288 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
32289 started. This field is always present.
32290
32291 @item running
32292 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
32293 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
32294 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32295
32296 @item stop-reason
32297 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
32298 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
32299 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
32300 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
32301 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
32302 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
32303 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
32304 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
32305 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32306
32307 @item stopping-tracepoint
32308 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
32309 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
32310 @samp{passcount}.
32311
32312 @item frames
32313 @itemx frames-created
32314 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
32315 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
32316 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
32317 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
32318
32319 @item buffer-size
32320 @itemx buffer-free
32321 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
32322 remaining space. These fields are optional.
32323
32324 @item circular
32325 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
32326 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
32327 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
32328 and may fill up.
32329
32330 @item disconnected
32331 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
32332 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
32333 that the trace run will stop.
32334
32335 @item trace-file
32336 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
32337 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
32338
32339 @end table
32340
32341 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32342
32343 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
32344
32345 @subheading -trace-stop
32346 @findex -trace-stop
32347
32348 @subsubheading Synopsis
32349
32350 @smallexample
32351 -trace-stop
32352 @end smallexample
32353
32354 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
32355 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
32356 @samp{running} fields are not output.
32357
32358 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32359
32360 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
32361
32362
32363 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32364 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
32365 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
32366
32367
32368 @ignore
32369 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
32370 @findex -symbol-info-address
32371
32372 @subsubheading Synopsis
32373
32374 @smallexample
32375 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
32376 @end smallexample
32377
32378 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
32379
32380 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32381
32382 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
32383
32384 @subsubheading Example
32385 N.A.
32386
32387
32388 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
32389 @findex -symbol-info-file
32390
32391 @subsubheading Synopsis
32392
32393 @smallexample
32394 -symbol-info-file
32395 @end smallexample
32396
32397 Show the file for the symbol.
32398
32399 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32400
32401 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
32402 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
32403
32404 @subsubheading Example
32405 N.A.
32406
32407
32408 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
32409 @findex -symbol-info-function
32410
32411 @subsubheading Synopsis
32412
32413 @smallexample
32414 -symbol-info-function
32415 @end smallexample
32416
32417 Show which function the symbol lives in.
32418
32419 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32420
32421 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
32422
32423 @subsubheading Example
32424 N.A.
32425
32426
32427 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
32428 @findex -symbol-info-line
32429
32430 @subsubheading Synopsis
32431
32432 @smallexample
32433 -symbol-info-line
32434 @end smallexample
32435
32436 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
32437
32438 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32439
32440 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
32441 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
32442
32443 @subsubheading Example
32444 N.A.
32445
32446
32447 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
32448 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
32449
32450 @subsubheading Synopsis
32451
32452 @smallexample
32453 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
32454 @end smallexample
32455
32456 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
32457
32458 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32459
32460 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
32461
32462 @subsubheading Example
32463 N.A.
32464
32465
32466 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
32467 @findex -symbol-list-functions
32468
32469 @subsubheading Synopsis
32470
32471 @smallexample
32472 -symbol-list-functions
32473 @end smallexample
32474
32475 List the functions in the executable.
32476
32477 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32478
32479 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
32480 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32481
32482 @subsubheading Example
32483 N.A.
32484 @end ignore
32485
32486
32487 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
32488 @findex -symbol-list-lines
32489
32490 @subsubheading Synopsis
32491
32492 @smallexample
32493 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
32494 @end smallexample
32495
32496 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
32497 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
32498 ascending PC order.
32499
32500 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32501
32502 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32503
32504 @subsubheading Example
32505 @smallexample
32506 (gdb)
32507 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
32508 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
32509 (gdb)
32510 @end smallexample
32511
32512
32513 @ignore
32514 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
32515 @findex -symbol-list-types
32516
32517 @subsubheading Synopsis
32518
32519 @smallexample
32520 -symbol-list-types
32521 @end smallexample
32522
32523 List all the type names.
32524
32525 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32526
32527 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
32528 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32529
32530 @subsubheading Example
32531 N.A.
32532
32533
32534 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
32535 @findex -symbol-list-variables
32536
32537 @subsubheading Synopsis
32538
32539 @smallexample
32540 -symbol-list-variables
32541 @end smallexample
32542
32543 List all the global and static variable names.
32544
32545 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32546
32547 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32548
32549 @subsubheading Example
32550 N.A.
32551
32552
32553 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
32554 @findex -symbol-locate
32555
32556 @subsubheading Synopsis
32557
32558 @smallexample
32559 -symbol-locate
32560 @end smallexample
32561
32562 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32563
32564 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
32565
32566 @subsubheading Example
32567 N.A.
32568
32569
32570 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
32571 @findex -symbol-type
32572
32573 @subsubheading Synopsis
32574
32575 @smallexample
32576 -symbol-type @var{variable}
32577 @end smallexample
32578
32579 Show type of @var{variable}.
32580
32581 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32582
32583 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
32584 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
32585
32586 @subsubheading Example
32587 N.A.
32588 @end ignore
32589
32590
32591 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32592 @node GDB/MI File Commands
32593 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
32594
32595 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
32596 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
32597
32598 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
32599 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
32600
32601 @subsubheading Synopsis
32602
32603 @smallexample
32604 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
32605 @end smallexample
32606
32607 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
32608 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
32609 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
32610 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
32611 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
32612 notification.
32613
32614 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32615
32616 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
32617
32618 @subsubheading Example
32619
32620 @smallexample
32621 (gdb)
32622 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32623 ^done
32624 (gdb)
32625 @end smallexample
32626
32627
32628 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
32629 @findex -file-exec-file
32630
32631 @subsubheading Synopsis
32632
32633 @smallexample
32634 -file-exec-file @var{file}
32635 @end smallexample
32636
32637 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
32638 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
32639 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
32640 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
32641 notification.
32642
32643 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32644
32645 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
32646
32647 @subsubheading Example
32648
32649 @smallexample
32650 (gdb)
32651 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32652 ^done
32653 (gdb)
32654 @end smallexample
32655
32656
32657 @ignore
32658 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
32659 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
32660
32661 @subsubheading Synopsis
32662
32663 @smallexample
32664 -file-list-exec-sections
32665 @end smallexample
32666
32667 List the sections of the current executable file.
32668
32669 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32670
32671 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
32672 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
32673 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
32674
32675 @subsubheading Example
32676 N.A.
32677 @end ignore
32678
32679
32680 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
32681 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
32682
32683 @subsubheading Synopsis
32684
32685 @smallexample
32686 -file-list-exec-source-file
32687 @end smallexample
32688
32689 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
32690 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
32691 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
32692 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
32693
32694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32695
32696 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
32697
32698 @subsubheading Example
32699
32700 @smallexample
32701 (gdb)
32702 123-file-list-exec-source-file
32703 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
32704 (gdb)
32705 @end smallexample
32706
32707
32708 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
32709 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
32710
32711 @subsubheading Synopsis
32712
32713 @smallexample
32714 -file-list-exec-source-files
32715 @end smallexample
32716
32717 List the source files for the current executable.
32718
32719 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
32720 name) of a source file.
32721
32722 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32723
32724 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
32725 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
32726
32727 @subsubheading Example
32728 @smallexample
32729 (gdb)
32730 -file-list-exec-source-files
32731 ^done,files=[
32732 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
32733 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
32734 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
32735 (gdb)
32736 @end smallexample
32737
32738 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
32739 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
32740
32741 @subsubheading Synopsis
32742
32743 @smallexample
32744 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
32745 @end smallexample
32746
32747 List the shared libraries in the program.
32748 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
32749 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32750
32751 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32752
32753 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
32754 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
32755 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
32756 library. Each range has the following fields:
32757
32758 @table @samp
32759 @item from
32760 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
32761 @item to
32762 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
32763 @end table
32764
32765 @subsubheading Example
32766 @smallexample
32767 (gdb)
32768 -file-list-exec-source-files
32769 ^done,shared-libraries=[
32770 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
32771 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
32772 (gdb)
32773 @end smallexample
32774
32775
32776 @ignore
32777 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
32778 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
32779
32780 @subsubheading Synopsis
32781
32782 @smallexample
32783 -file-list-symbol-files
32784 @end smallexample
32785
32786 List symbol files.
32787
32788 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32789
32790 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
32791
32792 @subsubheading Example
32793 N.A.
32794 @end ignore
32795
32796
32797 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
32798 @findex -file-symbol-file
32799
32800 @subsubheading Synopsis
32801
32802 @smallexample
32803 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
32804 @end smallexample
32805
32806 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
32807 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
32808 produced, except for a completion notification.
32809
32810 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32811
32812 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
32813
32814 @subsubheading Example
32815
32816 @smallexample
32817 (gdb)
32818 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32819 ^done
32820 (gdb)
32821 @end smallexample
32822
32823 @ignore
32824 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32825 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
32826 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
32827
32828 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
32829
32830 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
32831
32832 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
32833
32834 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
32835
32836 @c @subheading -overlay-map
32837
32838 @c @subheading -overlay-off
32839
32840 @c @subheading -overlay-on
32841
32842 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
32843
32844 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32845 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
32846 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
32847
32848 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
32849
32850 @c @subheading -signal-handle
32851
32852 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
32853
32854 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
32855 @end ignore
32856
32857
32858 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32859 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
32860 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
32861
32862
32863 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
32864 @findex -target-attach
32865
32866 @subsubheading Synopsis
32867
32868 @smallexample
32869 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
32870 @end smallexample
32871
32872 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
32873 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
32874 group, the id previously returned by
32875 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
32876
32877 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32878
32879 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
32880
32881 @subsubheading Example
32882 @smallexample
32883 (gdb)
32884 -target-attach 34
32885 =thread-created,id="1"
32886 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
32887 ^done
32888 (gdb)
32889 @end smallexample
32890
32891 @ignore
32892 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
32893 @findex -target-compare-sections
32894
32895 @subsubheading Synopsis
32896
32897 @smallexample
32898 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
32899 @end smallexample
32900
32901 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
32902 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
32903
32904 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32905
32906 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
32907
32908 @subsubheading Example
32909 N.A.
32910 @end ignore
32911
32912
32913 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
32914 @findex -target-detach
32915
32916 @subsubheading Synopsis
32917
32918 @smallexample
32919 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
32920 @end smallexample
32921
32922 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
32923 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
32924 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
32925
32926 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32927
32928 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
32929
32930 @subsubheading Example
32931
32932 @smallexample
32933 (gdb)
32934 -target-detach
32935 ^done
32936 (gdb)
32937 @end smallexample
32938
32939
32940 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
32941 @findex -target-disconnect
32942
32943 @subsubheading Synopsis
32944
32945 @smallexample
32946 -target-disconnect
32947 @end smallexample
32948
32949 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
32950 generally not resumed.
32951
32952 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32953
32954 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
32955
32956 @subsubheading Example
32957
32958 @smallexample
32959 (gdb)
32960 -target-disconnect
32961 ^done
32962 (gdb)
32963 @end smallexample
32964
32965
32966 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
32967 @findex -target-download
32968
32969 @subsubheading Synopsis
32970
32971 @smallexample
32972 -target-download
32973 @end smallexample
32974
32975 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
32976 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
32977
32978 @table @samp
32979 @item section
32980 The name of the section.
32981 @item section-sent
32982 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
32983 @item section-size
32984 The size of the section.
32985 @item total-sent
32986 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
32987 @item total-size
32988 The size of the overall executable to download.
32989 @end table
32990
32991 @noindent
32992 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
32993 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
32994
32995 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
32996 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
32997
32998 @table @samp
32999 @item section
33000 The name of the section.
33001 @item section-size
33002 The size of the section.
33003 @item total-size
33004 The size of the overall executable to download.
33005 @end table
33006
33007 @noindent
33008 At the end, a summary is printed.
33009
33010 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33011
33012 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
33013
33014 @subsubheading Example
33015
33016 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
33017 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
33018
33019 @smallexample
33020 (gdb)
33021 -target-download
33022 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
33023 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
33024 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
33025 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
33026 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
33027 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
33028 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
33029 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
33030 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
33031 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
33032 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
33033 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
33034 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
33035 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
33036 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
33037 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
33038 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
33039 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
33040 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
33041 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
33042 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
33043 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
33044 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
33045 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
33046 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
33047 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
33048 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
33049 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33050 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33051 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
33052 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
33053 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
33054 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
33055 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
33056 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
33057 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
33058 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
33059 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
33060 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
33061 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
33062 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
33063 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
33064 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
33065 write-rate="429"
33066 (gdb)
33067 @end smallexample
33068
33069
33070 @ignore
33071 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
33072 @findex -target-exec-status
33073
33074 @subsubheading Synopsis
33075
33076 @smallexample
33077 -target-exec-status
33078 @end smallexample
33079
33080 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
33081 not, for instance).
33082
33083 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33084
33085 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
33086
33087 @subsubheading Example
33088 N.A.
33089
33090
33091 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
33092 @findex -target-list-available-targets
33093
33094 @subsubheading Synopsis
33095
33096 @smallexample
33097 -target-list-available-targets
33098 @end smallexample
33099
33100 List the possible targets to connect to.
33101
33102 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33103
33104 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
33105
33106 @subsubheading Example
33107 N.A.
33108
33109
33110 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
33111 @findex -target-list-current-targets
33112
33113 @subsubheading Synopsis
33114
33115 @smallexample
33116 -target-list-current-targets
33117 @end smallexample
33118
33119 Describe the current target.
33120
33121 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33122
33123 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
33124 other things).
33125
33126 @subsubheading Example
33127 N.A.
33128
33129
33130 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
33131 @findex -target-list-parameters
33132
33133 @subsubheading Synopsis
33134
33135 @smallexample
33136 -target-list-parameters
33137 @end smallexample
33138
33139 @c ????
33140 @end ignore
33141
33142 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33143
33144 No equivalent.
33145
33146 @subsubheading Example
33147 N.A.
33148
33149 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
33150 @findex -target-flash-erase
33151
33152 @subsubheading Synopsis
33153
33154 @smallexample
33155 -target-flash-erase
33156 @end smallexample
33157
33158 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
33159
33160 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
33161
33162 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
33163 addresses and memory region sizes.
33164
33165 @smallexample
33166 (gdb)
33167 -target-flash-erase
33168 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
33169 (gdb)
33170 @end smallexample
33171
33172 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
33173 @findex -target-select
33174
33175 @subsubheading Synopsis
33176
33177 @smallexample
33178 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
33179 @end smallexample
33180
33181 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
33182
33183 @table @samp
33184 @item @var{type}
33185 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
33186 @item @var{parameters}
33187 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
33188 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
33189 @end table
33190
33191 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
33192 which the target program is, in the following form:
33193
33194 @smallexample
33195 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
33196 args=[@var{arg list}]
33197 @end smallexample
33198
33199 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33200
33201 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
33202
33203 @subsubheading Example
33204
33205 @smallexample
33206 (gdb)
33207 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
33208 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
33209 (gdb)
33210 @end smallexample
33211
33212 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33213 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
33214 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
33215
33216
33217 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
33218 @findex -target-file-put
33219
33220 @subsubheading Synopsis
33221
33222 @smallexample
33223 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
33224 @end smallexample
33225
33226 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
33227 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
33228
33229 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33230
33231 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
33232
33233 @subsubheading Example
33234
33235 @smallexample
33236 (gdb)
33237 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
33238 ^done
33239 (gdb)
33240 @end smallexample
33241
33242
33243 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
33244 @findex -target-file-get
33245
33246 @subsubheading Synopsis
33247
33248 @smallexample
33249 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
33250 @end smallexample
33251
33252 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
33253 on the host system.
33254
33255 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33256
33257 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
33258
33259 @subsubheading Example
33260
33261 @smallexample
33262 (gdb)
33263 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
33264 ^done
33265 (gdb)
33266 @end smallexample
33267
33268
33269 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
33270 @findex -target-file-delete
33271
33272 @subsubheading Synopsis
33273
33274 @smallexample
33275 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
33276 @end smallexample
33277
33278 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
33279
33280 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33281
33282 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
33283
33284 @subsubheading Example
33285
33286 @smallexample
33287 (gdb)
33288 -target-file-delete remotefile
33289 ^done
33290 (gdb)
33291 @end smallexample
33292
33293
33294 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33295 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
33296 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33297
33298 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
33299 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
33300
33301 @subsubheading Synopsis
33302
33303 @smallexample
33304 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
33305 @end smallexample
33306
33307 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
33308 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
33309 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33310
33311 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33312
33313 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
33314
33315 @subsubheading Result
33316
33317 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
33318 defined for each exception:
33319
33320 @table @samp
33321 @item name
33322 The name of the exception.
33323
33324 @item address
33325 The address of the exception.
33326
33327 @end table
33328
33329 @subsubheading Example
33330
33331 @smallexample
33332 -info-ada-exceptions aint
33333 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
33334 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33335 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
33336 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
33337 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
33338 @end smallexample
33339
33340 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
33341
33342 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
33343 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
33344 Catchpoint Commands}.
33345
33346
33347 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33348 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
33349 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
33350
33351 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
33352 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
33353 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
33354 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
33355
33356 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
33357 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
33358 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
33359
33360 @subsubheading Synopsis
33361
33362 @smallexample
33363 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
33364 @end smallexample
33365
33366 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
33367
33368 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
33369 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
33370 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
33371 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
33372 dash.
33373
33374 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33375
33376 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33377
33378 @subsubheading Result
33379
33380 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
33381
33382 @table @samp
33383 @item exists
33384 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
33385 @code{"false"} otherwise.
33386
33387 @end table
33388
33389 @subsubheading Example
33390
33391 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
33392
33393 @smallexample
33394 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
33395 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
33396 @end smallexample
33397
33398 @noindent
33399 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
33400 to the debugger:
33401
33402 @smallexample
33403 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
33404 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
33405 @end smallexample
33406
33407 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
33408 @findex -list-features
33409 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
33410
33411 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
33412 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
33413 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
33414 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
33415 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
33416 startup.
33417
33418 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
33419 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
33420 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
33421 is given below.
33422
33423 Example output:
33424
33425 @smallexample
33426 (gdb) -list-features
33427 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
33428 @end smallexample
33429
33430 The current list of features is:
33431
33432 @ftable @samp
33433 @item frozen-varobjs
33434 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
33435 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
33436 of @code{-varobj-create}.
33437 @item pending-breakpoints
33438 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
33439 command.
33440 @item python
33441 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
33442 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
33443 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
33444 @item thread-info
33445 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
33446 @item data-read-memory-bytes
33447 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
33448 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
33449 @item breakpoint-notifications
33450 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
33451 CLI will be announced via async records.
33452 @item ada-task-info
33453 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
33454 @item language-option
33455 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
33456 option (@pxref{Context management}).
33457 @item info-gdb-mi-command
33458 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
33459 @item undefined-command-error-code
33460 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
33461 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
33462 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
33463 @item exec-run-start-option
33464 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
33465 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
33466 @item data-disassemble-a-option
33467 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
33468 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
33469 @end ftable
33470
33471 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
33472 @findex -list-target-features
33473
33474 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
33475 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
33476 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
33477 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
33478 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
33479 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
33480 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
33481 Example output:
33482
33483 @smallexample
33484 (gdb) -list-target-features
33485 ^done,result=["async"]
33486 @end smallexample
33487
33488 The current list of features is:
33489
33490 @table @samp
33491 @item async
33492 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
33493 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
33494 while the target is running.
33495
33496 @item reverse
33497 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
33498 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33499
33500 @end table
33501
33502 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33503 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
33504 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33505
33506 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
33507
33508 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
33509 @findex -gdb-exit
33510
33511 @subsubheading Synopsis
33512
33513 @smallexample
33514 -gdb-exit
33515 @end smallexample
33516
33517 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
33518
33519 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33520
33521 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
33522
33523 @subsubheading Example
33524
33525 @smallexample
33526 (gdb)
33527 -gdb-exit
33528 ^exit
33529 @end smallexample
33530
33531
33532 @ignore
33533 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
33534 @findex -exec-abort
33535
33536 @subsubheading Synopsis
33537
33538 @smallexample
33539 -exec-abort
33540 @end smallexample
33541
33542 Kill the inferior running program.
33543
33544 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33545
33546 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
33547
33548 @subsubheading Example
33549 N.A.
33550 @end ignore
33551
33552
33553 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
33554 @findex -gdb-set
33555
33556 @subsubheading Synopsis
33557
33558 @smallexample
33559 -gdb-set
33560 @end smallexample
33561
33562 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
33563 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
33564
33565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33566
33567 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
33568
33569 @subsubheading Example
33570
33571 @smallexample
33572 (gdb)
33573 -gdb-set $foo=3
33574 ^done
33575 (gdb)
33576 @end smallexample
33577
33578
33579 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
33580 @findex -gdb-show
33581
33582 @subsubheading Synopsis
33583
33584 @smallexample
33585 -gdb-show
33586 @end smallexample
33587
33588 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
33589
33590 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33591
33592 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
33593
33594 @subsubheading Example
33595
33596 @smallexample
33597 (gdb)
33598 -gdb-show annotate
33599 ^done,value="0"
33600 (gdb)
33601 @end smallexample
33602
33603 @c @subheading -gdb-source
33604
33605
33606 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
33607 @findex -gdb-version
33608
33609 @subsubheading Synopsis
33610
33611 @smallexample
33612 -gdb-version
33613 @end smallexample
33614
33615 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
33616
33617 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33618
33619 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
33620 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
33621
33622 @subsubheading Example
33623
33624 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
33625 @c box in TeX.
33626 @smallexample
33627 (gdb)
33628 -gdb-version
33629 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
33630 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33631 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
33632 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
33633 ~ certain conditions.
33634 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33635 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
33636 ~ details.
33637 ~This GDB was configured as
33638 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
33639 ^done
33640 (gdb)
33641 @end smallexample
33642
33643 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
33644 @findex -list-thread-groups
33645
33646 @subheading Synopsis
33647
33648 @smallexample
33649 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
33650 @end smallexample
33651
33652 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
33653 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
33654 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
33655 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
33656 top-level thread groups.
33657
33658 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
33659 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
33660 available on the target.
33661
33662 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
33663 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
33664 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
33665 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
33666 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
33667 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
33668 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
33669 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
33670
33671 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
33672 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
33673 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
33674 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
33675 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
33676 @samp{threads} field.
33677
33678 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
33679 the following caveats:
33680
33681 @itemize @bullet
33682 @item
33683 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
33684 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
33685 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
33686
33687 @item
33688 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
33689 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
33690 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
33691 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
33692 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
33693 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
33694
33695 @end itemize
33696
33697 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
33698 have the following fields:
33699
33700 @table @code
33701 @item id
33702 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
33703 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
33704 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
33705
33706 @item type
33707 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
33708 valid type.
33709
33710 @item pid
33711 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
33712 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
33713
33714 @item exit-code
33715 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
33716 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
33717 only if the process is not running.
33718
33719 @item num_children
33720 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
33721 absent for an available thread group.
33722
33723 @item threads
33724 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
33725 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
33726 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
33727
33728 @item cores
33729 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
33730 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
33731 such information is not available.
33732
33733 @item executable
33734 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
33735 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
33736 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
33737
33738 @end table
33739
33740 @subheading Example
33741
33742 @smallexample
33743 @value{GDBP}
33744 -list-thread-groups
33745 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
33746 -list-thread-groups 17
33747 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
33748 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
33749 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
33750 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
33751 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
33752 -list-thread-groups --available
33753 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
33754 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
33755 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33756 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33757 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
33758 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
33759 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33760 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33761 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
33762 @end smallexample
33763
33764 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
33765 @findex -info-os
33766
33767 @subsubheading Synopsis
33768
33769 @smallexample
33770 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
33771 @end smallexample
33772
33773 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
33774 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
33775 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
33776 of data of that type.
33777
33778 The types of information available depend on the target operating
33779 system.
33780
33781 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33782
33783 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
33784
33785 @subsubheading Example
33786
33787 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
33788 like this:
33789
33790 @smallexample
33791 @value{GDBP}
33792 -info-os
33793 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
33794 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
33795 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
33796 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
33797 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
33798 col2="CPUs"@},
33799 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
33800 col2="File descriptors"@},
33801 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
33802 col2="Kernel modules"@},
33803 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
33804 col2="Message queues"@},
33805 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
33806 col2="Processes"@},
33807 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
33808 col2="Process groups"@},
33809 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
33810 col2="Semaphores"@},
33811 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
33812 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
33813 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
33814 col2="Sockets"@},
33815 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
33816 col2="Threads"@}]
33817 @value{GDBP}
33818 -info-os processes
33819 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
33820 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
33821 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
33822 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
33823 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
33824 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
33825 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
33826 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
33827 ...
33828 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
33829 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
33830 (gdb)
33831 @end smallexample
33832
33833 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
33834 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
33835 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
33836 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
33837 @code{info os} omits it.)
33838
33839 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
33840 @findex -add-inferior
33841
33842 @subheading Synopsis
33843
33844 @smallexample
33845 -add-inferior
33846 @end smallexample
33847
33848 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
33849 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
33850 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
33851 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
33852 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
33853 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
33854
33855 @subheading Example
33856
33857 @smallexample
33858 @value{GDBP}
33859 -add-inferior
33860 ^done,inferior="i3"
33861 @end smallexample
33862
33863 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
33864 @findex -interpreter-exec
33865
33866 @subheading Synopsis
33867
33868 @smallexample
33869 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
33870 @end smallexample
33871 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
33872
33873 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
33874
33875 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33876
33877 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
33878
33879 @subheading Example
33880
33881 @smallexample
33882 (gdb)
33883 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
33884 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
33885 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
33886 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
33887 ^done
33888 (gdb)
33889 @end smallexample
33890
33891 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
33892 @findex -inferior-tty-set
33893
33894 @subheading Synopsis
33895
33896 @smallexample
33897 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33898 @end smallexample
33899
33900 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
33901
33902 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33903
33904 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
33905
33906 @subheading Example
33907
33908 @smallexample
33909 (gdb)
33910 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33911 ^done
33912 (gdb)
33913 @end smallexample
33914
33915 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
33916 @findex -inferior-tty-show
33917
33918 @subheading Synopsis
33919
33920 @smallexample
33921 -inferior-tty-show
33922 @end smallexample
33923
33924 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
33925
33926 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33927
33928 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
33929
33930 @subheading Example
33931
33932 @smallexample
33933 (gdb)
33934 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33935 ^done
33936 (gdb)
33937 -inferior-tty-show
33938 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
33939 (gdb)
33940 @end smallexample
33941
33942 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
33943 @findex -enable-timings
33944
33945 @subheading Synopsis
33946
33947 @smallexample
33948 -enable-timings [yes | no]
33949 @end smallexample
33950
33951 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
33952 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
33953 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
33954 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
33955
33956 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33957
33958 No equivalent.
33959
33960 @subheading Example
33961
33962 @smallexample
33963 (gdb)
33964 -enable-timings
33965 ^done
33966 (gdb)
33967 -break-insert main
33968 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
33969 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
33970 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
33971 times="0"@},
33972 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
33973 (gdb)
33974 -enable-timings no
33975 ^done
33976 (gdb)
33977 -exec-run
33978 ^running
33979 (gdb)
33980 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
33981 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
33982 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
33983 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
33984 (gdb)
33985 @end smallexample
33986
33987 @node Annotations
33988 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
33989
33990 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
33991 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
33992 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
33993 relatively high level.
33994
33995 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
33996 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
33997
33998 @ignore
33999 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
34000 @end ignore
34001
34002 @menu
34003 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
34004 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
34005 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
34006 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
34007 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
34008 * Annotations for Running::
34009 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
34010 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
34011 @end menu
34012
34013 @node Annotations Overview
34014 @section What is an Annotation?
34015 @cindex annotations
34016
34017 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
34018 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
34019 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
34020 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
34021 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
34022 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
34023 cannot contain newline characters.
34024
34025 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
34026 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
34027 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
34028 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
34029 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
34030 means those three characters as output.
34031
34032 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
34033 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
34034 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
34035 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
34036 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
34037 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
34038 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
34039 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
34040 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
34041
34042 @table @code
34043 @kindex set annotate
34044 @item set annotate @var{level}
34045 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
34046 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
34047
34048 @item show annotate
34049 @kindex show annotate
34050 Show the current annotation level.
34051 @end table
34052
34053 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
34054
34055 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
34056
34057 @smallexample
34058 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
34059 GNU gdb 6.0
34060 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34061 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
34062 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
34063 under certain conditions.
34064 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34065 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
34066 for details.
34067 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
34068
34069 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34070 (@value{GDBP})
34071 ^Z^Zprompt
34072 @kbd{quit}
34073
34074 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34075 $
34076 @end smallexample
34077
34078 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
34079 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
34080 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
34081 output from @value{GDBN}.
34082
34083 @node Server Prefix
34084 @section The Server Prefix
34085 @cindex server prefix
34086
34087 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
34088 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
34089 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
34090 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
34091 a transparent manner.
34092
34093 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
34094 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
34095 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
34096 @code{print} command.
34097
34098 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
34099 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
34100
34101 @node Prompting
34102 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
34103
34104 @cindex annotations for prompts
34105 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
34106 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
34107 over, etc.
34108
34109 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
34110 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
34111 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
34112 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
34113 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
34114 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
34115 features the following annotations:
34116
34117 @smallexample
34118 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34119 ^Z^Zprompt
34120 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34121 @end smallexample
34122
34123 The input types are
34124
34125 @table @code
34126 @findex pre-prompt annotation
34127 @findex prompt annotation
34128 @findex post-prompt annotation
34129 @item prompt
34130 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
34131
34132 @findex pre-commands annotation
34133 @findex commands annotation
34134 @findex post-commands annotation
34135 @item commands
34136 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
34137 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
34138
34139 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
34140 @findex overload-choice annotation
34141 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
34142 @item overload-choice
34143 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
34144
34145 @findex pre-query annotation
34146 @findex query annotation
34147 @findex post-query annotation
34148 @item query
34149 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
34150
34151 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
34152 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
34153 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
34154 @item prompt-for-continue
34155 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
34156 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
34157 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
34158 presence of annotations.
34159 @end table
34160
34161 @node Errors
34162 @section Errors
34163 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
34164
34165 @findex quit annotation
34166 @smallexample
34167 ^Z^Zquit
34168 @end smallexample
34169
34170 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
34171
34172 @findex error annotation
34173 @smallexample
34174 ^Z^Zerror
34175 @end smallexample
34176
34177 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
34178
34179 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
34180 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
34181 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
34182 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
34183 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
34184 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
34185 to the top level.
34186
34187 @findex error-begin annotation
34188 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
34189
34190 @smallexample
34191 ^Z^Zerror-begin
34192 @end smallexample
34193
34194 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
34195 message.
34196
34197 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
34198 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
34199 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
34200
34201 @node Invalidation
34202 @section Invalidation Notices
34203
34204 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
34205 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
34206 changed.
34207
34208 @table @code
34209 @findex frames-invalid annotation
34210 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
34211
34212 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
34213 have changed.
34214
34215 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
34216 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
34217
34218 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
34219 deleted a breakpoint.
34220 @end table
34221
34222 @node Annotations for Running
34223 @section Running the Program
34224 @cindex annotations for running programs
34225
34226 @findex starting annotation
34227 @findex stopping annotation
34228 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
34229 @code{step} or @code{continue},
34230
34231 @smallexample
34232 ^Z^Zstarting
34233 @end smallexample
34234
34235 is output. When the program stops,
34236
34237 @smallexample
34238 ^Z^Zstopped
34239 @end smallexample
34240
34241 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
34242 annotations describe how the program stopped.
34243
34244 @table @code
34245 @findex exited annotation
34246 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
34247 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
34248 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
34249
34250 @findex signalled annotation
34251 @findex signal-name annotation
34252 @findex signal-name-end annotation
34253 @findex signal-string annotation
34254 @findex signal-string-end annotation
34255 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
34256 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
34257 annotation continues:
34258
34259 @smallexample
34260 @var{intro-text}
34261 ^Z^Zsignal-name
34262 @var{name}
34263 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
34264 @var{middle-text}
34265 ^Z^Zsignal-string
34266 @var{string}
34267 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
34268 @var{end-text}
34269 @end smallexample
34270
34271 @noindent
34272 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
34273 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
34274 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
34275 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
34276 user's benefit and have no particular format.
34277
34278 @findex signal annotation
34279 @item ^Z^Zsignal
34280 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
34281 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
34282 terminated with it.
34283
34284 @findex breakpoint annotation
34285 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
34286 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
34287
34288 @findex watchpoint annotation
34289 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
34290 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
34291 @end table
34292
34293 @node Source Annotations
34294 @section Displaying Source
34295 @cindex annotations for source display
34296
34297 @findex source annotation
34298 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
34299
34300 @smallexample
34301 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
34302 @end smallexample
34303
34304 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
34305 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
34306 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
34307 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
34308 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
34309 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
34310 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
34311 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
34312 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
34313 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
34314 depend on the language).
34315
34316 @node JIT Interface
34317 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
34318 @cindex just-in-time compilation
34319 @cindex JIT compilation interface
34320
34321 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
34322 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
34323 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
34324 performance while maintaining platform independence.
34325
34326 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
34327 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
34328 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
34329 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
34330 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
34331 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
34332
34333 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
34334 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
34335 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
34336 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
34337 LLVM JIT.
34338
34339 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
34340 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
34341 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
34342 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
34343 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
34344 out about additional code.
34345
34346 @menu
34347 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
34348 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
34349 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
34350 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
34351 @end menu
34352
34353 @node Declarations
34354 @section JIT Declarations
34355
34356 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
34357 implement the interface:
34358
34359 @smallexample
34360 typedef enum
34361 @{
34362 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
34363 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
34364 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
34365 @} jit_actions_t;
34366
34367 struct jit_code_entry
34368 @{
34369 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
34370 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
34371 const char *symfile_addr;
34372 uint64_t symfile_size;
34373 @};
34374
34375 struct jit_descriptor
34376 @{
34377 uint32_t version;
34378 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
34379 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
34380 uint32_t action_flag;
34381 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
34382 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
34383 @};
34384
34385 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
34386 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
34387
34388 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
34389 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
34390 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
34391 @end smallexample
34392
34393 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
34394 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
34395 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
34396
34397 @node Registering Code
34398 @section Registering Code
34399
34400 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
34401
34402 @itemize @bullet
34403 @item
34404 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
34405 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
34406
34407 @item
34408 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
34409 file.
34410
34411 @item
34412 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
34413
34414 @item
34415 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
34416
34417 @item
34418 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
34419 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34420 @end itemize
34421
34422 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
34423 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
34424 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
34425 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
34426
34427 @node Unregistering Code
34428 @section Unregistering Code
34429
34430 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
34431
34432 @itemize @bullet
34433 @item
34434 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
34435
34436 @item
34437 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
34438
34439 @item
34440 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
34441 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34442 @end itemize
34443
34444 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
34445 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
34446
34447 @node Custom Debug Info
34448 @section Custom Debug Info
34449 @cindex custom JIT debug info
34450 @cindex JIT debug info reader
34451
34452 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
34453 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
34454 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
34455 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
34456 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
34457 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
34458 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
34459 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
34460 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
34461
34462 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
34463 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
34464 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
34465 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
34466 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
34467 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
34468 compiler.
34469
34470 @menu
34471 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
34472 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
34473 @end menu
34474
34475 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34476 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34477 @kindex jit-reader-load
34478 @kindex jit-reader-unload
34479
34480 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
34481 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
34482
34483 @table @code
34484 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
34485 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
34486 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
34487 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
34488 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
34489 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
34490 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
34491
34492 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
34493 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
34494 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
34495 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
34496 @code{jit-reader-load}.
34497
34498 @item jit-reader-unload
34499 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
34500
34501 @end table
34502
34503 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34504 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34505 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
34506
34507 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
34508 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
34509
34510 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
34511 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
34512 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
34513 the system include directory.
34514
34515 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
34516 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
34517 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
34518
34519 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
34520 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
34521
34522 @findex gdb_init_reader
34523 @smallexample
34524 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
34525 @end smallexample
34526
34527 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
34528
34529 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
34530 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
34531 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
34532 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
34533 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
34534 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
34535
34536 @smallexample
34537 struct gdb_reader_funcs
34538 @{
34539 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
34540 int reader_version;
34541
34542 /* For use by the reader. */
34543 void *priv_data;
34544
34545 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
34546 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
34547 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
34548 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
34549 @};
34550 @end smallexample
34551
34552 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
34553 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
34554
34555 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
34556 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
34557 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
34558 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
34559 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
34560 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
34561 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
34562 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
34563 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
34564 target's address space.
34565
34566 @node In-Process Agent
34567 @chapter In-Process Agent
34568 @cindex debugging agent
34569 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
34570 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
34571 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
34572 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
34573 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
34574 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
34575 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
34576 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
34577 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
34578 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
34579 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
34580 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
34581 behavior without interrupting it.
34582
34583 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
34584 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
34585 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
34586 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
34587 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
34588 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
34589 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
34590 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
34591 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
34592
34593 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
34594 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
34595 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
34596 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
34597
34598 @anchor{Control Agent}
34599 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
34600 debugging with the following commands:
34601
34602 @table @code
34603 @kindex set agent on
34604 @item set agent on
34605 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
34606 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
34607 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
34608 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
34609 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
34610 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
34611
34612 @kindex set agent off
34613 @item set agent off
34614 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
34615 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
34616
34617 @kindex show agent
34618 @item show agent
34619 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
34620 the in-process agent.
34621 @end table
34622
34623 @menu
34624 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
34625 @end menu
34626
34627 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
34628 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
34629 @cindex in-process agent protocol
34630
34631 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
34632 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
34633 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
34634 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
34635 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
34636 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
34637 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
34638 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
34639 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
34640
34641 @menu
34642 * IPA Protocol Objects::
34643 * IPA Protocol Commands::
34644 @end menu
34645
34646 @node IPA Protocol Objects
34647 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
34648 @cindex ipa protocol objects
34649
34650 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
34651 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
34652
34653 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
34654 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
34655 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
34656 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
34657
34658 @enumerate
34659 @item
34660 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
34661 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
34662 @item
34663 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
34664 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
34665 the other one.
34666 @end enumerate
34667
34668 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
34669
34670 @enumerate
34671 @item
34672 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
34673 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
34674 @anchor{agent expression object}
34675 @item
34676 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
34677 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
34678 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
34679 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
34680 @item
34681 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
34682 @anchor{tracepoint object}
34683
34684 @end enumerate
34685
34686 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
34687 object:
34688
34689 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
34690 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
34691 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
34692 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
34693 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
34694 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
34695 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34696 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
34697 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
34698 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
34699 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
34700 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
34701 memory address for collecting.
34702 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
34703 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34704 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
34705 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34706 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
34707 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34708 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
34709 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
34710 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
34711 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
34712 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
34713 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
34714 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
34715 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
34716 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
34717 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
34718 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
34719 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
34720 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
34721 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
34722 @ref{agent expression object}
34723 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
34724 @ref{agent expression object}
34725 @item actions @tab variable
34726 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
34727 @end multitable
34728
34729 @node IPA Protocol Commands
34730 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
34731 @cindex ipa protocol commands
34732
34733 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
34734 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
34735
34736 @table @samp
34737
34738 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
34739 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
34740 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
34741 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
34742 in IPA finally.
34743
34744 Replies:
34745 @table @samp
34746 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
34747 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
34748 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
34749 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
34750 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
34751 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
34752 @item E @var{NN}
34753 for an error
34754
34755 @end table
34756
34757 @item close
34758 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
34759 is about to kill inferiors.
34760
34761 @item qTfSTM
34762 @xref{qTfSTM}.
34763 @item qTsSTM
34764 @xref{qTsSTM}.
34765 @item qTSTMat
34766 @xref{qTSTMat}.
34767 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
34768 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
34769
34770 Replies:
34771 @table @samp
34772 @item E @var{NN}
34773 for an error
34774 @end table
34775 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
34776 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
34777 @end table
34778
34779 @node GDB Bugs
34780 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
34781 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
34782 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
34783
34784 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
34785
34786 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
34787 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
34788 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
34789 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
34790
34791 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
34792 information that enables us to fix the bug.
34793
34794 @menu
34795 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
34796 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
34797 @end menu
34798
34799 @node Bug Criteria
34800 @section Have You Found a Bug?
34801 @cindex bug criteria
34802
34803 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
34804
34805 @itemize @bullet
34806 @cindex fatal signal
34807 @cindex debugger crash
34808 @cindex crash of debugger
34809 @item
34810 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
34811 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
34812
34813 @cindex error on valid input
34814 @item
34815 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
34816 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
34817 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
34818
34819 @cindex invalid input
34820 @item
34821 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
34822 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
34823 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
34824 for traditional practice''.
34825
34826 @item
34827 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
34828 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
34829 @end itemize
34830
34831 @node Bug Reporting
34832 @section How to Report Bugs
34833 @cindex bug reports
34834 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
34835
34836 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
34837 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
34838 contact that organization first.
34839
34840 You can find contact information for many support companies and
34841 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
34842 distribution.
34843 @c should add a web page ref...
34844
34845 @ifset BUGURL
34846 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
34847 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34848 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
34849 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
34850 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
34851 be used.
34852
34853 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
34854 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
34855 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
34856 @samp{bug-gdb}.
34857
34858 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
34859 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
34860 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
34861 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
34862 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
34863 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
34864 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
34865 bug reports to the mailing list.
34866 @end ifset
34867 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
34868 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34869 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
34870 @end ifclear
34871 @end ifset
34872
34873 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
34874 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
34875 fact or leave it out, state it!
34876
34877 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
34878 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
34879 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
34880 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
34881 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
34882 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
34883 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
34884 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
34885 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
34886
34887 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
34888 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
34889 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
34890 self-contained.
34891
34892 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
34893 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
34894 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
34895 bugs properly.
34896
34897 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
34898
34899 @itemize @bullet
34900 @item
34901 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
34902 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
34903 version}.
34904
34905 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
34906 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
34907
34908 @item
34909 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
34910 version number.
34911
34912 @item
34913 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
34914 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
34915 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
34916 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
34917
34918 @item
34919 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
34920 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
34921
34922 @item
34923 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
34924 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
34925 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
34926 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
34927 those compilers.
34928
34929 @item
34930 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
34931 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
34932 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
34933 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
34934
34935 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
34936 and then we might not encounter the bug.
34937
34938 @item
34939 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
34940 reproduce the bug.
34941
34942 @item
34943 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
34944 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
34945
34946 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
34947 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
34948 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
34949 a chance to make a mistake.
34950
34951 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
34952 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
34953 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
34954 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
34955 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
34956 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
34957 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
34958 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
34959
34960 @pindex script
34961 @cindex recording a session script
34962 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
34963 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
34964 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
34965 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
34966
34967 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
34968 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
34969
34970 @item
34971 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
34972 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
34973 it by context, not by line number.
34974
34975 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
34976 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
34977
34978 @end itemize
34979
34980 Here are some things that are not necessary:
34981
34982 @itemize @bullet
34983 @item
34984 A description of the envelope of the bug.
34985
34986 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
34987 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
34988 changes will not affect it.
34989
34990 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
34991 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
34992 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
34993 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
34994
34995 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
34996 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
34997 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
34998 less time, and so on.
34999
35000 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
35001 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
35002
35003 @item
35004 A patch for the bug.
35005
35006 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
35007 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
35008 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
35009 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
35010
35011 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
35012 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
35013 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
35014 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
35015
35016 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
35017 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
35018 help us to understand.
35019
35020 @item
35021 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
35022
35023 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
35024 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
35025 @end itemize
35026
35027 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
35028 @c and consists of the two following files:
35029 @c rluser.texi
35030 @c hsuser.texi
35031 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
35032 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
35033 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
35034 @include rluser.texi
35035 @include hsuser.texi
35036 @end ifclear
35037
35038 @node In Memoriam
35039 @appendix In Memoriam
35040
35041 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
35042 contributors:
35043
35044 @table @code
35045 @item Fred Fish
35046 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
35047 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
35048 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
35049
35050 @item Michael Snyder
35051 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
35052 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
35053 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
35054 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
35055 @end table
35056
35057 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
35058 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
35059
35060 @node Formatting Documentation
35061 @appendix Formatting Documentation
35062
35063 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
35064 @cindex reference card
35065 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
35066 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
35067 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
35068 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
35069 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
35070 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
35071
35072 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
35073 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
35074
35075 @smallexample
35076 make refcard.dvi
35077 @end smallexample
35078
35079 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
35080 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
35081 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
35082 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
35083 your @sc{dvi} output program.
35084
35085 @cindex documentation
35086
35087 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
35088 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
35089 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
35090 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
35091 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
35092 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
35093
35094 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
35095 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
35096 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
35097 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
35098 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
35099 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
35100 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
35101 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
35102
35103 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
35104 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
35105 @code{makeinfo}.
35106
35107 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
35108 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
35109 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
35110
35111 @smallexample
35112 cd gdb
35113 make gdb.info
35114 @end smallexample
35115
35116 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
35117 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
35118 Texinfo definitions file.
35119
35120 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
35121 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
35122 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
35123 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
35124 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
35125 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
35126 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
35127
35128 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
35129 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
35130 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
35131 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
35132 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
35133 directory.
35134
35135 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
35136 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
35137 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
35138 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
35139
35140 @smallexample
35141 make gdb.dvi
35142 @end smallexample
35143
35144 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
35145
35146 @node Installing GDB
35147 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
35148 @cindex installation
35149
35150 @menu
35151 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
35152 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
35153 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
35154 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
35155 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
35156 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
35157 @end menu
35158
35159 @node Requirements
35160 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
35161 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
35162
35163 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
35164 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
35165
35166 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
35167 @table @asis
35168 @item ISO C90 compiler
35169 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
35170 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
35171
35172 @end table
35173
35174 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
35175 @table @asis
35176 @item Expat
35177 @anchor{Expat}
35178 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
35179 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
35180 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
35181 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
35182 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
35183 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
35184
35185 Expat is used for:
35186
35187 @itemize @bullet
35188 @item
35189 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
35190 @item
35191 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
35192 @item
35193 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
35194 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
35195 @item
35196 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
35197 @item
35198 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
35199 @item
35200 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
35201 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
35202 @end itemize
35203
35204 @item MPFR
35205 @anchor{MPFR}
35206 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
35207 library. This library may be included with your operating system
35208 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35209 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
35210 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
35211 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
35212 option to specify its location.
35213
35214 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
35215 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
35216 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
35217 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
35218
35219 @item zlib
35220 @cindex compressed debug sections
35221 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
35222 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
35223 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
35224 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
35225 information in such binaries.
35226
35227 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
35228 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35229 @url{http://zlib.net}.
35230
35231 @item iconv
35232 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
35233 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
35234 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
35235 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
35236
35237 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
35238 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
35239 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
35240 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
35241
35242 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
35243 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
35244 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
35245
35246 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
35247 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
35248 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
35249 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
35250 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
35251 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
35252 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
35253 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
35254 @end table
35255
35256 @node Running Configure
35257 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
35258 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
35259 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
35260 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
35261 build the @code{gdb} program.
35262 @iftex
35263 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
35264 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
35265 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
35266 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
35267 @end iftex
35268
35269 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
35270 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
35271 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
35272
35273 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
35274 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
35275
35276 @table @code
35277 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
35278 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
35279
35280 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
35281 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
35282
35283 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
35284 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
35285
35286 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
35287 @sc{gnu} include files
35288
35289 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
35290 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
35291
35292 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
35293 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
35294
35295 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
35296 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
35297
35298 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
35299 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
35300
35301 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
35302 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
35303 @end table
35304
35305 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
35306 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
35307 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
35308
35309 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
35310 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
35311 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
35312 argument.
35313
35314 For example:
35315
35316 @smallexample
35317 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35318 ./configure @var{host}
35319 make
35320 @end smallexample
35321
35322 @noindent
35323 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
35324 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
35325 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
35326 correct value by examining your system.)
35327
35328 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
35329 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
35330 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
35331 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
35332
35333 @need 750
35334 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
35335 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
35336 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
35337
35338 @smallexample
35339 sh configure @var{host}
35340 @end smallexample
35341
35342 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
35343 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
35344 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
35345 @file{configure}
35346 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
35347 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
35348
35349 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
35350 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
35351 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
35352 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
35353 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
35354 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
35355 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
35356 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
35357 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35358
35359 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
35360 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
35361 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
35362 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
35363 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
35364
35365 @node Separate Objdir
35366 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
35367
35368 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
35369 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
35370 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
35371 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
35372 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
35373 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
35374 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
35375 program specified there.
35376
35377 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
35378 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
35379 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
35380 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
35381 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
35382 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
35383
35384 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
35385 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
35386
35387 @smallexample
35388 @group
35389 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35390 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
35391 cd ../gdb-sun4
35392 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
35393 make
35394 @end group
35395 @end smallexample
35396
35397 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
35398 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
35399 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
35400 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
35401 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
35402 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
35403
35404 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
35405 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
35406 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
35407 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
35408 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35409
35410 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
35411 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
35412 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
35413 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
35414 You specify a cross-debugging target by
35415 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
35416
35417 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
35418 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
35419 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
35420
35421 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
35422 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
35423 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
35424 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
35425 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
35426
35427 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
35428 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
35429 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
35430 with each other.
35431
35432 @node Config Names
35433 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
35434
35435 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
35436 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
35437 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
35438 of information in the following pattern:
35439
35440 @smallexample
35441 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
35442 @end smallexample
35443
35444 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
35445 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
35446 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
35447
35448 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
35449 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
35450 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
35451 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
35452 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
35453 abbreviations---for example:
35454
35455 @smallexample
35456 % sh config.sub i386-linux
35457 i386-pc-linux-gnu
35458 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
35459 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
35460 % sh config.sub hp9k700
35461 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
35462 % sh config.sub sun4
35463 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
35464 % sh config.sub sun3
35465 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
35466 % sh config.sub i986v
35467 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
35468 @end smallexample
35469
35470 @noindent
35471 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
35472 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
35473
35474 @node Configure Options
35475 @section @file{configure} Options
35476
35477 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
35478 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
35479 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
35480 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
35481
35482 @smallexample
35483 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
35484 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35485 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35486 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
35487 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
35488 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
35489 @var{host}
35490 @end smallexample
35491
35492 @noindent
35493 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
35494 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
35495 @samp{--}.
35496
35497 @table @code
35498 @item --help
35499 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
35500
35501 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
35502 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
35503 @file{@var{dir}}.
35504
35505 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
35506 Configure the source to install programs under directory
35507 @file{@var{dir}}.
35508
35509 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
35510 @need 2000
35511 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
35512 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
35513 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
35514 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
35515 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
35516 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
35517 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
35518 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
35519 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
35520 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
35521 @var{dirname}.
35522
35523 @item --norecursion
35524 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
35525 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
35526
35527 @item --target=@var{target}
35528 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
35529 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
35530 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
35531
35532 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
35533
35534 @item @var{host} @dots{}
35535 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
35536
35537 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
35538 @end table
35539
35540 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
35541 needed for special purposes only.
35542
35543 @node System-wide configuration
35544 @section System-wide configuration and settings
35545 @cindex system-wide init file
35546
35547 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
35548 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
35549 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
35550
35551 Here is the corresponding configure option:
35552
35553 @table @code
35554 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
35555 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
35556 @var{file}.
35557 @end table
35558
35559 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
35560 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
35561
35562 @itemize @bullet
35563 @item
35564 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
35565 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
35566 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
35567 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
35568 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
35569 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
35570
35571 @item
35572 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
35573 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
35574 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35575 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35576 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
35577 @end itemize
35578
35579 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
35580 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
35581 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
35582 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
35583 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
35584 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
35585 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
35586 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
35587 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
35588 reread.
35589
35590 @menu
35591 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35592 @end menu
35593
35594 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
35595 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35596 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
35597
35598 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
35599 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
35600 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
35601 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
35602 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
35603 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
35604
35605 The following scripts are currently available:
35606 @itemize @bullet
35607
35608 @item @file{elinos.py}
35609 @pindex elinos.py
35610 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
35611 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
35612 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
35613 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
35614 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
35615 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
35616
35617 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
35618 @pindex wrs-linux.py
35619 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
35620 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
35621 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
35622 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
35623
35624 @end itemize
35625
35626 @node Maintenance Commands
35627 @appendix Maintenance Commands
35628 @cindex maintenance commands
35629 @cindex internal commands
35630
35631 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
35632 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
35633 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
35634 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
35635 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
35636
35637 @table @code
35638 @kindex maint agent
35639 @kindex maint agent-eval
35640 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35641 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35642 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
35643 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
35644 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
35645 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
35646 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
35647 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
35648 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
35649 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
35650 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
35651 addition and return the sum.
35652 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
35653 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
35654
35655 @kindex maint agent-printf
35656 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
35657 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
35658 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
35659 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
35660 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
35661
35662 @kindex maint info breakpoints
35663 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
35664 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
35665 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
35666 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
35667 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
35668 is shown:
35669
35670 @table @code
35671 @item breakpoint
35672 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
35673
35674 @item watchpoint
35675 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
35676
35677 @item longjmp
35678 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
35679 @code{longjmp} calls.
35680
35681 @item longjmp resume
35682 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
35683
35684 @item until
35685 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
35686
35687 @item finish
35688 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
35689
35690 @item shlib events
35691 Shared library events.
35692
35693 @end table
35694
35695 @kindex maint info btrace
35696 @item maint info btrace
35697 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
35698
35699 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
35700 @item maint btrace packet-history
35701 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
35702 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
35703 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
35704 recording format.
35705
35706 @table @code
35707 @item bts
35708 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
35709 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
35710
35711 @table @asis
35712 @item Block number
35713 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
35714 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
35715 @item Highest @samp{PC}
35716 @end table
35717
35718 @item pt
35719 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
35720 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
35721 information is printed:
35722
35723 @table @asis
35724 @item Packet number
35725 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
35726 @item Trace offset
35727 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
35728 @item Packet opcode and payload
35729 @end table
35730 @end table
35731
35732 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
35733 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
35734 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
35735 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
35736 needed.
35737
35738 @kindex maint btrace clear
35739 @item maint btrace clear
35740 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
35741 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
35742
35743 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
35744 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
35745 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
35746 buffer.
35747
35748 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
35749 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
35750 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
35751 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
35752 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
35753 packet history.
35754
35755 @kindex set displaced-stepping
35756 @kindex show displaced-stepping
35757 @cindex displaced stepping support
35758 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
35759 @item set displaced-stepping
35760 @itemx show displaced-stepping
35761 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
35762 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
35763 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
35764 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
35765 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
35766
35767 @table @code
35768 @item set displaced-stepping on
35769 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
35770 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
35771
35772 @item set displaced-stepping off
35773 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
35774 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
35775
35776 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
35777 @item set displaced-stepping auto
35778 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
35779 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
35780 architecture supports displaced stepping.
35781 @end table
35782
35783 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
35784 @item maint check-psymtabs
35785 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
35786 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
35787
35788 @kindex maint check-symtabs
35789 @item maint check-symtabs
35790 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
35791
35792 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
35793 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
35794 Expand symbol tables.
35795 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
35796 names matching @var{regexp}.
35797
35798 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
35799 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
35800 @cindex demangler crashes
35801 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
35802 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
35803 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
35804 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
35805 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
35806 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
35807 option to terminate the current session.
35808
35809 @kindex maint cplus first_component
35810 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
35811 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
35812
35813 @kindex maint cplus namespace
35814 @item maint cplus namespace
35815 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
35816
35817 @kindex maint deprecate
35818 @kindex maint undeprecate
35819 @cindex deprecated commands
35820 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
35821 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
35822 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
35823 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
35824 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
35825 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
35826 the replacement as part of the warning.
35827
35828 @kindex maint dump-me
35829 @item maint dump-me
35830 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
35831 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
35832 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
35833 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
35834
35835 @kindex maint internal-error
35836 @kindex maint internal-warning
35837 @kindex maint demangler-warning
35838 @cindex demangler crashes
35839 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35840 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35841 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35842
35843 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
35844 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
35845 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
35846 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
35847 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
35848 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
35849 @value{GDBN} session.
35850
35851 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
35852 used as the text of the error or warning message.
35853
35854 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
35855
35856 @smallexample
35857 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
35858 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
35859 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
35860 debugging may prove unreliable.
35861 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
35862 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
35863 (@value{GDBP})
35864 @end smallexample
35865
35866 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
35867 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
35868 @cindex demangler crashes
35869
35870 @kindex maint set internal-error
35871 @kindex maint show internal-error
35872 @kindex maint set internal-warning
35873 @kindex maint show internal-warning
35874 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
35875 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
35876 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35877 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
35878 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35879 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
35880 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35881 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
35882 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
35883 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
35884 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
35885 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
35886 described in the table below.
35887
35888 @table @samp
35889 @item quit
35890 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
35891 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
35892
35893 @item corefile
35894 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
35895 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
35896 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
35897 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
35898 disabled.
35899 @end table
35900
35901 @kindex maint packet
35902 @item maint packet @var{text}
35903 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
35904 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
35905 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
35906 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
35907 checksum.
35908
35909 @kindex maint print architecture
35910 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35911 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
35912 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
35913
35914 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35915 @item maint print c-tdesc
35916 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
35917 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
35918 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
35919 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
35920 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
35921 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
35922 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
35923 modify XML target descriptions.
35924
35925 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
35926 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
35927 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
35928 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
35929
35930 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
35931 @kindex maint check libthread-db
35932 @item maint check libthread-db
35933 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
35934 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
35935 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
35936 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
35937 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
35938 on some platforms when debugging core files.
35939
35940 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
35941 @item maint print dummy-frames
35942 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
35943
35944 @smallexample
35945 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
35946 @dots{}
35947 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
35948 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
35949 58 return (a + b);
35950 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
35951 @dots{}
35952 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
35953 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
35954 (@value{GDBP})
35955 @end smallexample
35956
35957 Takes an optional file parameter.
35958
35959 @kindex maint print registers
35960 @kindex maint print raw-registers
35961 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
35962 @kindex maint print register-groups
35963 @kindex maint print remote-registers
35964 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35965 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35966 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35967 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35968 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35969 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
35970
35971 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
35972 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
35973 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
35974 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
35975 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
35976 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
35977 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
35978 and offsets in the `G' packets.
35979
35980 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
35981 write the information.
35982
35983 @kindex maint print reggroups
35984 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35985 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
35986 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
35987 information.
35988
35989 The register groups info looks like this:
35990
35991 @smallexample
35992 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
35993 Group Type
35994 general user
35995 float user
35996 all user
35997 vector user
35998 system user
35999 save internal
36000 restore internal
36001 @end smallexample
36002
36003 @kindex flushregs
36004 @item flushregs
36005 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
36006
36007 @kindex maint print objfiles
36008 @cindex info for known object files
36009 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
36010 Print a dump of all known object files.
36011 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
36012 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
36013 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
36014
36015 @kindex maint print user-registers
36016 @cindex user registers
36017 @item maint print user-registers
36018 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
36019 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
36020 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
36021 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
36022 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
36023 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
36024 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
36025
36026 @kindex maint print section-scripts
36027 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
36028 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
36029 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
36030 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
36031 matching @var{regexp}.
36032 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
36033 and the full path if known.
36034 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
36035
36036 @kindex maint print statistics
36037 @cindex bcache statistics
36038 @item maint print statistics
36039 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
36040 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
36041 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
36042 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
36043 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
36044 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
36045 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
36046 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
36047 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
36048 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
36049 lengths.
36050
36051 @kindex maint print target-stack
36052 @cindex target stack description
36053 @item maint print target-stack
36054 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
36055 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
36056 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
36057 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
36058 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
36059 address.
36060
36061 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
36062 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
36063
36064 @kindex maint print type
36065 @cindex type chain of a data type
36066 @item maint print type @var{expr}
36067 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
36068 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
36069 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
36070 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
36071 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
36072
36073 @kindex maint selftest
36074 @cindex self tests
36075 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
36076 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
36077 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
36078 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
36079 name will by ran.
36080
36081 @kindex "maint info selftests"
36082 @cindex self tests
36083 @item maint info selftests
36084 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
36085
36086 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36087 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36088 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36089 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36090 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
36091 information.
36092
36093 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
36094 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
36095 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
36096 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
36097 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
36098 always see the disassembly form.
36099
36100 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
36101
36102 @smallexample
36103 (gdb) info addr argc
36104 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
36105 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
36106 @end smallexample
36107
36108 For more information on these expressions, see
36109 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
36110
36111 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36112 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36113 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36114 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36115 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
36116
36117 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
36118 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
36119 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
36120 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
36121 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
36122 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
36123 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
36124 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
36125 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
36126
36127 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
36128 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
36129 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
36130 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
36131 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
36132
36133 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
36134 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
36135 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
36136 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
36137 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
36138 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
36139
36140 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
36141 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
36142 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
36143
36144 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
36145 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
36146 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
36147 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
36148
36149 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
36150 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
36151 @kindex maint set profile
36152 @kindex maint show profile
36153 @cindex profiling GDB
36154 @item maint set profile
36155 @itemx maint show profile
36156 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
36157
36158 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
36159 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
36160 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
36161 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
36162 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
36163 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
36164 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
36165
36166 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
36167 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
36168
36169 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
36170 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
36171 @cindex hardware debug registers
36172 @item maint set show-debug-regs
36173 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
36174 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
36175 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
36176 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
36177 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
36178 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
36179
36180 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
36181 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
36182 @item maint set show-all-tib
36183 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
36184 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
36185 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
36186 command.
36187
36188 @kindex maint set target-async
36189 @kindex maint show target-async
36190 @item maint set target-async
36191 @itemx maint show target-async
36192 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
36193 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
36194 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
36195 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
36196
36197 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
36198 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
36199 @item maint set target-non-stop
36200 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
36201
36202 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
36203 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
36204 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
36205 if supported by the target.
36206
36207 @table @code
36208 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
36209 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
36210 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
36211
36212 @item maint set target-non-stop on
36213 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
36214 does not indicate support.
36215
36216 @item maint set target-non-stop off
36217 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
36218 target supports it.
36219 @end table
36220
36221 @kindex maint set per-command
36222 @kindex maint show per-command
36223 @item maint set per-command
36224 @itemx maint show per-command
36225 @cindex resources used by commands
36226
36227 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
36228 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
36229
36230 @table @code
36231 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
36232 @itemx maint show per-command space
36233 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
36234 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
36235 took, following the command's own output.
36236 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36237 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36238
36239 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
36240 @itemx maint show per-command time
36241 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
36242 for each command.
36243 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
36244 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
36245 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
36246 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
36247 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
36248 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
36249 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
36250 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
36251 spent by the program been debugged.
36252 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36253 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36254
36255 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
36256 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
36257 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
36258 for each command.
36259 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
36260
36261 @enumerate a
36262 @item
36263 number of symbol tables
36264 @item
36265 number of primary symbol tables
36266 @item
36267 number of blocks in the blockvector
36268 @end enumerate
36269 @end table
36270
36271 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
36272 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
36273 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
36274 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
36275 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
36276 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
36277 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
36278 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
36279 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
36280 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
36281
36282 @kindex maint space
36283 @cindex memory used by commands
36284 @item maint space @var{value}
36285 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
36286 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36287
36288 @kindex maint time
36289 @cindex time of command execution
36290 @item maint time @var{value}
36291 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
36292 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36293
36294 @kindex maint translate-address
36295 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
36296 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
36297 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
36298 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
36299 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
36300 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
36301 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
36302
36303 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
36304 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
36305 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
36306
36307 @end table
36308
36309 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
36310 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
36311
36312 @table @code
36313 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
36314 @kindex set watchdog
36315 @cindex watchdog timer
36316 @cindex timeout for commands
36317 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
36318 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
36319 reports and error and the command is aborted.
36320
36321 @item show watchdog
36322 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
36323 @end table
36324
36325 @node Remote Protocol
36326 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
36327
36328 @menu
36329 * Overview::
36330 * Packets::
36331 * Stop Reply Packets::
36332 * General Query Packets::
36333 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
36334 * Tracepoint Packets::
36335 * Host I/O Packets::
36336 * Interrupts::
36337 * Notification Packets::
36338 * Remote Non-Stop::
36339 * Packet Acknowledgment::
36340 * Examples::
36341 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
36342 * Library List Format::
36343 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
36344 * Memory Map Format::
36345 * Thread List Format::
36346 * Traceframe Info Format::
36347 * Branch Trace Format::
36348 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
36349 @end menu
36350
36351 @node Overview
36352 @section Overview
36353
36354 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
36355 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
36356 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
36357 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
36358
36359 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
36360 transmitted and received data, respectively.
36361
36362 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
36363 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
36364 @cindex remote serial protocol
36365 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
36366 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
36367 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
36368 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
36369 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
36370
36371 @smallexample
36372 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36373 @end smallexample
36374 @noindent
36375
36376 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
36377 @noindent
36378 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
36379 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
36380 eight bit unsigned checksum).
36381
36382 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
36383 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
36384
36385 @smallexample
36386 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36387 @end smallexample
36388
36389 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
36390 @noindent
36391 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
36392 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
36393 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
36394
36395 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
36396 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36397 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
36398 retransmission):
36399
36400 @smallexample
36401 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36402 <- @code{+}
36403 @end smallexample
36404 @noindent
36405
36406 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
36407 once a connection is established.
36408 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
36409
36410 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
36411 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
36412 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
36413 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
36414 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
36415 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
36416 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
36417
36418 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
36419 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
36420 exceptions).
36421
36422 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
36423 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
36424 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
36425 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
36426
36427 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
36428 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
36429 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
36430
36431 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
36432 @anchor{Binary Data}
36433 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
36434 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
36435 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
36436 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
36437 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
36438 binary data.
36439
36440 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
36441 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
36442 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
36443 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
36444 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
36445 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
36446 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
36447 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
36448 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
36449 (described next).
36450
36451 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
36452 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
36453 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
36454 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
36455 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
36456 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
36457 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
36458 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
36459 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
36460 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
36461 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
36462 3}} more times.
36463
36464 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
36465 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
36466 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
36467 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
36468 @samp{0*"00}.
36469
36470 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
36471 error number. That number is not well defined.
36472
36473 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
36474 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
36475 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
36476 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
36477 on that response.
36478
36479 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
36480 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
36481 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
36482 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
36483 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
36484 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
36485
36486 @node Packets
36487 @section Packets
36488
36489 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
36490 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
36491 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
36492 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
36493
36494 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
36495 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
36496 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
36497 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
36498 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
36499 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
36500 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
36501 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
36502 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
36503 @var{baz}.
36504
36505 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
36506 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
36507 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
36508 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
36509 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
36510 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
36511 pick any thread.
36512
36513 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
36514 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
36515 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
36516 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
36517 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
36518 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
36519 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
36520 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
36521 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
36522 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
36523 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
36524 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
36525 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
36526
36527 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
36528 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
36529 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
36530 more information.
36531
36532 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
36533 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
36534
36535 Here are the packet descriptions.
36536
36537 @table @samp
36538
36539 @item !
36540 @cindex @samp{!} packet
36541 @anchor{extended mode}
36542 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
36543 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
36544 debugged.
36545
36546 Reply:
36547 @table @samp
36548 @item OK
36549 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
36550 @end table
36551
36552 @item ?
36553 @cindex @samp{?} packet
36554 @anchor{? packet}
36555 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
36556 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
36557 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36558
36559 Reply:
36560 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36561
36562 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
36563 @cindex @samp{A} packet
36564 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
36565 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
36566 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
36567
36568 Reply:
36569 @table @samp
36570 @item OK
36571 The arguments were set.
36572 @item E @var{NN}
36573 An error occurred.
36574 @end table
36575
36576 @item b @var{baud}
36577 @cindex @samp{b} packet
36578 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
36579 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
36580
36581 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
36582 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
36583 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
36584
36585 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
36586 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
36587 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
36588 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
36589 of view, nothing actually happened.}
36590
36591 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
36592 @cindex @samp{B} packet
36593 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
36594 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
36595
36596 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
36597 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
36598
36599 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
36600 @anchor{bc}
36601 @item bc
36602 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
36603 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36604
36605 Reply:
36606 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36607
36608 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
36609 @anchor{bs}
36610 @item bs
36611 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
36612 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36613
36614 Reply:
36615 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36616
36617 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36618 @cindex @samp{c} packet
36619 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
36620 is omitted, resume at current address.
36621
36622 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36623 packet}.
36624
36625 Reply:
36626 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36627
36628 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36629 @cindex @samp{C} packet
36630 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
36631 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
36632
36633 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36634 packet}.
36635
36636 Reply:
36637 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36638
36639 @item d
36640 @cindex @samp{d} packet
36641 Toggle debug flag.
36642
36643 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
36644 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
36645
36646 @item D
36647 @itemx D;@var{pid}
36648 @cindex @samp{D} packet
36649 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
36650 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
36651 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
36652
36653 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
36654 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
36655 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
36656 big-endian hex string.
36657
36658 Reply:
36659 @table @samp
36660 @item OK
36661 for success
36662 @item E @var{NN}
36663 for an error
36664 @end table
36665
36666 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
36667 @cindex @samp{F} packet
36668 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
36669 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
36670 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
36671
36672 @item g
36673 @anchor{read registers packet}
36674 @cindex @samp{g} packet
36675 Read general registers.
36676
36677 Reply:
36678 @table @samp
36679 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36680 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
36681 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
36682 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
36683 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
36684 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
36685
36686 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
36687 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
36688 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
36689 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
36690 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
36691 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
36692 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
36693 have been collected, and both have zero value:
36694
36695 @smallexample
36696 -> @code{g}
36697 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
36698 @end smallexample
36699
36700 @item E @var{NN}
36701 for an error.
36702 @end table
36703
36704 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
36705 @cindex @samp{G} packet
36706 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
36707 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
36708
36709 Reply:
36710 @table @samp
36711 @item OK
36712 for success
36713 @item E @var{NN}
36714 for an error
36715 @end table
36716
36717 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
36718 @cindex @samp{H} packet
36719 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
36720 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
36721 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
36722 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
36723 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
36724 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
36725 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36726
36727 Reply:
36728 @table @samp
36729 @item OK
36730 for success
36731 @item E @var{NN}
36732 for an error
36733 @end table
36734
36735 @c FIXME: JTC:
36736 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
36737 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
36738 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
36739 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
36740 @c described. For example:
36741 @c
36742 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
36743 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
36744 @c otherwise returns current registers.
36745 @c
36746 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
36747 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
36748 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
36749
36750 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
36751 @anchor{cycle step packet}
36752 @cindex @samp{i} packet
36753 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
36754 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
36755 step starting at that address.
36756
36757 @item I
36758 @cindex @samp{I} packet
36759 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
36760 step packet}.
36761
36762 @item k
36763 @cindex @samp{k} packet
36764 Kill request.
36765
36766 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
36767
36768 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
36769 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
36770
36771 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
36772
36773 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
36774 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
36775 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
36776
36777 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
36778 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
36779 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
36780
36781 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
36782 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
36783 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
36784 (@pxref{? packet}).
36785
36786 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
36787 @cindex @samp{m} packet
36788 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
36789 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
36790 any particular boundary.
36791
36792 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
36793 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
36794 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
36795 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
36796 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
36797 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
36798 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
36799 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
36800
36801 Reply:
36802 @table @samp
36803 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36804 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
36805 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
36806 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
36807 @item E @var{NN}
36808 @var{NN} is errno
36809 @end table
36810
36811 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36812 @cindex @samp{M} packet
36813 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
36814 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
36815 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
36816
36817 Reply:
36818 @table @samp
36819 @item OK
36820 for success
36821 @item E @var{NN}
36822 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
36823 written).
36824 @end table
36825
36826 @item p @var{n}
36827 @cindex @samp{p} packet
36828 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
36829 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
36830 register value is encoded.
36831
36832 Reply:
36833 @table @samp
36834 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36835 the register's value
36836 @item E @var{NN}
36837 for an error
36838 @item @w{}
36839 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
36840 @end table
36841
36842 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
36843 @anchor{write register packet}
36844 @cindex @samp{P} packet
36845 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
36846 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
36847 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
36848
36849 Reply:
36850 @table @samp
36851 @item OK
36852 for success
36853 @item E @var{NN}
36854 for an error
36855 @end table
36856
36857 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
36858 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
36859 @cindex @samp{q} packet
36860 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
36861 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
36862 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
36863
36864 @item r
36865 @cindex @samp{r} packet
36866 Reset the entire system.
36867
36868 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
36869
36870 @item R @var{XX}
36871 @cindex @samp{R} packet
36872 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
36873 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36874
36875 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
36876
36877 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36878 @cindex @samp{s} packet
36879 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
36880 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
36881
36882 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36883 packet}.
36884
36885 Reply:
36886 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36887
36888 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36889 @anchor{step with signal packet}
36890 @cindex @samp{S} packet
36891 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
36892 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
36893
36894 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36895 packet}.
36896
36897 Reply:
36898 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36899
36900 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
36901 @cindex @samp{t} packet
36902 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
36903 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
36904 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
36905
36906 @item T @var{thread-id}
36907 @cindex @samp{T} packet
36908 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36909
36910 Reply:
36911 @table @samp
36912 @item OK
36913 thread is still alive
36914 @item E @var{NN}
36915 thread is dead
36916 @end table
36917
36918 @item v
36919 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
36920 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
36921
36922 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
36923 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
36924 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
36925 The process ID is a
36926 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
36927 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
36928 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
36929
36930 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
36931 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
36932 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
36933 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
36934 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
36935 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
36936 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
36937 @c stopping or restarting threads.
36938
36939 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36940
36941 Reply:
36942 @table @samp
36943 @item E @var{nn}
36944 for an error
36945 @item @r{Any stop packet}
36946 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
36947 @item OK
36948 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
36949 @end table
36950
36951 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
36952 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
36953 @anchor{vCont packet}
36954 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
36955
36956 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
36957 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
36958 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
36959 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
36960 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
36961 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
36962 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
36963 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
36964 error.
36965
36966 Currently supported actions are:
36967
36968 @table @samp
36969 @item c
36970 Continue.
36971 @item C @var{sig}
36972 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36973 @item s
36974 Step.
36975 @item S @var{sig}
36976 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36977 @item t
36978 Stop.
36979 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
36980 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
36981 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
36982 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
36983 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
36984 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
36985
36986 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
36987 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
36988 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
36989 jumps to @var{start}).
36990
36991 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
36992 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
36993 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
36994
36995 @end table
36996
36997 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
36998 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
36999 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
37000
37001 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
37002 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
37003 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
37004 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
37005 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
37006 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
37007 as an implementation detail.
37008
37009 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
37010 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
37011 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
37012 stopped.
37013
37014 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
37015 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
37016 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
37017
37018 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
37019 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
37020
37021 Reply:
37022 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37023
37024 @item vCont?
37025 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
37026 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
37027
37028 Reply:
37029 @table @samp
37030 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
37031 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
37032 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
37033 @item @w{}
37034 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
37035 @end table
37036
37037 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
37038 @item vCtrlC
37039 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
37040 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
37041 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
37042 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
37043 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
37044 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
37045 variant.
37046
37047 Reply:
37048 @table @samp
37049 @item E @var{nn}
37050 for an error
37051 @item OK
37052 for success
37053 @end table
37054
37055 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
37056 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
37057 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
37058 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
37059
37060 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
37061 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
37062 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
37063 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
37064 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
37065 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
37066 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
37067 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
37068 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37069 packet is received.
37070
37071 Reply:
37072 @table @samp
37073 @item OK
37074 for success
37075 @item E @var{NN}
37076 for an error
37077 @end table
37078
37079 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37080 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
37081 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
37082 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
37083 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
37084 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
37085 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
37086 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
37087 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
37088 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
37089 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
37090 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
37091
37092
37093 Reply:
37094 @table @samp
37095 @item OK
37096 for success
37097 @item E.memtype
37098 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
37099 @item E @var{NN}
37100 for an error
37101 @end table
37102
37103 @item vFlashDone
37104 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
37105 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
37106 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
37107 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
37108 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
37109 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37110 request is completed.
37111
37112 @item vKill;@var{pid}
37113 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
37114 @anchor{vKill packet}
37115 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
37116 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
37117 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
37118 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
37119
37120 Reply:
37121 @table @samp
37122 @item E @var{nn}
37123 for an error
37124 @item OK
37125 for success
37126 @end table
37127
37128 @item vMustReplyEmpty
37129 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
37130 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
37131 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
37132 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
37133
37134 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
37135 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
37136 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
37137 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
37138 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
37139 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
37140
37141 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
37142 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
37143 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
37144 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
37145 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
37146 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
37147 state.
37148
37149 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
37150
37151 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37152
37153 Reply:
37154 @table @samp
37155 @item E @var{nn}
37156 for an error
37157 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37158 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37159 @end table
37160
37161 @item vStopped
37162 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
37163 @xref{Notification Packets}.
37164
37165 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37166 @anchor{X packet}
37167 @cindex @samp{X} packet
37168 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
37169 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
37170 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
37171 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37172
37173 Reply:
37174 @table @samp
37175 @item OK
37176 for success
37177 @item E @var{NN}
37178 for an error
37179 @end table
37180
37181 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37182 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37183 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
37184 @cindex @samp{z} packet
37185 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
37186 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
37187 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
37188
37189 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
37190 separately.
37191
37192 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
37193 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
37194 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
37195 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
37196 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
37197 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
37198
37199 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37200 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37201 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
37202 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
37203 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
37204 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
37205
37206 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
37207 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
37208 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
37209 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
37210 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
37211 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
37212 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
37213 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
37214 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
37215 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
37216 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
37217 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
37218 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37219
37220 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
37221 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
37222
37223 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
37224 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
37225
37226 @table @samp
37227
37228 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37229 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37230 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
37231
37232 @end table
37233
37234 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
37235 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37236 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
37237 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
37238 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
37239 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
37240 separators. Each expression has the following form:
37241
37242 @table @samp
37243
37244 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37245 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37246 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
37247
37248 @end table
37249
37250 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
37251 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
37252 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
37253 target, is not defined.}
37254
37255 Reply:
37256 @table @samp
37257 @item OK
37258 success
37259 @item @w{}
37260 not supported
37261 @item E @var{NN}
37262 for an error
37263 @end table
37264
37265 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37266 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37267 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
37268 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
37269 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
37270 address @var{addr}.
37271
37272 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
37273 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
37274 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
37275 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
37276
37277 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
37278 movement.}
37279
37280 Reply:
37281 @table @samp
37282 @item OK
37283 success
37284 @item @w{}
37285 not supported
37286 @item E @var{NN}
37287 for an error
37288 @end table
37289
37290 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37291 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37292 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
37293 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
37294 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37295 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37296
37297 Reply:
37298 @table @samp
37299 @item OK
37300 success
37301 @item @w{}
37302 not supported
37303 @item E @var{NN}
37304 for an error
37305 @end table
37306
37307 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37308 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37309 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
37310 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
37311 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37312 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37313
37314 Reply:
37315 @table @samp
37316 @item OK
37317 success
37318 @item @w{}
37319 not supported
37320 @item E @var{NN}
37321 for an error
37322 @end table
37323
37324 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37325 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37326 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
37327 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
37328 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37329 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37330
37331 Reply:
37332 @table @samp
37333 @item OK
37334 success
37335 @item @w{}
37336 not supported
37337 @item E @var{NN}
37338 for an error
37339 @end table
37340
37341 @end table
37342
37343 @node Stop Reply Packets
37344 @section Stop Reply Packets
37345 @cindex stop reply packets
37346
37347 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
37348 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
37349 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
37350 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
37351 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
37352 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
37353 @value{GDBN} source code.
37354
37355 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
37356 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
37357 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37358
37359 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
37360 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
37361 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
37362 components.
37363
37364 @table @samp
37365
37366 @item S @var{AA}
37367 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37368 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
37369 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
37370
37371 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
37372 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
37373 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37374 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
37375 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
37376 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
37377 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
37378 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
37379
37380 @itemize @bullet
37381 @item
37382 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
37383 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
37384 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
37385 two-digit hex number.
37386
37387 @item
37388 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
37389 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37390
37391 @item
37392 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
37393 the core on which the stop event was detected.
37394
37395 @item
37396 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
37397 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
37398 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
37399 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
37400
37401 @item
37402 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
37403 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
37404 future.
37405 @end itemize
37406
37407 The currently defined stop reasons are:
37408
37409 @table @samp
37410 @item watch
37411 @itemx rwatch
37412 @itemx awatch
37413 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
37414 hex.
37415
37416 @item syscall_entry
37417 @itemx syscall_return
37418 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
37419 syscall number, in hex.
37420
37421 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
37422 @item library
37423 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
37424 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
37425 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
37426
37427 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
37428 @item replaylog
37429 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
37430 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
37431 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
37432 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
37433 for more information.
37434
37435 @item swbreak
37436 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
37437 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
37438 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
37439 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
37440 part must be left empty.
37441
37442 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
37443 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
37444 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
37445 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
37446 address.
37447
37448 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37449 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37450 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37451 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37452 indicating support.
37453
37454 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
37455
37456 @item hwbreak
37457 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
37458 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
37459
37460 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
37461 apply.
37462
37463 @cindex fork events, remote reply
37464 @item fork
37465 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
37466 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37467 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37468 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37469 fork events.
37470
37471 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37472 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37473 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37474 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37475 indicating support.
37476
37477 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
37478 @item vfork
37479 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
37480 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37481 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37482 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37483 vfork events.
37484
37485 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37486 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37487 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37488 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37489 indicating support.
37490
37491 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
37492 @item vforkdone
37493 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
37494 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
37495 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
37496 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
37497 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
37498
37499 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37500 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37501 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37502 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37503 indicating support.
37504
37505 @cindex exec events, remote reply
37506 @item exec
37507 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
37508 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
37509 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
37510
37511 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37512 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37513 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37514 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37515 indicating support.
37516
37517 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
37518 @anchor{thread create event}
37519 @item create
37520 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
37521 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
37522 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
37523 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
37524 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
37525 @var{r} part is ignored.
37526
37527 @end table
37528
37529 @item W @var{AA}
37530 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37531 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
37532 applicable to certain targets.
37533
37534 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37535 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37536 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37537 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37538 hex strings.
37539
37540 @item X @var{AA}
37541 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37542 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
37543
37544 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37545 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37546 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37547 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37548 hex strings.
37549
37550 @anchor{thread exit event}
37551 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
37552 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
37553
37554 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
37555 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
37556 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
37557 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
37558
37559 @item N
37560 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
37561 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
37562 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
37563 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
37564 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
37565 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
37566 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
37567 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
37568 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
37569 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
37570 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
37571 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
37572 support.
37573
37574 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
37575 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
37576 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
37577 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
37578 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
37579
37580 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
37581 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
37582 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
37583 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
37584 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
37585 system calls.
37586
37587 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
37588 this very system call.
37589
37590 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
37591 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
37592 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
37593 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37594 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
37595 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
37596
37597 @end table
37598
37599 @node General Query Packets
37600 @section General Query Packets
37601 @cindex remote query requests
37602
37603 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
37604 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
37605 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
37606 sending information to and from the stub.
37607
37608 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
37609 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
37610 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
37611 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
37612 conventions:
37613
37614 @itemize @bullet
37615 @item
37616 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
37617 @item
37618 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
37619 letter.
37620 @item
37621 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
37622 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
37623 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
37624 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
37625 @end itemize
37626
37627 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
37628 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
37629 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
37630 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
37631 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
37632 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
37633 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
37634 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
37635 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
37636 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
37637 packet.}.
37638
37639 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
37640 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
37641 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
37642 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
37643 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
37644
37645 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
37646
37647 @table @samp
37648
37649 @item QAgent:1
37650 @itemx QAgent:0
37651 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
37652 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
37653
37654 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
37655 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
37656 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
37657 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
37658 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
37659 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
37660 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
37661 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
37662 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
37663 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
37664 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
37665
37666 @item qC
37667 @cindex current thread, remote request
37668 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
37669 Return the current thread ID.
37670
37671 Reply:
37672 @table @samp
37673 @item QC @var{thread-id}
37674 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
37675 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37676 @item @r{(anything else)}
37677 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
37678 @end table
37679
37680 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
37681 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
37682 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
37683 @anchor{qCRC packet}
37684 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
37685 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
37686 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
37687 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
37688
37689 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
37690 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
37691 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
37692 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
37693 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
37694 detect trailing zeros.
37695
37696 Reply:
37697 @table @samp
37698 @item E @var{NN}
37699 An error (such as memory fault)
37700 @item C @var{crc32}
37701 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
37702 @end table
37703
37704 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
37705 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
37706 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
37707 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
37708 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
37709 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
37710 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
37711 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
37712 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
37713 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
37714 randomization.
37715
37716 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37717
37718 Reply:
37719 @table @samp
37720 @item OK
37721 The request succeeded.
37722
37723 @item E @var{nn}
37724 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37725
37726 @item @w{}
37727 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
37728 by the stub.
37729 @end table
37730
37731 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37732 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37733 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
37734 address space randomization.
37735
37736 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
37737 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
37738 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
37739 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
37740 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
37741 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
37742 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
37743 inferior using a shell or not.
37744
37745 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
37746 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
37747 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
37748 values are considered an error.
37749
37750 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37751 mode}).
37752
37753 Reply:
37754 @table @samp
37755 @item OK
37756 The request succeeded.
37757
37758 @item E @var{nn}
37759 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37760 @end table
37761
37762 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37763 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37764 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37765 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
37766
37767 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
37768 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
37769
37770 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
37771 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
37772 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
37773 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
37774 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
37775 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
37776 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
37777 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
37778 environment}).
37779
37780 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
37781 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
37782 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
37783 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
37784 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
37785 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
37786 not be present.
37787
37788 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37789 mode}).
37790
37791 Reply:
37792 @table @samp
37793 @item OK
37794 The request succeeded.
37795 @end table
37796
37797 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37798 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37799 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37800 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37801 inferior.
37802
37803 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
37804 @pxref{set environment}.
37805
37806 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
37807 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
37808 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
37809 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
37810 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
37811 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
37812 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
37813 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
37814
37815 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
37816 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
37817
37818 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37819 mode}).
37820
37821 Reply:
37822 @table @samp
37823 @item OK
37824 The request succeeded.
37825 @end table
37826
37827 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37828 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37829 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37830 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37831 inferior.
37832
37833 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
37834 @pxref{unset environment}.
37835
37836 @item QEnvironmentReset
37837 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
37838 @cindex reset environment, remote request
37839 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
37840 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
37841 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
37842 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
37843 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
37844 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
37845 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
37846 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
37847 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
37848
37849 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37850 mode}).
37851
37852 Reply:
37853 @table @samp
37854 @item OK
37855 The request succeeded.
37856 @end table
37857
37858 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37859 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37860 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37861 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37862 inferior.
37863
37864 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
37865 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
37866 @cindex set working directory, remote request
37867 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
37868 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
37869 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
37870
37871 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
37872 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
37873 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
37874 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
37875 directory to its original, empty value.
37876
37877 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37878 mode}).
37879
37880 Reply:
37881 @table @samp
37882 @item OK
37883 The request succeeded.
37884 @end table
37885
37886 @item qfThreadInfo
37887 @itemx qsThreadInfo
37888 @cindex list active threads, remote request
37889 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
37890 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
37891 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
37892 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
37893 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
37894 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
37895 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
37896 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
37897
37898 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
37899
37900 Reply:
37901 @table @samp
37902 @item m @var{thread-id}
37903 A single thread ID
37904 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
37905 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
37906 @item l
37907 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37908 @end table
37909
37910 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37911 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
37912 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
37913 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
37914 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
37915 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37916 fields.
37917
37918 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
37919 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
37920 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
37921 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
37922 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
37923
37924 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
37925 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
37926 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
37927 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
37928 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
37929
37930 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
37931 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37932
37933 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
37934 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
37935 information associated with the variable.)
37936
37937 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
37938 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
37939 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
37940 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
37941 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
37942 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
37943
37944 Reply:
37945 @table @samp
37946 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37947 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
37948 local storage requested.
37949
37950 @item E @var{nn}
37951 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37952
37953 @item @w{}
37954 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37955 @end table
37956
37957 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
37958 @cindex get thread information block address
37959 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
37960 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
37961
37962 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
37963
37964 Reply:
37965 @table @samp
37966 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37967 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
37968 thread information block.
37969
37970 @item E @var{nn}
37971 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
37972 address could not be retrieved.
37973
37974 @item @w{}
37975 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37976 @end table
37977
37978 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
37979 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
37980 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
37981 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
37982 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
37983 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
37984 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
37985
37986 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
37987
37988 Reply:
37989 @table @samp
37990 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
37991 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
37992 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
37993 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
37994 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
37995 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
37996 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
37997 @end table
37998
37999 @item qOffsets
38000 @cindex section offsets, remote request
38001 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
38002 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
38003 image.
38004
38005 Reply:
38006 @table @samp
38007 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
38008 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
38009 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
38010 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
38011 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
38012 segments by the supplied offsets.
38013
38014 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
38015 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
38016 to the @code{Bss} section.}
38017
38018 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
38019 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
38020 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
38021 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
38022 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
38023 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
38024 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
38025 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
38026 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
38027 @end table
38028
38029 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
38030 @cindex thread information, remote request
38031 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
38032 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
38033 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
38034 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
38035
38036 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
38037 (see below).
38038
38039 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
38040
38041 @item QNonStop:1
38042 @itemx QNonStop:0
38043 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
38044 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
38045 @anchor{QNonStop}
38046 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
38047 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
38048
38049 Reply:
38050 @table @samp
38051 @item OK
38052 The request succeeded.
38053
38054 @item E @var{nn}
38055 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38056
38057 @item @w{}
38058 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
38059 the stub.
38060 @end table
38061
38062 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38063 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38064 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
38065 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
38066
38067 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
38068 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
38069 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
38070 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38071 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
38072 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
38073 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
38074
38075 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
38076 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
38077 is listed, every system call should be reported.
38078
38079 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
38080 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
38081 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
38082 report the requested syscalls.
38083
38084 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
38085 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38086
38087 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
38088 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
38089 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
38090 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
38091
38092 Reply:
38093 @table @samp
38094 @item OK
38095 The request succeeded.
38096
38097 @item E @var{nn}
38098 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38099
38100 @item @w{}
38101 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
38102 the stub.
38103 @end table
38104
38105 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
38106 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
38107 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38108 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38109
38110 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38111 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
38112 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38113 @anchor{QPassSignals}
38114 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
38115 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38116 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38117 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
38118 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
38119 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
38120 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
38121 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
38122 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
38123
38124 Reply:
38125 @table @samp
38126 @item OK
38127 The request succeeded.
38128
38129 @item E @var{nn}
38130 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38131
38132 @item @w{}
38133 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
38134 the stub.
38135 @end table
38136
38137 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
38138 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
38139 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38140 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38141
38142 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38143 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
38144 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
38145 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
38146 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
38147 Others should be silently discarded.
38148
38149 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
38150 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
38151 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
38152 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
38153 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
38154 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
38155 signals.
38156
38157 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
38158 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
38159
38160 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38161 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38162 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
38163 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
38164 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38165
38166 Reply:
38167 @table @samp
38168 @item OK
38169 The request succeeded.
38170
38171 @item E @var{nn}
38172 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38173
38174 @item @w{}
38175 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
38176 by the stub.
38177 @end table
38178
38179 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
38180 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
38181 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38182 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38183
38184 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
38185 @item QThreadEvents:1
38186 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
38187 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
38188 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
38189
38190 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
38191 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
38192 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
38193 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
38194 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
38195 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
38196 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
38197 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
38198 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
38199 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38200
38201 Reply:
38202 @table @samp
38203 @item OK
38204 The request succeeded.
38205
38206 @item E @var{nn}
38207 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38208
38209 @item @w{}
38210 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
38211 the stub.
38212 @end table
38213
38214 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
38215 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
38216
38217 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
38218 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
38219 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
38220 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
38221 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
38222 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
38223 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
38224 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
38225 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
38226
38227 Reply:
38228 @table @samp
38229 @item OK
38230 A command response with no output.
38231 @item @var{OUTPUT}
38232 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
38233 @item E @var{NN}
38234 Indicate a badly formed request.
38235 @item @w{}
38236 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
38237 @end table
38238
38239 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
38240 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38241 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38242 packets.)
38243
38244 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
38245 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
38246 @ifnotinfo
38247 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
38248 @end ifnotinfo
38249 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
38250 @anchor{qSearch memory}
38251 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
38252 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
38253 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
38254
38255 Reply:
38256 @table @samp
38257 @item 0
38258 The pattern was not found.
38259 @item 1,address
38260 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
38261 @item E @var{NN}
38262 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
38263 @item @w{}
38264 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
38265 @end table
38266
38267 @item QStartNoAckMode
38268 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
38269 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
38270 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
38271 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
38272
38273 Reply:
38274 @table @samp
38275 @item OK
38276 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
38277 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
38278 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
38279 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
38280 @item @w{}
38281 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
38282 @end table
38283
38284 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
38285 @cindex supported packets, remote query
38286 @cindex features of the remote protocol
38287 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
38288 @anchor{qSupported}
38289 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
38290 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
38291 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
38292 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
38293 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
38294 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
38295 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
38296 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
38297 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
38298 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
38299 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
38300 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
38301 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
38302 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
38303
38304 Reply:
38305 @table @samp
38306 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
38307 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
38308 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
38309 possible forms).
38310 @item @w{}
38311 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
38312 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
38313 @end table
38314
38315 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
38316 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
38317 are:
38318
38319 @table @samp
38320 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
38321 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
38322 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
38323 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
38324 @item @var{name}+
38325 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
38326 need an associated value.
38327 @item @var{name}-
38328 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
38329 @item @var{name}?
38330 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
38331 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
38332 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
38333 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
38334 @end table
38335
38336 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
38337 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
38338 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
38339 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
38340 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
38341
38342 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
38343 are defined:
38344
38345 @table @samp
38346 @item multiprocess
38347 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
38348 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38349 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38350 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38351 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
38352
38353 @item xmlRegisters
38354 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
38355 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
38356 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
38357 description.
38358
38359 @item qRelocInsn
38360 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
38361 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38362 instruction reply packet}).
38363
38364 @item swbreak
38365 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
38366 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38367
38368 @item hwbreak
38369 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
38370 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38371
38372 @item fork-events
38373 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
38374 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38375 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38376 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38377
38378 @item vfork-events
38379 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
38380 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38381 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38382 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38383
38384 @item exec-events
38385 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
38386 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38387 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38388 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38389
38390 @item vContSupported
38391 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
38392 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
38393 @end table
38394
38395 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
38396 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
38397 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
38398 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
38399 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
38400 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
38401 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
38402 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
38403 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
38404 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
38405 all the features it supports.
38406
38407 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
38408 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
38409
38410 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
38411 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
38412 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
38413 form response.
38414
38415 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
38416 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
38417 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
38418 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
38419
38420 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
38421 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
38422 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
38423 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
38424 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
38425
38426 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
38427
38428 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
38429 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
38430 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
38431 @item Feature Name
38432 @tab Value Required
38433 @tab Default
38434 @tab Probe Allowed
38435
38436 @item @samp{PacketSize}
38437 @tab Yes
38438 @tab @samp{-}
38439 @tab No
38440
38441 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
38442 @tab No
38443 @tab @samp{-}
38444 @tab Yes
38445
38446 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38447 @tab No
38448 @tab @samp{-}
38449 @tab Yes
38450
38451 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38452 @tab No
38453 @tab @samp{-}
38454 @tab Yes
38455
38456 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
38457 @tab No
38458 @tab @samp{-}
38459 @tab Yes
38460
38461 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
38462 @tab No
38463 @tab @samp{-}
38464 @tab Yes
38465
38466 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38467 @tab No
38468 @tab @samp{-}
38469 @tab Yes
38470
38471 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
38472 @tab No
38473 @tab @samp{-}
38474 @tab Yes
38475
38476 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
38477 @tab No
38478 @tab @samp{-}
38479 @tab No
38480
38481 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38482 @tab No
38483 @tab @samp{-}
38484 @tab Yes
38485
38486 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
38487 @tab No
38488 @tab @samp{-}
38489 @tab Yes
38490
38491 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
38492 @tab No
38493 @tab @samp{-}
38494 @tab Yes
38495
38496 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
38497 @tab No
38498 @tab @samp{-}
38499 @tab Yes
38500
38501 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
38502 @tab No
38503 @tab @samp{-}
38504 @tab Yes
38505
38506 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
38507 @tab No
38508 @tab @samp{-}
38509 @tab Yes
38510
38511 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
38512 @tab No
38513 @tab @samp{-}
38514 @tab Yes
38515
38516 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38517 @tab No
38518 @tab @samp{-}
38519 @tab Yes
38520
38521 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38522 @tab No
38523 @tab @samp{-}
38524 @tab Yes
38525
38526 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38527 @tab No
38528 @tab @samp{-}
38529 @tab Yes
38530
38531 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
38532 @tab Yes
38533 @tab @samp{-}
38534 @tab Yes
38535
38536 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
38537 @tab Yes
38538 @tab @samp{-}
38539 @tab Yes
38540
38541 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
38542 @tab Yes
38543 @tab @samp{-}
38544 @tab Yes
38545
38546 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
38547 @tab Yes
38548 @tab @samp{-}
38549 @tab Yes
38550
38551 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
38552 @tab Yes
38553 @tab @samp{-}
38554 @tab Yes
38555
38556 @item @samp{QNonStop}
38557 @tab No
38558 @tab @samp{-}
38559 @tab Yes
38560
38561 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
38562 @tab No
38563 @tab @samp{-}
38564 @tab Yes
38565
38566 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
38567 @tab No
38568 @tab @samp{-}
38569 @tab Yes
38570
38571 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
38572 @tab No
38573 @tab @samp{-}
38574 @tab Yes
38575
38576 @item @samp{multiprocess}
38577 @tab No
38578 @tab @samp{-}
38579 @tab No
38580
38581 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
38582 @tab No
38583 @tab @samp{-}
38584 @tab No
38585
38586 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
38587 @tab No
38588 @tab @samp{-}
38589 @tab No
38590
38591 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
38592 @tab No
38593 @tab @samp{-}
38594 @tab No
38595
38596 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
38597 @tab No
38598 @tab @samp{-}
38599 @tab No
38600
38601 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
38602 @tab No
38603 @tab @samp{-}
38604 @tab No
38605
38606 @item @samp{QAgent}
38607 @tab No
38608 @tab @samp{-}
38609 @tab No
38610
38611 @item @samp{QAllow}
38612 @tab No
38613 @tab @samp{-}
38614 @tab No
38615
38616 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
38617 @tab No
38618 @tab @samp{-}
38619 @tab No
38620
38621 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
38622 @tab No
38623 @tab @samp{-}
38624 @tab No
38625
38626 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
38627 @tab No
38628 @tab @samp{-}
38629 @tab No
38630
38631 @item @samp{tracenz}
38632 @tab No
38633 @tab @samp{-}
38634 @tab No
38635
38636 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
38637 @tab No
38638 @tab @samp{-}
38639 @tab No
38640
38641 @item @samp{swbreak}
38642 @tab No
38643 @tab @samp{-}
38644 @tab No
38645
38646 @item @samp{hwbreak}
38647 @tab No
38648 @tab @samp{-}
38649 @tab No
38650
38651 @item @samp{fork-events}
38652 @tab No
38653 @tab @samp{-}
38654 @tab No
38655
38656 @item @samp{vfork-events}
38657 @tab No
38658 @tab @samp{-}
38659 @tab No
38660
38661 @item @samp{exec-events}
38662 @tab No
38663 @tab @samp{-}
38664 @tab No
38665
38666 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
38667 @tab No
38668 @tab @samp{-}
38669 @tab No
38670
38671 @item @samp{no-resumed}
38672 @tab No
38673 @tab @samp{-}
38674 @tab No
38675
38676 @end multitable
38677
38678 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
38679
38680 @table @samp
38681 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
38682 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
38683 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
38684 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
38685 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
38686 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
38687 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
38688 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
38689 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
38690 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
38691
38692 @item qXfer:auxv:read
38693 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
38694 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
38695
38696 @item qXfer:btrace:read
38697 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38698 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
38699
38700 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
38701 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38702 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
38703
38704 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
38705 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
38706 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
38707
38708 @item qXfer:features:read
38709 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
38710 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
38711
38712 @item qXfer:libraries:read
38713 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
38714 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
38715
38716 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
38717 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
38718 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
38719
38720 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
38721 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
38722 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
38723 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
38724
38725 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
38726 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
38727 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
38728
38729 @item qXfer:sdata:read
38730 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
38731 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
38732
38733 @item qXfer:spu:read
38734 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
38735 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
38736
38737 @item qXfer:spu:write
38738 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
38739 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
38740
38741 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
38742 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
38743 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
38744
38745 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
38746 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
38747 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
38748
38749 @item qXfer:threads:read
38750 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
38751 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
38752
38753 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
38754 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38755 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
38756
38757 @item qXfer:uib:read
38758 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38759 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
38760
38761 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
38762 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38763 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
38764
38765 @item QNonStop
38766 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
38767 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
38768
38769 @item QCatchSyscalls
38770 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38771 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
38772
38773 @item QPassSignals
38774 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38775 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
38776
38777 @item QStartNoAckMode
38778 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
38779 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
38780
38781 @item multiprocess
38782 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
38783 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
38784 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
38785 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
38786 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
38787 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
38788 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
38789 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
38790 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
38791 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
38792 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
38793
38794 @item qXfer:osdata:read
38795 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
38796 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
38797
38798 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
38799 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
38800 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
38801 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
38802
38803 @item ConditionalTracepoints
38804 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
38805 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
38806
38807 @item ReverseContinue
38808 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
38809 (@pxref{bc}).
38810
38811 @item ReverseStep
38812 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
38813 (@pxref{bs}).
38814
38815 @item TracepointSource
38816 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
38817 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
38818
38819 @item QAgent
38820 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
38821
38822 @item QAllow
38823 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
38824
38825 @item QDisableRandomization
38826 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
38827
38828 @item StaticTracepoint
38829 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
38830 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
38831
38832 @item InstallInTrace
38833 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
38834 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
38835
38836 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
38837 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
38838 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
38839 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
38840
38841 @item QTBuffer:size
38842 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
38843 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
38844
38845 @item tracenz
38846 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
38847 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
38848 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
38849
38850 @item BreakpointCommands
38851 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
38852 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
38853 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
38854
38855 @item Qbtrace:off
38856 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
38857
38858 @item Qbtrace:bts
38859 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
38860
38861 @item Qbtrace:pt
38862 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
38863
38864 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
38865 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
38866
38867 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
38868 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
38869
38870 @item swbreak
38871 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
38872 breakpoints.
38873
38874 @item hwbreak
38875 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
38876 breakpoints.
38877
38878 @item fork-events
38879 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
38880
38881 @item vfork-events
38882 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
38883 and vforkdone events.
38884
38885 @item exec-events
38886 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
38887
38888 @item vContSupported
38889 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
38890 @samp{vCont?} packet.
38891
38892 @item QThreadEvents
38893 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
38894
38895 @item no-resumed
38896 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
38897
38898 @end table
38899
38900 @item qSymbol::
38901 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
38902 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
38903 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
38904 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
38905
38906 Reply:
38907 @table @samp
38908 @item OK
38909 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38910 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38911 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
38912 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
38913 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
38914 below.
38915 @end table
38916
38917 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
38918 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
38919
38920 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
38921 target has previously requested.
38922
38923 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
38924 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
38925 will be empty.
38926
38927 Reply:
38928 @table @samp
38929 @item OK
38930 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38931 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38932 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
38933 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
38934 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
38935 @end table
38936
38937 @item qTBuffer
38938 @itemx QTBuffer
38939 @itemx QTDisconnected
38940 @itemx QTDP
38941 @itemx QTDPsrc
38942 @itemx QTDV
38943 @itemx qTfP
38944 @itemx qTfV
38945 @itemx QTFrame
38946 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
38947
38948 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38949
38950 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
38951 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
38952 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
38953 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
38954 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
38955 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
38956 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
38957 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
38958 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
38959 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
38960 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
38961
38962 Reply:
38963 @table @samp
38964 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38965 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
38966 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
38967 the thread's attributes.
38968 @end table
38969
38970 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
38971 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38972 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38973 packets.)
38974
38975 @item QTNotes
38976 @itemx qTP
38977 @itemx QTSave
38978 @itemx qTsP
38979 @itemx qTsV
38980 @itemx QTStart
38981 @itemx QTStop
38982 @itemx QTEnable
38983 @itemx QTDisable
38984 @itemx QTinit
38985 @itemx QTro
38986 @itemx qTStatus
38987 @itemx qTV
38988 @itemx qTfSTM
38989 @itemx qTsSTM
38990 @itemx qTSTMat
38991 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38992
38993 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38994 @cindex read special object, remote request
38995 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
38996 @anchor{qXfer read}
38997 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
38998 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
38999 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
39000 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
39001 additional details about what data to access.
39002
39003 Reply:
39004 @table @samp
39005 @item m @var{data}
39006 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
39007 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
39008 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
39009 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
39010 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
39011 request.
39012
39013 @item l @var{data}
39014 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
39015 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
39016 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
39017
39018 @item l
39019 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
39020 There is no more data to be read.
39021
39022 @item E00
39023 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39024
39025 @item E @var{nn}
39026 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
39027 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39028
39029 @item @w{}
39030 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
39031 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
39032 @end table
39033
39034 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39035 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39036 formats, listed above.
39037
39038 @table @samp
39039 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39040 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
39041 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
39042 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
39043
39044 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39045 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39046
39047 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39048 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
39049
39050 Return a description of the current branch trace.
39051 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
39052 packet may have one of the following values:
39053
39054 @table @code
39055 @item all
39056 Returns all available branch trace.
39057
39058 @item new
39059 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
39060 the last read request.
39061
39062 @item delta
39063 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
39064 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
39065 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
39066 used to stitch traces together.
39067
39068 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
39069 @end table
39070
39071 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39072 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39073
39074 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39075 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
39076
39077 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
39078 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
39079
39080 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39081 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39082
39083 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39084 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
39085 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
39086 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
39087 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
39088 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
39089 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
39090
39091 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39092 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39093
39094 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39095 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
39096 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
39097 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
39098 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
39099
39100 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39101 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39102
39103 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39104 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
39105 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
39106 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39107 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39108
39109 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
39110 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
39111 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
39112
39113 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39114 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39115
39116 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39117 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
39118 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
39119 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
39120 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
39121 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
39122 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39123 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
39124
39125 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
39126 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
39127
39128 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39129 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39130
39131 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
39132 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
39133 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
39134 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
39135
39136 @table @code
39137 @item start=@var{address}
39138 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39139 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
39140 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
39141 chosen as the starting point.
39142
39143 @item prev=@var{address}
39144 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39145 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
39146 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
39147 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
39148 exists prior to the starting point.
39149
39150 @end table
39151
39152 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
39153 ignored.
39154
39155 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39156 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
39157 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
39158 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39159 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39160
39161 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39162 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39163
39164 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39165 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
39166
39167 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
39168 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
39169 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
39170 Action Lists}.
39171
39172 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39173 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39174 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39175
39176 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39177 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
39178 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
39179 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39180 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39181
39182 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39183 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39184 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39185
39186 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39187 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
39188 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39189 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
39190 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39191 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39192 in that context to be accessed.
39193
39194 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39195 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39196 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39197
39198 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39199 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
39200 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
39201 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39202 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39203
39204 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39205 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39206
39207 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39208 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
39209
39210 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
39211 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
39212 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39213
39214 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39215 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39216
39217 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39218 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
39219
39220 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
39221 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
39222
39223 This packet is not probed by default.
39224
39225 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39226 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
39227 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
39228 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
39229 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
39230
39231 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39232 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39233
39234 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39235 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
39236 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
39237 @xref{Operating System Information}.
39238
39239 @end table
39240
39241 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39242 @cindex write data into object, remote request
39243 @anchor{qXfer write}
39244 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
39245 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
39246 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
39247 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
39248 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
39249 to access.
39250
39251 Reply:
39252 @table @samp
39253 @item @var{nn}
39254 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
39255 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
39256
39257 @item E00
39258 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39259
39260 @item E @var{nn}
39261 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
39262 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39263
39264 @item @w{}
39265 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
39266 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
39267 @end table
39268
39269 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39270 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39271 formats, listed above.
39272
39273 @table @samp
39274 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39275 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
39276 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
39277 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39278 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
39279
39280 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39281 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39282 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39283
39284 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39285 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
39286 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39287 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
39288 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39289 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39290 in that context to be accessed.
39291
39292 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39293 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39294 @end table
39295
39296 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
39297 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
39298 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
39299 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
39300 must respond with an empty packet.
39301
39302 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
39303 @cindex query attached, remote request
39304 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
39305 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
39306 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
39307 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
39308 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
39309 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
39310 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
39311
39312 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
39313 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
39314 the @code{quit} command.
39315
39316 Reply:
39317 @table @samp
39318 @item 1
39319 The remote server attached to an existing process.
39320 @item 0
39321 The remote server created a new process.
39322 @item E @var{NN}
39323 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39324 @end table
39325
39326 @item Qbtrace:bts
39327 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
39328
39329 Reply:
39330 @table @samp
39331 @item OK
39332 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39333 @item E.errtext
39334 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39335 @end table
39336
39337 @item Qbtrace:pt
39338 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
39339
39340 Reply:
39341 @table @samp
39342 @item OK
39343 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39344 @item E.errtext
39345 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39346 @end table
39347
39348 @item Qbtrace:off
39349 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
39350
39351 Reply:
39352 @table @samp
39353 @item OK
39354 Branch tracing has been disabled.
39355 @item E.errtext
39356 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39357 @end table
39358
39359 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
39360 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39361 btrace recording method in bts format.
39362
39363 Reply:
39364 @table @samp
39365 @item OK
39366 The ring buffer size has been set.
39367 @item E.errtext
39368 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39369 @end table
39370
39371 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
39372 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39373 btrace recording method in pt format.
39374
39375 Reply:
39376 @table @samp
39377 @item OK
39378 The ring buffer size has been set.
39379 @item E.errtext
39380 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39381 @end table
39382
39383 @end table
39384
39385 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39386 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39387
39388 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
39389 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
39390 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
39391
39392 @menu
39393 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
39394 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
39395 @end menu
39396
39397 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
39398 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
39399
39400 @menu
39401 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
39402 @end menu
39403
39404 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
39405 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
39406 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
39407
39408 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39409
39410 @table @r
39411
39412 @item 2
39413 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
39414
39415 @item 3
39416 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
39417
39418 @item 4
39419 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
39420
39421 @end table
39422
39423 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
39424 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
39425
39426 @menu
39427 * MIPS Register packet Format::
39428 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
39429 @end menu
39430
39431 @node MIPS Register packet Format
39432 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
39433 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
39434
39435 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
39436 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
39437 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
39438 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
39439 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
39440 most-significant -- least-significant.
39441
39442 @table @r
39443
39444 @item MIPS32
39445 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
39446 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
39447 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
39448
39449 @item MIPS64
39450 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
39451 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
39452 as @code{MIPS32}.
39453
39454 @end table
39455
39456 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
39457 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
39458 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
39459
39460 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39461
39462 @table @r
39463
39464 @item 2
39465 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
39466
39467 @item 3
39468 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39469
39470 @item 4
39471 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
39472
39473 @item 5
39474 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39475
39476 @end table
39477
39478 @node Tracepoint Packets
39479 @section Tracepoint Packets
39480 @cindex tracepoint packets
39481 @cindex packets, tracepoint
39482
39483 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
39484 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
39485
39486 @table @samp
39487
39488 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
39489 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
39490 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
39491 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
39492 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
39493 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
39494 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
39495 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
39496 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
39497 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
39498 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
39499 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
39500 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
39501 actions.
39502
39503 Replies:
39504 @table @samp
39505 @item OK
39506 The packet was understood and carried out.
39507 @item qRelocInsn
39508 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39509 @item @w{}
39510 The packet was not recognized.
39511 @end table
39512
39513 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
39514 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
39515 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
39516 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
39517 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
39518 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
39519 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
39520
39521 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
39522 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
39523 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
39524 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
39525 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
39526 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
39527 tracepoint actions.
39528
39529 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
39530 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
39531 following forms:
39532
39533 @table @samp
39534
39535 @item R @var{mask}
39536 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
39537 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
39538 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
39539 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
39540 not fit in a 32-bit word.
39541
39542 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
39543 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
39544 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
39545 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
39546 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
39547 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
39548 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
39549
39550 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
39551 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
39552 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
39553 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
39554 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
39555 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
39556 packet).
39557
39558 @end table
39559
39560 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
39561 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
39562 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
39563 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
39564 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
39565 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
39566 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
39567 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
39568
39569 Replies:
39570 @table @samp
39571 @item OK
39572 The packet was understood and carried out.
39573 @item qRelocInsn
39574 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39575 @item @w{}
39576 The packet was not recognized.
39577 @end table
39578
39579 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
39580 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
39581 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
39582 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
39583 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
39584 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
39585 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
39586 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
39587
39588 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
39589 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
39590 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
39591 fit in a single packet.
39592 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
39593 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
39594
39595 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
39596 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
39597 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
39598 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
39599
39600 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
39601 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
39602 query packets.
39603
39604 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
39605 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
39606 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
39607 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
39608 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
39609 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
39610 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
39611 be found.
39612
39613 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
39614 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
39615 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
39616 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
39617 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
39618 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
39619 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
39620 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
39621 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
39622 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
39623 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
39624 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
39625 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
39626 variable.
39627
39628 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
39629 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
39630 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
39631 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
39632 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
39633
39634 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
39635 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
39636 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
39637 one of the following forms:
39638
39639 @table @samp
39640 @item F @var{f}
39641 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
39642 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
39643 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
39644
39645 @item T @var{t}
39646 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
39647 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
39648
39649 @end table
39650
39651 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
39652 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39653 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
39654 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
39655
39656 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
39657 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39658 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
39659 is a hexadecimal number.
39660
39661 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
39662 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39663 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
39664 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
39665 numbers.
39666
39667 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
39668 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
39669 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
39670
39671 @item qTMinFTPILen
39672 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
39673 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
39674 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
39675 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
39676 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
39677 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
39678 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
39679 arrange for that.
39680
39681 Replies:
39682
39683 @table @samp
39684 @item 0
39685 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
39686 @item @var{length}
39687 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
39688 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
39689 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
39690 regardless of size.
39691 @item E
39692 An error has occurred.
39693 @item @w{}
39694 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
39695 @end table
39696
39697 @item QTStart
39698 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
39699 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
39700 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
39701 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
39702 instruction reply packet}).
39703
39704 @item QTStop
39705 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
39706 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
39707
39708 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39709 @anchor{QTEnable}
39710 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
39711 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39712 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
39713 of data from it will resume.
39714
39715 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39716 @anchor{QTDisable}
39717 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
39718 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39719 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
39720 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
39721
39722 @item QTinit
39723 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
39724 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
39725
39726 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
39727 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
39728 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
39729 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
39730 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
39731
39732 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
39733 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
39734 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
39735 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
39736
39737 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
39738 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
39739 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
39740 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
39741 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
39742 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
39743
39744 @item qTStatus
39745 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
39746 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
39747
39748 The reply has the form:
39749
39750 @table @samp
39751
39752 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
39753 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
39754 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
39755 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
39756
39757 @end table
39758
39759 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
39760 explanations as one of the optional fields:
39761
39762 @table @samp
39763
39764 @item tnotrun:0
39765 No trace has been run yet.
39766
39767 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
39768 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
39769 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
39770 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
39771 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
39772
39773 @item tfull:0
39774 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
39775
39776 @item tdisconnected:0
39777 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
39778
39779 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
39780 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
39781
39782 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
39783 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
39784 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
39785 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
39786 is hex encoded.
39787
39788 @item tunknown:0
39789 The trace stopped for some other reason.
39790
39791 @end table
39792
39793 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
39794 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
39795 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
39796 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
39797 trace.
39798
39799 @table @samp
39800
39801 @item tframes:@var{n}
39802 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
39803
39804 @item tcreated:@var{n}
39805 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
39806 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
39807
39808 @item tsize:@var{n}
39809 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
39810
39811 @item tfree:@var{n}
39812 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
39813
39814 @item circular:@var{n}
39815 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
39816 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
39817 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
39818 and may fill up.
39819
39820 @item disconn:@var{n}
39821 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
39822 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
39823 that the trace run will stop.
39824
39825 @end table
39826
39827 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
39828 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
39829 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
39830 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
39831 address @var{addr}.
39832
39833 Replies:
39834 @table @samp
39835 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
39836 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
39837 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
39838 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
39839 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
39840
39841 @end table
39842
39843 @item qTV:@var{var}
39844 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
39845 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
39846 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
39847
39848 Replies:
39849 @table @samp
39850 @item V@var{value}
39851 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
39852 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
39853 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
39854 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
39855 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
39856 program is running.
39857
39858 @item U
39859 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
39860 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
39861 was not collected.
39862 @end table
39863
39864 @item qTfP
39865 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
39866 @itemx qTsP
39867 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
39868 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
39869 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
39870 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
39871 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
39872 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
39873
39874 @item qTfV
39875 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
39876 @itemx qTsV
39877 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
39878 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
39879 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
39880 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
39881 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
39882 trace state variables.
39883
39884 @item qTfSTM
39885 @itemx qTsSTM
39886 @anchor{qTfSTM}
39887 @anchor{qTsSTM}
39888 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
39889 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
39890 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
39891 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
39892 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
39893 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
39894
39895 Reply:
39896 @table @samp
39897 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
39898 A single marker
39899 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
39900 a comma-separated list of markers
39901 @item l
39902 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
39903 @item E @var{nn}
39904 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39905 @item @w{}
39906 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
39907 stub.
39908 @end table
39909
39910 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
39911 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
39912
39913 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
39914 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
39915 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
39916 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
39917 @dfn{last}).
39918
39919 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
39920 @anchor{qTSTMat}
39921 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
39922 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
39923 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
39924 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
39925 tracepoint markers.
39926
39927 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
39928 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
39929 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
39930 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
39931 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
39932 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
39933
39934 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
39935 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
39936 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
39937 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
39938 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
39939 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
39940 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
39941 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
39942 available.
39943
39944 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
39945 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
39946 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
39947
39948 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
39949 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
39950 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
39951 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
39952 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
39953 use whatever size it prefers.
39954
39955 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
39956 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
39957 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
39958 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
39959 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
39960
39961 @end table
39962
39963 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
39964 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
39965 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
39966 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
39967 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
39968 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
39969 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
39970 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
39971 it had executed in the original location.
39972
39973 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
39974 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
39975 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
39976 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
39977 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
39978 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
39979 format of the request is:
39980
39981 @table @samp
39982 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
39983
39984 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
39985 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
39986 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
39987 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
39988 memory starting at @var{to}.
39989 @end table
39990
39991 Replies:
39992 @table @samp
39993 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
39994 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
39995 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
39996 @item E @var{NN}
39997 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
39998 relocating the instruction.
39999 @end table
40000
40001 @node Host I/O Packets
40002 @section Host I/O Packets
40003 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
40004 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
40005
40006 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
40007 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
40008 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
40009 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
40010 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
40011 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
40012 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
40013 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
40014 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
40015 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
40016
40017 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
40018 its arguments. They have this format:
40019
40020 @table @samp
40021
40022 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
40023 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
40024 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
40025 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
40026 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
40027 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
40028 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
40029 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
40030 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
40031
40032 @end table
40033
40034 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
40035
40036 @table @samp
40037
40038 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
40039 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
40040 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
40041 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
40042 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
40043 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
40044 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
40045 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
40046 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
40047 @var{attachment}.
40048
40049 @item @w{}
40050 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
40051
40052 @end table
40053
40054 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
40055
40056 @table @samp
40057 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
40058 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
40059 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
40060 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
40061 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
40062 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
40063 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
40064
40065 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
40066 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
40067 -1 if an error occurs.
40068
40069 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
40070 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
40071 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
40072 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
40073 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
40074 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
40075 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
40076 @var{count} was zero.
40077
40078 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40079 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40080 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40081 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40082 some characters were escaped.
40083
40084 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
40085 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
40086 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
40087 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
40088 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
40089 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
40090 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
40091 error occurred.
40092
40093 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
40094 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
40095 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
40096 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
40097 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
40098 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
40099
40100 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
40101 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
40102 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
40103
40104 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
40105 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
40106 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
40107
40108 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40109 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40110 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40111 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40112 some characters were escaped.
40113
40114 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
40115 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
40116 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
40117 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
40118 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
40119 inferior(s).
40120
40121 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
40122 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
40123 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
40124 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
40125 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
40126 operation.
40127
40128 @end table
40129
40130 @node Interrupts
40131 @section Interrupts
40132 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
40133 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
40134
40135 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
40136 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
40137 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
40138 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
40139
40140 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
40141 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
40142 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
40143 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
40144 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
40145
40146 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
40147 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
40148 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
40149 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
40150 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
40151 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
40152 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
40153 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
40154
40155 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
40156 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
40157 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
40158
40159 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
40160 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
40161 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
40162 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
40163 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
40164 @code{0x03}.
40165
40166 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
40167 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
40168 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
40169 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
40170 currently-executing threads and processes.
40171 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
40172 running program, it should send one of the stop
40173 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
40174 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
40175 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
40176 Interrupts received while the
40177 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
40178 it is resumed next time.
40179
40180 @node Notification Packets
40181 @section Notification Packets
40182 @cindex notification packets
40183 @cindex packets, notification
40184
40185 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
40186 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
40187 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
40188 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
40189 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
40190 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
40191 is not a problem.
40192
40193 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
40194 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
40195 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
40196 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
40197 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
40198 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
40199 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
40200
40201 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
40202 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
40203
40204 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
40205 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
40206 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
40207 not they understand it.
40208
40209 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
40210 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
40211 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
40212 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
40213 recipients.
40214
40215 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
40216 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
40217 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
40218 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
40219 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
40220
40221 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
40222 @table @samp
40223 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
40224 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
40225 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
40226 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
40227 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
40228 @item @var{ack}
40229 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
40230 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
40231 @end table
40232
40233 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
40234 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
40235
40236 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
40237 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
40238 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
40239 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
40240 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
40241 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
40242 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
40243 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
40244 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
40245 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
40246
40247 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
40248 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
40249 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
40250 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
40251 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
40252 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
40253
40254 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
40255 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
40256 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
40257 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
40258 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
40259
40260 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
40261 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
40262 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
40263 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
40264 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
40265 normally.
40266
40267 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
40268 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
40269 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
40270 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
40271 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
40272 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
40273 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
40274 the process shall be repeated.
40275
40276 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
40277 following example:
40278 @smallexample
40279 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
40280 @code{...}
40281 -> @code{vStopped}
40282 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
40283 -> @code{vStopped}
40284 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
40285 -> @code{vStopped}
40286 <- @code{OK}
40287 @end smallexample
40288
40289 The following notifications are defined:
40290 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
40291
40292 @item Notification
40293 @tab Ack
40294 @tab Event
40295 @tab Description
40296
40297 @item Stop
40298 @tab vStopped
40299 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
40300 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
40301 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
40302 @value{GDBN}.
40303 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
40304
40305 @end multitable
40306
40307 @node Remote Non-Stop
40308 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
40309
40310 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
40311 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
40312 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
40313 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40314
40315 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
40316 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
40317 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
40318 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
40319 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
40320 probe the target state after a mode change.
40321
40322 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
40323 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
40324 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
40325 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
40326 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
40327 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
40328 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
40329 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
40330 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
40331 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
40332 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
40333
40334 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
40335 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
40336 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
40337 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
40338 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
40339 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
40340 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
40341 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
40342 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
40343 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
40344 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
40345 @samp{OK}.
40346
40347 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
40348 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
40349 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
40350 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
40351 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
40352 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
40353 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
40354 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
40355 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
40356 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
40357 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
40358 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
40359 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
40360
40361 @node Packet Acknowledgment
40362 @section Packet Acknowledgment
40363
40364 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40365 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40366 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
40367 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
40368 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
40369 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
40370 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
40371
40372 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
40373 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
40374 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
40375 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
40376 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
40377
40378 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
40379 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
40380 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
40381 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
40382
40383 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
40384 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
40385 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
40386 @pxref{qSupported}.
40387 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
40388 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
40389 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
40390 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
40391 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
40392 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
40393 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
40394
40395 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
40396 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
40397 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
40398 connection.
40399 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
40400 new connection is established,
40401 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
40402 for the current connection, once disabled.
40403
40404 @node Examples
40405 @section Examples
40406
40407 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
40408 does not get any direct output:
40409
40410 @smallexample
40411 -> @code{R00}
40412 <- @code{+}
40413 @emph{target restarts}
40414 -> @code{?}
40415 <- @code{+}
40416 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40417 -> @code{+}
40418 @end smallexample
40419
40420 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
40421
40422 @smallexample
40423 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
40424 <- @code{+}
40425 -> @code{s}
40426 <- @code{+}
40427 @emph{time passes}
40428 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40429 -> @code{+}
40430 -> @code{g}
40431 <- @code{+}
40432 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
40433 -> @code{+}
40434 @end smallexample
40435
40436 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40437 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40438 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
40439
40440 @menu
40441 * File-I/O Overview::
40442 * Protocol Basics::
40443 * The F Request Packet::
40444 * The F Reply Packet::
40445 * The Ctrl-C Message::
40446 * Console I/O::
40447 * List of Supported Calls::
40448 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
40449 * Constants::
40450 * File-I/O Examples::
40451 @end menu
40452
40453 @node File-I/O Overview
40454 @subsection File-I/O Overview
40455 @cindex file-i/o overview
40456
40457 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
40458 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
40459 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
40460 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
40461 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
40462 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
40463
40464 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
40465 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
40466 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
40467 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
40468 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
40469
40470 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
40471 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
40472 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
40473 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
40474 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
40475 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
40476 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
40477
40478 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
40479 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
40480 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
40481 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
40482 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
40483
40484 @smallexample
40485 (@value{GDBP}) continue
40486 <- target requests 'system call X'
40487 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
40488 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
40489 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
40490 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
40491 @end smallexample
40492
40493 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
40494 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
40495 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
40496 system are not supported by this protocol.
40497
40498 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
40499
40500 @node Protocol Basics
40501 @subsection Protocol Basics
40502 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
40503
40504 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
40505 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
40506 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
40507 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
40508 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
40509 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
40510 to call the appropriate host system call:
40511
40512 @itemize @bullet
40513 @item
40514 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
40515
40516 @item
40517 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
40518 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
40519 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
40520 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
40521
40522 @end itemize
40523
40524 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
40525
40526 @itemize @bullet
40527 @item
40528 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
40529 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
40530 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
40531 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
40532 packet.
40533
40534 @item
40535 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
40536 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
40537
40538 @item
40539 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
40540
40541 @item
40542 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
40543
40544 @item
40545 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
40546 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
40547 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
40548 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
40549 packet.
40550
40551 @end itemize
40552
40553 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
40554 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
40555
40556 @itemize @bullet
40557 @item
40558 Return value.
40559
40560 @item
40561 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
40562
40563 @item
40564 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
40565
40566 @end itemize
40567
40568 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
40569 the latest continue or step action.
40570
40571 @node The F Request Packet
40572 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
40573 @cindex file-i/o request packet
40574 @cindex @code{F} request packet
40575
40576 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
40577
40578 @table @samp
40579 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
40580
40581 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
40582 This is just the name of the function.
40583
40584 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
40585 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
40586 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
40587 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
40588 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
40589 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
40590 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
40591
40592 @end table
40593
40594
40595
40596 @node The F Reply Packet
40597 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
40598 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
40599 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
40600
40601 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
40602
40603 @table @samp
40604
40605 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
40606
40607 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
40608
40609 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
40610 representation.
40611 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
40612
40613 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
40614 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
40615 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
40616
40617 @smallexample
40618 F0,0,C
40619 @end smallexample
40620
40621 @noindent
40622 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
40623
40624 @smallexample
40625 F-1,4,C
40626 @end smallexample
40627
40628 @noindent
40629 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
40630
40631 @end table
40632
40633
40634 @node The Ctrl-C Message
40635 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
40636 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
40637
40638 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
40639 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
40640 the target should behave as if it had
40641 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
40642 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
40643 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
40644 packet.
40645
40646 It's important for the target to know in which
40647 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
40648
40649 @itemize @bullet
40650 @item
40651 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
40652
40653 @item
40654 The system call on the host has been finished.
40655
40656 @end itemize
40657
40658 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
40659 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
40660 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
40661 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
40662 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
40663 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
40664
40665 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
40666 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
40667 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
40668 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
40669 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
40670 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
40671 or the full action has been completed.
40672
40673 @node Console I/O
40674 @subsection Console I/O
40675 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
40676
40677 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
40678 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
40679 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
40680 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
40681 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
40682 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
40683 conditions is met:
40684
40685 @itemize @bullet
40686 @item
40687 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
40688 @code{read}
40689 system call is treated as finished.
40690
40691 @item
40692 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
40693 newline.
40694
40695 @item
40696 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
40697 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
40698
40699 @end itemize
40700
40701 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
40702 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
40703 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
40704 is stopped at the user's request.
40705
40706
40707 @node List of Supported Calls
40708 @subsection List of Supported Calls
40709 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
40710
40711 @menu
40712 * open::
40713 * close::
40714 * read::
40715 * write::
40716 * lseek::
40717 * rename::
40718 * unlink::
40719 * stat/fstat::
40720 * gettimeofday::
40721 * isatty::
40722 * system::
40723 @end menu
40724
40725 @node open
40726 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
40727 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
40728
40729 @table @asis
40730 @item Synopsis:
40731 @smallexample
40732 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
40733 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
40734 @end smallexample
40735
40736 @item Request:
40737 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
40738
40739 @noindent
40740 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
40741
40742 @table @code
40743 @item O_CREAT
40744 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
40745 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
40746 are concerned.
40747
40748 @item O_EXCL
40749 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
40750 an error and open() fails.
40751
40752 @item O_TRUNC
40753 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
40754 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
40755 truncated to zero length.
40756
40757 @item O_APPEND
40758 The file is opened in append mode.
40759
40760 @item O_RDONLY
40761 The file is opened for reading only.
40762
40763 @item O_WRONLY
40764 The file is opened for writing only.
40765
40766 @item O_RDWR
40767 The file is opened for reading and writing.
40768 @end table
40769
40770 @noindent
40771 Other bits are silently ignored.
40772
40773
40774 @noindent
40775 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
40776
40777 @table @code
40778 @item S_IRUSR
40779 User has read permission.
40780
40781 @item S_IWUSR
40782 User has write permission.
40783
40784 @item S_IRGRP
40785 Group has read permission.
40786
40787 @item S_IWGRP
40788 Group has write permission.
40789
40790 @item S_IROTH
40791 Others have read permission.
40792
40793 @item S_IWOTH
40794 Others have write permission.
40795 @end table
40796
40797 @noindent
40798 Other bits are silently ignored.
40799
40800
40801 @item Return value:
40802 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
40803 occurred.
40804
40805 @item Errors:
40806
40807 @table @code
40808 @item EEXIST
40809 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
40810
40811 @item EISDIR
40812 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
40813
40814 @item EACCES
40815 The requested access is not allowed.
40816
40817 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40818 @var{pathname} was too long.
40819
40820 @item ENOENT
40821 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40822
40823 @item ENODEV
40824 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
40825
40826 @item EROFS
40827 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
40828 write access was requested.
40829
40830 @item EFAULT
40831 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
40832
40833 @item ENOSPC
40834 No space on device to create the file.
40835
40836 @item EMFILE
40837 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
40838
40839 @item ENFILE
40840 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
40841 has been reached.
40842
40843 @item EINTR
40844 The call was interrupted by the user.
40845 @end table
40846
40847 @end table
40848
40849 @node close
40850 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
40851 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
40852
40853 @table @asis
40854 @item Synopsis:
40855 @smallexample
40856 int close(int fd);
40857 @end smallexample
40858
40859 @item Request:
40860 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
40861
40862 @item Return value:
40863 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
40864
40865 @item Errors:
40866
40867 @table @code
40868 @item EBADF
40869 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
40870
40871 @item EINTR
40872 The call was interrupted by the user.
40873 @end table
40874
40875 @end table
40876
40877 @node read
40878 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
40879 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
40880
40881 @table @asis
40882 @item Synopsis:
40883 @smallexample
40884 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
40885 @end smallexample
40886
40887 @item Request:
40888 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
40889
40890 @item Return value:
40891 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
40892 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
40893 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
40894
40895 @item Errors:
40896
40897 @table @code
40898 @item EBADF
40899 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
40900 reading.
40901
40902 @item EFAULT
40903 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40904
40905 @item EINTR
40906 The call was interrupted by the user.
40907 @end table
40908
40909 @end table
40910
40911 @node write
40912 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
40913 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
40914
40915 @table @asis
40916 @item Synopsis:
40917 @smallexample
40918 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
40919 @end smallexample
40920
40921 @item Request:
40922 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
40923
40924 @item Return value:
40925 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
40926 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
40927 is returned.
40928
40929 @item Errors:
40930
40931 @table @code
40932 @item EBADF
40933 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
40934 writing.
40935
40936 @item EFAULT
40937 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40938
40939 @item EFBIG
40940 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
40941 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
40942
40943 @item ENOSPC
40944 No space on device to write the data.
40945
40946 @item EINTR
40947 The call was interrupted by the user.
40948 @end table
40949
40950 @end table
40951
40952 @node lseek
40953 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
40954 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
40955
40956 @table @asis
40957 @item Synopsis:
40958 @smallexample
40959 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
40960 @end smallexample
40961
40962 @item Request:
40963 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
40964
40965 @var{flag} is one of:
40966
40967 @table @code
40968 @item SEEK_SET
40969 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
40970
40971 @item SEEK_CUR
40972 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
40973 bytes.
40974
40975 @item SEEK_END
40976 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
40977 bytes.
40978 @end table
40979
40980 @item Return value:
40981 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
40982 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
40983 value of -1 is returned.
40984
40985 @item Errors:
40986
40987 @table @code
40988 @item EBADF
40989 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
40990
40991 @item ESPIPE
40992 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
40993
40994 @item EINVAL
40995 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
40996
40997 @item EINTR
40998 The call was interrupted by the user.
40999 @end table
41000
41001 @end table
41002
41003 @node rename
41004 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
41005 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
41006
41007 @table @asis
41008 @item Synopsis:
41009 @smallexample
41010 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
41011 @end smallexample
41012
41013 @item Request:
41014 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
41015
41016 @item Return value:
41017 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41018
41019 @item Errors:
41020
41021 @table @code
41022 @item EISDIR
41023 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
41024 directory.
41025
41026 @item EEXIST
41027 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
41028
41029 @item EBUSY
41030 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
41031 process.
41032
41033 @item EINVAL
41034 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
41035 of itself.
41036
41037 @item ENOTDIR
41038 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
41039 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
41040 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
41041
41042 @item EFAULT
41043 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
41044
41045 @item EACCES
41046 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41047
41048 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41049
41050 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
41051
41052 @item ENOENT
41053 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
41054
41055 @item EROFS
41056 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41057
41058 @item ENOSPC
41059 The device containing the file has no room for the new
41060 directory entry.
41061
41062 @item EINTR
41063 The call was interrupted by the user.
41064 @end table
41065
41066 @end table
41067
41068 @node unlink
41069 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
41070 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
41071
41072 @table @asis
41073 @item Synopsis:
41074 @smallexample
41075 int unlink(const char *pathname);
41076 @end smallexample
41077
41078 @item Request:
41079 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
41080
41081 @item Return value:
41082 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41083
41084 @item Errors:
41085
41086 @table @code
41087 @item EACCES
41088 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41089
41090 @item EPERM
41091 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
41092
41093 @item EBUSY
41094 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
41095 being used by another process.
41096
41097 @item EFAULT
41098 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41099
41100 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41101 @var{pathname} was too long.
41102
41103 @item ENOENT
41104 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41105
41106 @item ENOTDIR
41107 A component of the path is not a directory.
41108
41109 @item EROFS
41110 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41111
41112 @item EINTR
41113 The call was interrupted by the user.
41114 @end table
41115
41116 @end table
41117
41118 @node stat/fstat
41119 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
41120 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
41121 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
41122
41123 @table @asis
41124 @item Synopsis:
41125 @smallexample
41126 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
41127 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
41128 @end smallexample
41129
41130 @item Request:
41131 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
41132 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
41133
41134 @item Return value:
41135 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41136
41137 @item Errors:
41138
41139 @table @code
41140 @item EBADF
41141 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
41142
41143 @item ENOENT
41144 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
41145 path is an empty string.
41146
41147 @item ENOTDIR
41148 A component of the path is not a directory.
41149
41150 @item EFAULT
41151 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41152
41153 @item EACCES
41154 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41155
41156 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41157 @var{pathname} was too long.
41158
41159 @item EINTR
41160 The call was interrupted by the user.
41161 @end table
41162
41163 @end table
41164
41165 @node gettimeofday
41166 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
41167 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
41168
41169 @table @asis
41170 @item Synopsis:
41171 @smallexample
41172 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
41173 @end smallexample
41174
41175 @item Request:
41176 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
41177
41178 @item Return value:
41179 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
41180
41181 @item Errors:
41182
41183 @table @code
41184 @item EINVAL
41185 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
41186
41187 @item EFAULT
41188 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41189 @end table
41190
41191 @end table
41192
41193 @node isatty
41194 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
41195 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
41196
41197 @table @asis
41198 @item Synopsis:
41199 @smallexample
41200 int isatty(int fd);
41201 @end smallexample
41202
41203 @item Request:
41204 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
41205
41206 @item Return value:
41207 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
41208
41209 @item Errors:
41210
41211 @table @code
41212 @item EINTR
41213 The call was interrupted by the user.
41214 @end table
41215
41216 @end table
41217
41218 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
41219 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
41220 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
41221 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
41222 needed.
41223
41224
41225 @node system
41226 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
41227 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
41228
41229 @table @asis
41230 @item Synopsis:
41231 @smallexample
41232 int system(const char *command);
41233 @end smallexample
41234
41235 @item Request:
41236 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
41237
41238 @item Return value:
41239 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
41240 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
41241 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
41242 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
41243 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
41244 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
41245 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
41246
41247 @item Errors:
41248
41249 @table @code
41250 @item EINTR
41251 The call was interrupted by the user.
41252 @end table
41253
41254 @end table
41255
41256 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
41257 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
41258 the host is simplified before it's returned
41259 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
41260 is discarded, and the return value consists
41261 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
41262
41263 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
41264 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
41265 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
41266
41267 @table @code
41268 @item set remote system-call-allowed
41269 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
41270 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
41271 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
41272
41273 @item show remote system-call-allowed
41274 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
41275 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
41276 protocol.
41277 @end table
41278
41279 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41280 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41281 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41282
41283 @menu
41284 * Integral Datatypes::
41285 * Pointer Values::
41286 * Memory Transfer::
41287 * struct stat::
41288 * struct timeval::
41289 @end menu
41290
41291 @node Integral Datatypes
41292 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
41293 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41294
41295 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
41296 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
41297 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
41298
41299 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
41300 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
41301
41302 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
41303
41304 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
41305 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
41306
41307 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
41308
41309 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
41310 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
41311 byte order.
41312
41313 @node Pointer Values
41314 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
41315 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
41316
41317 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
41318 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
41319 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
41320 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
41321
41322 @smallexample
41323 @code{1aaf/12}
41324 @end smallexample
41325
41326 @noindent
41327 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
41328 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
41329 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
41330 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
41331
41332 @smallexample
41333 @code{123456/d}
41334 @end smallexample
41335
41336 @node Memory Transfer
41337 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
41338 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
41339
41340 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
41341 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
41342 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
41343 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
41344 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
41345 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
41346 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
41347
41348
41349 @node struct stat
41350 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
41351 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
41352
41353 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
41354 is defined as follows:
41355
41356 @smallexample
41357 struct stat @{
41358 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
41359 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
41360 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
41361 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
41362 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
41363 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
41364 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
41365 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
41366 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
41367 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
41368 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
41369 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
41370 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
41371 @};
41372 @end smallexample
41373
41374 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41375 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41376 structure is of size 64 bytes.
41377
41378 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
41379 range of values.
41380
41381 @table @code
41382
41383 @item st_dev
41384 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
41385
41386 @item st_ino
41387 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41388
41389 @item st_mode
41390 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
41391 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
41392
41393 @item st_uid
41394 @itemx st_gid
41395 @itemx st_rdev
41396 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41397
41398 @item st_atime
41399 @itemx st_mtime
41400 @itemx st_ctime
41401 These values have a host and file system dependent
41402 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
41403 support exact timing values.
41404 @end table
41405
41406 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
41407 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
41408 continuing.
41409
41410 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
41411 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
41412 get truncated on the target.
41413
41414 @node struct timeval
41415 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
41416 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
41417
41418 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
41419 is defined as follows:
41420
41421 @smallexample
41422 struct timeval @{
41423 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
41424 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
41425 @};
41426 @end smallexample
41427
41428 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41429 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41430 structure is of size 8 bytes.
41431
41432 @node Constants
41433 @subsection Constants
41434 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
41435
41436 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
41437 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
41438 values before and after the call as needed.
41439
41440 @menu
41441 * Open Flags::
41442 * mode_t Values::
41443 * Errno Values::
41444 * Lseek Flags::
41445 * Limits::
41446 @end menu
41447
41448 @node Open Flags
41449 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
41450 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
41451
41452 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
41453
41454 @smallexample
41455 O_RDONLY 0x0
41456 O_WRONLY 0x1
41457 O_RDWR 0x2
41458 O_APPEND 0x8
41459 O_CREAT 0x200
41460 O_TRUNC 0x400
41461 O_EXCL 0x800
41462 @end smallexample
41463
41464 @node mode_t Values
41465 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
41466 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
41467
41468 All values are given in octal representation.
41469
41470 @smallexample
41471 S_IFREG 0100000
41472 S_IFDIR 040000
41473 S_IRUSR 0400
41474 S_IWUSR 0200
41475 S_IXUSR 0100
41476 S_IRGRP 040
41477 S_IWGRP 020
41478 S_IXGRP 010
41479 S_IROTH 04
41480 S_IWOTH 02
41481 S_IXOTH 01
41482 @end smallexample
41483
41484 @node Errno Values
41485 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
41486 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
41487
41488 All values are given in decimal representation.
41489
41490 @smallexample
41491 EPERM 1
41492 ENOENT 2
41493 EINTR 4
41494 EBADF 9
41495 EACCES 13
41496 EFAULT 14
41497 EBUSY 16
41498 EEXIST 17
41499 ENODEV 19
41500 ENOTDIR 20
41501 EISDIR 21
41502 EINVAL 22
41503 ENFILE 23
41504 EMFILE 24
41505 EFBIG 27
41506 ENOSPC 28
41507 ESPIPE 29
41508 EROFS 30
41509 ENAMETOOLONG 91
41510 EUNKNOWN 9999
41511 @end smallexample
41512
41513 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
41514 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
41515
41516 @node Lseek Flags
41517 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
41518 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
41519
41520 @smallexample
41521 SEEK_SET 0
41522 SEEK_CUR 1
41523 SEEK_END 2
41524 @end smallexample
41525
41526 @node Limits
41527 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
41528 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
41529
41530 All values are given in decimal representation.
41531
41532 @smallexample
41533 INT_MIN -2147483648
41534 INT_MAX 2147483647
41535 UINT_MAX 4294967295
41536 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
41537 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
41538 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
41539 @end smallexample
41540
41541 @node File-I/O Examples
41542 @subsection File-I/O Examples
41543 @cindex file-i/o examples
41544
41545 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41546 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
41547
41548 @smallexample
41549 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
41550 @emph{request memory read from target}
41551 -> @code{m1234,6}
41552 <- XXXXXX
41553 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
41554 -> @code{F6}
41555 @end smallexample
41556
41557 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41558 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
41559
41560 @smallexample
41561 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41562 @emph{request memory write to target}
41563 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41564 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
41565 -> @code{F6}
41566 @end smallexample
41567
41568 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
41569 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
41570
41571 @smallexample
41572 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41573 -> @code{F-1,9}
41574 @end smallexample
41575
41576 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
41577 host is called:
41578
41579 @smallexample
41580 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41581 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
41582 <- @code{T02}
41583 @end smallexample
41584
41585 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
41586 host is called:
41587
41588 @smallexample
41589 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41590 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41591 <- @code{T02}
41592 @end smallexample
41593
41594 @node Library List Format
41595 @section Library List Format
41596 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41597
41598 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
41599 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
41600 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
41601 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
41602 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
41603 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
41604 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
41605 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
41606 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
41607 are loaded.
41608
41609 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
41610 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
41611 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
41612 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
41613
41614 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
41615 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
41616 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
41617 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
41618 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
41619 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
41620
41621 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41622 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41623
41624 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
41625 offset, looks like this:
41626
41627 @smallexample
41628 <library-list>
41629 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
41630 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
41631 </library>
41632 </library-list>
41633 @end smallexample
41634
41635 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
41636 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
41637
41638 @smallexample
41639 <library-list>
41640 <library name="sharedlib.o">
41641 <section address="0x10000000"/>
41642 <section address="0x20000000"/>
41643 <section address="0x30000000"/>
41644 </library>
41645 </library-list>
41646 @end smallexample
41647
41648 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
41649
41650 @smallexample
41651 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
41652 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
41653 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41654 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
41655 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41656 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
41657 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41658 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
41659 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41660 @end smallexample
41661
41662 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
41663 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
41664 section for each library.
41665
41666 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41667 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41668 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41669
41670 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
41671 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
41672 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
41673 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
41674
41675 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
41676 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
41677 target, the following parameters are reported:
41678
41679 @itemize @minus
41680 @item
41681 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
41682 @code{struct link_map}.
41683 @item
41684 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
41685 (Thread Local Storage) access.
41686 @item
41687 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
41688 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
41689 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
41690 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
41691 @item
41692 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
41693 @end itemize
41694
41695 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
41696 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
41697 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
41698
41699 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41700 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41701
41702 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
41703 looks like this:
41704
41705 @smallexample
41706 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
41707 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
41708 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
41709 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
41710 l_ld="0x152350"/>
41711 </library-list-svr>
41712 @end smallexample
41713
41714 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
41715
41716 @smallexample
41717 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
41718 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
41719 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41720 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
41721 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
41722 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41723 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
41724 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
41725 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
41726 @end smallexample
41727
41728 @node Memory Map Format
41729 @section Memory Map Format
41730 @cindex memory map format
41731
41732 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
41733 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
41734 memory map.
41735
41736 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
41737 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
41738 lists memory regions.
41739
41740 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41741 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
41742
41743 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41744
41745 @smallexample
41746 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41747 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
41748 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
41749 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
41750 <memory-map>
41751 region...
41752 </memory-map>
41753 @end smallexample
41754
41755 Each region can be either:
41756
41757 @itemize
41758
41759 @item
41760 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
41761 bytes from there:
41762
41763 @smallexample
41764 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41765 @end smallexample
41766
41767
41768 @item
41769 A region of read-only memory:
41770
41771 @smallexample
41772 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41773 @end smallexample
41774
41775
41776 @item
41777 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
41778 bytes in length:
41779
41780 @smallexample
41781 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
41782 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
41783 </memory>
41784 @end smallexample
41785
41786 @end itemize
41787
41788 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
41789 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
41790 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
41791
41792 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
41793
41794 @smallexample
41795 <!-- ................................................... -->
41796 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
41797 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
41798 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
41799 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
41800 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
41801 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
41802 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
41803 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
41804 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
41805 and its type, or device. -->
41806 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
41807 start CDATA #REQUIRED
41808 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
41809 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
41810 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
41811 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
41812 @end smallexample
41813
41814 @node Thread List Format
41815 @section Thread List Format
41816 @cindex thread list format
41817
41818 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
41819 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
41820 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
41821 the following structure:
41822
41823 @smallexample
41824 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41825 <threads>
41826 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
41827 ... description ...
41828 </thread>
41829 </threads>
41830 @end smallexample
41831
41832 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
41833 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
41834 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
41835 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
41836 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
41837 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
41838 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
41839 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
41840
41841
41842 @node Traceframe Info Format
41843 @section Traceframe Info Format
41844 @cindex traceframe info format
41845
41846 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
41847 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
41848 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
41849 collected in a traceframe.
41850
41851 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
41852 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
41853
41854 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41855 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41856
41857 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41858
41859 @smallexample
41860 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41861 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
41862 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
41863 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
41864 <traceframe-info>
41865 block...
41866 </traceframe-info>
41867 @end smallexample
41868
41869 Each traceframe block can be either:
41870
41871 @itemize
41872
41873 @item
41874 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
41875 @var{length} bytes from there:
41876
41877 @smallexample
41878 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41879 @end smallexample
41880
41881 @item
41882 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
41883 collected:
41884
41885 @smallexample
41886 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
41887 @end smallexample
41888
41889 @end itemize
41890
41891 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
41892
41893 @smallexample
41894 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
41895 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41896
41897 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
41898 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
41899 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
41900 <!ELEMENT tvar>
41901 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
41902 @end smallexample
41903
41904 @node Branch Trace Format
41905 @section Branch Trace Format
41906 @cindex branch trace format
41907
41908 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
41909 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
41910 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
41911 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
41912
41913 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
41914 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
41915
41916 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41917 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41918
41919 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41920
41921 @smallexample
41922 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41923 <!DOCTYPE btrace
41924 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
41925 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
41926 <btrace>
41927 block...
41928 </btrace>
41929 @end smallexample
41930
41931 @itemize
41932
41933 @item
41934 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
41935 and ending at @var{end}:
41936
41937 @smallexample
41938 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
41939 @end smallexample
41940
41941 @end itemize
41942
41943 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
41944
41945 @smallexample
41946 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
41947 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41948
41949 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
41950 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
41951 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
41952
41953 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
41954
41955 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
41956
41957 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
41958 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
41959 family CDATA #REQUIRED
41960 model CDATA #REQUIRED
41961 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
41962
41963 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
41964 @end smallexample
41965
41966 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
41967 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
41968 @cindex branch trace configuration format
41969
41970 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
41971 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
41972 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
41973
41974 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
41975 settings for that format. The following information is described:
41976
41977 @table @code
41978 @item bts
41979 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
41980 @table @code
41981 @item size
41982 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
41983 @end table
41984 @item pt
41985 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
41986 PT}) format.
41987 @table @code
41988 @item size
41989 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
41990 @end table
41991 @end table
41992
41993 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41994 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41995
41996 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
41997
41998 @smallexample
41999 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
42000 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42001
42002 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
42003 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42004
42005 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
42006 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42007 @end smallexample
42008
42009 @include agentexpr.texi
42010
42011 @node Target Descriptions
42012 @appendix Target Descriptions
42013 @cindex target descriptions
42014
42015 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
42016 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
42017 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
42018 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
42019 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
42020 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
42021 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
42022
42023 @itemize @bullet
42024 @item
42025 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
42026 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
42027 @item
42028 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
42029 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
42030 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
42031 @item
42032 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
42033 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
42034 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
42035 @end itemize
42036
42037 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
42038 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
42039 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
42040 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
42041 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
42042
42043 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42044 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
42045
42046 @menu
42047 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
42048 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
42049 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
42050 descriptions.
42051 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
42052 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
42053 @end menu
42054
42055 @node Retrieving Descriptions
42056 @section Retrieving Descriptions
42057
42058 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
42059 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
42060 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
42061 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
42062 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
42063 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
42064 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
42065 Format}.
42066
42067 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
42068 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
42069 specify a file are:
42070
42071 @table @code
42072 @cindex set tdesc filename
42073 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
42074 Read the target description from @var{path}.
42075
42076 @cindex unset tdesc filename
42077 @item unset tdesc filename
42078 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
42079 will use the description supplied by the current target.
42080
42081 @cindex show tdesc filename
42082 @item show tdesc filename
42083 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
42084 @end table
42085
42086
42087 @node Target Description Format
42088 @section Target Description Format
42089 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
42090
42091 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
42092 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
42093 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
42094 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
42095 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
42096 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
42097 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
42098
42099 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
42100 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
42101 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
42102 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
42103 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
42104
42105 Here is a simple target description:
42106
42107 @smallexample
42108 <target version="1.0">
42109 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
42110 </target>
42111 @end smallexample
42112
42113 @noindent
42114 This minimal description only says that the target uses
42115 the x86-64 architecture.
42116
42117 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
42118 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
42119 are explained further below.
42120
42121 @smallexample
42122 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42123 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
42124 <target version="1.0">
42125 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
42126 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
42127 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
42128 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
42129 </target>
42130 @end smallexample
42131
42132 @noindent
42133 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
42134 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
42135 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
42136 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
42137 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
42138 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
42139 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
42140 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
42141 the version mismatch.
42142
42143 @subsection Inclusion
42144 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
42145 @cindex XInclude
42146 @ifnotinfo
42147 @cindex <xi:include>
42148 @end ifnotinfo
42149
42150 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
42151 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
42152 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
42153 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
42154 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
42155
42156 @smallexample
42157 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
42158 @end smallexample
42159
42160 @noindent
42161 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
42162 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
42163 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
42164 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
42165 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
42166 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
42167 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
42168 original description.
42169
42170 @subsection Architecture
42171 @cindex <architecture>
42172
42173 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
42174
42175 @smallexample
42176 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
42177 @end smallexample
42178
42179 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42180 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42181
42182 @subsection OS ABI
42183 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
42184
42185 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42186 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42187
42188 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
42189
42190 @smallexample
42191 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
42192 @end smallexample
42193
42194 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
42195 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
42196
42197 @subsection Compatible Architecture
42198 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
42199
42200 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42201 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42202
42203 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
42204
42205 @smallexample
42206 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
42207 @end smallexample
42208
42209 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42210 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42211
42212 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
42213 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
42214 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
42215 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
42216 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
42217 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
42218 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
42219
42220 @smallexample
42221 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
42222 <compatible>spu</compatible>
42223 @end smallexample
42224
42225 @subsection Features
42226 @cindex <feature>
42227
42228 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
42229 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
42230 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
42231 has this form:
42232
42233 @smallexample
42234 <feature name="@var{name}">
42235 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
42236 @var{reg}@dots{}
42237 </feature>
42238 @end smallexample
42239
42240 @noindent
42241 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
42242 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
42243 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
42244 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
42245
42246 @subsection Types
42247
42248 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
42249 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
42250 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
42251 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
42252 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
42253 and enum types.
42254
42255 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
42256 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
42257 Types must be defined before they are used.
42258
42259 @cindex <vector>
42260 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
42261 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
42262 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
42263 @var{count}:
42264
42265 @smallexample
42266 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
42267 @end smallexample
42268
42269 @cindex <union>
42270 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
42271 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
42272 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
42273 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
42274
42275 @smallexample
42276 <union id="@var{id}">
42277 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42278 @dots{}
42279 </union>
42280 @end smallexample
42281
42282 @cindex <struct>
42283 @cindex <flags>
42284 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
42285 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
42286 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
42287 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
42288 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
42289 specified.
42290
42291 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
42292
42293 @smallexample
42294 <struct id="@var{id}">
42295 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42296 @dots{}
42297 </struct>
42298 @end smallexample
42299
42300 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
42301 No implicit padding is added.
42302
42303 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
42304
42305 @smallexample
42306 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42307 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42308 @dots{}
42309 </struct>
42310 @end smallexample
42311
42312 @smallexample
42313 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42314 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42315 @dots{}
42316 </flags>
42317 @end smallexample
42318
42319 The @var{name} value is required.
42320 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
42321 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
42322 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
42323
42324 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
42325 is optional.
42326 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
42327 and zero represents the least significant bit.
42328
42329 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
42330 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
42331
42332 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
42333
42334 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
42335 defining them with @samp{struct}:
42336
42337 @itemize @bullet
42338 @item
42339 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
42340 @item
42341 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
42342 @end itemize
42343
42344 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
42345 defining them with @samp{flags}:
42346
42347 @itemize @bullet
42348 @item
42349 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
42350
42351 @smallexample
42352 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
42353 $1 = 42
42354 @end smallexample
42355
42356 @end itemize
42357
42358 @subsection Registers
42359 @cindex <reg>
42360
42361 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
42362
42363 @smallexample
42364 <reg name="@var{name}"
42365 bitsize="@var{size}"
42366 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
42367 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
42368 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
42369 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
42370 @end smallexample
42371
42372 @noindent
42373 The components are as follows:
42374
42375 @table @var
42376
42377 @item name
42378 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
42379
42380 @item bitsize
42381 The register's size, in bits.
42382
42383 @item regnum
42384 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
42385 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
42386 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
42387 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
42388 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
42389 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
42390 in order of increasing register number.
42391
42392 @item save-restore
42393 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
42394 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
42395 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
42396 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
42397 ABI.
42398
42399 @item type
42400 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
42401 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
42402 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
42403 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
42404 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
42405 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
42406
42407 @item group
42408 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
42409 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
42410 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
42411 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
42412 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
42413 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
42414 @code{info registers}.
42415
42416 @end table
42417
42418 @node Predefined Target Types
42419 @section Predefined Target Types
42420 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
42421
42422 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
42423 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
42424 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
42425 types. The currently supported types are:
42426
42427 @table @code
42428
42429 @item bool
42430 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
42431
42432 @item int8
42433 @itemx int16
42434 @itemx int24
42435 @itemx int32
42436 @itemx int64
42437 @itemx int128
42438 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42439
42440 @item uint8
42441 @itemx uint16
42442 @itemx uint24
42443 @itemx uint32
42444 @itemx uint64
42445 @itemx uint128
42446 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42447
42448 @item code_ptr
42449 @itemx data_ptr
42450 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
42451 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
42452 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
42453 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
42454 may be marked as data pointers.
42455
42456 @item ieee_single
42457 Single precision IEEE floating point.
42458
42459 @item ieee_double
42460 Double precision IEEE floating point.
42461
42462 @item arm_fpa_ext
42463 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
42464
42465 @item i387_ext
42466 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
42467
42468 @item i386_eflags
42469 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
42470
42471 @item i386_mxcsr
42472 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
42473
42474 @end table
42475
42476 @node Enum Target Types
42477 @section Enum Target Types
42478 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
42479
42480 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
42481 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
42482
42483 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
42484
42485 @smallexample
42486 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42487 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
42488 @dots{}
42489 </enum>
42490 @end smallexample
42491
42492 Enums must be defined before they are used.
42493
42494 @smallexample
42495 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
42496 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
42497 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
42498 </enum>
42499 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
42500 <field name="X" start="0"/>
42501 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
42502 </flags>
42503 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
42504 @end smallexample
42505
42506 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
42507 would be printed as:
42508
42509 @smallexample
42510 (gdb) info register flags
42511 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
42512 @end smallexample
42513
42514 @node Standard Target Features
42515 @section Standard Target Features
42516 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
42517
42518 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
42519 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
42520 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
42521 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
42522 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
42523 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
42524 can recognize them.
42525
42526 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
42527 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
42528 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
42529 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
42530 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
42531 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
42532 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
42533 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
42534
42535 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
42536 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
42537 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
42538
42539 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
42540 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
42541 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
42542 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
42543
42544 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
42545 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
42546 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
42547
42548 @menu
42549 * AArch64 Features::
42550 * ARC Features::
42551 * ARM Features::
42552 * i386 Features::
42553 * MicroBlaze Features::
42554 * MIPS Features::
42555 * M68K Features::
42556 * NDS32 Features::
42557 * Nios II Features::
42558 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
42559 * PowerPC Features::
42560 * S/390 and System z Features::
42561 * Sparc Features::
42562 * TIC6x Features::
42563 @end menu
42564
42565
42566 @node AArch64 Features
42567 @subsection AArch64 Features
42568 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
42569
42570 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
42571 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
42572 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42573
42574 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42575 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
42576 and @samp{fpcr}.
42577
42578 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
42579 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
42580 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
42581
42582 @node ARC Features
42583 @subsection ARC Features
42584 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
42585
42586 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
42587 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
42588 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
42589 that one of the core registers features is present.
42590 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
42591
42592 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
42593 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42594 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42595 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
42596 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42597 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
42598 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
42599
42600 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
42601 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
42602 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
42603 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
42604 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
42605 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42606
42607 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
42608 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42609 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42610 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
42611 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
42612 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
42613 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
42614 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
42615 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
42616 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
42617
42618 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
42619 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
42620
42621 @node ARM Features
42622 @subsection ARM Features
42623 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
42624
42625 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
42626 ARM targets.
42627 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
42628 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42629
42630 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
42631 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
42632 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
42633 and @samp{xpsr}.
42634
42635 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
42636 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
42637
42638 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
42639 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
42640 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
42641 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
42642
42643 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
42644 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
42645 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
42646 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
42647 halves of the double-precision registers.
42648
42649 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
42650 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
42651 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
42652 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
42653 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
42654 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
42655
42656 @node i386 Features
42657 @subsection i386 Features
42658 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
42659
42660 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
42661 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42662
42663 @itemize @minus
42664 @item
42665 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
42666 @item
42667 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
42668 @item
42669 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
42670 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
42671 @item
42672 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
42673 @item
42674 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
42675 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
42676 @end itemize
42677
42678 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
42679
42680 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
42681 describe registers:
42682
42683 @itemize @minus
42684 @item
42685 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
42686 @item
42687 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
42688 @item
42689 @samp{mxcsr}
42690 @end itemize
42691
42692 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
42693 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
42694 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
42695
42696 @itemize @minus
42697 @item
42698 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
42699 @item
42700 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
42701 @end itemize
42702
42703 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
42704 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
42705
42706 @itemize @minus
42707 @item
42708 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
42709 @item
42710 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
42711 @end itemize
42712
42713 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
42714 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
42715
42716 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
42717 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
42718
42719 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
42720 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
42721 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
42722
42723 @itemize @minus
42724 @item
42725 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42726 @end itemize
42727
42728 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
42729
42730 @itemize @minus
42731 @item
42732 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42733 @end itemize
42734
42735 It should
42736 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
42737
42738 @itemize @minus
42739 @item
42740 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
42741 @item
42742 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
42743 @end itemize
42744
42745 It should
42746 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
42747
42748 @itemize @minus
42749 @item
42750 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42751 @end itemize
42752
42753 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
42754 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
42755 valid for i386 and amd64.
42756
42757 @node MicroBlaze Features
42758 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
42759 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
42760
42761 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
42762 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
42763 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
42764 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
42765 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
42766
42767 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
42768 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
42769
42770 @node MIPS Features
42771 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
42772 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
42773
42774 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
42775 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
42776 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
42777 on the target.
42778
42779 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
42780 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
42781 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42782
42783 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
42784 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
42785 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
42786 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42787
42788 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
42789 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
42790 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
42791 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42792
42793 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
42794 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
42795 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
42796
42797 @node M68K Features
42798 @subsection M68K Features
42799 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
42800
42801 @table @code
42802 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
42803 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
42804 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
42805 One of those features must be always present.
42806 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
42807 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
42808 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
42809 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
42810
42811 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
42812 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
42813 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
42814 @samp{fpiaddr}.
42815 @end table
42816
42817 @node NDS32 Features
42818 @subsection NDS32 Features
42819 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
42820
42821 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
42822 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
42823 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
42824 and @samp{pc}.
42825
42826 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42827 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
42828 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
42829 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
42830
42831 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
42832 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
42833 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
42834 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
42835 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
42836 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
42837 support to it could be totally removed some day.
42838
42839 @node Nios II Features
42840 @subsection Nios II Features
42841 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
42842
42843 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
42844 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
42845 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
42846 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
42847 @samp{mpuacc}).
42848
42849 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
42850 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
42851 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
42852
42853 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
42854 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
42855 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
42856
42857 @node PowerPC Features
42858 @subsection PowerPC Features
42859 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
42860
42861 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
42862 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
42863 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
42864 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42865
42866 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
42867 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
42868
42869 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
42870 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
42871 and @samp{vrsave}.
42872
42873 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
42874 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
42875 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
42876 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
42877 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
42878 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
42879
42880 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
42881 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
42882 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
42883 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
42884 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
42885 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
42886 user.
42887
42888 @node S/390 and System z Features
42889 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
42890 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
42891 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
42892
42893 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
42894 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
42895 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
42896 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
42897 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
42898 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
42899 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
42900 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
42901 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
42902
42903 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
42904 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
42905 @samp{fpc}.
42906
42907 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
42908 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
42909
42910 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
42911 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
42912 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
42913 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
42914 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
42915 32-bit wide.
42916
42917 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
42918 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
42919 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
42920
42921 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
42922 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
42923 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
42924 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
42925 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
42926 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
42927 @samp{v31}.
42928
42929 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
42930 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
42931 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
42932
42933 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
42934 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
42935 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
42936
42937 @node Sparc Features
42938 @subsection Sparc Features
42939 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
42940 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
42941 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42942 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42943
42944 @itemize @minus
42945 @item
42946 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
42947 @item
42948 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
42949 @item
42950 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
42951 @item
42952 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
42953 @end itemize
42954
42955 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42956
42957 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42958 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42959
42960 @itemize @minus
42961 @item
42962 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
42963 @item
42964 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
42965 @end itemize
42966
42967 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42968 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42969
42970 @itemize @minus
42971 @item
42972 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
42973 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
42974 @item
42975 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
42976 for sparc64
42977 @end itemize
42978
42979 @node TIC6x Features
42980 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
42981 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
42982 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
42983 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
42984 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
42985 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
42986
42987 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
42988 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
42989 through @samp{B31}.
42990
42991 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
42992 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
42993
42994 @node Operating System Information
42995 @appendix Operating System Information
42996 @cindex operating system information
42997
42998 @menu
42999 * Process list::
43000 @end menu
43001
43002 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
43003 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
43004 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
43005 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
43006 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
43007 on a different aspect of target.
43008
43009 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
43010 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
43011 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
43012 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
43013
43014 @node Process list
43015 @appendixsection Process list
43016 @cindex operating system information, process list
43017
43018 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
43019 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
43020 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
43021 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
43022
43023 An example document is:
43024
43025 @smallexample
43026 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43027 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
43028 <osdata type="processes">
43029 <item>
43030 <column name="pid">1</column>
43031 <column name="user">root</column>
43032 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
43033 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
43034 </item>
43035 </osdata>
43036 @end smallexample
43037
43038 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
43039 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
43040 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
43041 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
43042 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
43043 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
43044 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
43045
43046 @node Trace File Format
43047 @appendix Trace File Format
43048 @cindex trace file format
43049
43050 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
43051 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
43052
43053 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
43054 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
43055 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
43056 in the future.
43057
43058 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
43059 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
43060 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
43061 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
43062 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
43063 of this section.
43064
43065 @table @code
43066 @item R @var{size}
43067 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
43068 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
43069 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
43070 a single trace file.
43071
43072 @item status @var{status}
43073 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
43074 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
43075 file.
43076
43077 @item tp @var{payload}
43078 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43079 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
43080 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43081 reply packets.
43082
43083 @item tsv @var{payload}
43084 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43085 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
43086 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43087 reply packets.
43088
43089 @item tdesc @var{payload}
43090 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
43091 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
43092 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
43093 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
43094 file. Includes are not allowed.
43095
43096 @end table
43097
43098 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
43099 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
43100 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
43101 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
43102 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
43103 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
43104 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
43105 endianness.
43106
43107 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
43108
43109 @table @code
43110 @item R @var{bytes}
43111 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
43112 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
43113 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
43114
43115 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
43116 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
43117 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
43118 @var{length} bytes.
43119
43120 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
43121 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
43122 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
43123
43124 @end table
43125
43126 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
43127 of blocks.
43128
43129 @node Index Section Format
43130 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
43131 @cindex .gdb_index section format
43132 @cindex index section format
43133
43134 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
43135 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
43136 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
43137 description.
43138
43139 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
43140 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
43141 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
43142 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
43143 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
43144 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
43145
43146 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
43147
43148 @enumerate
43149 @item
43150 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
43151 unless otherwise noted:
43152
43153 @enumerate
43154 @item
43155 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
43156 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
43157 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
43158 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
43159 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
43160 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
43161 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
43162
43163 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
43164 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
43165 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
43166 currently not flagged as deprecated.
43167
43168 @item
43169 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
43170
43171 @item
43172 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
43173 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
43174 to the next offset.
43175
43176 @item
43177 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
43178
43179 @item
43180 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
43181
43182 @item
43183 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
43184 @end enumerate
43185
43186 @item
43187 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
43188 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
43189 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
43190 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
43191 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
43192 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
43193 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
43194 CU indices.
43195
43196 @item
43197 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
43198 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
43199 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
43200 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
43201
43202 @item
43203 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
43204 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
43205
43206 @enumerate
43207 @item
43208 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
43209
43210 @item
43211 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
43212 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
43213
43214 @item
43215 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
43216 @end enumerate
43217
43218 @item
43219 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
43220 the hash table is always a power of 2.
43221
43222 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
43223 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
43224 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
43225 constant pool.
43226
43227 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
43228 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
43229 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
43230
43231 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
43232 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
43233 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
43234 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
43235 index version:
43236
43237 @table @asis
43238 @item Version 4
43239 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
43240
43241 @item Versions 5 to 7
43242 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
43243 @end table
43244
43245 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
43246
43247 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
43248 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
43249 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
43250 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
43251 collision.
43252
43253 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
43254 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
43255 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
43256 the code.
43257
43258 @item
43259 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
43260 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
43261 strings.
43262
43263 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
43264 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
43265 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
43266 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
43267 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
43268 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
43269
43270 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
43271 @end enumerate
43272
43273 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
43274 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
43275 CU index+attributes value for each use.
43276
43277 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
43278 (bit 0 = LSB):
43279
43280 @table @asis
43281
43282 @item Bits 0-23
43283 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
43284 @item Bits 24-27
43285 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
43286 @item Bits 28-30
43287 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
43288
43289 @table @asis
43290 @item 0
43291 This value is reserved and should not be used.
43292 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
43293 with previous versions of the index.
43294 @item 1
43295 The symbol is a type.
43296 @item 2
43297 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
43298 @item 3
43299 The symbol is a function.
43300 @item 4
43301 Any other kind of symbol.
43302 @item 5,6,7
43303 These values are reserved.
43304 @end table
43305
43306 @item Bit 31
43307 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
43308
43309 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
43310 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
43311 @value{GDBN} sources.
43312
43313 @end table
43314
43315 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
43316 global/static attributes in the index.
43317
43318 @smallexample
43319 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
43320 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
43321 switch (die->tag)
43322 @{
43323 case DW_TAG_typedef:
43324 case DW_TAG_base_type:
43325 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
43326 kind = TYPE;
43327 is_static = 1;
43328 break;
43329 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
43330 kind = VARIABLE;
43331 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43332 break;
43333 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
43334 kind = FUNCTION;
43335 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
43336 break;
43337 case DW_TAG_constant:
43338 kind = VARIABLE;
43339 is_static = ! is_external;
43340 break;
43341 case DW_TAG_variable:
43342 kind = VARIABLE;
43343 is_static = ! is_external;
43344 break;
43345 case DW_TAG_namespace:
43346 kind = TYPE;
43347 is_static = 0;
43348 break;
43349 case DW_TAG_class_type:
43350 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
43351 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
43352 case DW_TAG_union_type:
43353 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
43354 kind = TYPE;
43355 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43356 break;
43357 default:
43358 assert (0);
43359 @}
43360 @end smallexample
43361
43362 @node Man Pages
43363 @appendix Manual pages
43364 @cindex Man pages
43365
43366 @menu
43367 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
43368 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
43369 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
43370 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
43371 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
43372 @end menu
43373
43374 @node gdb man
43375 @heading gdb man
43376
43377 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
43378
43379 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
43380 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
43381 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
43382 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
43383 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
43384 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
43385 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
43386 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
43387 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
43388 @c man end
43389
43390 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
43391 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
43392 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
43393 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
43394
43395 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
43396 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
43397
43398 @itemize @bullet
43399 @item
43400 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
43401
43402 @item
43403 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
43404
43405 @item
43406 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
43407
43408 @item
43409 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
43410 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
43411 @end itemize
43412
43413 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
43414 Modula-2.
43415
43416 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
43417 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
43418 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
43419 by using the command @code{help}.
43420
43421 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
43422 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
43423 executable program as the argument:
43424
43425 @smallexample
43426 gdb program
43427 @end smallexample
43428
43429 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
43430
43431 @smallexample
43432 gdb program core
43433 @end smallexample
43434
43435 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
43436 to debug a running process:
43437
43438 @smallexample
43439 gdb program 1234
43440 gdb -p 1234
43441 @end smallexample
43442
43443 @noindent
43444 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
43445 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
43446 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
43447
43448 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
43449
43450 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
43451 @table @env
43452 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43453 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
43454
43455 @item run [@var{arglist}]
43456 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
43457
43458 @item bt
43459 Backtrace: display the program stack.
43460
43461 @item print @var{expr}
43462 Display the value of an expression.
43463
43464 @item c
43465 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
43466
43467 @item next
43468 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
43469 function calls in the line.
43470
43471 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43472 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
43473
43474 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43475 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
43476
43477 @item step
43478 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
43479 function calls in the line.
43480
43481 @item help [@var{name}]
43482 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
43483 about using @value{GDBN}.
43484
43485 @item quit
43486 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
43487 @end table
43488
43489 @ifset man
43490 For full details on @value{GDBN},
43491 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43492 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
43493 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
43494 @end ifset
43495 @c man end
43496
43497 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
43498 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
43499 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
43500 encountered with no
43501 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
43502 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
43503 Many options have
43504 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
43505 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
43506 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
43507 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
43508 more usual convention.)
43509
43510 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
43511 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
43512 option is used.
43513
43514 @table @env
43515 @item -help
43516 @itemx -h
43517 List all options, with brief explanations.
43518
43519 @item -symbols=@var{file}
43520 @itemx -s @var{file}
43521 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
43522
43523 @item -write
43524 Enable writing into executable and core files.
43525
43526 @item -exec=@var{file}
43527 @itemx -e @var{file}
43528 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
43529 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
43530 dump.
43531
43532 @item -se=@var{file}
43533 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
43534 file.
43535
43536 @item -core=@var{file}
43537 @itemx -c @var{file}
43538 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
43539
43540 @item -command=@var{file}
43541 @itemx -x @var{file}
43542 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
43543
43544 @item -ex @var{command}
43545 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
43546
43547 @item -directory=@var{directory}
43548 @itemx -d @var{directory}
43549 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
43550
43551 @item -nh
43552 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
43553
43554 @item -nx
43555 @itemx -n
43556 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
43557
43558 @item -quiet
43559 @itemx -q
43560 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
43561 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
43562
43563 @item -batch
43564 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
43565 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
43566 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
43567 commands in the command files.
43568
43569 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
43570 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
43571 more useful, the message
43572
43573 @smallexample
43574 Program exited normally.
43575 @end smallexample
43576
43577 @noindent
43578 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
43579 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
43580
43581 @item -cd=@var{directory}
43582 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
43583 instead of the current directory.
43584
43585 @item -fullname
43586 @itemx -f
43587 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
43588 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
43589 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
43590 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
43591 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
43592 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
43593 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
43594 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
43595
43596 @item -b @var{bps}
43597 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
43598 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
43599
43600 @item -tty=@var{device}
43601 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
43602 @end table
43603 @c man end
43604
43605 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
43606 @ifset man
43607 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43608 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43609 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43610
43611 @smallexample
43612 info gdb
43613 @end smallexample
43614
43615 @noindent
43616 should give you access to the complete manual.
43617
43618 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43619 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43620 @end ifset
43621 @c man end
43622
43623 @node gdbserver man
43624 @heading gdbserver man
43625
43626 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
43627 @format
43628 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
43629 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43630
43631 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43632
43633 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43634 @c man end
43635 @end format
43636
43637 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
43638 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
43639 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
43640
43641 @ifclear man
43642 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
43643 @end ifclear
43644 @ifset man
43645 Usage (server (target) side):
43646 @end ifset
43647
43648 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
43649 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
43650 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
43651 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
43652
43653 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
43654 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
43655 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
43656
43657 @smallexample
43658 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
43659 @end smallexample
43660
43661 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
43662
43663 @smallexample
43664 @ifset man
43665 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
43666 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
43667 @end ifset
43668 @ifclear man
43669 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
43670 @end ifclear
43671 @end smallexample
43672
43673 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
43674 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
43675 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
43676
43677 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
43678
43679 @smallexample
43680 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
43681 @end smallexample
43682
43683 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
43684 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
43685 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
43686 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
43687 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
43688 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
43689 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
43690 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
43691 print an error message and exit.
43692
43693 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
43694 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
43695
43696 @smallexample
43697 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43698 @end smallexample
43699
43700 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
43701 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
43702
43703 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
43704 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
43705 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
43706 the program you want to debug.
43707
43708 @smallexample
43709 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43710 @end smallexample
43711
43712 @ifclear man
43713 @subheading Usage (host side)
43714 @end ifclear
43715 @ifset man
43716 Usage (host side):
43717 @end ifset
43718
43719 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
43720 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
43721 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
43722 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
43723 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
43724 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
43725 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
43726 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
43727 descriptor. For example:
43728
43729 @smallexample
43730 @ifset man
43731 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
43732 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
43733 @end ifset
43734 @ifclear man
43735 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
43736 @end ifclear
43737 @end smallexample
43738
43739 @noindent
43740 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
43741
43742 @smallexample
43743 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
43744 @end smallexample
43745
43746 @noindent
43747 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
43748 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
43749 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
43750 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
43751 `Connection refused'.
43752
43753 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
43754 described in
43755 @ifset man
43756 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
43757 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
43758 @end ifset
43759 @ifclear man
43760 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
43761 @end ifclear
43762 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
43763
43764 @smallexample
43765 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
43766 @end smallexample
43767
43768 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
43769 case.
43770 @c man end
43771
43772 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
43773 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
43774
43775 @itemize @bullet
43776
43777 @item
43778 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
43779
43780 @smallexample
43781 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43782 @end smallexample
43783
43784 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
43785 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
43786 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
43787 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
43788 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
43789 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
43790 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
43791
43792 @item
43793 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
43794 program:
43795
43796 @smallexample
43797 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43798 @end smallexample
43799
43800 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
43801 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
43802 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
43803 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
43804
43805 @item
43806 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
43807
43808 @smallexample
43809 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43810 @end smallexample
43811
43812 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
43813 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
43814 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
43815 debug several processes in the same session.
43816 @end itemize
43817
43818 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
43819
43820 @table @env
43821
43822 @item --help
43823 List all options, with brief explanations.
43824
43825 @item --version
43826 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
43827
43828 @item --attach
43829 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
43830
43831 @smallexample
43832 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43833 @end smallexample
43834
43835 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
43836 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
43837
43838 @item --multi
43839 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
43840 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
43841 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
43842 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
43843
43844 @smallexample
43845 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43846 @end smallexample
43847
43848 @item --debug
43849 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
43850 process.
43851 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
43852 the developers.
43853
43854 @item --remote-debug
43855 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
43856 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
43857 the developers.
43858
43859 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
43860 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
43861 of debugging output.
43862 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
43863
43864 @item --wrapper
43865 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
43866 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
43867 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
43868 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
43869
43870 @item --once
43871 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
43872 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
43873 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
43874 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
43875
43876 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
43877
43878 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
43879 @c QDisableRandomization.
43880
43881 @end table
43882 @c man end
43883
43884 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
43885 @ifset man
43886 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43887 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43888 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43889
43890 @smallexample
43891 info gdb
43892 @end smallexample
43893
43894 should give you access to the complete manual.
43895
43896 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43897 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43898 @end ifset
43899 @c man end
43900
43901 @node gcore man
43902 @heading gcore
43903
43904 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
43905
43906 @format
43907 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
43908 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
43909 @c man end
43910 @end format
43911
43912 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
43913 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
43914 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
43915 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
43916 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
43917 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
43918 its job the program remains running without any change.
43919 @c man end
43920
43921 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
43922 @table @env
43923 @item -a
43924 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
43925 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
43926 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
43927 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
43928 dump-excluded-mappings}).
43929
43930 @item -o @var{prefix}
43931 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
43932 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
43933 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
43934 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
43935 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
43936 @end table
43937 @c man end
43938
43939 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
43940 @ifset man
43941 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43942 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43943 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43944
43945 @smallexample
43946 info gdb
43947 @end smallexample
43948
43949 @noindent
43950 should give you access to the complete manual.
43951
43952 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43953 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43954 @end ifset
43955 @c man end
43956
43957 @node gdbinit man
43958 @heading gdbinit
43959
43960 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
43961
43962 @format
43963 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
43964 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43965 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43966 @end ifset
43967
43968 ~/.gdbinit
43969
43970 ./.gdbinit
43971 @c man end
43972 @end format
43973
43974 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
43975 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
43976 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
43977 described in
43978 @ifset man
43979 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
43980 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
43981 @end ifset
43982 @ifclear man
43983 @ref{Sequences}.
43984 @end ifclear
43985
43986 Please read more in
43987 @ifset man
43988 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
43989 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
43990 @end ifset
43991 @ifclear man
43992 @ref{Startup}.
43993 @end ifclear
43994
43995 @table @env
43996 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43997 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43998 @end ifset
43999 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44000 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
44001 @end ifclear
44002 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44003 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
44004 See more in
44005 @ifset man
44006 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
44007 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
44008 @end ifset
44009 @ifclear man
44010 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
44011 @end ifclear
44012
44013 @item ~/.gdbinit
44014 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44015 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
44016
44017 @item ./.gdbinit
44018 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
44019 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
44020 See more in
44021 @ifset man
44022 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
44023 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
44024 @end ifset
44025 @ifclear man
44026 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
44027 @end ifclear
44028 @end table
44029 @c man end
44030
44031 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
44032 @ifset man
44033 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
44034
44035 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44036 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44037 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44038
44039 @smallexample
44040 info gdb
44041 @end smallexample
44042
44043 should give you access to the complete manual.
44044
44045 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44046 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44047 @end ifset
44048 @c man end
44049
44050 @node gdb-add-index man
44051 @heading gdb-add-index
44052 @pindex gdb-add-index
44053 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
44054
44055 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
44056
44057 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
44058 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
44059 @c man end
44060
44061 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
44062 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
44063 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
44064 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
44065 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
44066 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
44067
44068 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
44069 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
44070 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
44071 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
44072 named @code{.debug_*}).
44073
44074 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
44075 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
44076 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
44077 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
44078
44079 See more in
44080 @ifset man
44081 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
44082 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
44083 @end ifset
44084 @ifclear man
44085 @ref{Index Files}.
44086 @end ifclear
44087 @c man end
44088
44089 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
44090 @ifset man
44091 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44092 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44093 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44094
44095 @smallexample
44096 info gdb
44097 @end smallexample
44098
44099 should give you access to the complete manual.
44100
44101 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44102 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44103 @end ifset
44104 @c man end
44105
44106 @include gpl.texi
44107
44108 @node GNU Free Documentation License
44109 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
44110 @include fdl.texi
44111
44112 @node Concept Index
44113 @unnumbered Concept Index
44114
44115 @printindex cp
44116
44117 @node Command and Variable Index
44118 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
44119
44120 @printindex fn
44121
44122 @tex
44123 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
44124 % meantime:
44125 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
44126 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
44127 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
44128 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
44129 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
44130 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
44131 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
44132 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
44133 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
44134 \page\colophon
44135 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
44136 @end tex
44137
44138 @bye
This page took 2.465583 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.